Quarterlytics / Basic Materials / Steel / Mesoblast / FY2017 Annual Report

Mesoblast
Annual Report 2017

MSB · ASX Basic Materials
Claim this profile
Ticker MSB
Exchange ASX
Sector Basic Materials
Industry Steel
Employees 51-200
← All annual reports
FY2017 Annual Report · Mesoblast
Loading PDF…
M

E

S

O

B

L

A

S

T

L

I

M

I

T

E

D

A

N

N

U

A

L

R

E

P

O

R

T

2

0

1

7

A world leader in
developing innovative
cellular medicines

 
 
 
 
CONTENTS

MESSAGE FROM THE CHAIRMAN 
FORM 20-F 

1
2
SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION  205
CORPORATE DIRECTORY  207

CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Mesoblast Limited and its Board of Directors are committed to implementing and achieving an effective corporate 
governance framework to ensure that the Company is managed effectively and in an honest and ethical way. 

The Company’s Corporate Governance statement for the financial year ending 30 June 2017 has been approved by 
the Board and is available on our website at http://www.mesoblast.com/company/corporate-governance

 
 
 
  
 
MESSAGE FROM THE CHAIRMAN

It is my pleasure to present the 2017  
Annual Report. 

The 2017 financial year saw Mesoblast continue to make 
substantial advances towards its goal of commercializing 
multiple cellular medicines. Our three most advanced programs 
are now approaching major inflection points.

In the coming months, we expect to have top-line results from 
our Phase 3 trial in acute graft versus host disease in children 
and for the end-stage chronic heart failure trial in patients 
requiring a left ventricular assist device (LVAD), which is being 
funded by the United States National Institutes of Health and 
the Canadian Health Research Institute. We also anticipate 
completing recruitment in our Phase 3 trial in chronic low back 
pain due to disc degeneration.

As these value accretive milestones approach, we intend to 
enter into strategic partnerships which will reflect the late-stage 
value of our product candidates. Additionally, we will seek to 
take advantage of potential benefits that may be available under 
the United States 21st Century Cures Act, notably those that 
may afford avenues to expedite development of regenerative 
medicines.

We will remain focused on allocating our resources towards 
achieving the key milestones that will deliver maximal 
shareholder value from our advanced product pipeline,  
while at the same time prudently managing spend.

Mesoblast’s global leadership in the development of innovative 
cellular medicines is underpinned by our team’s deep expertise 
in cellular pathways and mechanisms, our extensive intellectual 
property portfolio across all major markets, and our scalable 
industrialized manufacturing capabilities.

The varied and considerable experience of the Board is another 
significant asset for the Company and as we approach product 
commercialization, we will seek to complement the existing 
skill sets with additional international biopharmaceutical and 
commercial expertise.

I would like to thank Mesoblast’s Chief Executive, Dr Silviu 
Itescu, his management team and all the hardworking 
employees who have contributed to Mesoblast’s continued 
progress in bringing our product candidates to maturity. 

We remain grateful for the ongoing support and loyalty from our 
shareholders, and we look forward to updating you on further 
substantial progress which is expected in the coming year.

Brian Jamieson

Chairman

MESOBLAST LIMITED 2017 ANNUAL REPORT 1

 
FORM
20-F

as filed with the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) on August 30, 2017.

2  MESOBLAST LIMITED 2017 ANNUAL REPORT

 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

FORM 20-F

 REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES 

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE 

ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended June 30, 2017

OR

 TRANSITION  REPORT  PURSUANT  TO  SECTION  13  OR  15(d)  OF  THE  SECURITIES 

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

OR

 SHELL  COMPANY  REPORT  PURSUANT  TO  SECTION  13  OR  15(d)  OF  THE  SECURITIES 

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Date of event requiring this shell company report

For the transition period from                 to

Commission file number 001-37626

MESOBLAST LIMITED

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

N/A
(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)

AUSTRALIA
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

Level 38, 55 Collins Street
Melbourne, VIC, 3000, Australia
Telephone: +61 (3) 9639 6036
(Address of principal executive offices)

Silviu Itescu
Chief Executive Officer
Telephone: +61 (3) 9639 6036; Fax: +61 (3) 9639 6030
Level 38, 55 Collins Street
Melbourne, VIC, 3000, Australia
(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act. None

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

Title of each class
American Depositary Shares, each representing five
Ordinary Shares*

Name of each exchange on which registered
The NASDAQ Global Select Market

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period 

covered by the annual report.

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

428,221,398 Ordinary Shares

 Yes      No

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to 

Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

 Yes      No

Indicate  by  check  mark  whether  the  registrant  (1)  has  filed  all  reports  required  to  be  filed  by  Section  13  or  15(d)  of  the 
Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file 
such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

 Yes      No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every 
Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the 
preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

 Yes      No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer, or an 
emerging growth company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 
12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer  

Accelerated filer  


Non-accelerated filer
Emerging growth company 

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if 
the  registrant  has  elected  not  to  use  the  extended  transition  period  for  complying  with  any  new  or  revised  financial  accounting 
standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.

        

Indicate  by  check  mark  which  basis  of  accounting  the  registrant  has  used  to  prepare  the  financial  statements  included  in  this 

filing:

U.S. GAAP  

International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International 
Accounting Standards Board 



Other  

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the 

registrant has elected to follow.

Item 17      Item 18  

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the 

Exchange Act).

 Yes      No

Table of Contents

INTRODUCTION AND USE OF CERTAIN TERMS ............................................................................................................... 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS.................................................................................................................................... 

PART I.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 

Item 1.

Identity of Directors, Senior Management..................................................................................................... 

Item 2. Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable........................................................................................................ 

Item 3. Key Information............................................................................................................................................. 

3.A Selected Financial Data.................................................................................................................................. 

3.B Capitalization and Indebtedness .................................................................................................................... 

3.C Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds ..................................................................................................... 

3.D Risk Factors ................................................................................................................................................... 

Item 4.

Information on the Company ......................................................................................................................... 

4.A History and Development of Mesoblast ........................................................................................................ 

4.B Business Overview......................................................................................................................................... 

4.C Organizational Structure ................................................................................................................................ 

4.D Property, Plants and Equipment..................................................................................................................... 

Item 4A. Unresolved Staff Comments .......................................................................................................................... 

Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects............................................................................................. 

5.A Operating Results........................................................................................................................................... 

5.B Liquidity and Capital Resources.................................................................................................................... 

5.C Research and Development, Patents and Licenses ........................................................................................ 

5.D Trend Information.......................................................................................................................................... 

5.E Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements .................................................................................................................. 

5.F Contractual Obligations and Commitments................................................................................................... 

Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees............................................................................................. 

6.A Directors and Senior Management................................................................................................................. 

6.B Compensation ................................................................................................................................................ 

6.C Board Practices .............................................................................................................................................. 

6.D Employees...................................................................................................................................................... 

6.E Share Ownership............................................................................................................................................ 

Item 7. Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions ..................................................................................... 

7.A Major Shareholders........................................................................................................................................ 

7.B Related Party Transactions ............................................................................................................................ 

7.C Interests of Experts and Counsel.................................................................................................................... 

Item 8. Financial Information..................................................................................................................................... 

8.A Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information ........................................................................... 

8.B Significant Changes ....................................................................................................................................... 

2

2

4

4

4

4

4

5

5

5

36

36

39

68

68

68

68

68

88

91

91

91

91

92

93

99

115

117

118

119

119

120

120

120

120

120

Item 9. The Offer and Listing..................................................................................................................................... 

9.A Offer and Listing Details ............................................................................................................................... 

9.B Plan of Distribution........................................................................................................................................ 

9.C Markets .......................................................................................................................................................... 

9.D Selling Shareholders ...................................................................................................................................... 

9.E Dilution .......................................................................................................................................................... 

9.F Expenses of the Issue ..................................................................................................................................... 

Item 10. Additional Information .................................................................................................................................. 

10.A Share Capital.................................................................................................................................................. 

10.B Memorandum and Articles of Association .................................................................................................... 

10.C Material Contracts.......................................................................................................................................... 

10.D Exchange Controls ......................................................................................................................................... 

10.E Taxation ......................................................................................................................................................... 

10.F Dividends and Paying Agents........................................................................................................................ 

10.G Statement by Experts ..................................................................................................................................... 

10.H Documents on Display................................................................................................................................... 

10.I Subsidiary Information .................................................................................................................................. 

Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk........................................................................ 

Item 12. Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities ................................................................................. 

12.A Debt Securities ............................................................................................................................................... 

12.B Warrants and Rights....................................................................................................................................... 

12.C Other Securities.............................................................................................................................................. 

12.D American Depositary Shares.......................................................................................................................... 

PART II ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 

Item 13. Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies........................................................................................ 

Item 14. Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds ........................................... 

Item 15. Controls and Procedures ................................................................................................................................ 

Item 16A. Audit Committee Financial Expert ................................................................................................................ 

Item 16B. Code of Ethics................................................................................................................................................ 

Item 16C. Principal Accountant Fees and Services ........................................................................................................ 

Item 16D. Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees..................................................................... 

Item 16E. Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers........................................................ 

121

121

122

122

122

122

122

123

123

123

127

127

129

136

136

136

136

136

136

136

136

136

137

138

138

138

138

139

139

139

139

139

Item 16F. Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant .............................................................................................. 

 139

Item 16G. Corporate Governance ................................................................................................................................... 

Item 16H. Mine Safety Disclosure.................................................................................................................................. 

PART III ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 

Item 17. Financial Statements ...................................................................................................................................... 

Item 18. Financial Statements ...................................................................................................................................... 

Item 19. Exhibits .......................................................................................................................................................... 

SIGNATURES ............................................................................................................................................................................. 

139

140

140

140

140

202

204

INTRODUCTION AND USE OF CERTAIN TERMS

Mesoblast Limited and its consolidated subsidiaries publish consolidated financial statements expressed in U.S. dollars, unless 
otherwise  indicated.  Our  consolidated  financial  statements  found  in  Item  18  of  this  annual  report  on  Form  20-F  are  prepared  in 
accordance  with  International  Financial  Reporting  Standards  as  issued  by  the  International  Accounting  Standards  Board  and 
Australian equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the Australian Accounting Standards Board.

Except where the context requires otherwise and for purposes of this Form 20-F only:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

“ADSs”  refers  to  our  American  depositary  shares,  each  of  which  represents  ordinary  shares,  and  “ADRs”  refers  to  the
American depositary receipts that evidence our ADSs.

“Mesoblast,” “we,” “us” or “our” refer to Mesoblast Limited and its subsidiaries.

“A$” or “Australian dollar” refers to the legal currency of Australia.

“IFRS”  refers  to  the  International  Financial  Reporting  Standards  as  issued  by  the  International  Accounting  Standards
Board, or IASB.

“AIFRS” refers to the Australian equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the Australian
Accounting Standards Board, or AASB.

“U.S. GAAP” refers to the Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States.

“FDA” refers to the United States Food and Drug Administration.

“NIH” refers to the United States National Institutes of Health.

“US$” or “U.S. dollars” refers to the legal currency of the United States.

“U.S.” or “United States” refers to the United States of America.

Australian Disclosure Requirements

Our ordinary shares are primarily quoted on the Australian Securities Exchange (“ASX”) in addition to our listing of our ADSs on the 
Nasdaq Global Select Market. As part of our ASX listing, we are required to comply with various disclosure requirements as set out 
under  the  Australian  Corporations  Act  2001  and  the  ASX  Listing  Rules.  Information  furnished  under  the  sub-heading  “Australian 
Disclosure  Requirements”  is  intended  to  comply  with  ASX  listing  and  Corporations  Act  2001  disclosure  requirements  and  is  not 
intended to fulfill information required by this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Form 20-F includes forward-looking statements that relate to future events or our future financial performance and involve 
known  and  unknown  risks,  uncertainties  and  other  factors  that  may  cause  our  actual  results,  levels  of  activity,  performance  or 
achievements  to  differ  materially  from  any  future  results,  levels  of  activity,  performance  or  achievements  expressed  or  implied  by 
these forward-looking statements. Words such as, but not limited to, “believe,” “expect,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “intend,” “plan,” 
“targets,” “likely,” “will,” “would,” “could,” and similar expressions or phrases identify forward-looking statements. We have based 
these forward-looking statements largely on our current expectations and future events and financial trends that we believe may affect 
our financial condition, results of operation, business strategy and financial needs. Forward- looking statements include, but are not 
limited to, statements about:

•

•

•

•

•

•

the  initiation,  timing,  progress  and  results  of  our  preclinical  and  clinical  studies,  and  our  research  and  development
programs;

our ability to advance product candidates into, enroll and successfully complete, clinical studies, including multi-national
clinical trials;

our ability to advance our manufacturing capabilities;

the timing or likelihood of regulatory filings and approvals, manufacturing activities and product marketing activities, if
any;

the commercialization of our product candidates, if approved;

regulatory or public perceptions and market acceptance surrounding the use of stem-cell based therapies;

2

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

the  potential  for  our  product  candidates,  if  any  are  approved,  to  be  withdrawn  from  the  market  due  to  patient  adverse
events or deaths;

the potential benefits of strategic collaboration agreements and our ability to enter into and maintain established strategic
collaborations;

our ability to establish and maintain intellectual property on our product candidates and our ability to successfully defend
these in cases of alleged infringement;

the  scope  of  protection  we  are  able  to  establish  and  maintain  for  intellectual  property  rights  covering  our  product
candidates and technology;

estimates of our expenses, future revenues, capital requirements and our needs for additional financing;

our financial performance;

developments relating to our competitors and our industry;

the pricing and reimbursement of our product candidates, if approved; and

other risks and uncertainties, including those listed under the caption “Risk Factors”.

You should read thoroughly this Form 20-F and the documents that we refer to herein with the understanding that our actual 
future results may be materially different from and/or worse than what we expect. We qualify all of our forward-looking statements by 
these cautionary statements. Other sections of this Form 20-F include additional factors which could adversely impact our business 
and financial performance. Moreover, we operate in an evolving environment. New risk factors emerge from time to time and it is not 
possible for our management to predict all risk factors, nor can we assess the impact of all factors on our business or the extent to 
which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking 
statements.

This  Form  20-F  also  contains  third-party  data  relating  to  the  biopharmaceutical  market  that  includes  projections  based  on  a 
number of assumptions. The biopharmaceutical market may not grow at the rates projected by market data, or at all. The failure of this 
market  to  grow  at  the  projected  rates  may  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business  and  the  market  price  of  our  ADSs. 
Furthermore, if any one or more of the assumptions underlying the market data turns out to be incorrect, actual results may differ from 
the projections based on these assumptions. You should not place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements.

You should not rely upon forward-looking statements as predictions of future events. The forward-looking statements made in 
this Form 20-F relate only to events or information as of the date on which the statements are made in this Form 20-F. We undertake 
no obligation to update or revise any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

3

PART I

Item 1.

Identity of Directors, Senior Management

Not applicable.

Item 2.

Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Not applicable.

Item 3.

Key Information

3.A

Selected Financial Data

The  following  selected  consolidated  financial  data  presented  below  has  been  extracted  from  our  consolidated  financial 
statements prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB. Our consolidated financial statements for the years ended June 
30, 2017, 2016 and 2015 are included in “Item 18. Financial Statements” in this Form 20-F. 

The  summary  consolidated  financial  data  should  be  read  in  conjunction  with  “Item  5.  Operating  and  Financial  Review  and 
Prospects”  and  our  consolidated  financial  statements  and  related  notes  thereto.  Historical  results  are  not  necessarily  indicative  of 
results to be expected in the future.

(in thousands except per share information)
Consolidated Income Statement Data:
Revenue:

Commercialization revenue
Milestone revenue
Interest revenue

Total revenue

Research & development
Manufacturing commercialization
Management and administration
Fair value remeasurement of contingent 
consideration(1)
Impairment of intangible assets
Other operating income and expenses
Loss before income tax
Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss attributable to the owners of Mesoblast
   Limited

2017

2016

2015

2014

2013

Year ended June 30,

  $

 $

1,444 
500 
468 
2,412     

37,969    $
3,500     
1,079     
42,548     

15,004    $
2,000     
2,757     
19,761     

15,004    $
—     
8,386     
23,390     

18,685 
— 
10,616 
29,301 

(58,914)    
(12,065)    
(23,007)    

(50,013)    
(29,763)    
(22,500)    

(62,649)    
(23,783)    
(29,540)    

(50,929)    
(25,434)    
(24,403)    

(48,513)
(23,082)
(22,899)

(130)    

28,112 

(15,336)

(4,327)

— 

—     
1,489     
(90,215)    
13,400     

(61,919)    
2,714     
(90,821)    
86,694     

—     
15,303     
(96,244)    
—     

—     
6,173     
(75,530)    
(4)    

— 
4,543 
(60,650)
(1,470)

$

(76,815)

$

(4,127)   $

(96,244)   $

(75,534)   $

(62,120)

Losses per share from continuing operations attributable to the
   ordinary equity holders:
Basic - losses per share
Diluted - losses per share

Cents

Cents

Cents

Cents

Cents

(19.43)
(19.43)

(1.14)    
(1.14)    

(29.99)    
(29.99)    

(23.65)    
(23.65)    

(21.02)
(21.02)

(1) For the year ended June 30, 2017 the Group identified an opportunity to enhance the presentation of the Fair value 

remeasurement of contingent consideration and associated unwinding of the discount rate recorded within Finance costs in the 
Consolidated Income Statement. The Group considered that the change in contingent consideration is primarily due to changes in 
assumptions about the settlement of the contingent consideration and these line items in the Consolidated Income Statement 
should therefore be reported in aggregate, to provide more relevant information to the users of the financial statements. This 
change in presentation has been retrospectively applied to the years ended June 30, 2016, 2015, 2014 and 2013.

4

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
      
      
      
      
  
 
 
  
  
      
      
      
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
      
      
      
      
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
       
       
       
       
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
2017

2016

As of June 30,
2015

2014

2013

45,761 
63,609 
655,686 
36,670 
138,920 

80,937 
88,823 
684,018 
29,415 
155,857 

110,701 
122,460 
781,766 
48,407 
313,779 

185,003 
191,931 
847,153 
40,199 
308,594 

292,449 
307,789 
819,663 
46,921 
235,071 

830,425 
31,243 
(344,902)
516,766 

770,272 
25,976 
(268,087)
528,161 

709,191 
22,756 
(263,960)
467,987 

662,722 
43,553 
(167,716)
538,559 

642,378 
34,396 
(92,182)
584,592

2017

2016

Year ended June 30,
2015

2014

2013

(95,471)
142 
60,005 

(87,996)
(1,727)
62,066 

(101,036)
(5,064)
45,852 

(74,906)
(38,202)
2,196 

(55,746)
(4,801)
174,415 

(35,324)

(27,657)

(60,248)

(110,912)

113,868

(in thousands except shares information)
Consolidated Balance Sheet Data:
Cash and cash equivalents
Total current assets
Total assets
Total current liabilities
Total liabilities
Equity:

Issued capital (428,221,398; 381,363,137;
   336,997,729; 321,640,094 and 316,468,901
   ordinary shares (no par value) issued as of
   June 30, 2017, 2016,  2015, 2014 and 2013, 
respectively)
Reserves
(Accumulated loss)/retained earnings

Total equity

(in thousands)
Cash Flow Data:
Net cash (outflows) in operating activities
Net cash inflows/(outflows) in investing activities
Net cash inflows in financing activities
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash 
equivalents

3.B

Capitalization and Indebtedness

Not applicable.

3.C

Reasons for the offer and use of proceeds

Not applicable.

3.D Risk Factors

You should carefully consider the risks described below and all other information contained in this Annual Report on Form 20-F 
before  making  an  investment  decision.  If  any  of  the  following  risks  actually  occur,  our  business,  financial  condition  and  results  of 
operations could be materially and adversely affected. In that event, the trading price of our ADSs could decline, and you may lose 
part or all of your investment. This Annual Report on Form 20-F also contains forward-looking information that involves risks and 
uncertainties. Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of many 
factors, including the risks described below and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

Risks Related to Our Financial Position and Capital Requirements

We have incurred operating losses since our inception and anticipate that we will continue to incur substantial operating losses for 
the foreseeable future. We may never achieve or sustain profitability.

We are a clinical-stage biotechnology company and we have not yet generated significant revenues. We have incurred net losses 
during most of our fiscal periods since our inception. For the year ended June 30, 2017, we had a comprehensive loss of $76.5 million. 
Our  net  loss  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  was  $76.8 million.  As  of  June  30,  2017,  we  have  an  accumulated  deficit  of 
$344.9 million since our inception. We do not know whether or when we will become profitable. Our losses have resulted principally 
from costs incurred in our manufacturing and clinical development activities.

We anticipate that our expenses will increase in the future as we move toward commercialization, including the scaling up of 
our manufacturing activities. Biopharmaceutical product development is a highly speculative undertaking and involves a substantial 
degree  of  risk.  To  achieve  and  maintain  profitability,  we  must  successfully  develop  our  product  candidates,  obtain  regulatory 

5

approval, and manufacture, market and sell those products for which we obtain regulatory approval. If we obtain regulatory approval 
to  market  a  product  candidate,  our  future  revenue  will  depend  upon  the  size  of  any  markets  in  which  our  product  candidates  may 
receive  approval,  and  our  ability  to  achieve  sufficient  market  acceptance,  pricing,  reimbursement  from  third-party  payors,  and 
adequate market share for our product candidates in those markets. We may not succeed in these activities, and we may never generate 
revenue  from  product  sales  that  is  significant  enough  to  achieve  profitability.  Our  failure  to  become  or  remain  profitable  would 
depress  our  market  value  and  could  impair  our  ability  to  raise  capital,  expand  our  business,  discover  or  develop  other  product 
candidates or continue our operations. A decline in the value of our company could cause you to lose part or all of your investment.

We have never generated any revenue from product sales and may never be profitable.

Our  ability  to  generate  revenue  and  achieve  profitability  depends  on  our  ability,  either  alone  or  with  strategic  collaboration 
partners, to successfully complete the development of, and obtain the regulatory approvals necessary to commercialize, our product 
candidates. We do not anticipate generating revenues from product sales for the foreseeable future (other than licensing revenue from 
sales of TEMCELL® HS. Inj. (“TEMCELL”), a registered trademark of   JCR Pharmaceuticals Co., Ltd. (“JCR”), by JCR in Japan), 
and we may never generate product sales. Our ability to generate future revenues from product sales depends heavily on our success in 
a number of areas, including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

completing research and preclinical and clinical development of our product candidates;

seeking and obtaining regulatory and marketing approvals for product candidates for which we complete clinical studies;

establishing  and  maintaining  supply  and  manufacturing  relationships  with  third  parties  that  can  provide  adequate  (in
amount  and  quality)  products  and  services  to  support  clinical  development  and  the  market  demand  for  our  product
candidates, if approved;

launching  and  commercializing  product  candidates  for  which  we  obtain  regulatory  and  marketing  approval,  either  by
collaborating  with  a  partner  or,  if  launched  independently,  by  establishing  a  sales  force,  marketing  and  distribution
infrastructure;

obtaining market acceptance of our product candidates and stem cell therapy as a viable treatment option;

addressing any competing technological and market developments;

obtaining and sustaining an adequate level of reimbursement from payors;

identifying and validating new stem cell therapy product candidates;

negotiating favorable terms in any collaboration, licensing or other arrangements into which we may enter;

maintaining,  protecting  and  expanding  our  portfolio  of  intellectual  property  rights,  including  patents,  trade  secrets  and
know-how;

attracting, hiring and retaining qualified personnel; and

implementing additional internal systems and infrastructure, as needed.

Even  if  one  or  more  of  the  product  candidates  that  we  develop  is  approved  for  commercial  sale,  we  anticipate  incurring 
significant costs associated with commercializing any approved product candidate. Our expenses could increase beyond expectations 
if we are required by the United States Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”), the European Medicines Agency (“EMA”), or other 
regulatory  agencies, domestic or foreign, to  perform  clinical  and  other studies in addition  to  those  that  we currently  anticipate.  We 
may not become profitable and may need to obtain additional funding to continue operations.

We  require  substantial  additional  financing  to  achieve  our  goals,  and  our  failure  to  obtain  this  necessary  capital  when  needed 
could force us to delay, limit, reduce or terminate our product development or commercialization efforts.

Our operations have consumed substantial amounts of cash since inception. As of June 30, 2017, our cash and cash equivalents 
were $45.8 million. We expect to continue to incur significant expenses and increasing operating losses for the foreseeable future in 
connection  with  our  planned  research,  development  and  product  commercialization  efforts.  In  addition,  we  will  require  additional 
financing to achieve our goals and our failure to do so could adversely affect our commercialization efforts. We anticipate that our 
expenses will increase if and as we:

•

•

continue the research and clinical development of our product candidates, including MPC-150-IM (Class II-IV Congestive
Heart Failure (“CHF”)), MPC-06-ID (Chronic Low Back Pain (“CLBP”)), MSC-100-IV (acute Graft versus Host Disease
(“aGVHD”)) and MPC-300-IV (inflammatory conditions) product candidates;

initiate and advance our product candidates into larger and more expensive clinical studies;

6

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

seek to identify, assess, acquire, and/or develop other product candidates and technologies;

seek  regulatory  and  marketing  approvals  in  multiple  jurisdictions  for  our  product  candidates  that  successfully  complete 
clinical studies;

establish  collaborations  with  third  parties  for  the  development  and  commercialization  of  our  product  candidates,  or 
otherwise build and maintain a sales, marketing and distribution infrastructure to commercialize any products for which 
we may obtain marketing approval;

further  develop  and  implement  our  proprietary  manufacturing  processes  in  both  planar  technology  and  our  bioreactor 
programs and expand our manufacturing capabilities and resources for commercial production;

seek coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, including government and private payors for future products;

make  milestone  or  other  payments  under  our  agreements  pursuant  to  which  we  have  licensed  or  acquired  rights  to 
intellectual property and technology;

seek to maintain, protect and expand our intellectual property portfolio; and

seek to attract and retain skilled personnel.

If  we  were  to  experience  any  delays  or  encounter  issues  with  any  of  the  above,  including  clinical  holds,  failed  studies, 
inconclusive  or  complex  results,  safety  or  efficacy  issues,  or  other  regulatory  challenges  that  require  longer  follow-up  of  existing 
studies, additional studies, or additional supportive studies in order to pursue marketing approval, it could further increase the costs 
associated with the above. Further, the net operating losses we incur may fluctuate significantly from quarter to quarter and year to 
year, such that a period-to-period comparison of our results of operations may not be a good indication of our future performance.

To the extent that we raise additional capital through the sale of equity or convertible debt securities, your ownership interest 
may be diluted, and the terms of these securities may include liquidation or other preferences that adversely affect your rights as a 
shareholder  or  as  a  holder  of  the  ADSs.  Debt  financing,  if  available,  may  involve  agreements  that  include  covenants  limiting  or 
restricting our ability to take certain actions, such as incurring additional debt, making capital expenditures or declaring dividends. If 
we  raise  additional  funds  through  collaborations,  strategic  collaborations  or  partnerships,  or  marketing,  distribution  or  licensing 
arrangements with third parties, we may be required to do so at an earlier stage than would otherwise be ideal and/or may have to limit 
valuable rights to our intellectual property, technologies, product candidates or future revenue streams, or grant licenses or other rights 
on terms that are not favorable to us. Furthermore, any additional fundraising efforts may divert our management from their day-to-
day activities, which may adversely affect our ability to develop and commercialize our product candidates.

As described in Note 1(ii) of our accompanying financial statements, our continuing viability and our ability to continue as a 
going concern and meet our debts and commitments as they fall due are dependent upon entering into an arrangement with a third 
party  partner  on  one  or  more  of  our  four  Tier  1  product  candidates  that  would  result  in  non-dilutive  funding  and/or  raising  further 
capital,  together  with  various  cost  containment  and  deferment  strategies  being  completed  including  the  reprioritization  of  certain 
projects.

Management  and  the  directors  believe  that  we  will  be  successful  in  the  above  matters  and,  accordingly,  have  prepared  the 
financial report on a going concern basis, notwithstanding that there is a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt on our 
ability to continue as a going concern and that we may be unable to realize our assets and liabilities in the normal course of business. 
Our  financial statements  do not include any adjustments that  may result from the outcome of  this  uncertainty.   If we are unable to 
obtain adequate funding or partnerships in the future, we may not be able to continue as a going concern, and our shareholders and 
holders of the ADSs may lose some or all of their investment in us.

Risks Related to Clinical Development and Regulatory Review and Approval of Our Product Candidates

Our  product  candidates  are  based  on  our  novel  mesenchymal  lineage  adult  stem  cells  (“MLC”)  technology,  which  makes  it 
difficult  to  accurately  and  reliably  predict  the  time  and  cost  of  product  development  and  subsequently  obtaining  regulatory 
approval. At the moment, no industrially manufactured stem cell products have been approved in the United States.

Other than with respect to sales of TEMCELL by our licensee JCR in Japan, we have not commercially marketed, distributed or 
sold  any  products,  either  ourselves  or  through  a  licensee.  The  success  of  our  business  depends  on  our  ability  to  develop  and 
commercialize  our  lead  product  candidates.  We  have  concentrated  our  product  research  and  development  efforts  on  our  MLC 
platform, a novel type of stem cell therapy. Our future success depends on the successful development of this therapeutic approach. 
There can be no assurance that any development problems we experience in the future related to our MLC platform will not cause 
significant  delays  or  unanticipated  costs,  or  that  such  development  problems  can  be  solved.  We  may  also  experience  delays  in 
developing sustainable, reproducible and scalable manufacturing processes or transferring these processes to collaborators, which may 
prevent us from completing our clinical studies or commercializing our products on a timely or profitable basis, if at all.

7

In addition, the clinical study requirements of the FDA, the EMA and other regulatory agencies and the criteria these regulators 
use  to  determine  the  safety  and  efficacy  of  a  product  candidate  vary  substantially  according  to  the  type,  complexity,  novelty  and 
intended  use  and  market  of  the  potential  product  candidates.  The  regulatory  approval  process  for  novel  product  candidates  such  as 
ours  can  be  more  expensive  and  take  longer  than  other,  better  known  or  extensively  studied  pharmaceutical  or  other  product 
candidates to develop. In addition, adverse developments in clinical trials of cell therapy products conducted by others may cause the 
FDA or other regulatory bodies to change the requirements for approval of any of our product candidates. At the moment, no other 
industrially manufactured stem cell products have been approved in the United States, which makes it difficult to determine how long 
it will take or how much it will cost to obtain regulatory approvals for our product candidates in either the United States or elsewhere.

We may fail to demonstrate safety and efficacy to the satisfaction of applicable regulatory agencies.

Other  than  with  respect  to  TEMCELL  our  licensed  product  in  Japan,  we  have  not  obtained  any  regulatory  approvals  for  a 
product,  either  ourselves  or  through  a  licensee.  We  must  conduct  extensive  testing  of  our  product  candidates  to  demonstrate  their 
safety and efficacy, including both preclinical animal testing and human clinical trials, before we can obtain regulatory approval to 
market and sell them. Conducting such testing is a lengthy, time-consuming, and expensive process and there is a high rate of failure. 
Our current and completed preclinical and clinical results for our product candidates are not necessarily predictive of the results of our 
ongoing or future clinical trials. Promising results in preclinical studies of a product candidate may not be predictive of similar results 
in humans during clinical trials, and successful results from early human clinical trials of a product candidate may not be replicated in 
later and larger human clinical trials or in clinical trials for different indications. If the results of our or our collaborators’ ongoing or 
future clinical trials are negative or inconclusive with respect to the efficacy of our product candidates or if we or they do not meet the 
clinical endpoints with statistical significance or if there are safety concerns or adverse events associated with our product candidates, 
we or our collaborators may be prevented or delayed in obtaining marketing approval for our product candidates.  Even if ongoing or 
future clinical studies meet the clinical endpoints with statistical significance, the FDA or other regulatory agencies may still find the 
data insufficient for marketing approval based on other factors.

We may encounter substantial delays in our clinical studies.

We cannot guarantee that any preclinical testing or clinical trials will be conducted as planned or completed on schedule, if at 
all.  As  a  result,  we  may  not  achieve  our  expected  clinical  milestones.  A  failure  can  occur  at  any  stage  of  testing.  Events  that  may 
prevent successful or timely commencement, enrollment or completion of clinical development include:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

problems which may arise as a result of our transition of the Phase 3 CHF trial from Teva Pharmaceutical Industries Ltd;

delays in raising, or inability to raise, sufficient capital to fund the planned trials;

delays by us or our collaborators in reaching a consensus with regulatory agencies on trial design;

changes in trial design;

inability to identify, recruit and train suitable clinical investigators;

inability to add new clinical trial sites;

delays  in  reaching  agreement  on  acceptable  terms  for  the  performance  of  the  trials  with  prospective  clinical  research 
organizations (“CROs”), and clinical trial sites;

delays in obtaining required Institutional Review Board (“IRB”), approval at each clinical trial site;

delays in recruiting suitable clinical sites and patients (i.e., subjects) to participate in clinical trials;

imposition of a clinical hold by regulatory agencies for any reason, including negative clinical results, safety concerns or 
as a result of an inspection of manufacturing or clinical operations or trial sites;

failure by CROs, other third parties or us or our collaborators to adhere to clinical trial requirements;

failure  to  perform  in  accordance  with  the  FDA’s  current  Good  Clinical  Practices  (“cGCP”),  or  applicable  regulatory 
guidelines in other countries;

delays in the testing, validation, manufacturing and delivery of the product candidates to the clinical sites;

delays caused by patients not completing participation in a trial or not returning for post-treatment follow-up;

delays caused by clinical trial sites not completing a trial;

failure to demonstrate adequate efficacy;

8

•

•

•

occurrence of serious adverse events in clinical trials that are associated with the product candidates that are viewed to 
outweigh its potential benefits;

changes in regulatory requirements and guidance that require amending or submitting new clinical protocols; or

disagreements  between  us  and  the  FDA  or  other  regulatory  agencies  regarding  a  clinical  trial  design,  protocol 
amendments, or interpreting the data from our clinical trials.

Delays, including delays caused by the above factors, can be costly and could negatively affect our or our collaborators’ ability 
to complete clinical trials for our product candidates. If we or our collaborators are not able to successfully complete clinical trials or 
are not able to do so in a timely and cost-effective manner, we will not be able to obtain regulatory approval and/or will not be able to 
commercialize our product candidates and our commercial partnering opportunities will be harmed.

We may find it difficult to enroll patients in our clinical trials, especially for indications such as aGVHD which are designated as 
orphan or niche markets, which could delay or prevent development of our product candidates.

Identifying and qualifying patients to participate in clinical trials of our product candidates is critical to our success. The timing 
of our clinical trials depends on the speed at which we can recruit patients to participate in testing our product candidates as well as 
completion of required follow-up periods. In general, if patients are unwilling to participate in our stem cell therapy trials because of 
negative publicity from adverse events in the biotechnology or stem cell industries or for other reasons, including competitive clinical 
trials for similar patient populations, the timeline for recruiting patients, conducting trials and obtaining regulatory approval for our 
product candidates may be delayed. More specifically, certain of our product candidates, including MSC-100-IV for aGVHD, target 
indications  with  relatively  small  patient  populations,  which  can  prolong  the  clinical  trial  timeline  for  the  regulatory  process  if 
sufficient patients cannot be enrolled in a timely manner. As a result, we or our collaborators generally will have to run multi-site and 
potentially multi-national trials, which can be time consuming, expensive and require close coordination and supervision. If we have 
difficulty enrolling a sufficient number of patients or otherwise conducting clinical trials as planned, we or our collaborators may need 
to delay, limit or terminate ongoing or planned clinical trials, any of which would have an adverse effect on our business.

In addition, our planned clinical trials targeting more prevalent indications, such as our product candidates for CLBP, MPC-06-
ID, and CHF, MPC-150-IM, may require the recruitment of several thousand patients. If there are delays in accumulating the required 
number of trial subjects or, in trials where clinical events are a primary endpoint, there may be delays in completing the trial. These 
delays  could  result  in  increased  costs,  delays  in  advancing  development  of  our  product  candidates,  including  delays  in  testing  the 
effectiveness, or even termination of the clinical trials altogether.

Patient enrollment and completion of clinical trials are affected by factors including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

size of the patient population, particularly in orphan diseases;

severity of the disease under investigation;

design of the trial protocol;

eligibility criteria for the particular trial;

perceived risks and benefits of the product candidate being tested;

proximity and availability of clinical trial sites for prospective patients;

availability of competing therapies and clinical trials;

efforts to facilitate timely enrollment in clinical trials;

patient referral practices of physicians;

ability to monitor patients adequately during and after treatment; and

the degree of treatment effect in event-driven trials.

Once enrolled, patients may choose to discontinue their participation at any time during the trial, for any reason. Participants 
also  may  be  terminated  from  the  study  at  the  initiative  of  the  investigator,  for  example  if  they  experience  serious  adverse  clinical 
events or do not follow the study directions. If we are unable to maintain an adequate number of patients in our clinical trials, we may 
be required to delay or terminate an ongoing clinical trial, which would have an adverse effect on our business.

9

We may participate in multinational clinical trials, which present additional and unique risks.

We plan to seek initial marketing approval for our product candidates in the United States and in select non-U.S. jurisdictions 
such as Europe, Japan and Canada. Conducting trials on a multinational basis requires collaboration with foreign medical institutions 
and  healthcare  providers.  Our  ability  to  successfully  initiate,  enroll  and  complete  a  clinical  trial  in  multiple  countries  is  subject  to 
numerous risks unique to conducting business internationally, including:

•

•

•

•

•

difficulty in establishing or managing relationships with physicians and CROs;

standards within different jurisdictions for conducting clinical trials and resulting patients;

our inability to locate qualified local consultants, physicians and partners;

the  potential  burden  of  complying  with  a  variety  of  foreign  laws,  medical  standards  and  regulatory  requirements, 
including the regulation of pharmaceutical and biotechnology products and treatments; and

differing genotypes, average body weights and other patient profiles within and across countries from our donor profile 
may impact the optimal dosing or may otherwise impact the results of our clinical trials.

Serious adverse events or other safety risks could require us to abandon development and preclude, delay or limit approval of our 
product candidates, or limit the scope of any approved indication or market acceptance.

Participants in clinical trials of our investigational stem cell products may experience adverse reactions or other undesirable side 
effects. While some of these can be anticipated, others may be unexpected. We cannot predict the frequency, duration, or severity of 
adverse  reactions  or  undesirable  side  effects  that  may  occur  during  clinical  investigation  of  our  product  candidates.  If  any  of  our 
product candidates, prior to or after any approval for commercial sale, cause adverse events or are associated with other safety risks, a 
number of potentially significant negative consequences could result, including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

regulatory authorities may suspend (e.g., through a clinical hold) or terminate clinical trials;

regulatory authorities may deny regulatory approval of our product candidates;

regulators may restrict the indications or patient populations for which a product candidate is approved;

regulatory authorities may require certain labeling statements, such as warnings or contraindications or limitations on the 
indications  for  use,  and/or  impose  restrictions  on  distribution  in  the  form  of  a  risk  evaluation  and  mitigation  strategy 
(“REMS”), in connection with approval, if any;

regulatory authorities may withdraw their approval, require more onerous labeling statements or impose a more restrictive 
REMS than any product that is approved;

we may be required to change the way the product is administered or conduct additional clinical trials;

patient recruitment into our clinical trials may suffer;

our relationships with our collaborators may suffer;

we could be required to provide compensation to subjects for their injuries, e.g., if we are sued and found to be liable or if 
required by the laws of the relevant jurisdiction or by the policies of the clinical site; or

our reputation may suffer.

There can be no assurance that adverse events associated with our product candidates will not be observed, even where no prior 
adverse events have occurred. As is typical in clinical development, we have a program of ongoing toxicology studies in animals for 
our other clinical-stage product candidates and cannot provide assurance that the findings from such studies or any ongoing or future 
clinical trials will not adversely affect our clinical development activities.

We may voluntarily suspend or terminate our clinical trials if at any time we believe that they present an unacceptable risk to 
participants or if preliminary data demonstrate that our product candidates are unlikely to receive regulatory approval or unlikely to be 
successfully commercialized. In addition, regulatory agencies, IRBs or data safety monitoring boards may at any time recommend the 
temporary or permanent discontinuation of our clinical trials or request that we cease using investigators in the clinical trials if they 
believe that the clinical trials are not being conducted in accordance with applicable regulatory requirements, or that they present an 
unacceptable  safety  risk  to  participants.  If  we  elect  or  are  forced  to  suspend  or  terminate  a  clinical  trial  for  any  of  our  product 
candidates,  the  commercial  prospects  for  that  product  as  well  as  our  other  product  candidates  may  be  harmed  and  our  ability  to 
generate product revenue from these product candidates may be delayed or eliminated. Furthermore, any of these events could prevent 
us or our collaborators from achieving or maintaining market acceptance of the affected product and could substantially increase the 

10

costs  of  commercializing  our  product  candidates  and  impair  our  ability  to  generate  revenue  from  the  commercialization  of  these 
product candidates either by us or by our collaborators.

Several  of  our  product  candidates  treat  patients  who  are  extremely  ill,  and  patient  deaths  that  occur  in  our  clinical  trials  could 
negatively impact our business even if they are not shown to be related to our product candidates.

We  are  developing  MPC-150-IM,  which  will  focus  on  Class  II-IV  CHF,  and  MSC-100-IV,  which  will  focus  on  steroid-

refractory aGVHD. The patients who receive our product candidates are very ill due to their underlying diseases.

Generally,  patients  remain  at  high  risk  following  their  treatment  with  our  product  candidates  and  may  more  easily  acquire 
infections  or  other  common  complications  during  the  treatment  period,  which  can  be  serious  and  life  threatening.  As  a  result,  it  is 
likely that we will observe severe adverse outcomes during our Phase 3 trials for these product candidates, including patient death. If a 
significant number of study subject deaths were to occur, regardless of whether such deaths are attributable to our product candidates, 
our ability to obtain regulatory approval for the applicable product candidate may be adversely impacted and our business could be 
materially harmed.

The requirements to obtain regulatory approval of the FDA and regulators in other jurisdictions can be costly, time-consuming, 
and  unpredictable.  If  we  or  our  collaborators  are  unable  to  obtain  timely  regulatory  approval  for  our  product  candidates,  our 
business may be substantially harmed.

The  regulatory  approval  process  is  expensive  and  the  time  and  resources  required  to  obtain  approval  from  the  FDA  or  other 
regulatory authorities in other jurisdictions to sell any product candidate is uncertain and approval may take years. Whether regulatory 
approval will be granted is unpredictable and depends upon numerous factors, including the discretion of the regulatory authorities. 
For  example,  governing  legislation,  approval  policies,  regulations,  regulatory  policies,  or  the  type  and  amount  of  preclinical  and 
clinical data necessary to gain approval may change during the course of a product candidate’s clinical development and may vary 
among jurisdictions. It is possible that none of our existing or future product candidates will ever obtain regulatory approval (other 
than TEMCELL our licensed product in Japan), even if we expend substantial time and resources seeking such approval.

Further, regulatory requirements governing stem cell therapy products in particular have changed and may continue to change in 
the future. For example, in December 2016, the 21st Century Cures Act (“Cures Act”) was signed into law in the United States.  This 
new law is designed to advance medical innovation, and includes a number of provisions that may impact our product development 
programs.   For  example,  the  Cures  Act  establishes  a  new  “regenerative  medicine  advanced  therapy”  designation,  and  creates  an 
accelerated approval pathway for such products. As this is a new law, it is not clear yet what impact it will have on the operation of 
our business. It is also unclear how and when the FDA will fully implement the Cures Act.

Any  regulatory  review  committees  and  advisory  groups  and  any  contemplated  new  guidelines  may  lengthen  the  regulatory 
review process, require us to perform additional studies, increase our development costs, lead to changes in regulatory positions and 
interpretations,  delay  or  prevent  approval  and  commercialization  of  our  product  candidates  or  lead  to  significant  post-approval 
limitations or restrictions. As we advance our product candidates, we will be required to consult with these regulatory and advisory 
groups, and comply with applicable guidelines. If we fail to do so, we may be required to delay or discontinue development of our 
product candidates. Delay or failure to obtain, or unexpected costs in obtaining, the regulatory approval necessary to bring a product 
candidate to market could decrease our ability to generate sufficient revenue to maintain our business.

Our product candidates could fail to receive regulatory approval for many reasons, including the following:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

we may be unable to successfully complete our ongoing and future clinical trials of product candidates;

we may be unable to demonstrate to the satisfaction of the FDA or other regulatory authorities that a product candidate is 
safe, pure, and potent for any or all of a product candidate’s proposed indications;

we  may  be  unable  to  demonstrate  that  a  product  candidate’s  benefits  outweigh  the  risk  associated  with  the  product 
candidate;

the FDA or other regulatory authorities may disagree with the design or implementation of our clinical trials;

the  results  of  clinical  trials  may  not  meet  the  level  of  statistical  significance  required  by  the  FDA  or  other  regulatory 
authorities for approval;

the FDA or other regulatory authorities may disagree with our interpretation of data from preclinical studies or clinical 
trials;

a decision by the FDA, other regulatory authorities or us to suspend or terminate a clinical trial at any time;

11

•

•

•

•

•

the data collected from clinical trials of our product candidates may be inconclusive or may not be sufficient to support the 
submission  of  a  Biologics  License  Application  (“BLA”),  or  other  submission  or  to  obtain  regulatory  approval  in  the 
United States or elsewhere;

the inability to obtain sufficient quantities of the product candidates required for clinical trials;

our third party manufacturers of supplies needed for manufacturing product candidates may fail to satisfy FDA or other 
regulatory requirements and may not pass inspections that may be required by FDA or other regulatory authorities;

the failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements following approval of any of our product candidates may 
result in the refusal by the FDA or similar foreign regulatory agency to approve a pending BLA or supplement to a BLA 
submitted by us for other indications or new product candidates; and

the  approval  policies  or  regulations  of  the  FDA  or  other  regulatory  authorities  outside  of  the  United  States  may 
significantly change in a manner rendering our clinical data insufficient for approval.

We or our collaborators may gain regulatory approval for any of our product candidates in some but not all of the territories 
available  and  any  future  approvals  may  be  for  some  but  not  all  of  the  target  indications,  limiting  their  commercial  potential. 
Regulatory requirements and timing of product approvals vary from country to country and some jurisdictions may require additional 
testing beyond what is required to obtain FDA approval. Approval by the FDA does not ensure approval by regulatory authorities in 
other countries or jurisdictions, and approval by one foreign regulatory authority does not ensure approval by regulatory authorities in 
other countries or by the FDA. The foreign regulatory approval process may include all of the risks associated with obtaining FDA 
approval. In addition, regulatory approval does not specify pricing or reimbursement which may not match our expectations based on 
the results of our clinical data.

We are seeking an expedited approval path for cellular medicines designated as Regenerative Medicine Advanced Therapies 
(“RMAT”) under the 21st Century Cures Act.  This is a new designation category, and there is no certainty that our products will 
receive this designation or that it will accelerate approval.

 The  FDA  has  not  yet  issued  formal  guidance  under  the  Cures  Act  and  there  is  no  certainty  as  to  whether  any  of  our  product 
candidates will receive RMAT designation under the Cures Act or that receiving such designation will provide an expedited pathway 
to  approval.   While  the  Cures  Act  offers  several  benefits  to  drugs  designated  as  RMATs,  including  eligibility  for  increased  agency 
support and advice during development, priority review on filing, accelerated approval based on potential surrogate endpoints, and for 
potential  to  use  patient  registry  data  and  other  sources  of  real  world  evidence  for  post  approval  confirmatory  studies,  there  is  no 
assurance that any of these potential benefits will either apply to our drug candidates or, if applicable, accelerate marketing approval.

Even if we obtain regulatory approval for a product candidate, our products will be subject to ongoing regulatory scrutiny.

Any  of  our  product  candidates  that  are  approved  in  the  United  States  or  in  other  jurisdictions  will  continue  to  be  subject  to 
ongoing regulatory requirements relating to the quality, identity, strength, purity, safety, efficacy, testing, manufacturing, marketing, 
advertising, promotion, distribution, sale, storage, packaging, pricing, import or export, record-keeping and submission of safety and 
other  post-market  information  for  all  approved  product  candidates.  In  the  United  States,  this  includes  both  federal  and  state 
requirements. In particular, as a condition of approval of a BLA, the FDA may require a REMS, to ensure that the benefits of the drug 
outweigh the potential risks. REMS can include medication guides, communication plans for healthcare professionals and elements to 
assure safe use (“ETASU”). ETASU can include, but are not limited to, special training or certification for prescribing or dispensing, 
dispensing only under certain circumstances, special monitoring, and the use of patient registries. Moreover, regulatory approval may 
require  substantial  post-approval  (Phase 4)  testing  and  surveillance  to  monitor  the  drug’s  safety  or  efficacy.  Delays  in  the  REMS 
approval  process  could  result  in  delays  in  the  BLA  approval  process.  In  addition,  as  part  of  the  REMS,  the  FDA  could  require 
significant restrictions, such as restrictions on the prescription, distribution and patient use of the product, which could significantly 
impact  our  ability  to  effectively  commercialize  our  product  candidates,  and  dramatically  reduce  their  market  potential  thereby 
adversely impacting our business, results of operations and financial condition. Post-approval study requirements could add additional 
burdens,  and  failure  to  timely  complete  such  studies,  or  adverse  findings  from  those  studies,  could  adversely  affect  our  ability  to 
continue marketing the product.

12

Any  failure  to  comply  with  ongoing  regulatory  requirements,  as  well  as  post-approval  discovery  of  previously  unknown 
problems,  including  adverse  events  of  unanticipated  severity  or  frequency,  or  with  manufacturing  operations  or  processes,  may 
significantly and adversely affect our ability to generate revenue from our product candidates, and may result in, among other things:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

restrictions on the marketing or manufacturing of the product candidates, withdrawal of the product candidates from the 
market, or voluntary or mandatory product recalls;

suspension or withdrawal of  regulatory approval;

costly regulatory inspections;

fines, warning letters, or holds on clinical trials;

refusal  by  the  FDA  to  approve  pending  applications  or  supplements  to  approved  applications  filed  by  us  or  our 
collaborators, or suspension or revocation of BLAs;

restrictions on our operations;

product seizure or detention, or refusal to permit the import or export of products; or

injunctions or the imposition of civil or criminal penalties by FDA or other regulatory bodies.

If regulatory sanctions are applied or if regulatory approval is withdrawn, the value of our business and our operating results 

will be adversely affected.

The FDA’s policies, or that of the applicable regulatory bodies in other jurisdictions, may change, and additional government 
regulations may be enacted that could prevent, limit or delay regulatory approval of our product candidates. We cannot predict the 
likelihood,  nature  or  extent  of  government  regulation  that  may  arise  from  future  legislation  or  administrative  action,  either  in  the 
United States or abroad. If we or our collaborators are not able to maintain regulatory compliance, are slow or unable to adopt new 
requirements or policies, or effect changes to existing requirements, we or our collaborators may no longer be able to lawfully market 
our product, and we may not achieve or sustain profitability, which would adversely affect our business.

Ethical and other concerns surrounding the use of embryonic stem cell-based therapy may negatively affect regulatory approval or 
public perception of our non-embryonic stem cell product candidates, which could reduce demand for our products or depress our 
share price.

The use of embryonic stem cells (“ESCs”), for research and therapy has been the subject of considerable public debate, with 
many people voicing ethical, legal and social concerns related to their collection and use. Our cells are not ESCs, which have been the 
predominant focus of this public debate and concern in the United States and elsewhere. However, the distinction between ESCs and 
non-ESCs, such as our MLCs, is frequently misunderstood by the public. Negative public attitudes toward stem cell therapy could also 
result in greater governmental regulation of stem cell therapies, which could harm our business. The use of these cells could give rise 
to ethical and social commentary adverse to us, which could harm the market demand for new products and depress the price of our 
ordinary shares. Ongoing lack of understanding of the difference between ESCs and non-ESCs could negatively impact the public’s 
perception of our company and product candidates and could negatively impact us.

Additional government-imposed restrictions on, or concerns regarding possible government regulation of, the use of stem cells 
in research, development and commercialization could also cause an adverse effect on us by harming our ability to establish important 
partnerships or  collaborations,  delaying  or  preventing  the  development  of  certain product  candidates,  and  causing  a  decrease  in  the 
price of our ordinary shares or by otherwise making it more difficult for us to raise additional capital. For example, concerns regarding 
such  possible  regulation  could  impact  our  ability  to  attract  collaborators  and  investors.  Also,  existing  and  potential  government 
regulation of stem cells may lead researchers to leave the field of stem cell research altogether in order to assure that their careers will 
not be impeded by restrictions on their work. This may make it difficult for us to find and retain qualified scientific personnel.

Fast track designation by the FDA may not lead to a faster development or regulatory review or approval process, and it does not 
increase the likelihood that any of our product candidates will receive marketing approval in the United States.

If  a  drug  is  intended  for  the  treatment  of  a  serious  or  life-threatening  condition  or  disease  and  the  applicable  nonclinical  or 
clinical data demonstrate the potential to address unmet medical needs for this condition, the drug sponsor may apply for FDA fast 
track designation. The FDA has broad discretion whether or not to grant this designation, so even if we believe a particular product 
candidate is eligible for this designation, we cannot assure that the FDA would decide to grant it. Our MSC-100-IV product candidate 
has received fast track designation for the treatment of aGVHD by the FDA. We may in the future seek fast track designation for other 
of our product candidates as appropriate in the United States. For any product candidate that receives fast track designation, we may 

13

not experience a faster development, review or approval process compared to conventional FDA procedures. The FDA may withdraw 
fast track designation if it believes that the designation is no longer supported by data from our clinical development program.

Orphan drug designation may not ensure that we will enjoy market exclusivity in a particular market, and if we fail to obtain or 
maintain  orphan  drug  designation  or  other  regulatory  exclusivity  for  some  of  our  product  candidates,  our  competitive  position 
would be harmed.

A product candidate that receives orphan drug designation can benefit from potential commercial benefits following approval. 
Under the Orphan Drug Act, the FDA may designate a product candidate as an orphan drug if it is intended to treat a rare disease or 
condition, defined as affecting (1) a patient population of fewer than 200,000 in the United States, (2) a patient population greater than 
200,000 in the United States where there is no reasonable expectation that the cost of developing the drug will be recovered from sales 
in the United States, or (3) an “orphan subset” of a patient population greater than 200,000 in the United States. In the European Union 
(“EU”),  the  EMA’s  Committee  for  Orphan  Medicinal  Products  grants  orphan  drug  designation  to  promote  the  development  of 
products that are intended for the diagnosis, prevention or treatment of a life-threatening or chronically debilitating condition affecting 
not more than 10,000 persons in the EU. Currently, this designation provides market exclusivity in the U.S. and the European Union 
for  seven  years  and  ten  years,  respectively,  if  a  product  is  the  first  such  product  approved  for  such  orphan  indication.  This  market 
exclusivity does not, however, pertain to indications other than those for which the drug was specifically designated in the approval, 
nor does it prevent other types of drugs from receiving orphan designations or approvals in these same indications. Further, even after 
an orphan drug is approved, the FDA can subsequently approve a drug with similar chemical structure for the same condition if the 
FDA  concludes  that  the  new  drug  is  clinically  superior  to  the  orphan  product  or  a  market  shortage  occurs.  In  the  EU,  orphan 
exclusivity may be reduced to six years if the drug no longer satisfies the original designation criteria or can be lost altogether if the 
marketing  authorization  holder  consents  to  a  second  orphan  drug  application  or  cannot  supply  enough  drug,  or  when  a  second 
applicant demonstrates its drug is “clinically superior” to the original orphan drug.

Our MSC-100-IV product candidate has received orphan drug designation for the treatment of aGVHD by the FDA. If we seek 
orphan drug designations for other product candidates in other indications, we may fail to receive such orphan drug designations and, 
even  if  we  succeed,  such  orphan  drug  designations  may  fail  to  result  in  or  maintain  orphan  drug  exclusivity  upon  approval,  which 
would harm our competitive position.

Breakthrough therapy designation by the FDA may not lead to a faster development or regulatory review or approval process, and 
it does not increase the likelihood that any of our product candidates will receive marketing approval in the United States.

We have in the past and may in the future apply for breakthrough therapy designation for our product candidates, as appropriate, 
in the United States. A breakthrough therapy is defined as a product that is intended, alone or in combination with one or more other 
drugs,  to  treat  a  serious  or  life-threatening  disease  or  condition,  and  for  which  preliminary  clinical  evidence  indicates  substantial 
improvement  over  existing  therapies  on  one  or  more  clinically  significant  endpoints,  such  as  substantial  treatment  effects  observed 
early  in  clinical  development.  For  drugs  and  biologics  that  have  been  designated  as  breakthrough  therapies,  interaction  and 
communication  between  the  FDA  and  the  applicant  can  help  to  identify  the  most  efficient  path  for  clinical  development  while 
minimizing the number of patients placed in ineffective control regimens. Products designated as breakthrough therapies by the FDA 
may, in some cases, also be eligible for accelerated approval.

Designation as a breakthrough therapy is within the discretion of the FDA. Accordingly, even if we believe one of our products 
or product candidates meets the criteria for designation as a breakthrough therapy, the FDA may disagree. In any event, the receipt of 
a  breakthrough  therapy  designation  for  a  product  or  product  candidate  may  not  result  in  a  faster  development  process,  review  or 
approval compared to products considered for approval under conventional FDA procedures and does not assure ultimate approval by 
the FDA. We have in the past been denied breakthrough designation for certain of our product candidates. In addition, even if one or 
more of our products or product candidates does qualify as a breakthrough therapy, the FDA may later decide that the products no 
longer meet the conditions for qualification or decide that the time period for FDA review or approval will not be shortened.

We may face competition from biosimilars due to changes in the regulatory environment.

We may face competition from biosimilars due to the changing regulatory environment. In the United States, the Biologics Price 
Competition and Innovation Act of 2009 created an abbreviated approval pathway for biological products that are demonstrated to be 
“highly  similar,”  or  biosimilar,  to  or  “interchangeable”  with  an  FDA-approved  innovator  (original)  biological  product.  This  new 
pathway could allow competitors to reference data from innovator biological products already approved after 12 years from the time 
of approval. For several years the annual budget requests of President Obama’s administration included proposals to cut this 12-year 
period of exclusivity down to seven years. Those proposals were not adopted by Congress. Under President Trump’s administration, it 
is unclear if a similar change will be pursued. In Europe, the European Commission has granted marketing authorizations for several 
biosimilars pursuant to a set of general and product class-specific guidelines for biosimilar approvals issued over the past few years. In 

14

Europe, a competitor may reference data from biological products already approved, but will not be able to get on the market until ten 
years  after  the  time  of  approval.  This  10-year  period  will  be  extended  to  11  years  if,  during  the  first  eight  of  those  10  years,  the 
marketing authorization holder obtains an approval for one or more new therapeutic indications that bring significant clinical benefits 
compared with existing therapies. In addition, companies may be developing biosimilars in other countries that could compete with 
our products. If competitors are able to obtain marketing approval for biosimilars referencing our products, our products may become 
subject to competition from such biosimilars, with the attendant competitive pressure and consequences.

Risks Related to Collaborators

We rely on third parties to conduct our nonclinical and clinical studies and perform other tasks for us. If these third parties do not 
successfully carry out their contractual duties, meet expected deadlines, or comply with regulatory requirements, we may not be 
able to obtain regulatory approval for or commercialize our product candidates in a timely and cost-effective manner or at all, and 
our business could be substantially harmed.

We have relied upon and plan to continue to rely upon third-party entities, including CROs, academic institutions, hospitals and 
other third-party collaborators, to monitor, support, conduct and/or oversee preclinical and clinical studies of our current and future 
product candidates. We rely on these parties for execution of our nonclinical and clinical studies, and control only certain aspects of 
their activities. Nevertheless, we are responsible for ensuring that each of our studies is conducted in accordance with the applicable 
protocol, legal, regulatory, and scientific standards and our reliance on the CROs does not relieve us of our regulatory responsibilities. 
If we or any of these third-parties fail to comply with the applicable protocol, legal, regulatory, and scientific standards, the clinical 
data generated in our clinical studies may be deemed unreliable and the FDA, EMA or comparable foreign regulatory authorities may 
require us to perform additional clinical studies before approving our marketing applications.

If  any  of  our  relationships  with  these  third-parties  terminate,  we  may  not  be  able  to  enter  into  arrangements  with  alternative 
parties or do so on commercially reasonable terms. In addition, these parties are not our employees, and except for remedies available 
to us under our agreements with such third parties, we cannot control whether or not they devote sufficient time and resources to our 
on-going nonclinical and clinical programs. If third parties do not successfully carry out their contractual duties or obligations or meet 
expected deadlines, if they need to be replaced or if the quality or accuracy of the data they obtain is compromised due to the failure to 
adhere to our protocols, regulatory requirements, or for other reasons, our clinical studies may be extended, delayed, or terminated and 
we may not be able to obtain regulatory approval for or successfully commercialize our product candidates. Third parties may also 
generate higher costs than anticipated. As a result, our results of operations and the commercial prospects for our product candidates 
would be harmed, our costs could increase, and our ability to generate revenue could be delayed.

Switching or adding additional third parties involves additional cost and requires management time and focus. In addition, there 
is  a  natural  transition  period  when  a  new  third  party  commences  work.  As  a  result,  delays  occur,  which  can  materially  impact  our 
ability  to  meet  our  desired  clinical  development  timelines.  Though  we  carefully  manage  our  relationships  with  these  third  parties, 
there can be no assurance that we will not encounter similar challenges or delays in the future or that these delays or challenges will 
not have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, and prospects.

Our existing product development and/or commercialization arrangements, and any that we may enter into in the future, may not 
be successful, which could adversely affect our ability to develop and commercialize our product candidates.

We are a party to, and continue to seek additional, collaboration arrangements with other biopharmaceutical companies for the 
development  and/or  commercialization  of  our  current  and  future  product  candidates.  We  may  enter  into  new  arrangements  on  a 
selective basis depending on the merits of retaining certain development and commercialization rights for ourselves as compared to 
entering  into  selective  collaboration  arrangements  with  leading  pharmaceutical  or  biotechnology  companies  for  each  product 
candidate, both in the United States and internationally. To the extent that we decide to enter into collaboration agreements, we will 
face  significant  competition  in  seeking  appropriate  collaborators.  Any  failure  to  meet  our  clinical  milestones  with  respect  to  an 
unpartnered product candidate would make finding a collaborator more difficult. Moreover, collaboration arrangements are complex 
and  time  consuming  to  negotiate,  document  and  implement,  and  we  cannot  guarantee  that  we  can  successfully  maintain  such 
relationships or that the terms of such arrangements will be favorable to us. If we fail to establish and implement collaboration or other 
alternative arrangements, the value of our business and operating results will be adversely affected.

We may not be successful in our efforts to establish, implement and maintain collaborations or other alternative arrangements if 
we choose to enter into such arrangements. The terms of any collaboration or other arrangements that we may establish may not be 
favorable to us. The management of collaborations may take significant time and resources that distract our management from other 
matters.

15

Our ability to successfully collaborate with any future collaborators may be impaired by multiple factors including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

a collaborator may shift its priorities and resources away from our programs due to a change in business strategies, or a 
merger, acquisition, sale or downsizing of its company or business unit;

a collaborator may cease development in therapeutic areas which are the subject of our strategic alliances;

a collaborator may change the success criteria for a particular program or product candidate thereby delaying or ceasing 
development of such program or candidate;

a significant delay in initiation of certain development activities by a collaborator will also delay payments tied to such 
activities, thereby impacting our ability to fund our own activities;

a collaborator could develop a product that competes, either directly or indirectly, with our current or future products, if 
any;

a  collaborator  with  commercialization  obligations  may  not  commit  sufficient  financial  or  human  resources  to  the 
marketing, distribution or sale of a product;

a collaborator with manufacturing responsibilities may encounter regulatory, resource or quality issues and be unable to 
meet demand requirements;

a collaborator may exercise its rights under the agreement to terminate our collaboration;

a  dispute  may  arise  between  us  and  a  collaborator  concerning  the  research  or  development  of  a  product  candidate  or 
commercialization  of  a  product  resulting  in  a  delay  in  milestones,  royalty  payments  or  termination  of  a  program  and 
possibly resulting in costly litigation or arbitration which may divert management attention and resources;

the results of our clinical trials may not match our collaborators’ expectations, even if statistically significant;

a collaborator may not adequately protect or enforce the intellectual property rights associated with a product or product 
candidate; and

a collaborator may use our proprietary information or intellectual property in such a way as to invite litigation from a third 
party.

Any  such  activities  by  our  current  or  future  collaborators  could  adversely  affect  us  financially  and  could  harm  our  business 

reputation.

Risks Related to Our Manufacturing and Supply Chain

We  have  no  experience  manufacturing  our  product  candidates  at  a  commercial  scale.  We  may  not  be  able  to  manufacture  our 
product candidates in quantities sufficient for development and commercialization if our product candidates are approved, or for 
any future commercial demand for our product candidates.

We  have  manufactured  clinical  quantities  of  our  MLC  product  candidates  in  our  manufacturing  facilities,  owned  by  Lonza 
Walkersville,  Inc.  and  Lonza  Bioscience  Singapore  Pte.  Ltd.  (collectively  referred  to  as  “Lonza”).  We  do  not  have  any  direct 
experience  in  manufacturing  commercial  quantities  of  any  of  our  product  candidates.  The  production  of  any  biopharmaceutical, 
particularly  stem  cells,  involves  complex  processes  and  protocols. We  cannot  provide  assurance  that  such  production  efforts  will 
enable  us  to  manufacture  our  product  candidates  in  the  quantities  and  with  the  quality  needed  for  clinical  trials  and  any  resulting 
commercialization. If  we  are  unable  to  do  so,  our  clinical  trials  and  commercialization  efforts,  if  any,  may  not  proceed  in  a  timely 
fashion  and  our  business  will  be  adversely  affected.  If  any  of  our  product  candidates  are  approved  for  commercialization  and 
marketing,  we  may  be  required  to  manufacture  the  product  in  large  quantities  to  meet  demand.  Producing  product  in  commercial 
quantities requires developing and adhering to complex manufacturing processes that are different from the manufacture of a product 
in  smaller  quantities  for  clinical  trials,  including  adherence  to  additional  and  more  demanding  regulatory  standards.  Although  we 
believe that we have developed processes and protocols that will enable us to consistently manufacture commercial-scale quantities of 
product,  we  cannot  provide  assurance  that  such  processes  and  protocols  will  enable  us  to  manufacture  our  product  candidates  in 
quantities that may be required for commercialization of the product with yields and at costs that will be commercially attractive. If we 
are unable to establish or maintain commercial manufacture of the product or are unable to do so at costs that we currently anticipate, 
our business will be adversely affected.

Further,  we  have  made  significant  advances  in  the  development  of  3-dimensional  (“3D”),  bioreactor  based  production  for 
MLCs, the goal of which is to allow us to produce our products at commercial scale. There is no guarantee that we will successfully 
complete this process, due to multiple factors, including the failure to produce sufficient quantities and the inability to produce cells 
that are equivalent in physical and therapeutic properties as compared to the products produced using our current two-dimensional, or 

16

2D,  manufacturing  processes.  In  the  event  our  transition  to  3D  manufacturing  is  unsuccessful,  we  may  not  be  able  to  produce  our 
products in a cost-efficient manner and our business may be adversely affected.

We rely on Lonza as our sole supplier and manufacturer of certain of our product candidates. Our business could be harmed if 
Lonza fails to provide us with sufficient quantities of these product candidates or fails to do so at acceptable quality levels or prices.

We do not currently have, nor do we plan to acquire, the infrastructure or capability internally to manufacture our MLC product 
candidates for use in the conduct of our clinical trials, and we currently lack the internal resources and the capability to manufacture 
any of our product candidates on a clinical or commercial scale. As a result, we currently depend on Lonza to manufacture our MLC 
product candidates. Relying on Lonza as our sole source to manufacture our MLC product candidates entails risks, and Lonza may:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

cease or reduce production or deliveries, raise prices or renegotiate terms;

be unable to meet any product specifications and quality requirements consistently;

delay or be unable to procure or expand sufficient manufacturing capacity, which may harm our reputation or frustrate our 
customers;

not have the capacity sufficient to support the scale-up of manufacturing for our product candidates;

have manufacturing and product quality issues related to scale-up of manufacturing;

experience costs and validation of new equipment facilities requirement for scale-up that it will pass on to us;

fail to comply with cGMP and similar international standards;

lose its manufacturing facility in Singapore, stored inventory or laboratory facilities through fire or other causes, or other 
loss of materials necessary to manufacture our product candidates;

experience disruptions to its operations by conditions unrelated to our business or operations, including the bankruptcy or 
interruptions of its suppliers;

experience carrier disruptions or increased costs that it will pass on to us;

fail to secure adequate supplies of essential ingredients in our manufacturing process;

experience  failure  of  third  parties  involved  in  the  transportation,  storage  or  distribution  of  our  products,  including  the 
failure to deliver supplies it uses for the manufacture of our product candidates under specified storage conditions and in a 
timely manner; and

appropriate or misuse our trade secrets and other proprietary information.

Any of these events could lead to delays in the development of our product candidates, including delays in our clinical trials, or 
failure  to  obtain  regulatory  approval  for  our  product  candidates,  or  it  could  impact  our  ability  to  successfully  commercialize  our 
current  product  candidates  or  any  future  products.  Some  of  these  events  could  be  the  basis  for  FDA  or  other  regulatory  action, 
including injunction, recall, seizure or total or partial suspension of production.

In addition, the lead time needed to establish a relationship with a new manufacturer can be lengthy, and we may experience 
delays in meeting demand in the event we must switch to a new manufacturer. We are expanding our manufacturing collaborations in 
order to meet future demand and to provide back-up manufacturing options, which also involves risk and requires significant time and 
resources.  Our  future  collaborators  may  need  to  expand  their  facilities  or  alter  the  facilities  to  meet  future  demand  and  changes  in 
regulations.  These  activities  may  lead  to  delays,  interruptions  to  supply,  or  may  prove  to  be  more  costly  than  anticipated.  Any 
problems  in  our  manufacturing  process  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  results  of  operations  and  financial 
condition.

We may not be able to manufacture or commercialize our product candidates in a profitable manner.

We  intend  to  implement  a  business  model  under  which  we  control  the  manufacture  and  supply  of  our  product  candidates, 
including  but  not  exclusively,  through  our  product  suppliers,  including  Lonza. We  and  the  suppliers  of  our  product  candidates, 
including  Lonza,  have  no  experience  manufacturing  our  product  candidates  at  commercial  scale.  Accordingly,  there  can  be  no 
assurance  as  to  whether  we  and  our  suppliers  will  be  able  to  scale-up  the  manufacturing  processes  and  implement  technological 
improvements in a manner that will allow the manufacture of our product candidates in a cost effective manner. Our collaborators’ 
inability to sell our product candidates at a price that exceeds our cost of manufacture by an amount that is profitable for us will have a 
material adverse result on the results of our operations and our financial condition.

17

Our or our collaborators’ ability to identify, test and verify new donor tissue in order to create new master cell banks involves many 
risks.

The initial stage of manufacturing involves obtaining MLC-containing bone marrow from donors, for which we currently rely 
on Lonza. MLCs are isolated from each donor’s bone marrow, and expanded to create a master cell bank. Each individual master cell 
bank  comes  from  a  single  donor.  A  single  master  cell  bank  can  source  many  production  runs,  which  in  turn  can  produce  up  to 
thousands of doses of a given product, depending on the dose level. The process of identifying new donor tissue, testing and verifying 
its validity in order to create new master cell banks and validating such cell bank with the FDA and other regulatory agencies is time 
consuming,  costly  and  prone  to  the  many  risks  involved  with  creating  living  cell  products.  There  could  be  consistency  or  quality 
control  issues  with  any  new  master  cell  bank.  Although  we  believe  we  and  our  collaborators  have  the  necessary  know-how  and 
processes  to  enable  us  to  create  master  cell  banks  with  consistent  quality  and  within  the  timeframe  necessary  to  meet  projected 
demand and we have begun doing so, we cannot be certain that we or our collaborators will be able to successfully do so, and any 
failure or delays in creating new master cell banks will have a material adverse impact on our business, results of operations, financial 
conditions and growth prospects and could result in our inability to continue operations.

We and our collaborators depend on a limited number of suppliers for our product candidates’ materials, equipment or supplies 
and components required to manufacture our product candidates. The loss of these suppliers, or their failure to provide quality 
supplies on a timely basis, could cause delays in our current and future capacity and adversely affect our business.

We  and  our  collaborators  depend  on  a  limited  number  of  suppliers  for  the  materials,  equipment  and  components  required  to 
manufacture  our  product  candidates  and  the  product  candidates  themselves.  We  rely  exclusively  on  Lonza  to  supply  certain  of  our 
product candidates. In addition, we rely on general market availability third parties to provide various “devices” or “carriers” for some 
of our programs (e.g., the catheter for use with MPC-150-IM, and the hyaluronic acid used for disc repair). The main consumable used 
in our manufacturing process is our media, which currently is sourced from fetal bovine serum (“FBS”). This material comes from 
limited sources, and as a result is expensive. Consequently, we or our collaborators may not be able to obtain sufficient quantities of 
our product candidates or other critical materials equipment and components in the future, at affordable prices or at all. A delay or 
interruption  by  our  suppliers  may  also  harm  our  business,  and  operating  results.  In  addition,  the  lead  time  needed  to  establish  a 
relationship with a new supplier can be lengthy, and we or our collaborators may experience delays in meeting demand in the event 
we must switch to a new supplier. The time and effort to qualify for and, in some cases, obtain regulatory approval for a new supplier 
could result in additional costs, diversion of resources or reduced manufacturing yields, any of which would negatively impact our 
operating  results.  Our  and  our  collaborators’  dependence  on  single-source  suppliers  exposes  us  to  numerous  risks,  including  the 
following:

•

•

•

our or our collaborators’ suppliers may cease or reduce production or deliveries, raise prices or renegotiate terms;

we or our collaborators may be unable to locate suitable replacement suppliers on acceptable terms or on a timely basis, or 
at all; and

delays caused by supply issues may harm our reputation, frustrate our customers and cause them to turn to our competitors 
for future needs.

We and our collaborators and Lonza are subject to significant regulation with respect to manufacturing our product candidates. 
The Lonza manufacturing facilities on which we rely may not continue to meet regulatory requirements or may not be able to meet 
supply demands.

All  entities  involved  in  the  preparation  of  therapeutics  for  clinical  studies  or  commercial  sale,  including  our  existing 
manufacturers,  including  Lonza,  are  subject  to  extensive  regulation.  Components  of  a  finished  therapeutic  product  approved  for 
commercial sale or used in late-stage clinical studies must be manufactured in accordance with current Good Manufacturing Practice 
and other international regulatory requirements. These regulations govern manufacturing processes and procedures (including record 
keeping)  and  the  implementation  and  operation  of  quality  systems  to  control  and  assure  the  quality  of  investigational  products  and 
products  approved  for  sale.  Poor  control  of  production  processes  can  lead  to  the  introduction  of  contaminants  or  to  inadvertent 
changes  in  the  properties  or  stability  of  our  product  candidates.  We,  our  collaborators,  or  suppliers  must  supply  all  necessary 
documentation  in  support  of  a  BLA  on  a  timely  basis  and  must  adhere  to  current  Good  Laboratory  Practice  and  current  Good 
Manufacturing  Practice  regulations  enforced  by  the  FDA  and  other  regulatory  agencies  through  their  facilities  inspection  program. 
Lonza  and  other  suppliers  have  never  produced  a  commercially  approved  cellular  therapeutic  product  and  therefore  have  not  yet 
obtained the requisite regulatory authority approvals to do so.

Before  we  can  begin  commercial  manufacture  of  our  products  for  sale  in  the  United  States,  we  must  obtain  FDA  regulatory 
approval for the product, in addition to the approval of the processes and quality systems associated with the manufacturing of such 
product,  which  requires  a  successful  FDA  inspection  of  the  facility  handling  the  manufacturing  of  our  product,  including  Lonza’s 
manufacturing facilities. The novel nature of our product candidates creates significant challenges in regards to manufacturing. For 
example,  the  U.S. federal  and  state  governments  and  other  jurisdictions  impose  restrictions  on  the  acquisition  and  use  of  tissue, 

18

including those incorporated in federal Good Tissue Practice regulations. We may not be able to identify or develop sources for the 
cells  necessary  for  our  product candidates  that  comply  with  these  laws  and  regulations.  Further,  we  may  be  required  to  conduct 
additional clinical trials using 3D manufacturing processes before we receive regulatory approval.

In addition, the regulatory authorities may, at any time before or after product approval, audit or inspect a manufacturing facility 
involved with the preparation of our product candidates or raw materials or the associated quality systems for compliance with the 
regulations applicable to the activities being conducted. Although we oversee each contract manufacturer involved in the production 
of  our  product  candidates,  we  cannot  control  the  manufacturing  process  of,  and  are  dependent  on,  Lonza  for  compliance  with  the 
regulatory  requirements.  If  Lonza  is  unable  to  comply  with  manufacturing  regulations,  we  may  be  subject  to  fines,  unanticipated 
compliance expenses, recall or seizure of any approved products, total or partial suspension of production and/or enforcement actions, 
including  injunctions,  and  criminal  or  civil  prosecution.  These  possible  sanctions  would  adversely  affect  our  business,  results  of 
operations and financial condition. If Lonza fails to maintain regulatory compliance, the FDA or other applicable regulatory authority 
can impose regulatory sanctions including, among other things, refusal to approve a pending application for a new drug product or 
biologic product, withdrawal of an approval, or suspension of production. As a result, our business, financial condition, and results of 
operations may be materially harmed.

We will rely on third parties to perform many necessary services for the commercialization of our product candidates, including 
services related to the distribution, storage and transportation of our products.

We  will  rely  upon  third  parties  for  certain  storage,  distribution and  other  logistical  services.  In  accordance  with  certain  laws, 
regulations and specifications, our product candidates must be stored and transported at low temperatures within a certain range. If 
these environmental conditions deviate, our product candidates’ remaining shelf-lives could be impaired or their efficacy and safety 
could become adversely affected, making them no longer suitable for use. If any of the third parties that we intend to rely upon in our 
storage, distribution and other logistical services process fail to comply with applicable laws and regulations, fail to meet expected 
deadlines,  or  otherwise  do  not  carry  out  their  contractual  duties  to  us,  or  encounter  physical  damage  or  natural  disaster  at  their 
facilities, our ability to deliver product to meet commercial demand may be significantly impaired.

Product recalls or inventory losses caused by unforeseen events may adversely affect our operating results and financial condition.

Our  product  candidates  are  manufactured,  stored  and  distributed  using  technically  complex  processes  requiring  specialized 
facilities, highly specific raw materials and other production constraints. The complexity of these processes, as well as strict company 
and government standards for the manufacture, storage and distribution of our product candidates, subjects us to risks. For example, 
during the manufacturing process we have from time to time experienced several different types of issues that have led to a rejection 
of various batches. Historically, the most common reasons for batch rejections include major process deviations during the production 
of a specific batch and failure of manufactured product to meet one or more specifications. While product candidate batches released 
for  the  use  in  clinical  trials  or  for  commercialization  undergo  sample  testing,  some  latent  defects  may  only  be  identified  following 
product  release.  In  addition,  process  deviations  or  unanticipated  effects  of  approved  process  changes  may  result  in  these  product 
candidates  not  complying  with  stability  requirements  or  specifications.  The  occurrence  or  suspected  occurrence  of  production  and 
distribution difficulties can lead to lost inventories, and in some cases product recalls, with consequential reputational damage and the 
risk  of  product  liability.  The  investigation  and  remediation  of  any  identified  problems  can  cause  production  delays,  substantial 
expense, lost sales and delays of new product launches. In the event our production efforts require a recall or result in an inventory 
loss, our operating results and financial condition may be adversely affected.

19

Risks Related to Commercialization of Our Product Candidates

Our  future  commercial  success  depends  upon  attaining  significant  market  acceptance  of  our  product  candidates,  if  approved, 
among physicians, patients and healthcare payors.

Even  when  product  development  is  successful  and  regulatory  approval  has  been  obtained,  our  ability  to  generate  significant 
revenue  depends  on  the  acceptance  of  our  products  by  physicians,  payors  and  patients.  Many  potential  market  participants  have 
limited  knowledge  of,  or  experience  with,  stem  cell-based  products,  so  gaining  market  acceptance  and  overcoming  any  safety  or 
efficacy  concerns  may  be  more  challenging  than  for  more  traditional  therapies.  Our  efforts  to  educate  the  medical  community  and 
third-party  payors  on  the  benefits  of  our  product  candidates  may  require  significant  resources  and  may  never  be  successful.  Such 
efforts  to  educate  the  marketplace  may  require  more  resources  than  are  required  by  the  conventional  therapies  marketed  by  our 
competitors. We cannot assure you that our products will achieve the expected market acceptance and revenue if and when they obtain 
the requisite regulatory approvals. Alternatively, even if we obtain regulatory approval, that approval may be for indications or patient 
populations that are not as broad as intended or desired or may require labeling that includes significant use or distribution restrictions 
or safety warnings. The market acceptance of each of our product candidates will depend on a number of factors, including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

the efficacy and safety of the product candidate, as demonstrated in clinical trials;

the clinical indications for which the product is approved and the label approved by regulatory authorities for use with the 
product, including any warnings or contraindications that may be required on the label;

acceptance by physicians and patients of the product as a safe and effective treatment;

the cost, safety and efficacy of treatment in relation to alternative treatments;

the continued projected growth of markets for our various indications;

relative convenience and ease of administration;

the prevalence and severity of adverse side effects; 

the effectiveness of our, and our collaborators’, sales and marketing efforts; and

sufficient third-party insurance coverage and reimbursement.

Market  acceptance  is  critical  to  our  ability  to  generate  significant  revenue.  Any  product  candidate,  if  approved  and 
commercialized, may be accepted in only limited capacities or not at all. If any approved products are not accepted by the market to 
the extent that we expect, we may not be able to generate significant revenue and our business would suffer.

If,  in  the  future,  we  are  unable  to  establish  our  own  sales,  marketing  and  distribution  capabilities  or  enter  into  licensing  or 
collaboration agreements for these purposes, we may not be successful in independently commercializing any future products.

We  have  no  sales  and  marketing  infrastructure  and,  as  a  company,  have  limited  sales,  marketing  or  distribution  experience. 
Commercializing  our  product  candidates,  if  such  product  candidates  obtain  regulatory  approval,  would  require  significant  sales, 
distribution  and  marketing  capabilities.  Where  and  when  appropriate,  we  may  elect  to  utilize  contract  sales  forces  or  distribution 
collaborators to assist in the commercialization of our product candidates. If we enter into arrangements with third parties to perform 
sales, marketing and distribution services for our product candidates, the resulting revenue or the profitability from this revenue to us 
may be lower than if we had sold, marketed and distributed that product ourselves. In addition, we may not be successful in entering 
into  arrangements  with  third  parties  to  sell,  market  and  distribute  any  future  products  or  may  be  unable  to  do  so  on  terms  that  are 
favorable  to  us.  We  may  have  little  control  over  such  third  parties,  and  any  of  these  third  parties  may  fail  to  devote  the  necessary 
resources and attention to sell, market and distribute our current or any future products effectively.

To the extent we are unable to engage third parties to assist us with these functions, we will have to invest significant amounts 
of financial and management resources, some of which will need to be committed prior to any confirmation that any of our proprietary 
product  candidates  will  be  approved.  For  any  future  products  for  which  we  decide  to  perform  sales,  marketing  and  distribution 
functions ourselves, we could face a number of additional risks, including:

•

•

our inability to recruit and retain adequate numbers of effective sales and marketing personnel or to develop alternative 
sales channels;

the inability of sales personnel to obtain access to physicians or persuade adequate numbers of physicians to prescribe any 
future products;

20

•

•

the  lack  of  complementary  products  to  be  offered  by  sales  personnel,  which  may  put  us  at  a  competitive  disadvantage 
relative to companies with more diversified product lines; and

unforeseen costs and expenses associated with creating and maintaining an independent sales and marketing organization.

We face substantial competition, which may result in others discovering, developing or commercializing products before, or more 
successfully, than we do.

The biopharmaceutical industry is highly competitive and subject to rapid change. The industry continues to expand and evolve 
as  an  increasing  number  of  competitors  and  potential  competitors  enter  the  market.  Many  of  our  potential  competitors  have 
significantly  greater  development,  financial,  manufacturing,  marketing,  technical  and  human  resources  than  we  do.  Large 
pharmaceutical  companies,  in  particular,  have  extensive  experience  in  clinical  testing,  obtaining  regulatory  approvals,  recruiting 
patients  and  in  manufacturing  pharmaceutical  products.  Recent  and  potential  future  merger  and  acquisition  activity  in  the 
biotechnology and pharmaceutical industries may result in even more resources being concentrated among a smaller number of our 
competitors.  Established  pharmaceutical  companies  may  also  invest  heavily  to  accelerate  discovery  and  development  of  novel 
compounds  that  could  make  our  product  candidates  obsolete.  As  a  result  of  all  of  these  factors,  our  competitors  may  succeed  in 
obtaining  patent  protection  and/or  FDA  approval  or  discovering,  developing  and  commercializing  our  product  candidates  or 
competitors to our product candidates before we do. Specialized, smaller or early-stage companies may also prove to be significant 
competitors, particularly those with a focus and expertise in the stem cell industry and/or those with collaboration arrangements and 
other  third  party  payors.  In  addition,  any  new  product  that  competes  with  an  approved  product  must  demonstrate  compelling 
advantages in efficacy, convenience, tolerability and safety in order to overcome price competition and to be commercially successful. 
If  we  are  not  able  to  compete  effectively  against  potential  competitors,  our  business  will  not  grow  and  our  financial  condition  and 
results of operations will suffer.

Our  marketed  products  may  be  used  by  physicians  for  indications  that  are  not  approved  by  the  FDA.  If  the  FDA  finds  that  we 
marketed our products in a manner that promoted off-label use, we may be subject to civil or criminal penalties.

Under the Federal Food, Drug and Cosmetic Act (“FDCA”), and other laws, if any of our product candidates are approved by 
the FDA, we would be prohibited from promoting our products for off-label uses. This means, for example, that we would not be able 
to make claims about the use of our marketed products outside of their approved indications, and we would not be able to proactively 
discuss  or  provide  information  on  off-label  uses  of  such  products,  with  very  specific  and  limited  exceptions.  The  FDA  does  not, 
however, prohibit physicians from prescribing products for off-label uses in the practice of medicine. Should the FDA determine that 
our activities constituted the promotion of off-label use, the FDA could issue a warning or untitled letter or, through the Department of 
Justice, bring an action for seizure or injunction, and could seek to impose fines and penalties on us and our executives. In addition, 
failure to follow FDA rules and guidelines relating to promotion and advertising can result in, among other things, the FDA’s refusal 
to approve a product, the suspension or withdrawal of an approved product from the market, product recalls, fines, disgorgement of 
money, operating restrictions, injunctions or criminal prosecutions.

Healthcare legislative reform measures may have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations. 

In the United States, there have been and continue to be a number of legislative initiatives to contain healthcare costs. For 
example, in 2010, the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act, 
or collectively, the Affordable Care Act, was passed. The Affordable Care Act is a sweeping law intended to broaden access to health 
insurance, reduce or constrain the growth of healthcare spending, enhance remedies against fraud and abuse, add new transparency 
requirements  for  healthcare  and  the  health  insurance  industry,  impose  new  taxes  and  fees  on  the  healthcare  industry  and  impose 
additional  health  policy  reforms.  There  have  been  a  number  of  judicial  and  congressional  challenges  to  certain  aspects  of  the 
Affordable  Care  Act,  and  we  expect  that  with  the  recent  change  in  the  administration  the  Affordable  Care  Act  may  be  repealed  or 
significantly amended. We can provide no assurance that the Affordable Care Act, as currently enacted or as amended in the future, 
will  not  adversely  affect  our  business  and  financial  results,  and  we  cannot  predict  how  future  federal  or  state  legislative  or 
administrative changes relating to healthcare reform will affect our business.

Currently,  the  outcome  of  potential  reforms  and  changes  to  government  negotiation/regulation  to  healthcare  costs  are 
unknown. If there are changes in policy limit reimbursements that we are able to receive through federal programs, it could negatively 
impact reimbursement levels from private payors, and our business, revenues or profitability could be adversely affected.

If we or our collaborators fail to obtain and sustain an adequate level of reimbursement for our products by third-party payors, 
sales and profitability would be adversely affected.

Our  and  our  collaborators’  ability  to  commercialize  any  products  successfully  will  depend,  in  part,  on  the  extent  to  which 
coverage and reimbursement for our products and related treatments will be available from government healthcare programs, private 

21

health insurers, managed care plans, and other organizations. Additionally, even if there is a commercially viable market, if the level 
of third-party reimbursement is below our expectations, our revenue and profitability could be materially and adversely affected.

Third-party  payors,  such  as  government  programs,  including  Medicare  in  the  United  States,  or  private  healthcare  insurers, 
carefully review and increasingly question the coverage of, and challenge the prices charged for medical products and services, and 
many  third-party  payors  limit  coverage  of  or  reimbursement  for  newly  approved  healthcare  products.  Reimbursement  rates  from 
private  health  insurance  companies  vary  depending  on  the  company,  the  insurance  plan  and  other  factors,  including  the  third-party 
payor’s determination that use of a product is:

•

•

•

•

•

a covered benefit under its health plan;

safe, effective and medically necessary;

appropriate for the specific patient;

cost-effective; and

neither experimental nor investigational.

A current trend in the U.S. healthcare industry as well as in other countries around the world is toward cost containment. Large 
public  and  private  payors,  managed  care  organizations,  group  purchasing  organizations  and  similar  organizations  are  exerting 
increasing influence on decisions regarding the use of, and reimbursement levels for, particular treatments. In particular, third-party 
payors may limit the covered indications. Cost-control initiatives could decrease the price we might establish for any product, which 
could result in product revenue and profitability being lower than anticipated.

There may be significant delays in obtaining coverage and reimbursement for newly approved drugs, and coverage may be more 
limited than the purposes for which the drug is approved by the FDA or other regulatory authorities. Moreover, eligibility for coverage 
and  reimbursement  does  not  imply  that  a  drug  will  be  paid  for  in  all  cases  or  at  a  rate  that  covers  our  costs,  including  research, 
development,  manufacture,  sale  and  distribution  expenses.  Interim  reimbursement  levels  for  new  drugs,  if  applicable,  may  also  be 
insufficient to cover our and any collaborator’s costs and may not be made permanent. Reimbursement rates may vary according to 
the use of the drug and the clinical setting in which it is used, may be based on reimbursement levels already set for lower cost drugs 
and may be incorporated into existing payments for other services. Our inability to promptly obtain coverage and profitable payment 
rates from both government-funded and private payors for any approved products that we develop could have a material adverse effect 
on our operating results, our ability to raise capital needed to commercialize products and our overall financial condition.

Furthermore, reimbursement systems in international markets vary significantly by country and by region, and reimbursement 
approvals must be obtained on a country-by-country basis. Our existing or future collaborators, if any, may elect to reduce the price of 
our products in order to increase the likelihood of obtaining reimbursement approvals which could adversely affect our revenues and 
profits.  In  many  countries,  including  for  example  in  Japan,  products  cannot  be  commercially  launched  until  reimbursement  is 
approved. Further, the negotiation process in some countries can exceed 12 months. In addition, pricing and reimbursement decisions 
in  certain  countries  can  be  affected  by  decisions  taken  in  other  countries,  which  can  lead  to  mandatory  price  reductions  and/or 
additional  reimbursement  restrictions  across  a  number  of  other  countries,  which  may  thereby  adversely  affect  our  sales  and 
profitability. In the event that countries impose prices which are not sufficient to allow us or our collaborators to generate a profit, our 
collaborators  may  refuse  to  launch  the  product  in  such  countries  or  withdraw  the  product  from  the  market,  which  would  adversely 
affect sales and profitability.

Due to the novel nature of our stem cell therapy and the potential for our product candidates to offer therapeutic benefit in a single 
administration, we face uncertainty related to pricing and reimbursement for these product candidates.

Our  target  patient  populations  for  some  of  our  product  candidates  may  be  relatively  small,  and  as  a  result,  the  pricing  and 
reimbursement  of  our  product  candidates,  if  approved,  must  be  adequate  to  support  commercial  infrastructure.  If  we  are  unable  to 
obtain adequate levels of reimbursement, our ability to successfully market and sell our product candidates will be adversely affected. 
Due to the novel nature of our stem cell therapy, the manner and level at which reimbursement is provided for services related to our 
product candidates (e.g., for administration of our product to patients) is uncertain. Inadequate reimbursement for such services may 
lead to physician resistance and adversely affect our ability to market or sell our products. Further, if the results of our clinical trials do 
not clearly demonstrate the efficacy of our product candidates, our pricing and reimbursement may be adversely affected.

Price controls may be imposed in foreign markets, which may adversely affect our future profitability.

In some countries, particularly EU member states, Japan, Australia and Canada, the pricing of prescription drugs is subject to 
governmental control. In these countries, pricing negotiations with governmental authorities can take considerable time after receipt of 
marketing approval for a product. In addition, there can be considerable pressure by governments and other stakeholders on prices and 

22

reimbursement levels, including as part of cost containment measures. Political, economic and regulatory developments may further 
complicate pricing negotiations, and pricing negotiations may continue after reimbursement has been obtained. Reference pricing used 
by  various  EU  member  states and  parallel  distribution,  or arbitrage  between low-priced  and  high-priced member states,  can  further 
reduce prices. In some countries, we or our collaborators may be required to conduct a clinical trial or other studies that compare the 
cost-effectiveness  of  our  product  candidates  to  other  available  therapies  in  order  to  obtain  or  maintain  reimbursement  or  pricing 
approval.  Publication  of  discounts  by  third-party  payors  or  authorities  may  lead  to  further  pressure  on  the  prices  or  reimbursement 
levels within the country of publication and other countries. If reimbursement of our products is unavailable or limited in scope or 
amount, or if pricing is set at unsatisfactory levels, our business, revenues or profitability could be adversely affected.

If the market opportunities for our product candidates are smaller than we believe they are, our revenues may be adversely affected 
and our business may suffer. Because the target patient populations of certain of our product candidates are small, we must be 
able to successfully identify patients and achieve a significant market share to maintain profitability and growth.

Our  projections  of  the  number  of  people  with  diseases  targeted  by  our  product  candidates  are  based  on  estimates.  These 
estimates may prove to be incorrect and new studies may change the estimated incidence or prevalence of these diseases. The number 
of  patients  in  the  United  States,  Europe  and  elsewhere  may  turn  out  to  be  lower  than  expected,  may  not  be  otherwise  amenable  to 
treatment  with  our  products,  or  new  patients  may  become  increasingly  difficult  to  identify  or  gain  access  to,  all  of  which  would 
adversely affect our results of operations and our business.

We  are  exposed  to  risks  related  to  our  international  operations,  and  failure  to  manage  these  risks  may  adversely  affect  our 
operating results and financial condition.

We and our subsidiaries operate out of Australia, the United States, Singapore, the United Kingdom and Switzerland, and we 
have  a  collaborator,  JCR,  with  rights  to  develop  and  distribute  products  based  on  our  MSC  technology  in  Japan.  Our  primary 
manufacturing collaborator, Lonza, serves us primarily out of their facilities in Singapore, and through contractual relationships with 
third  parties,  has  access  to  storage  facilities  in  the  U.S.,  Europe,  Australia  and  Singapore.  As  a  result,  a  significant  portion  of  our 
operations  are  conducted  by  and/or  rely  on  entities  outside  the  markets  in  which  certain  of  our  trials  take  place,  our  suppliers  are 
sourced, our product candidates are developed, and, if any such product candidates obtain regulatory approval, our products may be 
sold.  Accordingly,  we  import  a  substantial  number  of  products  into  such  markets.  We  may,  therefore,  be  denied  access  to  our 
customers, suppliers or other collaborators or denied the ability to ship products from any of these sites as a result of a closing of the 
borders  of  the  countries  in  which  we  operate,  or  in  which  these  operations  are  located,  due  to  economic,  legislative,  political  and 
military conditions in such countries. For example, on June 23, 2016, a referendum was held on the United Kingdom's membership in 
the European Union, the outcome of which was a vote in favor of leaving the European Union. The United Kingdom's vote to leave 
the  European  Union  creates  an  uncertain  political  and  economic  environment  in  the  United  Kingdom  and  potentially  across  other 
European Union member states, which may last for a number of months or years. If any of our product candidates are approved for 
commercialization,  we  may  enter  into  agreements  with  third  parties  to  market  them  on  a  worldwide  basis  or  in  more  limited 
geographical regions. We expect that we will be subject to additional risks related to entering into international business relationships, 
including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

unexpected changes in tariffs, trade barriers and regulatory requirements;

economic weakness, including inflation, or political instability in particular foreign economies and markets;

logistics  and  regulations  associated  with  shipping  cell  samples  and  other  perishable  items,  including  infrastructure 
conditions and transportation delays;

potential import and export issues with the U.S. Customs and Border Protection and similar bodies in other jurisdictions;

compliance with tax, employment, immigration and labor laws for employees living or traveling abroad;

workforce uncertainty in countries where labor unrest is more common than in the United States;

production shortages resulting from any events affecting raw material supply or manufacturing capabilities abroad; and

business  interruptions  resulting  from  geopolitical  actions,  including  war  and  terrorism,  or  natural  disasters  including 
earthquakes, typhoons, floods and fires.

Use of animal-derived materials could harm our product development and commercialization efforts.

Some  of  the  manufacturing  materials  and/or  components  that  we  use  in,  and  which  are  critical  to,  implementation  of  our 
technology  involve  the  use  of  animal-derived  products,  including  FBS.  Suppliers  or  regulatory  changes  may  limit  or  restrict  the 
availability of such materials for clinical and commercial use. While FBS is commonly used in the production of various marketed 
biopharmaceuticals, the suppliers of FBS that meet our strict quality standards are limited in number and region. As such, to the extent 

23

that any such suppliers or regions face an interruption in supply (for example, a new occurrence of so-called “mad cow disease”), it 
may  lead  to  a  restricted  supply  of  the  serum  currently  required  for  our  product  manufacturing  processes.  Any  restrictions  on  these 
materials would impose a potential competitive disadvantage for our products or prevent our ability to manufacture our cell products. 
The FDA has issued regulations for controls over bovine material in animal feed. These regulations do not appear to affect our ability 
to  purchase  the  manufacturing  materials  we  currently  use.  However,  the  FDA  may  propose  new  regulations  that  could  affect  our 
operations.  Our  inability  to  develop  or  obtain  alternative  compounds  would  harm  our  product  development  and  commercialization 
efforts.  There  are  certain  limitations  in  the  supply  of  certain  animal-derived  materials,  which  may  lead  to  delays  in  our  ability  to 
complete clinical trials or eventually to meet the anticipated market demand for our cell products.

If  product  liability  lawsuits  are  brought  against  us,  we  may  incur  substantial  liabilities  and  may  be  required  to  limit 
commercialization of our product candidates.

We face an inherent risk of product liability as a result of the human clinical use of our product candidates and will face an even 
greater risk if we commercialize any products. For example, we may be sued if any product we develop allegedly causes injury or is 
found  to  be  otherwise  unsuitable  during  product  testing,  manufacturing,  marketing  or  sale.  Any  such  product  liability  claims  may 
include  allegations  of  defects  in  manufacturing,  defects  in  design,  a  failure  to  warn  of  dangers  inherent  in  the  product,  negligence, 
strict  liability,  and  a  breach  of  warranties.  Claims  could  also  be  asserted  under  state  consumer  protection  acts.  If  we  cannot 
successfully  defend  ourselves  against  product  liability  claims,  we  may  incur  substantial  liabilities  or  be  required  to  limit 
commercialization  of  our  product  candidates.  Even  a  successful  defense  would  require  significant  financial  and  management 
resources. Regardless of the merits or eventual outcome, liability claims may result in:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

decreased demand for our products, even if such products are approved;

injury to our reputation;

withdrawal of clinical trial participants;

costs to defend the related litigations;

a diversion of management’s time and our resources;

substantial monetary awards to trial participants or patients;

product recalls, withdrawals, or labeling, marketing or promotional restrictions;

increased cost of liability insurance;

loss of revenue;

the inability to commercialize our product candidates; and

a decline in our ordinary share price.

Failure  to  obtain  and  retain  sufficient  product  liability  insurance  at  an  acceptable  cost  to  protect  against  potential  product 
liability  claims  could  prevent  or  inhibit  the  commercialization  of  products  we  develop.  Additionally,  our  insurance  policies  have 
various exclusions, and we may be subject to a product liability claim for which we have no coverage or reduced coverage. Any claim 
that may be brought against us could result in a court judgment or settlement in an amount that is not covered, in whole or in part, by 
our insurance or that is in excess of the limits of our insurance coverage. We will have to pay any amounts awarded by a court or 
negotiated in a settlement that exceed our coverage limitations or that are not covered by our insurance, and we may not have, or be 
able to obtain, sufficient capital to pay such amounts.

Risks Related to Our Intellectual Property

We may not be able to protect our proprietary technology in the marketplace.

Our success will depend, in part, on our ability to obtain patents, protect our trade secrets and operate without infringing on the 
proprietary rights of others. We rely upon a combination of patents, trade secret protection, and confidentiality agreements to protect 
the intellectual property of our product candidates. Patents might not be issued or granted with respect to our patent applications that 
are currently pending, and issued or granted patents might later be found to be invalid or unenforceable, be interpreted in a manner 
that  does  not  adequately  protect  our  current  product  or  any  future  products,  or  fail  to  otherwise  provide  us  with  any  competitive 
advantage. As such, we do not know the degree of future protection that we will have on our proprietary products and technology, if 
any, and a failure to obtain adequate intellectual property protection with respect to our product candidates and proprietary technology 
could have a material adverse impact on our business.

24

Filing,  prosecuting  and  defending  patents  throughout  the  world  would  be  prohibitively  expensive,  so  our  policy  is  to  patent 
technology in jurisdictions with significant or otherwise relevant commercial opportunities or activities. However, patent protection 
may  not  be  available  for  some  of  the  products  or  technology  we  are  developing.  If  we  must  spend  significant  time  and  money 
protecting or enforcing our patents, designing around patents held by others or licensing, potentially for large fees, patents or other 
proprietary rights held by others, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be harmed.

The patent positions of biopharmaceutical products are complex and uncertain.

The scope and extent of patent protection for our product candidates are particularly uncertain. To date, our principal product 
candidates  have  been  based  on  specific  subpopulations  of  known  and  naturally  occurring  adult  stem  cells.  We  anticipate  that  the 
products  we  develop  in  the  future  will  continue  to  include  or  be  based  on  the  same  or  other  naturally  occurring  stem  cells  or 
derivatives or products thereof. Although we have sought and expect to continue to seek patent protection for our product candidates, 
their methods of use and methods of manufacture, any or all of them may not be subject to effective patent protection. Publication of 
information  related  to  our  product  candidates  by  us  or  others  may  prevent  us  from  obtaining  or  enforcing  patents  relating  to  these 
products  and  product  candidates.  Furthermore,  others  may  independently  develop  similar  products,  may  duplicate  our  products,  or 
may design around our patent rights. In addition, any of our issued patents may be declared invalid. If we fail to adequately protect our 
intellectual property, we may face competition from companies who attempt to create a generic product to compete with our product 
candidates.  We  may  also  face  competition  from  companies  who  develop  a  substantially  similar  product  to  our  other  product 
candidates that may not be covered by any of our patents.

Filing,  prosecuting  and  defending  patents  on  product  candidates  in  all  countries  throughout  the  world  would  be  prohibitively 
expensive,  and  our  intellectual  property  rights  in  some  countries  outside  the  U.S.  can  be  less  extensive  than  those  in  the  U.S.  In 
addition, the laws of some foreign countries do not protect intellectual property rights to the same extent as federal and state laws in 
the U.S. Consequently, we may not be able to prevent third parties from practicing our inventions in all countries outside the U.S., or 
from  selling  or  importing  products  made  using  our  inventions  in  and  into  the  U.S.  or  other  jurisdictions.  Competitors  may  use  our 
technologies  in  jurisdictions  where  we  have  not  obtained  patent  protection  to  develop  their  own  products  and  further,  may  export 
otherwise infringing products to territories where we have patent protection, but enforcement is not as strong as that in the U.S. These 
products  may  compete  with  our  current  or  future  products,  if  any,  and  our  patents  or  other  intellectual  property  rights  may  not  be 
effective or sufficient to prevent them from competing.

Many  companies  have  encountered  significant  problems  in  protecting  and  defending  intellectual  property  rights  in  foreign 
jurisdictions.  The  legal  systems  of  certain  countries  do  not  favor  the  enforcement  of  patents,  trade  secrets  and  other  intellectual 
property protection, particularly those relating to biotechnology products, which could make it difficult for us to stop the infringement 
of our patents or marketing of competing products in violation of our proprietary rights generally. Proceedings to enforce our patent 
rights in foreign jurisdictions could result in substantial costs and divert our efforts and attention from other aspects of our business, 
could put our patents at risk of being invalidated or interpreted narrowly and our patent applications at risk of not issuing and could 
provoke third parties to assert claims against us. We may not prevail in any lawsuits that we initiate and the damages or other remedies 
awarded, if any, may not be commercially meaningful. Accordingly, our efforts to enforce our intellectual property rights around the 
world may be inadequate to obtain a significant commercial advantage from the intellectual property that we develop or license.

We may be unable to adequately prevent disclosure of trade secrets and other proprietary information.

We  maintain  certain  of  our  proprietary  know-how  and  technological  advances  as  trade  secrets,  especially  where  we  do  not 
believe  patent  protection  is  appropriate  or  obtainable,  including,  but  not  exclusively,  with  respect  to  certain  aspects  of  the 
manufacturing  of  our  products.  However,  trade  secrets  are  difficult  to  protect.  We  take  a  number  of  measures  to  protect  our  trade 
secrets  including,  limiting  disclosure,  physical  security  and  confidentiality  and  non-disclosure  agreements.  We  enter  into 
confidentiality  agreements  with  our  employees,  consultants,  outside  scientific  collaborators,  contract  manufacturing  partners, 
sponsored  researchers  and  other  advisors  and  third  parties  to  protect  our  trade  secrets  and  other  proprietary  information.  These 
agreements may not effectively prevent disclosure of confidential information and may not provide an adequate remedy in the event of 
unauthorized disclosure of confidential information. In addition, others may independently discover our trade secrets and proprietary 
information.  Costly and time-consuming  litigation could be  necessary  to enforce and  determine  the scope  of our  proprietary  rights. 
Failure to obtain or maintain trade secret protection, or failure to adequately protect our intellectual property could enable competitors 
to  develop  generic  products  or  use  our  proprietary  information  to  develop  other  products  that  compete  with  our  products  or  cause 
additional, material adverse effects upon our business, results of operations and financial condition.

We  may  be  forced  to  litigate  to  enforce  or  defend  our  intellectual  property  rights,  and/or  the  intellectual  property  rights  of  our 
licensors.

We may be forced to litigate to enforce or defend our intellectual property rights against infringement by competitors, and to 
protect  our  trade  secrets  against  unauthorized  use.  In  so  doing,  we  may  place  our  intellectual  property  at  risk  of  being  invalidated, 

25

unenforceable, or limited or narrowed in scope and may no longer be used to prevent the manufacture and sale of competitive product. 
Further,  an  adverse  result  in  any  litigation  or  other  proceedings  before  government  agencies  such  as  the  United  States  Patent  and 
Trademark Office (“USPTO”), may place pending applications at risk of non-issuance. Further, interference proceedings, derivation 
proceedings, entitlement proceedings, ex parte reexamination, inter partes reexamination, inter partes review, post-grant review, and 
opposition proceedings provoked by third parties or brought by the USPTO or any foreign patent authority may be used to challenge 
inventorship,  ownership,  claim  scope,  or  validity  of  our  patent  applications.  Furthermore,  because  of  the  substantial  amount  of 
discovery  required  in  connection  with  intellectual  property  litigation,  there  is  a  risk  that  some  of  our  confidential  and  proprietary 
information could be compromised by disclosure during this type of litigation.

Intellectual  property  disputes  could  cause  us  to  spend  substantial  resources  and  distract  our  personnel  from  their  normal 
responsibilities.

Even if resolved in our favor, litigation or other legal proceedings relating to intellectual property claims may cause us to incur 
significant  expenses,  and  could  distract  our  technical  and/or  management  personnel  from  their  normal  responsibilities.  In  addition, 
there could be public announcements of the results of hearings, motions or other interim proceedings or developments and if securities 
analysts or investors perceive these results to be negative, it could have a substantial adverse effect on the market price of our ADSs 
and ordinary shares. Such litigation or proceedings could substantially increase our operating losses and reduce the resources available 
for  development  activities  or  any  future  sales,  marketing  or  distribution  activities.  We  may  not  have  sufficient  financial  or  other 
resources to adequately conduct such litigation or proceedings. Some of our competitors may be able to sustain the costs of litigation 
proceedings  more  effectively  than  we  can  because  of  their  greater  financial  resources  and  personnel.  In  addition,  the  uncertainties 
associated with litigation could have a material adverse effect on our ability to raise the funds necessary to conduct our clinical trials, 
continue our internal research programs, in-license needed technology or enter into strategic collaborations that would help us bring 
our product candidates to market. As a result, uncertainties resulting from the initiation and continuation of patent litigation or other 
proceedings could have a material adverse effect on our ability to compete in the marketplace.

U.S. patent reform legislation and court decisions could increase the uncertainties and costs surrounding the prosecution of our 
patent applications and the enforcement or defense of our issued U.S. patents.

On September 16, 2011, the Leahy-Smith America Invents Act, or the Leahy-Smith Act, was signed into law. The Leahy-Smith 
Act  includes  a  number  of  significant  changes  to  U.S.  patent  law,  including  provisions  that  switches  the  U.S.  patent  system  from  a 
“first to invent” to a “first inventor to file” system, and affect the way patent applications will be prosecuted and may also affect patent 
litigation. Under a “first-to-file” system, assuming the other requirements for patentability are met, the first inventor to file a patent 
application  generally  will  be  entitled  to  the  patent  on  an  invention  regardless  of  whether  another  inventor  had  made  the  invention 
earlier. The USPTO issued Final Rules and Guidelines governing first-inventor-to-file in February 2013, and continues to develop and 
implement additional regulations and procedures to govern administration of the Leahy-Smith Act. Many of the substantive changes to 
patent  law  associated  with  the  Leahy-Smith  Act,  and  in  particular  the  first-to-file  provisions,  only  became  effective  on  March 16, 
2013. The full effect of these changes are currently unclear as the USPTO has not yet adopted all pertinent final rules and regulations, 
the courts have yet to address these provisions and the applicability of the Leahy-Smith Act and new regulations on specific patents, 
including our patents discussed herein, have not been determined and would need to be reviewed. Accordingly, it is not yet clear what, 
if  any,  impact  the  Leahy-Smith  Act  will  have  on  the  operation  of  our  business.  As  a  result,  the  Leahy-Smith  Act  and  its 
implementation could increase the uncertainties and costs surrounding the prosecution of patent applications and the enforcement or 
defense of issued patents, or it could cause us to lose patent rights if we fail to timely file patent applications and another party files on 
an invention before we do, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial condition.

On June 13, 2013, the U.S. Supreme Court decision in Association for Molecular Pathology v. Myriad Genetics, Inc., held that 
isolated DNA sequences are not patentable because they constitute a product of nature. The Supreme Court did not address stem cells 
in particular, and as a result, it is not yet clear what, if any, impact this Supreme Court decision or future decisions will have on the 
operation of our business.

If  third  parties  claim  that  intellectual  property  used  by  us  infringes  upon  their  intellectual  property,  commercialization  of  our 
product candidates and our operating profits could be adversely affected.

There  is  a  substantial  amount  of  litigation,  both  within  and  outside  the  United  States,  involving  patent  and  other  intellectual 
property  rights  in  the  biopharmaceutical  industry.  We  may,  from  time  to  time,  be  notified  of  claims  that  we  are  infringing  upon 
patents,  trademarks,  copyrights,  or  other  intellectual  property  rights  owned  by  third  parties,  and  we  cannot  provide  assurances  that 
other companies will not, in the future, pursue such infringement claims against us or any third-party proprietary technologies we have 
licensed. Any such claims could also be expensive and time consuming to defend and divert management’s attention and resources, 
and  could  delay  or  prevent  us  from  commercializing  our  product  candidates.  Our  competitive  position  could  suffer  as  a  result. 
Although we have reviewed certain third-party patents and patent filings that we believe may be relevant to our product candidates, 
we have not conducted a freedom-to-operate search or analysis for our product candidates, and we may not be aware of patents or 

26

pending or future patent applications that, if issued, would block us from commercializing our product candidates. Thus, we cannot 
guarantee  that  our  product  candidates,  or  our  commercialization  thereof,  do  not  and  will  not  infringe  any  third  party’s  intellectual 
property.

If  we  do  not  obtain  patent  term  extension  in  the  United  States  under  the  Hatch-Waxman  Act  and  in  foreign  countries  under 
similar legislation, thereby potentially extending the term of our marketing exclusivity of our product candidates, our business may 
be materially harmed.

Depending on the timing, duration and specifics of FDA marketing approval of our product candidates, if any, one of the U.S. 
patents covering each of such approved product(s) or the use thereof may be eligible for up to five years of patent term restoration 
under the Hatch-Waxman Act. The Hatch-Waxman Act allows a maximum of one patent to be extended per FDA approved product. 
Patent term extension also may be available in certain foreign countries upon regulatory approval of our product candidates, including 
by the EMA in the EU or the PMDA in Japan. Nevertheless, we may not be granted patent term extension either in the United States 
or in any foreign country because of, for example, failing to apply within applicable deadlines, failing to apply prior to expiration of 
relevant patents or otherwise failing to satisfy applicable requirements. Moreover, the term of extension, as well as the scope of patent 
protection during any such extension, afforded by the governmental authority could be less than we request. In addition, if a patent we 
wish to extend is owned by another party and licensed to us, we may need to obtain approval and cooperation from our licensor to 
request the extension.

If we are unable to obtain patent term extension or restoration, or the term of any such extension is less than we request, the 
period  during  which  we  will  have  the  right  to  exclusively  market  our  product  will  be  shortened  and  our  competitors  may  obtain 
approval of competing products following our patent expiration, and our revenue could be reduced, possibly materially.

Risks Related to Our Business and Industry

If  we  fail  to  attract  and  keep  senior  management  and  key  scientific  personnel,  we  may  be  unable  to  successfully  develop  our 
product candidates, conduct our clinical trials and commercialize our product candidates.

We  are  highly  dependent  on  members  of  our  executive  management,  particularly  Silviu  Itescu,  our  Chief  Executive  Officer. 
Dr. Itescu was an early pioneer in the study and clinical development of stem cell therapeutics and is globally recognized in the field 
of regenerative medicine. The loss of the services of Dr. Itescu or any other member of the executive management team could impede 
the achievement of our research, development and commercialization objectives. We do not maintain “key person” insurance for any 
of our executives or other employees.

Recruiting and retaining qualified scientific, clinical, manufacturing, sales and marketing personnel will also be critical to our 
success.  We  may  not  be  able  to  attract  and  retain  these  personnel  on  acceptable  terms  given  the  competition  among  numerous 
pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies for similar personnel. We also experience competition for the hiring of scientific and 
clinical personnel from universities and research institutions. In addition, we rely on consultants and advisors, including scientific and 
clinical  advisors,  to  assist  us  in  formulating  our  research  and  development  and  commercialization  strategy.  Our  consultants  and 
advisors may be employed by employers other than us and may have commitments under consulting or advisory contracts with other 
entities that may limit their availability to us.

Our  employees,  principal  investigators,  consultants  and  collaboration  partners  may  engage  in  misconduct  or  other  improper 
activities, including noncompliance with laws and regulatory standards and requirements and insider trading.

We are exposed to the risk of employee fraud or other misconduct. Misconduct by employees could include failures to comply 
with FDA regulations, to provide accurate information to the FDA, to comply with manufacturing standards we have established, to 
comply with federal and state healthcare fraud and abuse laws and regulations, to report financial information or data accurately or to 
disclose unauthorized activities to us. In particular, sales, marketing and business arrangements in the healthcare industry are subject 
to  extensive  laws  and  regulations  intended  to  prevent  fraud,  kickbacks,  self-dealing  and  other  abusive  practices.  These  laws  and 
regulations restrict or prohibit a wide range of activity relating to pricing, discounting, marketing and promotion, sales commissions, 
customer  incentive  programs  and  other  business  arrangements.  Employee  misconduct  could  also  involve  the  improper  use  of 
information obtained in the course of clinical trials, which could result in regulatory sanctions and serious harm to our reputation, or, 
given we are a listed company in Australia and the United States, breach of insider trading laws. It is not always possible to identify 
and  deter  employee  misconduct,  and  the  precautions  we  take  to  detect  and  prevent  this  activity  may  not  be  effective  in  controlling 
unknown  or  unmanaged  risks  or  losses  or  in  protecting  us  from  governmental  investigations  or  other  actions  or  lawsuits  stemming 
from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations. If any such actions are instituted against us, and we are not successful 
in defending ourselves or asserting our rights, those actions could have a significant impact on our business, including the imposition 
of significant fines or other sanctions.

27

We  may  acquire  other  companies  or  assets  which  could  divert  our  management’s  attention,  result  in  additional  dilution  to  our 
shareholders and otherwise disrupt our operations and harm our operating results.

We  have  in  the  past  and  may  in  the  future  seek  to  acquire  businesses,  products  or  technologies  that  we  believe  could 
complement or expand our product offerings, enhance our technical capabilities or otherwise offer growth opportunities. For example, 
we  acquired  MSC-assets  from  Osiris  Therapeutics,  Inc.  (“Osiris”)  in  2013.  The  pursuit  of  potential  acquisitions  may  divert  the 
attention  of  management  and  cause  us  to  incur  various  expenses  in  identifying,  investigating  and  pursuing  suitable  acquisitions, 
whether or not they are consummated. If we acquire additional businesses, we may not be able to integrate the acquired personnel, 
operations  and  technologies  successfully,  or  effectively  manage  the  combined  business  following  the  acquisition.  We  also  may  not 
achieve the anticipated benefits from the acquired business due to a number of factors, including:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

incurrence of acquisition-related costs;

diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns;

unanticipated costs or liabilities associated with the acquisition;

harm to our existing business relationships with collaborators as a result of the acquisition;

harm to our brand and reputation;

the potential loss of key employees;

use of resources that are needed in other parts of our business; and

use of substantial portions of our available cash to consummate the acquisition.

In  the  future,  if  our  acquisitions  do  not  yield  expected  returns,  we  may  be  required  to  take  charges  to  our  operating  results 
arising  from  the  impairment  assessment  process.  Acquisitions  may  also  result  in  dilutive  issuances  of  equity  securities  or  the 
incurrence  of  debt,  which  could  adversely  affect  our  operating  results.  In  addition,  if  an  acquired  business  fails  to  meet  our 
expectations, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

We  and  our  collaborators  must  comply  with  environmental  laws  and  regulations,  and  failure  to  comply  with  these  laws  and 
regulations could expose us to significant liabilities.

We  and  our  collaborators  are  subject  to  various  federal,  state  and  local  environmental  laws,  rules  and  regulations,  including 
those relating to the discharge of materials into the air, water and ground, the manufacture, storage, handling, use, transportation and 
disposal of hazardous and biological materials, and the health and safety of employees with respect to laboratory activities required for 
the  development  of  products  and  technologies.  In  the  event  of  contamination  or  injury,  or  failure  to  comply  with  environmental, 
occupational health and safety and export control laws and regulations, it could cause an interruption of our commercialization efforts, 
research and development efforts, or business operations, and we could be held liable for any resulting damages and any such liability 
could exceed our assets and resources.

We  work  with  outside  scientists  and  their  institutions  in  developing  product  candidates.  These  scientists  may  have  other 
commitments or conflicts of interest, which could limit our access to their expertise and harm our ability to leverage our discovery 
platform.

We  work  with  scientific  advisors  and  collaborators  at  academic  research  institutions  in  connection  with  our  product 
development. These scientific advisors serve as our link to the specific pools of trial participants we are targeting in that these advisors 
may:

•

•

•

•

•

identify individuals as potential candidates for study;

obtain their consent to participate in our research;

perform medical examinations and gather medical histories;

conduct the initial analysis of suitability of the individuals to participate in our research based on the foregoing; and

collect data and biological samples from trial participants periodically in accordance with our study protocols.

These  scientists  and  collaborators  are  not  our  employees,  rather  they  serve  as  either  independent  contractors  or  the  primary 
investigators  under  research  collaboration  agreements  that  we  have  with  their  sponsoring  academic  or  research  institution.  Such 
scientists  and  collaborators  may  have  other  commitments  that  would  limit  their  availability  to  us.  Although  our  scientific  advisors 
generally agree not to do competing work, if an actual or potential conflict of interest between their work for us and their work for 
another  entity  arises,  we  may  lose  their  services.  It  is  also  possible  that  some  of  our  valuable  proprietary  knowledge  may  become 

28

publicly  known  through  these  scientific  advisors  if  they  breach  their  confidentiality  agreements  with  us,  which  would  cause 
competitive harm to our business.

If  our  ability  to  use  cumulative  carry  forward  net  operating  losses  is  or  becomes  subject  to  certain  limitations  or  if  certain  tax 
incentive credits from which we benefit expire or no longer apply to us, our business, results of operations and financial condition 
may be adversely affected.

We  are  an  Australian  company  subject  to  taxation  in  Australia  and  other  jurisdictions.  As  of  June  30,  2017,  our  cumulative 
operating losses have a total potential tax benefit of $113.1 million at local tax rates (excluding other temporary differences). These 
losses may be available for use once we are in a tax profitable position. These losses were incurred in different jurisdictions and can 
only be offset against profits earned in the relevant jurisdictions. Tax losses are able to be carried forward at their nominal amount 
indefinitely in Australia and in Singapore, and for up to 20 years in the U.S. as long as certain conditions are met. In order to use these 
tax losses, it is necessary to satisfy certain tests and, as a result, we cannot assure you that the tax losses will be available to offset 
profits if and when we earn them. Utilization of our net operating loss and research and development credit carryforwards in the U.S. 
may be subject to substantial annual limitation due to ownership change limitations that could occur in the future provided by Section 
382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986. Our carry forward net operating losses in the U.S. first start to expire in 2032. In addition, 
we are eligible for certain research and development tax incentive refundable credits in Australia that may increase our available cash 
flow.  The  Australian  federal  government's  Research  and  Development  Tax  Incentive  grant  is  available  for  eligible  research  and 
development  purposes  based  on  the  filing  of  an  annual  application.  We  currently  project  to  benefit  from  these  incentives  in  future 
taxable  years.  We  recognized  income  of  $1.5  million  and  $3.8  million,  respectively,  from  the  Research  and  Development  Tax 
Incentive program for the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016. To the extent our research and development expenditures are deemed 
to be “ineligible,” then our grants would decrease.

There can be no assurances that we will continue to benefit from these incentives or that such tax incentive credit programs will 
not be revoked or modified in any way in the future. The Australian government may in the future decide to modify the requirements 
of, reduce the amounts of the grants available under, or discontinue its research and development tax incentive program. For instance, 
the Australian government undertook a review of its Research and Development Tax Incentive program in 2016. The review panel's 
recommendation, which has not been adopted or implemented as of the date of this Annual Report, would reduce the amount of the 
grants  available  to  a  maximum  of  A$2.0  million  per  annum  for  companies  with  an  annual  aggregate  turnover  of  less  than  A$20.0 
million,  such  as  us.  A  final  Australian  federal  government  response  to  its  review  of  the  Research  and  Development  Tax  Incentive 
program  has  not  yet  been  released  or  implemented  as  of  the  date  of  this  Report.  If  the  Research  and  Development  Tax  program 
incentives are revoked or modified, such as was recommended by the review panel, or if we are no longer eligible for such incentives, 
our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

Taxing authorities could reallocate our taxable income within our subsidiaries, which could increase our consolidated tax liability.

We  conduct  operations  in  multiple  tax  jurisdictions  and  the  tax  laws  of  those  jurisdictions  generally  require  that  the  transfer 
prices  between  affiliated  companies  in  different  jurisdictions  be  the  same  as  those  between  unrelated  companies  dealing  at  arms’ 
length, and that such prices are supported by contemporaneous documentation. While we believe that we operate in compliance with 
applicable  transfer  pricing  laws  and  intend  to  continue  to  do  so,  our  transfer  pricing  procedures  are  not  binding  on  applicable  tax 
authorities. If tax authorities in any of these countries were to successfully challenge our transfer prices as not reflecting arms’ length 
transactions,  they  could  require  us  to  adjust  our  transfer  prices  and  thereby  reallocate  our  income  to  reflect  these  revised  transfer 
prices, which could result in a higher tax liability to us, and possibly interest and penalties, and could adversely affect our business, 
results of operations and financial condition.

The pharmaceutical industry is highly regulated and pharmaceutical companies are subject to various federal and state fraud and 
abuse laws, including, without limitation, the federal Anti-Kickback Statute and the federal False Claims Act.

Healthcare fraud and abuse regulations are complex and can be subject to varying interpretations as to whether or not a statute 

has been violated. The laws that may affect our ability to operate include:

•

•

•

the federal Anti-Kickback Statute which prohibits, among other things, the knowing and willful payment of remuneration 
to induce or reward patient referrals or the generation of business involving any item or service which may be payable by 
the federal health care programs (e.g., drugs, supplies, or health care services for Medicare or Medicaid patients);

the federal False Claims Act which prohibits, among other things, individuals or entities from knowingly presenting, or 
causing  to  be  presented,  claims  for  payment  for  government  funds  (e.g.,  payment  from  Medicare  or  Medicaid)  or 
knowingly making, using, or causing to be made or used a false record or statement, material to a false or fraudulent claim 
for government funds;

the  federal  Health  Insurance  Portability  and  Accountability  Act  of  1996  (“HIPAA”),  as  amended  by  the  Health 
Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act (“HITECH”), and its implementing regulations, imposes 

29

certain  requirements  relating  to  the  privacy,  security  and  transmission  of  individually  identifiable  health  information. 
Among other things, HIPAA imposes civil and criminal liability for the wrongful access or disclosure of protected health 
information;

the federal Physician Payments Sunshine Act, created under Section 6002 of the Patient Protection and Affordable Care 
Act  (“ACA”),  as  amended,  requires  certain  manufacturers  of  drugs,  devices,  biologics  and  medical  supplies  for  which 
payment is available under Medicare, Medicaid or the Children’s Health Insurance Program (with certain exceptions) to 
report information related to certain payments or other transfers of value made or distributed to physicians and teaching 
hospitals, or to entities or individuals at the request of, or designated on behalf of, those physicians and teaching hospitals 
and to report annually certain ownership and investment interests held by physicians and their immediate family members;

the  FDCA,  which,  among  other  things,  regulates  the  testing,  development,  approval,  manufacture,  promotion  and 
distribution of drugs, devices and biologics. The FDCA prohibits manufacturers from selling or distributing “adulterated” 
or “misbranded” products. A drug product may be deemed misbranded if, among other things, (i) the product labeling is 
false or misleading, fails to contain requisite information or does not bear adequate directions for use; (ii) the product is 
manufactured at an unregistered facility; or (iii) the product lacks the requisite FDA clearance or approval;

the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (“FCPA”), which prohibits corrupt payments, gifts or transfers of value to non-
U.S. officials; and

non-U.S. and U.S. state law equivalents of each of the above federal laws, such as anti-kickback and false claims laws 
which may apply to items or services reimbursed by any third-party payor, including commercial insurers.

•

•

•

•

Any  failure  to  comply  with  these  laws,  or  the  regulations  adopted  thereunder,  could  result  in  administrative,  civil,  and/or 
criminal  penalties,  and  could  result  in  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  reputation,  business,  results  of  operations  and  financial 
condition.

The federal fraud and abuse laws have been interpreted to apply to arrangements between pharmaceutical manufacturers and a 
variety of health care professionals. Although the federal Anti-Kickback Statute has several statutory exemptions and regulatory safe 
harbors  protecting  certain  common  activities  from  prosecution,  all  elements  of  the  potentially  applicable  exemption  or  safe  harbor 
must  be  met  in  order  for  the  arrangement  to  be  protected,  and  prosecutors  have  interpreted  the  federal  healthcare  fraud  statutes  to 
attack a wide range of conduct by pharmaceutical companies. In addition, most states have statutes or regulations similar to the federal 
anti-kickback and federal false claims laws, which apply to items and services covered by Medicaid and other state programs, or, in 
several states, apply regardless of the payor. Administrative, civil and criminal sanctions may be imposed under these federal and state 
laws.

Further, the ACA, among other things, amended the intent standard under the Anti-Kickback Statute such that a person or entity 
no  longer  needs  to  have  actual  knowledge  of  the  statute  or  specific  intent  to  violate  it  in  order  to  have  committed  a  violation.  In 
addition, the ACA makes clear that a claim including items or services resulting from a violation of the federal Anti-Kickback Statute 
constitutes a false or fraudulent claim under the federal False Claims Act. Any violations of these laws, or any action against us for 
violation of these laws, even if we successfully defend against it, could result in a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, 
results of operations and financial condition.

A  failure  to  adequately  protect  private  health  information  could  result  in  severe  harm  to  our  reputation  and  subject  us  to 
significant liabilities, each of which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Throughout the clinical trial process, we may obtain the private health information of our trial subjects. There are a number of 
state,  federal  and  international  laws  protecting  the  privacy  and  security  of  health  information  and  personal  data.  As  part  of  the 
American Recovery and Reinvestment Act 2009 (“ARRA”), Congress amended the privacy and security provisions of HIPAA. HIPAA 
imposes  limitations  on  the  use  and  disclosure  of  an  individual’s  healthcare  information  by  healthcare  providers  conducting  certain 
electronic transactions, healthcare clearinghouses, and health insurance plans, collectively referred to as covered entities. The HIPAA 
amendments also impose compliance obligations and corresponding penalties for non-compliance on certain individuals and entities 
that provide services to or perform certain functions on behalf of healthcare providers and other covered entities involving the use or 
disclosure of individually identifiable health information, collectively referred to as business associates. ARRA also made significant 
increases in the penalties for improper use or disclosure of an individual’s health information under HIPAA and extended enforcement 
authority  to  state  attorneys  general.  The  amendments  also  create  notification  requirements  to  federal  regulators,  and  in  some  cases 
local and national media, for individuals whose health information has been inappropriately accessed or disclosed. Notification is not 
required  under  HIPAA  if  the  health  information  that  is  improperly  used  or  disclosed  is  deemed  secured  in  accordance  with  certain 
encryption  or  other  standards  developed  by  the  U.S.  Department  of  Health  and  Human  Services,  or  HHS.  Most  states  have  laws 
requiring notification of affected individuals and state regulators in the event of a breach of personal information, which is a broader 
class of information than the health information protected by HIPAA. Many state laws impose significant data security requirements, 
such as encryption or mandatory contractual terms to ensure ongoing protection of personal information. Activities outside of the U.S. 

30

implicate  local  and  national  data  protection  standards,  impose  additional  compliance  requirements  and  generate  additional  risks  of 
enforcement  for  non-compliance.  The  EU’s  Data  Protection  Directive,  Canada’s  Personal  Information  Protection  and  Electronic 
Documents Act and other data protection, privacy and similar national, state/provincial and local laws may also restrict the access, use 
and disclosure of patient health information abroad. We may be required to expend significant capital and other resources to ensure 
ongoing  compliance  with  applicable  privacy  and  data  security  laws,  to  protect  against  security  breaches  and  hackers  or  to  alleviate 
problems caused by such breaches.

Our operations are subject to anti-corruption laws, including Australian bribery laws, the United Kingdom Bribery Act, and the 
FCPA and other anti-corruption laws that apply in countries where we do business.

Anti-corruption  laws  generally  prohibit  us  and  our  employees  and  intermediaries  from  bribing,  being  bribed  or  making  other 
prohibited payments to government officials or other persons to obtain or retain business or gain some other business advantage. We 
participate in collaborations and relationships with third parties whose actions could potentially subject us to liability under these anti-
corruption laws. In addition, we cannot predict the nature, scope or effect of future regulatory requirements to which our international 
operations might be subject or the manner in which existing laws might be administered or interpreted.

There is no assurance that we will be completely effective in ensuring our compliance with all applicable anti-corruption laws or 
other laws including trade related laws. If we are not in compliance with these laws, we may be subject to criminal and civil penalties, 
disgorgement and other sanctions and remedial measures, and legal expenses, which could have an adverse impact on our business, 
financial  condition,  results  of  operations  and  liquidity.  Likewise,  any  investigation  of  any  potential  violations  of  these  laws  by 
respective government bodies could also have an adverse impact on our reputation, our business, results of operations and financial 
condition.

We may lose our foreign private issuer status, which would then require us to comply with the Exchange Act’s domestic reporting 
regime and cause us to incur additional legal, accounting and other expenses.

In  order  to  maintain  our  current  status  as  a  foreign  private  issuer,  either  (1) a  majority  of  our  ordinary  shares  must  be  either 
directly or indirectly owned of record by non-residents of the United States or (2) (a) a majority of our executive officers or directors 
must  not  be  U.S.  citizens  or  residents,  (b) more  than  50  percent  of  our  assets  cannot  be  located  in  the  United  States  and  (c) our 
business must be administered principally outside the United States. If we lost this status, we would be required to comply with the 
Exchange Act reporting and other requirements applicable to U.S. domestic issuers, which are more detailed and extensive than the 
requirements  for  foreign  private  issuers.  We  may  also  be  required  to  make  changes  in  our  corporate  governance  practices  in 
accordance  with  various  SEC  rules  and  Nasdaq  listing  standards.  Further,  we  would  be  required  to  comply  with  United  States 
generally accepted accounting principles, as opposed to IFRS, in the preparation and issuance of our financial statements for historical 
and  current  periods.  The  regulatory  and  compliance  costs  to  us  under  U.S.  securities  laws  if  we  are  required  to  comply  with  the 
reporting requirements applicable to a U.S. domestic issuer may be higher than the cost we would incur as a foreign private issuer. As 
a result, we expect that a loss of foreign private issuer status would increase our legal and financial compliance costs.

If  we  fail  to   maintain  proper  internal  controls,  our  ability  to  produce  accurate  financial  statements  or  comply  with  applicable 
regulations could be impaired.

Section 404(a) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (the “Sarbanes-Oxley Act”), requires that our management assess and report 
annually  on  the  effectiveness  of  our  internal  controls  over  financial  reporting  and  identify  any  material  weaknesses  in  our  internal 
controls  over  financial  reporting.  In  order  to  maintain  and  improve  the  effectiveness  of  our  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  and 
internal  control  over  financial  reporting,  we  have  expended,  and  anticipate  that  we  will  continue  to  expend,  significant  resources, 
including accounting-related costs and significant management oversight. 

If either we are unable to conclude that we have effective internal controls over financial reporting or our independent auditors 
are unwilling or unable to provide us with an unqualified report on the effectiveness of our internal controls over financial reporting as 
required by Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, investors may lose confidence in our operating results, the price of the ADSs 
could  decline  and  we  may  be  subject  to  litigation  or  regulatory  enforcement  actions.  In  addition,  if  we  are  unable  to  meet  the 
requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, we may not be able to remain listed on Nasdaq Global Select Market.

We have incurred and will continue to incur significant increased costs as a result of operating as a company whose ADSs are 
publicly traded in the United States, and our management will continue to be required to devote substantial time to new compliance 
initiatives.

As a company whose ADSs have recently begun to be publicly traded in the United States, we have incurred and will continue 
to incur significant legal, accounting, insurance and other expenses that we did not previously incur. In addition, the Sarbanes-Oxley 
Act,  Dodd-Frank  Wall  Street  Reform  and  Consumer  Protection  Act  and  related  rules  implemented  by  the  SEC  and  Nasdaq,  have 

31

imposed  various  requirements  on  public  companies  including  requiring  establishment  and  maintenance  of  effective  disclosure  and 
financial  controls.  Our  management  and  other  personnel  will  need  to  continue  to  devote  a  substantial  amount  of  time  to  these 
compliance initiatives, and we will need to add additional personnel and build our internal compliance infrastructure. Moreover, these 
rules  and  regulations  have  increased  and  will  continue  to  increase  our  legal  and  financial  compliance  costs  and  will  make  some 
activities more time-consuming and costly. These laws and regulations could also make it more difficult and expensive for us to attract 
and retain qualified persons to serve on our board of directors, our board committees or as our senior management. Furthermore, if we 
are  unable  to  satisfy  our  obligations  as  a  public  company,  we  could  be  subject  to  delisting  of  the  ADSs,  fines,  sanctions  and  other 
regulatory action and potentially civil litigation.

We have never declared or paid dividends on our ordinary shares, and we do not anticipate paying dividends in the foreseeable 
future. Therefore, you must rely on price-appreciation of our ordinary shares or ADSs for a return on your investment.

We have never declared or paid cash dividends on our ordinary shares. For the foreseeable future, we currently intend to retain 
all available funds and any future earnings to support our operations and to finance the growth and development of our business. Any 
future  determination  to  declare  cash  dividends  will  be  made  at  the  discretion  of  our  board  of  directors,  subject  to  compliance  with 
applicable laws and covenants under current or future credit facilities, which may restrict or limit our ability to pay dividends, and will 
depend on our financial condition, operating results, capital requirements, general business conditions and other factors that our board 
of directors may deem relevant. We do not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our ordinary shares in the foreseeable future. As a 
result,  a  return  on  your  investment  in  our  ordinary  shares  or  ADSs  will  likely  only  occur  if  our  ordinary  share  or  ADS  price 
appreciates. There is no guarantee that our ordinary shares or ADSs will appreciate in value in the future.

Australian  takeover  laws  may  discourage  takeover  offers  being  made  for  us  or  may  discourage  the  acquisition  of  a  significant 
position in our ordinary shares or ADSs.

We are incorporated in Australia and are subject to the takeover laws of Australia. Among other things, we are subject to the 
Australian  Corporations  Act  2001  (the  “Corporations  Act”).  Subject  to  a  range  of  exceptions,  the  Corporations  Act  prohibits  the 
acquisition of a direct or indirect interest in our issued voting shares if the acquisition of that interest will lead to a person’s voting 
power in us increasing to more than 20%, or increasing from a starting point that is above 20% and below 90%. Australian takeover 
laws  may  discourage  takeover  offers  being  made  for  us  or  may  discourage  the  acquisition  of  a  significant  position  in  our  ordinary 
shares. This may have the ancillary effect of entrenching our board of directors and may deprive or limit our shareholders’ opportunity 
to sell their ordinary shares and may further restrict the ability of our shareholders to obtain a premium from such transactions, and 
which will also impact the value of the ADSs.

Risks Related to Our Trading Markets

The  market  price  and  trading  volume  of  our  ordinary  shares  and  ADSs  may  be  volatile  and  may  be  affected  by  economic 
conditions beyond our control.

The  market  price  of  our  ordinary  shares  and  ADSs  may  be  highly  volatile  and  subject  to  wide  fluctuations.  In  addition,  the 
trading volume of our ordinary shares and ADSs may fluctuate and cause significant price variations to occur. We cannot assure you 
that the market price of our ordinary shares and ADSs will not fluctuate or significantly decline in the future.

Some specific factors that could  negatively affect  the price of  our ordinary shares  and ADSs or  result  in fluctuations  in their 

price and trading volume include:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

results of clinical trials of our product candidates;

results of clinical trials of our competitors’ products;

regulatory actions with respect to our products or our competitors’ products;

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our quarterly operating results or those of our competitors;

publication of research reports by securities analysts about us or our competitors in the industry;

our failure or the failure of our competitors to meet analysts’ projections or guidance that we or our competitors may give 
to the market;

fluctuations of exchange rates between the U.S. dollar and the Australian dollar;

additions to or departures of our key management personnel;

issuances by us of debt or equity securities;

32

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

litigation  involving  our  company,  including:  shareholder  litigation;  investigations  or  audits  by  regulators  into  the 
operations of our company; or proceedings initiated by our competitors or clients;

strategic  decisions  by  us  or  our  competitors,  such  as  acquisitions,  divestitures,  spin-offs,  joint  ventures,  strategic 
investments or changes in business strategy;

the passage of legislation or other regulatory developments affecting us or our industry;

fluctuations in the valuation of companies perceived by investors to be comparable to us;

changes in trading volume of ADSs on the Nasdaq Global Select Market and of our ordinary shares on the ASX;

sales  or  perceived  potential  sales  of  the  ADSs  or  ordinary  shares  by  us,  our  directors,  senior  management  or  our 
shareholders in the future;

short selling or other market manipulation activities;

announcement or expectation of additional financing efforts;

terrorist acts, acts of war or periods of widespread civil unrest;

natural disasters and other calamities;

changes in market conditions for biopharmaceutical companies; and

conditions in the U.S. or Australian financial markets or changes in general economic conditions.

The dual listing of our ordinary shares and the ADSs may adversely affect the liquidity and value of these securities.

Our  ADSs  are  listed  on  the  Nasdaq  and  our  ordinary  shares  are  listed  on  the  ASX.  We  cannot  predict  the  effect  of  this  dual 
listing  on  the  value  of  our  ordinary  shares  and  ADSs.  However,  the  dual  listing  of  our  ordinary  shares  and  ADSs  may  dilute  the 
liquidity of these securities in one or both markets and may adversely affect the development of an active trading market for the ADSs 
in the United States. The price of the ADSs could also be adversely affected by trading in our ordinary shares on the ASX, and vice 
versa.

If securities or industry analysts do not publish research reports about our business, or if they issue an adverse opinion about our 
business, the market price and trading volume of our ordinary shares and/or ADSs could decline.

The trading market for our ordinary shares and ADSs will be influenced by the research and reports that securities or industry 
analysts  publish  about  us  or  our  business.  Securities  and  industry  analysts  may  discontinue  research  on  our  company,  to  the  extent 
such coverage currently exists, or in other cases, may never publish research on our company. If no or too few securities or industry 
analysts  commence  coverage  of  our  company,  the  trading  price  for  our  ordinary  shares  and  ADSs  would  likely  be  negatively 
impacted. In the event securities or industry analysts initiate coverage, if one or more of the analysts who cover us downgrade our 
ordinary shares or ADSs or publish inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, the market price of our ADSs would likely 
decline.  If  one  or  more  of  these  analysts  cease  coverage  of  our  company  or  fail  to  publish  reports  on  us  regularly,  demand  for  our 
ordinary shares and/or ADSs could decrease, which might cause our price and trading volume to decline.

Risks Related to Ownership of Our ADSs

An active trading market for the ADSs may not develop in the United States

Our ADSs are listed in the United States on the Nasdaq under the symbol “MESO.” However, we cannot assure you that an 
active  public  market  in  the  United  States  for  the  ADSs  will  develop  on  that  exchange,  or  if  developed,  that  this  market  will  be 
sustained.  In  the  past,  following  periods  of  volatility  in  the  market  price  of  a  company’s  securities,  shareholders  often  instituted 
securities class action litigation against that company. If we were involved in a class action suit, it could divert the attention of senior 
management and, if adversely determined, could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

We are subject to risks associated with currency fluctuations, and changes in foreign currency exchange rates could impact our 
results of operations.

Historically,  a  substantial  portion  of  our  operating  expenses  has  been  denominated  in  U.S.  dollars  and  our  main  currency 
requirements are U.S. dollars, Australian dollars and Singapore dollars. Approximately 95% of our cash and cash equivalents as of 
June 30, 2017 were denominated in U.S. dollars and 5% were denominated in Australian dollars. Because we have multiple functional 
currencies  across  different  jurisdictions,  changes  in  the  exchange  rate  between  these  currencies  and  the  foreign  currencies  of  the 
transactions  recorded  in  our  accounts  could  materially  impact  our  reported  results  of  operations  and  distort  period-to-period 

33

comparisons. For example, a portion of our research and clinical trials are undertaken in Australia. As such, payment will be made in 
Australian dollar currency, and may exceed the budgeted expenditure if there are adverse currency fluctuations against the U.S. dollar.

Further, any significant change in the value of the Australian dollar may have a material adverse effect on the value of our ADSs 
in  U.S.  dollars.  More  specifically,  if  we  decide  to  convert  our  Australian  dollars  into  U.S.  dollars  for  any  business  purpose, 
appreciation of the U.S. dollar against the Australian dollar would have a negative effect on the U.S. dollar amount available to us. 
Appreciation or depreciation in the value of the Australian dollar relative to the U.S. dollar would affect our financial results reported 
in U.S. dollar terms without giving effect to any underlying change in our business or results of operations. As a result of such foreign 
currency fluctuations, it could be more difficult to detect underlying trends in our business and results of operations.

We currently report our financial results under IFRS, which differs in certain significant respect from U.S. GAAP.

Currently  we  report  our  financial  statements  under  IFRS.  There  have  been  and  there  may  in  the  future  be  certain  significant 
differences  between  IFRS  and  U.S.  GAAP,  including  differences  related  to  revenue  recognition,  intangible  assets,  share-based 
compensation expense, income tax and earnings per share. As a result, our financial information and reported earnings for historical or 
future periods could be significantly different if they were prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. In addition, we do not intend to 
provide a reconciliation between IFRS and U.S. GAAP unless it is required under applicable law. As a result, you may not be able to 
meaningfully compare our financial statements under IFRS with those companies that prepare financial statements under U.S. GAAP.

As a foreign private issuer, we are permitted and expect to follow certain home country corporate governance practices in lieu of 
certain Nasdaq requirements applicable to domestic issuers and we are permitted to file less information with the Securities and 
Exchange Commission than a company that is not a foreign private issuer. This may afford less protection to holders of our ADSs.

As a “foreign private issuer,” as defined in Rule 405 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities 
Act”),  whose  ADSs  will  be  listed  on  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market,  we  will  be  permitted  to,  and  plan  to,  follow  certain  home 
country  corporate  governance  practices  in  lieu  of  certain  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market  requirements.  For  example,  we  may  follow 
home country practice with regard to certain corporate governance requirements, such as the composition of the board of directors and 
quorum requirements applicable to shareholders’ meetings. This difference may result in a board that is more difficult to remove and 
less shareholder approvals required generally. In addition, we may follow home country practice instead of the Nasdaq Global Select 
Market requirement to hold executive sessions and to obtain shareholder approval prior to the issuance of securities in connection with 
certain acquisitions or private placements of securities. The above differences may result in less shareholder oversight and requisite 
approvals for certain acquisition or financing related decisions. Further, we may follow home country practice instead of the Nasdaq 
Global  Select  Market  requirement  to  obtain  shareholder  approval  prior  to  the  establishment  or  amendment  of  certain  share  option, 
purchase  or  other  compensation  plans.  This  difference  may  result  in  less  shareholder  oversight  and  requisite  approvals  for  certain 
company  compensation  related  decisions.  A  foreign  private  issuer  must  disclose  in  its  annual  reports  filed  with  the  Securities  and 
Exchange Commission, or SEC, and the Nasdaq Global Select Market, the requirements with which it does not comply followed by a 
description of its applicable home country practice. The Australian home country practices described above may afford less protection 
to holders of the ADSs than that provided under the Nasdaq Global Select Market rules.

Further, as a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from certain rules under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended 
(the “Exchange Act”), that impose disclosure requirements as well as procedural requirements for proxy solicitations under Section 14 
of the Exchange Act. In addition, our officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and “short-swing” 
profit  recovery  provisions  of  Section 16  of  the  Exchange  Act.  Moreover,  we  are  not  required  to  file  periodic  reports  and  financial 
statements with the SEC as frequently or as promptly as a company that files as a domestic issuer whose securities are registered under 
the Exchange Act, nor are we generally required to comply with the SEC’s Regulation FD, which restricts the selective disclosure of 
material non-public information. Accordingly, the information may not be disseminated in as timely a manner, or there may be less 
information publicly available concerning us generally than there is for a company that files as a domestic issuer.

ADS holders may be subject to additional risks related to holding ADSs rather than ordinary shares.

ADS holders do not hold ordinary shares directly and, as such, are subject to, among others, the following additional risks.

•

•

As an ADS holder, we will not treat you as one of our shareholders and you will not be able to exercise shareholder rights, 
except through the American depositary receipt, or ADR, depositary as permitted by the deposit agreement.

Distributions on the ordinary shares represented by your ADSs will be paid to the ADR depositary, and before the ADR 
depositary makes a distribution to you on behalf of your ADSs, any withholding taxes that must be paid will be deducted. 
Additionally, if the exchange rate fluctuates during a time when the ADR depositary cannot convert the foreign currency, 
you may lose some or all of the value of the distribution.

34

•

We  and  the  ADR  depositary  may  amend  or  terminate  the  deposit  agreement  without  the  ADS  holders’  consent  in  a 
manner that could prejudice ADS holders.

ADS holders must act through the ADR depositary to exercise your voting rights and, as a result, you may be unable to exercise 

your voting rights on a timely basis.

As a holder of ADSs (and not the ordinary shares underlying your ADSs), we will not treat you as one of our shareholders, and 
you  will  not  be  able  to  exercise  shareholder  rights.  The  ADR  depositary  will  be  the  holder  of  the  ordinary  shares  underlying  your 
ADSs, and ADS holders will be able to exercise voting rights with respect to the ordinary shares represented by the ADSs only in 
accordance with the deposit agreement relating to the ADSs. There are practical limitations on the ability of ADS holders to exercise 
their voting rights due to the additional procedural steps involved in communicating with these holders. For example, holders of our 
ordinary shares will receive notice of shareholders’ meetings by mail or email and will be able to exercise their voting rights by either 
attending the shareholders meeting in person or voting by proxy. ADS holders, by comparison, will not receive notice directly from 
us. Instead, in accordance with the deposit agreement, we will provide notice to the ADR depositary of any such shareholders meeting 
and details concerning the matters to be voted upon. As soon as practicable after receiving notice from us of any such meeting, the 
ADR depositary will mail to holders of ADSs the notice of the meeting and a statement as to the manner in which voting instructions 
may be given by ADS holders. To exercise their voting rights, ADS holders must then instruct the ADR depositary as to voting the 
ordinary shares represented by their ADSs. Due to these procedural steps involving the ADR depositary, the process for exercising 
voting rights may take longer for ADS holders than for holders of ordinary shares. The ordinary shares represented by ADSs for which 
the  ADR  depositary  fails  to  receive  timely  voting  instructions  will  not  be  voted.  Under  Australian  law  and  our  Constitution,  any 
resolution to be considered at a meeting of the shareholders shall be decided on a show of hands unless a poll is demanded by the 
shareholders at or before the declaration of the result of the show of hands. Under voting by a show of hands, multiple “yes” votes by 
ADS holders will only count as one “yes” vote and will be negated by a single “no” vote, unless a poll is demanded.

If we are or become classified as a passive foreign investment company, our U.S. securityholders may suffer adverse tax 
consequences.

Based upon an analysis of our income and assets for the taxable year ended June 30, 2017, we do not believe we were a passive 

foreign investment company (a "PFIC") for our most recent tax year. In general, if at least 75% of our gross income for any taxable 
year consists of passive income or at least 50% of the average quarterly value of assets is attributable to assets that produce passive 
income or are held for the production of passive income, including cash, then we will be classified as a PFIC for U.S. federal income 
tax purposes. Passive income for this purpose generally includes dividends, interest, certain royalties and rents, and gains from 
commodities and securities transactions. Passive assets for this purpose generally includes assets held for the production of passive 
income. Accordingly, passive assets generally include any cash, cash equivalents and cash invested in short-term, interest bearing, 
debt instruments or bank deposits that are readily convertible into cash. Since PFIC status depends upon the composition of our 
income and assets and the market value of our assets from time to time, and as the determination of PFIC status must be made 
annually at the end of each taxable year, there can be no assurance that we will not be considered a PFIC for any future taxable year. 
Investors should be aware that our gross income for purposes of the PFIC income test depends on the receipt of Australian research 
and development tax incentive credits and other active revenue, and there can be no assurances that such tax incentive credit programs 
will not be revoked or modified, that we will continue to conduct our operations in the manner necessary to be eligible for such 
incentives or that we will receive other gross income that is not considered passive for purposes of the PFIC income test. If we were a 
PFIC for any taxable year during a U.S. investor’s holding period for the ordinary shares or ADSs, we would ordinarily continue to be 
treated as a PFIC for each subsequent year during which the U.S. investor owned the ordinary shares or ADSs. If we were treated as a 
PFIC, U.S. holders would be subject to special punitive tax rules with respect to any "excess distribution" received from us and any 
gain realized from a sale or other disposition (including a pledge) of the ordinary shares or ADSs unless a U.S. holder made a timely 
"qualified electing fund" or "mark-to-market" election. For a more detailed discussion of the U.S. tax consequences to U.S. holders if 
we were classified as a PFIC, see Item 10.E- "Taxation — Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations to U.S. Holders — 
Passive Foreign Investment Company".

Changes  in  foreign  currency  exchange  rates  could  impact  amounts  you  receive  as  a  result  of  any  dividend  or  distribution  we 
declare on our ordinary shares.

Any significant change in the value of the Australian dollar may impact amounts you receive in U.S. dollars as a result of any 
dividend or distribution we declare on our ordinary shares as a holder of our ADSs. More specifically, any dividends that we pay on 
our ordinary shares will be in Australian dollars. The depositary for the ADSs has agreed to pay to you the cash dividends or other 
distributions  it  or  the  custodian  receives  on  our  ordinary  shares  or  other  deposited  securities  after  deducting  its  fees  and  expenses, 
including  any  such  fees  or  expenses  incurred  to  convert  any  such  Australian  dollars  into  U.S.  dollars.  You  will  receive  these 
distributions in U.S. dollars in proportion to the number of our ordinary shares your ADSs represent. Depreciation of the U.S. dollar 
against the Australian dollar would have a negative effect on any such distribution payable to you.

35

You may not receive distributions on our ordinary shares represented by the ADSs or any value for such distribution if it is illegal 
or impractical to make them available to holders of ADSs.

While we do not anticipate paying any dividends on our ordinary shares in the foreseeable future, if such a dividend is declared, 
the  depositary  for  the  ADSs  has  agreed  to  pay  to  you  the  cash  dividends  or  other  distributions  it  or  the  custodian  receives  on  our 
ordinary shares or other deposited securities after deducting its fees and expenses. You will receive these distributions in proportion to 
the  number  of  our  ordinary  shares  your  ADSs  represent.  However,  in  accordance  with  the  limitations  set  forth  in  the  deposit 
agreement, it may be unlawful or impractical to make a distribution available to holders of ADSs. We have no obligation to take any 
other action to permit the distribution of the ADSs, ordinary shares, rights or anything else to holders of the ADSs. This means that 
you may not receive the distributions we make on our ordinary shares or any value from them if it is unlawful or impractical to make 
them available to you. These restrictions may have a material adverse effect on the value of your ADSs.

You may be subject to limitations on transfers of your ADSs.

ADSs are transferable on the books of the depositary. However, the depositary may close its transfer books at any time or from 
time  to  time  when  it  deems  expedient  in  connection  with  the  performance  of  its  duties.  In  addition,  the  depositary  may  refuse  to 
deliver, transfer or register transfers of ADSs generally when our books or the books of the depositary are closed, or at any time if we 
or the depositary deems it advisable to do so because of any requirement of law or of any government or governmental body, or under 
any provision of the deposit agreement, or for any other reason.

U.S.  investors  may  have  difficulty  enforcing  civil  liabilities  against  our  company,  our  directors  or  members  of  our  senior 
management.

Several  of  our  officers  and  directors  are  non-residents  of  the  United  States,  and  a  substantial  portion  of  the  assets  of  such 
persons are located outside the United States. As a result, it may be impossible to serve process on such persons in the United States or 
to enforce judgments obtained in U.S. courts against them based on civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States. 
Even  if  you  are  successful  in  bringing  such  an  action,  there  is  doubt  as  to  whether  Australian  courts  would  enforce  certain  civil 
liabilities  under  U.S.  securities  laws  in  original  actions  or  judgments  of  U.S.  courts  based  upon  these  civil  liability  provisions.  In 
addition,  awards  of  punitive  damages  in  actions  brought  in  the  United  States  or  elsewhere  may  be  unenforceable  in  Australia  or 
elsewhere outside the U.S. An award for monetary damages under the U.S. securities laws would be considered punitive if it does not 
seek  to  compensate  the  claimant  for  loss  or  damage  suffered  and  is  intended  to  punish  the  defendant.  The  enforceability  of  any 
judgment in Australia will depend on the particular facts of the case as well as the laws and treaties in effect at the time. The United 
States and Australia do not currently have a treaty or statute providing for recognition and enforcement of the judgments of the other 
country (other than arbitration awards) in civil and commercial matters.

As  a  result,  our  public  shareholders  and  holders  of  the  ADSs  may  have  more  difficulty  in  protecting  their  interests  through 
actions against us, our management, our directors than would shareholders of a corporation incorporated in a jurisdiction in the United 
States.

Our Constitution and Australian laws and regulations applicable to us may adversely affect our ability to take actions that could be 
beneficial to our shareholders.

As an Australian company we are subject to different corporate requirements than a corporation organized under the laws of the 
United  States.  Our  Constitution,  as  well  as  the  Corporations  Act,  sets  forth  various  rights  and  obligations  that  apply  to  us  as  an 
Australian company and which may not apply to a U.S. corporation. These requirements may operate differently than those of many 
U.S. companies.

Item 4.

Information on the Company

4.A

History and Development of Mesoblast

Mesoblast Limited

Mesoblast Limited was incorporated on June 8, 2004 as a public company in Australia under the Corporations Act 2001 with an 
indefinite duration. On December 16, 2004 we became listed on the Australian Securities Exchange (the “ASX”). On November 13, 
2015, we became listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market (“Nasdaq”) and from this date we have been dual-listed in Australia and 
the U.S. Our registered office is located at the following address:

Mesoblast Ltd
Level 38
55 Collins Street

36

Melbourne VIC 3000
Australia
Telephone: +61 3 9639 6036
Web: www.mesoblast.com

Our agent for service of process in the United States is Mesoblast Inc., 505 Fifth Avenue, Level 3, New York, NY 10017.

For a list of our significant subsidiaries, see Exhibit 8.1 to this Annual Report.

Important Corporate Developments 

Fiscal year 2017 to date of annual report 

August

Announced an entitlement offer of ordinary shares to all existing eligible shareholders in Australia and New Zealand and 
institutional  shareholders  in  certain  other  countries  in  private  placements.  The  entitlement  offer  is  underwritten  by  an 
Australian investment bank and is expected to raise gross proceeds of approximately A$50.7 million. 

Announced plans to achieve an accelerated market entry of product candidate MPC-150-IM in the treatment of patients 
with the most advanced stages of chronic heart failure, defined as New York Heart Association stages Class III and Class 
IV.

Results from the Phase 2a trial in patients with post-traumatic osteoarthritis published in peer-reviewed journal Arthritis 
Research and Therapy.

June

April

Results  from  Phase  2  trial  in  patients  with  biologic  refractory  rheumatoid  arthritis  were  selected  by  peer  review  and 
presented at the European League Against Rheumatism (EULAR) Annual European Congress of Rheumatology.

Phase  3  trial  of  product  candidate  MPC-150-IM  in  patients  with  moderate  to  advanced  chronic  heart  failure  was 
successful in the pre-specified interim futility analysis of the efficacy endpoint in the trial's first 270 patients. The trial’s 
Independent Data Monitoring Committee formally recommended that the trial should continue as planned

Received  A$3.7  million  from  the  Australian  Government  for  Research  &  Development  activities  conducted  during  the 
2016 financial year.

FDA  cleared  the  commencement  of  a  24-patient  trial  sponsored  and  funded  by  the  Boston  Children’s  Hospital  and 
combining  Mesoblast's  MPCs  with  corrective  heart  surgery  in  children  under  the  age  of  5  with  hypoplastic  left  heart 
syndrome.

March 

Successfully  completed  a  fully  underwritten  institutional  placement  of  26.25  million  new  shares  for  gross  proceeds  of 
approximately $40 million.

Results from the Phase 2 trial in patients with chronic low back pain due to intervertebral disc degeneration showed that a 
single intra-discal injection of 6 million MPCs resulted in meaningful improvements in both pain and function that were 
durable for at least 36 months.

FDA granted a Fast Track designation for the use of MSC-100-IV to achieve improved overall response rate in children 
with steroid refractory acute graft versus host disease.

February

39-week data from the Phase 2 trial in patients with rheumatoid arthritis resistant to anti-Tumor Necrosis Factor agents 
showed that a single intravenous infusion of the product candidate MPC-300-IV was well tolerated and demonstrated a 
durable improvement in clinical symptoms, physical function, and disease activity relative to placebo over this period of 
follow-up.

Results  of  a  new  study  published  in  the  peer-reviewed  journal  Stem  Cell  Research  &  Therapy  showed  that  a  single 
intravenous  infusion  of  150  million  of  the  Company’s  proprietary  allogeneic  “off-the-shelf”  STRO-3  immunoselected 
MPCs  significantly  improved  clinical  disease  severity,  reduced  joint  cartilage  erosions,  and  improved  synovial 
inflammation and histopathology in a large animal model of early rheumatoid arthritis.

December    Entered into an equity purchase agreement with Mallinckrodt Pharmaceuticals to exclusively negotiate a commercial and 
development partnership for MPC-06-ID in the treatment or prevention of moderate/severe chronic low back pain due to 
disc  degeneration  and  MSC-100-IV  in  the  treatment  of  acute  graft  versus  host  disease.  As  consideration,  Mallinckrodt 
purchased approximately 20.04 million of Mesoblast’s ordinary shares.

MD  Anderson  Cancer  Center  and  the  United  States  National  Institutes  of  Health  (NIH)  agreed  to  fund  a  clinical  trial 
combining MPC-based expansion and ex-vivo fucosylation of hematopoietic stem cells for cord blood transplantation in 
cancer patients. 

37

November Phase  3  trial  of  product  candidate  MSC-100-IV  used  as  front-line  therapy  in  children  with  steroid-resistant  acute  graft 

versus host disease was successful in a pre-specified interim futility analysis.

October

Received the Frost & Sullivan Asia Pacific 2016 Cell Therapy Company of the Year Award. 

Results from the Phase 2 trial of product candidate, MPC-300-IV, in patients with diabetic kidney disease published in the 
peer-reviewed journal EBioMedicine.

September Mr William (Bill) A. Burns, former Chief Executive Officer (CEO) of Roche Pharmaceuticals, appointed Vice Chairman 

of Mesoblast

August 

Intellectual property portfolio covering the use of its mesenchymal precursor cells in the treatment of rheumatic diseases, 
including rheumatoid arthritis, strengthened by the granting of a key patent by the United States Patent and Trademark 
Office.

Results from Phase 2 trial in biologic refractory rheumatoid arthritis showed that a single intravenous infusion of product 
candidate, MPC-300-IV, was well tolerated and demonstrated a dose-related improvement in clinical symptoms, physical 
function and disease activity relative to placebo through the 12 week primary endpoint.

24 month results from phase 2 trial of chronic low back pain product candidate MPC-06-ID presented at the 24th Annual 
Scientific Meeting of the Spine Intervention Society and received the 2016 Best Basic Science Abstract award.

July

Announced plans for an early interim analysis on its Phase 3 chronic heart failure trial, projections for annualized cash 
burn and the establishment of an equity facility to provide up to A$120 million funding at the Company’s discretion for 
up to three years.

Fiscal year 2016  

June

May

April

March

Worldwide  rights  to  mesenchymal  precursor  cell  technology  platform  for  the  cardiovascular  field  regained  from  Teva 
Pharmaceutical Industries Ltd and agreement by the FDA for the use of a second navigational catheter system in Phase 3 
program for advanced heart failure.

Received A$6.2 million from the Australian Government for Research & Development activities during the 2015 fiscal 
year. 

Results  from  Phase  2a  trial  in  patients  with  post-traumatic  knee  injury  to  the  anterior  cruciate  ligament  showed  that  a 
single  intra-articular  injection  of  product  candidate,  MPC-75-IA,  resulted  in  improvement  in  pain,  function,  cartilage 
thickness, and joint structure over 24 months.

United  States  Patent  and  Trademark  Office  granted  a  key  patent  covering  the  use  of  the  Company’s  proprietary 
mesenchymal  precursor  cells  for  the  treatment  or  prevention  of  a  broad  range  of  rheumatic  conditions,  including 
rheumatoid arthritis. 

Exclusively  licensed  patented  technology  developed  at  Harvard  Medical  School  for  the  modification  of  mesenchymal 
lineage adult stem cells to enhance their natural homing properties to sites of excessive inflammation.

February Mesoblast’s licensee in Japan, JCR Pharmaceuticals Co Ltd (“JCR”), launched TEMCELL® HS. Inj. (“TEMCELL”), a 
registered  trademark  of  JCR,  for  the  treatment  of  acute  graft  versus  host  disease  in  children  and  adults  in  Japan. 
TEMCELL. is the first allogeneic cell therapy to be fully approved in Japan.

Results presented from Expanded Access Program showing that use of MSC-100-IV demonstrated clinically meaningful 
responses  and  associated  significantly  increased  survival  in  children  with  steroid-refractory  acute  graft  versus  host 
disease.

Results  from  the  first  cohort  of  Phase  2  trial  in  rheumatoid  arthritis  patients  who  have  previously  failed  one  or  more 
biologic agents showed that product candidate, MPC-300-IV, resulted in early and sustained clinical responses.

January

The  United  States  Food  and  Drug  Administration  agreed  to  a  reduction  of  the  size  of  ongoing  Phase  3  trial  in  chronic 
heart failure of its proprietary cell-based medicine MPC-150-IM from 1,165 to approximately 600 patients.

November

Initial public offering in the United States with listing on Nasdaq Global Select Market completed.

Mesoblast’s licensee in Japan, JCR, received notification that the Japanese Government’s National Health Insurance body 
formally set the price for the mesenchymal stem cell product TEMCELL.

October

United  States  Patent  and  Trademark  Office  granted  a  key  patent  covering  the  use  of  the  Company’s  proprietary  adult 
mesenchymal precursor cells for the formation and repair of blood vessels in ischemic tissues.

38

September Additional Phase 2 trial results for the treatment of chronic heart failure showed that mesenchymal precursor cell therapy 

had the greatest cardioprotective effect in the subset of patients with more advanced heart failure.

Mesoblast’s Japanese partner, JCR, received full approval from the Japanese Ministry of Health, Labour and Welfare for 
TEMCELL.

July  

Phase 2 trial results of cell therapy product candidate for the treatment of chronic heart failure published in Circulation 
Research, the peer-reviewed journal of the American Heart Association.  

Phase 2 trial results of cell therapy product candidate for the treatment of type 2 diabetes published in Diabetes Care, the 
peer-reviewed journal of the American Diabetes Association.

4.B

Business Overview

We  are  a  global  leader  in  developing  innovative  cellular  medicines.  We  have  leveraged  our  proprietary  technology  platform,  
based  on  specialized  cells  known  as  mesenchymal  lineage  adult  stem  cells  (“MLCs”),  to  establish  a  broad  portfolio  of  late-stage 
product candidates. 

Our allogeneic, “off the shelf” product candidates target advanced stages of diseases with high, unmet medical needs including 
cardiovascular conditions, orthopedic disorders, immunologic and inflammatory disorders and oncology and hematologic conditions. 
We also have a promising emerging pipeline of products for follow-on indications.

Each  MLC-derived  product  candidate  has  distinct  technical  characteristics,  target  indications,  reimbursement  strategy, 

commercialization potential, and partnering opportunities.

Mesenchymal Lineage Adult Stem Cells

MLCs are present around blood vessels in all tissues where they can respond effectively to various signals associated with tissue 
damage. This response includes the secretion by MLCs of a variety of biomolecules, including growth factors, cytokines, chemokines 
and immunomodulatory biomolecules that affect various reparative mechanisms associated with the maintenance of tissue health. The 
coordinated beneficial effects of these biomolecules on damaged tissues include:

•

•

•

Blood  vessel  function  and  regeneration.  MLCs  play  a  central  role  in  the  maintenance,  repair  and  regeneration  of  blood 
vessels. This is achieved in large part through the secretion of growth factors which act on neighboring endothelial cells to 
promote blood vessel regeneration and function.

Tissue  repair.  MLCs  represent  a  key  cellular  constituent  of  stem  cell  niches  in  multiple  adult  tissues  such  as  the  bone 
marrow, heart and brain where they facilitate endogenous tissue repair by multiple mechanisms, including promotion of 
survival and function of mature cells within a given tissue or of the endogenous stem cells with which they are associated 
in  niches  within  these  tissues.  This  is  achieved  by  secretion  of  a  broad  repertoire  of  bioactive  molecules,  including 
chemokines,  growth  factors  and  enzymes,  which  promote  survival  and  proliferation  together  with  remodeling  of  the 
extracellular matrix of the tissue.

Immunomodulation. Located at the interface between the circulation and the tissues, MLCs play a physiological role in 
modulating  immune  responses  via  their  ability  to  alter  the  effector  functions  of  extravasated  white  blood  cells  by  up-
regulation of a battery of secreted immunomodulatory proteins.

Our MLC technology platform enables development of a broad product range based on distinct cell types derived from or that 
are  the  progeny  of  the  earliest  precursors  of  the  mesenchymal  cell  lineage  in  adult  tissues.  Mesenchymal  precursor  cells  (MPCs), 
constitute the earliest known cell type in the MLC lineage in vivo.

MPCs can be isolated using monoclonal antibodies and culture-expanded using methods that enable efficient expansion without 
differentiation. Mesenchymal stem cells (MSCs), are defined biologically in culture following density gradient separation from other 
tissue  cell  types  and  following  culture  by  plastic  adherence.  MSCs  presumably  represent  culture-expanded  in  vitro  progeny  of  the 
undifferentiated MPCs present in vivo. The different functional characteristics of each cell type enables distinct product development 
for different targeted diseases.

Allogeneic, Off-the-Shelf, Commercially Scalable Products

Our  proprietary  MLC-based  products  have  two  distinct  technical  properties  that  enable  their  use  for  allogeneic  purposes, 

meaning cells from one donor can be expanded to treat many unrelated recipients.

39

Expansion: We have developed proprietary methods that enable the large scale expansion of our MLCs while maintaining their 
ability  to  produce  key  biomolecules  associated  with  tissue  health  and  repair.  This  allows  us  to  produce  a  cellular  product  with 
consistent,  well-defined  therapeutic  properties,  batch  release  criteria  and  established  potency  assays,  all  with  accompanying 
manufacturing economies of scale.

Immune Privilege: Unlike other categories of stem cells or mature cell lineages, MLCs are immune privileged, in that they do 
not  express  specific  cell  surface  co-stimulatory  molecules  that  would  otherwise  initiate  an  immune  response  when  administered  to 
unrelated patients.

In  contrast,  autologous  stem  cell  products,  which  are  produced  from  the  patient’s  own  stem  cells,  require  individual  product 
regulatory  testing  and  do  not  benefit  from  manufacturing  economies  of  scale.  Moreover,  autologous  therapies  are  vulnerable  to 
significant patient-to-patient variability.

Our Product Candidates

We have prioritized our therapeutic programs into tiers based on stage of development, largest market opportunities and nearest 
term revenue potential. Tier 1 programs represent our lead programs where we focus the majority of our time and resources. Tier 2 
programs are continually evaluated, and we may advance these programs into Tier 1 depending on merit of clinical data generated, 
market  opportunity  or  collaboration  opportunity.  These  product  candidates  are  discussed  in  detail  below.  Additional  product 
candidates may advance into Tier 1 and Tier 2 going forward.  

We have three Tier 1 Phase 3 clinical trials actively recruiting in the United States, including MPC-150-IM for chronic and end-
stage heart failure, MPC-06-ID for chronic low back pain, and MSC-100-IV for acute graft versus host disease in children. We have 
another Tier 1 product candidate, MPC-300-IV for immune mediated diseases, which has been evaluated in Phase 2 trials in biologic 
refractory rheumatoid arthritis, and also diabetic kidney disease and type 2 diabetes. Our licensee in Japan, JCR, launched the first 
allogeneic cell-based product in Japan in February 2016, for the treatment of acute graft versus host disease. Below, we discuss our 
Tier 1 programs as well as our Tier 2 programs.

40

Tier 1 Programs

MPC-150-IM for the Treatment of Advanced and End-Stage Chronic Heart Failure (“CHF”) Due to Left Ventricular Dysfunction  

Overview

MPC-150-IM is being evaluated for the treatment of advanced CHF. MPC-150-IM consists of 150 million MPCs administered 
by  direct  cardiac  injection  in  patients  suffering  from  moderate/severe  or  end-stage  CHF  and  progressive  loss  of  heart  function 
following damage to the heart muscle caused by a heart attack, coronary artery disease, hypertension, genetic factors, or other causes.

MPCs  release  a  range  of  factors  when  triggered  by  specific  receptor-ligand  interactions  within  damaged  tissue.  Based  on 
preclinical data, it is believed that the factors released from the MPCs induce functional cardiac recovery by simultaneous activation 
of multiple pathways, including induction of endogenous vascular network formation, reduction in harmful inflammation, reduction in 
cardiac fibrosis, and regeneration of heart muscle through activation of intrinsic tissue precursors.

Our unit dose of 150 million cells was based on multiple preclinical large animal studies in ischemic and non-ischemic heart 
failure  models  which  identified  an  optimal  cell  dose  above  110  million.  A  completed  Phase  2  dose-  ranging  study  in  patients  with 
moderate  to  advanced  chronic  heart  failure  of  either  ischemic  or  non-ischemic  etiology  identified  the  150  million  dose  as  the  most 
effective for both improvement in left ventricular volumes and remodeling and in prevention of heart failure related hospitalizations or 
cardiac death.

Two trials of our MPC-150-IM investigational agent are ongoing: our Phase 3 trial in patients with Class II/III advanced CHF, 
and a Phase 2b trial in patients with end-stage CHF which is being conducted by in North America by a team of researchers within the 
National Institutes of Health (NIH)-funded Cardiothoracic Surgical Trials Network (CTSN).

Market Opportunity

CHF is a chronic condition characterized by an enlarged heart and insufficient blood flow to the organs and extremities of the 
body. The condition progresses over time and can be caused by many factors that put an excess demand on the heart muscle, including 
high blood pressure, incompetent valves, infections of the heart muscle or valves, or congenital heart problems.

In 2016, more than 15 million patients in the seven major global pharmaceutical markets are estimated to have been diagnosed 
with CHF. The American Heart Association estimated in 2017 that prevalence is expected to grow 46% by 2030 in the U.S., affecting 
more than 8 million Americans.  CHF causes severe economic, social, and personal costs. In the U.S., it is estimated that CHF results 
in direct costs of $60.2 billion annually when identified as a primary diagnosis and $115 billion as part of a disease milieu.

CHF is classified in relation to the severity of the symptoms experienced by the patient. The most commonly used classification 

system for functional severity of heart failure, established by the New York Heart Association (“NYHA”), is as follows:

•

•

•

•

Class I (mild): patients experience no or very mild symptoms with ordinary physical activity

Class II (mild): patients experience fatigue and shortness of breath during moderate physical activity

Class III (moderate): patients experience shortness of breath during even light physical activity

Class IV or end-stage (severe): patients are exhausted even at rest

Risk for recurrent heart failure-related hospitalizations and terminal cardiac events increases progressively with increases in left 
ventricular  volumes,  reduction  in  LV  ejection  fraction,  and  progression  in  NYHA  functional  class.  About  40%  of  all  heart  failure 
patients  have  a  low  ejection  fraction  (<35-40%),  NYHA  Class  II,  III  or  IV  CHF,  and  are  at  considerable  risk  of  repeated 
hospitalizations and death despite maximal drug therapy.

Patients with advanced or Class III/IV CHF continue to represent the greatest unmet medical need despite recent advances in 
new  therapeutic  agents  for  heart  failure.  In  contemporary  studies,  Class  III/IV  heart  failure  patients,  characterized  by  heart  failure 
hospitalizations in the previous 12 months, severely impaired baseline cardiac function, increased systolic and diastolic volumes, and 
elevated  B-type  natriuretic  peptide  (“BNP”)  levels,  have  been  reported  to  have  a  50%  incidence  of  terminal  cardiac  events  or 
cardiovascular hospitalization for decompensated heart failure over a median period of 16.6 months.

The  definitive  method  of  treating  end-stage  disease  currently  is  a  heart  transplant  or  implanting  a  mechanical  assist  device. 
Although there are many patients awaiting a heart transplant, due to limited supply there were only 3,191 heart transplants performed 
in the U.S. in 2016.

41

Results from our Phase 2 trials in patients with Class II/III CHF and in patients with end-stage CHF requiring mechanical assist 
devices have shown that our MPCs appear to have the potential to positively impact patients with the advanced forms of CHF due to 
diminished LV systolic function. We believe that targeting advanced heart failure patients with the most unmet need can provide us 
with the most effective Phase 3 program, the most efficient path to market, and the opportunity for the most attractive pricing.

Completed Phase 2 Trial in NYHA Class II/III CHF Patients 

The  primary  objective  of  the  Phase  2  study  was  to  evaluate  the  safety  and  tolerability  of  3  increasing  doses  (25,  75,  or  150 
million  cells)  of  MPCs  in  patients  with  chronic  heart  failure  due  to  left  ventricular  systolic  dysfunction  of  either  ischemic  or  non-
ischemic etiology. The secondary objectives were to look at efficacy via multiple parameters, and to identify an optimal effective dose 
and the optimal target population for MPC treatment.

Endomyocardial  injections  of  MPCs  in  patients  with  chronic  heart  failure  were  feasible  and  safe.  The  incidence  of  adverse 

events was similar across all groups, and there was no clinically significant immune response in any patients who received MPCs.
The 150 million cell dose showed the greatest effect on left ventricular remodeling and functional capacity and a threshold benefit for 
reducing heart failure-related major adverse cardiovascular events (“HF-MACE”) long-term. 

More specifically:

•

•

Using pre-specified endpoint analyses, there was a dose-related improvement in both left ventricular end-systolic volume 
(“LVESV”)  and  left  ventricular  end-diastolic  volume  (“LVEDV”),  with  the  150  million  cell  dose  showing  the  greatest 
effect  from  baseline  compared  to  controls  for  LV  remodeling  (LVESV  and  LVEDV  both  p<0.02)  at  month  6  post 
treatment  and  functional  exercise  capacity  for  150M  dose  vs.  controls  as  measured  by  six  minute  walk  test  (6MTW: 
p=0.062) at month 12 post-treatment. 

An independent blind adjudication of potential HF-MACE was conducted post-hoc. Over 36 months of follow up, the 150 
million cell dose was associated with a significantly greater probability of remaining free of HF-MACE events compared 
to the control group (0% versus 33% HF-MACE by Kaplan-Meier, p=0.026 by log-rank). The 25 and 75 million doses 
were not statistically different than controls with respect to this measure. On the basis of these results, the optimal dose for 
therapeutic benefit was considered to be the 150 million MPC dose.

In  order  to  identify  the  most  appropriate  target  population  for  the  150  million  MPC  dose,  we  evaluated  whether  optimal 
responders to MPC therapy were in the groups with more or less advanced heart failure. A further post-hoc analysis was performed in 
a blinded manner stratifying controls or 150 million MPC treated patients into those with a baseline LVESV of either <100 ml or >100 
ml as a surrogate for significant myocardial contractile abnormality and more advanced chronic heart failure. The >100 ml LVESV 
threshold was chosen because it falls more than 3 standard deviations above the mean for normal LVESV. In the Phase 2 trial, 60% of 
patients met this criterion. A further sensitivity analysis across every decile in baseline LVESV between 70 ml and 120ml confirmed 
the findings seen in the stratification using a LVESV greater than 100 ml. This analysis demonstrated that:

•

•

•

•

•

•

the therapeutic benefit of the 150 million dose on parameters of LV remodeling were markedly amplified by focusing on 
the  target  population  with  substantial  baseline  LV  contractile  abnormality  and  more  advanced  heart  failure  (LVESV 
greater than 100 ml);

control patients with advanced heart failure (baseline LVESV > 100 ml) had the fastest progression of their disease over 6 
months  in  terms  of  significant  worsening  in  LVESV  and  LVEDV  volumes,  and  worsening  left  ventricular  ejection 
fraction (“LVEF”);

over a 6 month follow-up period, the 150 million MPC dose had a substantial cardioprotective effect on LVESV (p<0.02), 
LVEDV  (p<0.03)  and  LVEF  (p<0.05)  in  Class  II/III  patients  with  substantial  baseline  LV  contractile  abnormality  (i.e. 
those with baseline LVESV > 100 ml);

in  the  Phase  2  trial,  all  of  the  HF-MACE  over  36  months  of  follow-up  occurred  exclusively  in  the  controls  with  more 
advanced  heart  failure  resulting  in  an  annualized  HF-MACE  rate  in  these  patients  of  24%  compared  with  11%  in  the 
aggregated control group (i.e., baseline LVESV < 100 ml or >100 ml);

more specifically, among 18 Class II/III CHF patients with baseline LVESV > 100 ml, 5/7 (71%) control-treated versus 
0/11 150 million MPC-treated patients experienced one or more HF-MACE over 36 months (p=0.0007); and

therefore, the effect of the 150 million MPC dose on overall HF-MACE in the Phase 2 trials was markedly amplified in 
those  patients  with  advanced  heart  failure  and  a  high  rate  of  progression.  This  may  represent  the  optimal  target  patient 
population for MPC therapy in CHF patients.

42

Completed Pilot Phase 2a Trial in Patients With End-Stage Heart Failure Requiring Mechanical Support 

A multi-center, randomized, double-blind, sham-procedure controlled trial conducted by a team of researchers within the NIH-
funded  CTSN  evaluated  30  patients  2:1  randomized  to  epicardial  injection  of  25  million  MPCs  or  medium  (control)  during  left 
ventricular assist device (“LVAD”) implantation for either bridge-to-transplant or destination therapy. 

The results of this trial were presented at the American Heart Association Scientific Sessions 2013 and published in Circulation 

in June 2014.

No patients developed a primary safety event at the trial’s 90-day primary endpoint, nor during the 12- month follow-up period.  

At 90 days, there were three deaths (30%) in the control group and none in the MPC group.   In addition, median time to a first re-
hospitalisation event in MPC-treated patients of 91 days compared with 50 days for the controls.

At  the  pre-specified  90  day  primary  endpoint  analysis  of  the  trial,  50%  of  MPC  treated  patients  were  able  to  successfully 
tolerate weaning off of LVAD support for at least 30 minutes compared to 20% in the control group. Over the 12 month follow-up 
period,  eighty-five  percent  (85%)  of  MPC  patients  tolerated  one  or  more  temporary  LVAD  weans,  compared  to  40%  of  control 
patients.  Based  on  these  results,  the  posterior  probability  that  a  single  injection  of  the  25  million  low-dose  of  MPCs  increased  the 
likelihood of successful weaning is 93%. The duration of temporary LVAD wean, for those who tolerated it, was greater in MPC than 
control patients at each time point.

This trial has demonstrated feasibility and safety, and suggested that a single low-dose MPC injection improved cardiac function 
and  had  an  early  benefit  on  survival.  We  hypothesize  that  a  higher  MPC  dose  may  further  enhance  the  ability  to  wean  LVAD 
recipients  off  support,  and  may  show  a  more  prolonged  survival  benefit,  which  is  the  basis  of  the  Phase  2b  study  discussed  below 
under “Program for End-Stage CHF”.

Current Status and Anticipated Milestones 

Mesoblast's  product  candidate  MPC-150-IM  is  in  late-stage  clinical  development  in  two  randomized  controlled  trials  which 
target,  respectively,  severe  and  end-stage  advanced  CHF.   Based  on  cumulative  clinical  results  to  date  and  the  serious  and  life-
threatening  nature  of  this  disease,  we  believe  there  is  a  pathway  for  accelerated  entry  of  this  product  candidate  into  the  market  to 
provide a paradigm shift in treatment. 

Patients with NYHA Class III/Class IV experience high mortality rates, recurrent hospitalizations, and incur substantial cost of 
care  despite  maximal  existing  therapies.  We  believe  that  under  new  regulatory  frameworks  that  recognize  the  serious  and  life-
threatening nature of advanced CHF, positive results from our ongoing Phase 2b/3 trials in these patients could support accelerated 
approval for MPC-150-IM and an opportunity to create a paradigm shift in this potential multi-billion dollar market.

MPC-150-IM is being evaluated in two ongoing randomized placebo-controlled Phase 2b/3 trials in patients with either severe 
or end-stage advanced CHF. The mechanism of action (MOA) by which MPC-150-IM is thought to exert its effects in these patient 
populations is through immunomodulation and cardiac repair. Positive clinical signals supporting a common underlying MOA have 
been previously published in Phase 2 trials of Mesoblast’s allogeneic MPC therapy in moderate/severe and end-stage heart failure.

Program for End-Stage CHF

A Phase 2b trial of MPC-150-IM in 159 patients with end-stage heart failure and an implantable LVAD is nearly fully recruited, 
with top-line results for the trial's primary endpoint expected in Q1 2018. The trial is being fully funded by the NIH and conducted by 
a multi-center team of researchers within the NIH-funded CTSN. The trial is also supported by the National Institute of Neurological 
Disorders  and  Stroke  and  the  Canadian  Institutes  for  Health  Research.  The  trial’s  results  will  be  used  to  support  the  marketing 
approval application for the product candidate.  

The  trial  is  evaluating  the  effects  of  a  single  epicardial  injection  of  MPC-150-IM  into  the  hearts  of  patients  with  end-stage 
chronic heart failure. This is a prospective, multi-center, double-blind, placebo controlled, 2:1 randomized, (MPC to placebo) single 
dose cohort trial to evaluate the safety and efficacy of injecting a dose of 150 million MPCs into the native myocardium of LVAD 
recipients. Patients with advanced CHF, implanted with an FDA-approved LVAD as either bridge-to-transplant or destination therapy 
are eligible to participate in the trial. All patients will be followed until 12 months post randomization.

The primary efficacy endpoint of the study is the number of temporary weans from LVAD tolerated over the 6 months post-
randomization,  indicating  strengthening  of  the  native  heart  muscle.  Additional  efficacy  endpoints  include  patient  survival,  adverse 
events and rehospitalization rates over 12 months. 

43

If  MPC-150-IM  is  successful  in  this  difficult-to-treat  patient  population  facing  high  risk  of  hospitalization  or  death,  data 
generated  from  this  trial  will  be  used  to  support  a  regulatory  marketing  application  in  this  target  population  that  continues  to  have 
unmet medical needs despite maximal standard of care. If data from clinical trials with our investigational agent prove successful at 
demonstrating improved efficacy on top of existing standard of care, we believe this may also assist us in negotiating attractive pricing 
and reimbursement terms.

Program for Class II/III CHF patients

We are conducting a multicenter, double-blinded, 1:1 randomized, sham-procedure-controlled Phase 3 trial of MPC-150-IM in 
approximately 600 Class II/III CHF patients. The trial is actively enrolling patients in the United States and Canada with NYHA Class 
II/III  disease  at  high  risk  of  repeated  heart  failure  hospitalizations  or  Terminal  Cardiac  Event  (“TCE”)  (cardiac  death,  LVAD 
placement, heart transplant or insertion of an artificial heart). The enrollment criteria for this trial includes a prior decompensated heart 
failure event (e.g., hospitalization) within the previous 9 months and/or very high level of NT-proBNP, a protein used in diagnosis and 
screening of CHF. These inclusion criteria are expected to result in enrichment for patients with substantial left ventricular contractile 
abnormality, advanced chronic heart failure due to LV systolic dysfunction and higher risk of recurrent decompensated heart failure 
hospitalizations  and  TCEs.  This  target  patient  population  was  shown  to  respond  effectively  to  treatment  with  MPC-150-IM  in  our 
previous Phase 2 trial.

More  than  400  of  the  anticipated  approximately  600  patients  have  been  randomized  to  date.  The  trial’s  primary  efficacy 
endpoint  is  a  comparison  of  recurrent  non-fatal  HF-related  major  adverse  cardiac  events  (HF-MACE)  between  either  MPC-treated 
patients or sham-treated controls.

In  April  2017,  the  trial  achieved  a  successful  pre-specified  interim  futility  analysis  of  the  efficacy  endpoint  in  the  first  270 
patients. In addition, the independent Data Monitoring Committee formally recommended the continuation of the trial.   We believe 
that positive results from this Phase 3 trial in advanced CHF patients would serve to confirm results with MPC-150-IM obtained in 
end-stage heart failure patients.

MSC-100-IV/JR-031 for the Treatment of acute Graft versus Host Disease (“aGVHD”)

Overview

MSC-100-IV  is  our  intravenously  delivered  product  candidate  for  the  treatment  of  acute  steroid-refractory  graft  versus  host 
disease,  or  SR-aGVHD,  following  allogeneic  bone  marrow  transplant  (“BMT”).  Available  data  from  clinical  dose  ranging  studies 
identified an effective dose to be 2 x 106 MLCs/kg, body weight, to be administered repeatedly for at least four weeks after diagnosis 
of aGVHD. For the U.S. market, the unit packaging is 25 million cells per vial for intravenous infusion. TEMCELL for the treatment 
of aGVHD is a MSC-based product candidate that our partner, JCR, has launched in Japan.

In  a  BMT,  donor  cells  attack  the  recipient,  causing  aGVHD.  The  donor  T-cell  mediated  inflammatory  response  involves 
secretion of TNF-alpha and IFN-gamma, resulting in activation of pro-inflammatory T-cells and tissue damage in the skin, gut and 
liver which is often fatal.

MSC-100-IV was developed to counteract the inflammatory processes by down-regulating the production of pro-inflammatory 
cytokines, increasing production of anti-inflammatory cytokines, and enabling recruitment of endogenous anti-inflammatory cells to 
involved tissues.

Currently there are no approved therapies for patients with acute steroid-refractory graft versus host disease (“SR-aGVHD”) in 
the U.S., and off-label options have demonstrated mixed efficacy with high toxicity. As such, we believe there is a significant need for 
effective treatment with a favorable risk/benefit profile.

MSC-100-IV has been used for the treatment of aGVHD in children in the U.S., Canada and several European countries under 

an expanded access program, or EAP. This program enrolled more than 240 patients suffering from SR-aGVHD.

Market Opportunity

According to the Center for International Blood and Marrow Transplant Research, there are approximately 30,000 allogeneic 
BMTs globally per year for diseases including hematological cancers, with ~20% of all cases in the pediatric population. Nearly 50% 
of all allogeneic BMT patients develop aGVHD. Liver or gastrointestinal involvement occur in up to 40% of all patients with aGVHD 
and are associated with the greatest risk of death, with mortality rates of up to 85%. 

The  aGVHD  market  requires  a  small,  targeted  commercial  footprint.  The  target  market  for  aGVHD  will  primarily  be  board-
certified physicians in hematology/oncology who perform hematopoietic stem cell transplants. In the U.S., there are approximately 75 

44

centers  that  perform  pediatric  transplants,  with  50%  of  all  transplants  occurring  at  approximately  15  centers.  Similarly,  there  are 
approximately 110 centers that perform adult transplants with half of those transplants occurring at approximately 20 centers.

Results from Expanded Access Program

From 2008 an expanded access program (“EAP”), called Protocol 275, was conducted for a group of pediatric patients with SR-
aGVHD treated with MSC-100-IV. An EAP provides investigational therapy to patients outside of a clinical trial in a country that has 
not  received  marketing  approval  for  the  product  candidate  being  evaluated.  It  is  intended  for  the  treatment  of  serious  or  life-
threatening conditions for which there is no available alternative treatment and where there is existing evidence of safety as well as 
signals of efficacy in order to establish that the patient may benefit from the therapy.

In  February  2016,  we  announced  results  from  241  children  treated  in  the  EAP.   The  results,  presented  at  the  tandem  annual 
scientific  meetings  of  the  Center  for  International  Blood  &  Marrow  Transplant  Research  and  the  American  Society  of  Blood  and 
Marrow  Transplantation  in  Hawaii,  demonstrated  clinically  meaningful  responses  and  associated  significantly  increased  survival  in 
children with steroid-refractory aGVHD.  Key results were:

•

•

•

•

•

an overall response rate of 65% was seen at day 28 after treatment with MSC-100-IV;

a response rate of 81% was seen when MSC-100-IV was used as front-line therapy following steroid failure;

in patients with gastrointestinal and liver disease, who have the highest mortality risk, overall response rates were 65% 
and 62% respectively;

children  who  achieved  overall  response  at  day  28  had  significantly  improved  survival  (82%  vs  39%,  log  rank  p-value 
<0.0001); and

extending  therapy  beyond  day  28  in  the  subset  of  children  who  had  not  achieved  an  overall  response  but  had  some 
improvement  at  day  28  (mixed  response)  resulted  in  significantly  improved  survival  (72%  vs  18%,  log  rank  p-value 
0.003).

Current Status and Anticipated Milestone

Japan. Our licensee, JCR, has launched its aGVHD MSC based product (TEMCELL) in Japan in February 2016. TEMCELL is 
the first “allogeneic” cell-based product in Japan, meaning a product containing cells from a single donor was expanded and used in 
many unrelated patients. 

The Japanese Government’s National Health Insurance (“NHI”) body has formally set a price for the mesenchymal stem cell 
product TEMCELL® HS Inj. at ¥868,680 for 72 million cells. A four-week, multi-dose treatment course of TEMCELL for an average 
adult is expected to be reimbursed at ¥13,898,880, or at ¥20,848,320 if symptoms persist and additional dosing is required. We are 
entitled to receive royalties and other payments at pre-defined thresholds of net sales. 

U.S. The FDA has acknowledged that the results from the EAP provide a substantial safety experience and likely evidence of a 
treatment effect. The FDA has also acknowledged that given the prior results with mesenchymal lineage stem cells in this indication, 
and the unmet medical needs, a randomized controlled study is neither feasible nor ethical. However, given the number of additional 
therapies received by many of the EAP patients (often 2-4 prior therapies), additional data in the absence of confounding additional 
therapies has been requested by the FDA. We expect to provide this additional data through the on-going single-arm, open-label Phase 
3 study of up to 60 pediatric patients with SR-aGVHD treated with our MLC product candidate. These patients will not receive other 
line therapies thus allowing the treatment effect of our MLC product candidate to be clearly observed.

Supporting the notion that our MLC product candidate may be effective as first line therapy in SR-aGVHD, in a subset analysis 
of 28 pediatric patients recruited in Protocol 280 (a randomized, placebo controlled trial of MSC-100-IV as first-line therapy in SR-
aGVHD) overall response was significantly improved in treated children. Moreover, in 32 children with SR-aGVHD within the 275 
EAP protocol, where MSC-100-IV was administered as first-line therapy, a similar proportion responded as was seen in the overall 
EAP program. 

Accordingly, we initiated an open-label Phase 3 trial of up to 60 children with enrollment expected to be completed and interim 
results  anticipated  in  2H  CY2017.  The  pre-specified  interim  futility  analysis  of  the  trial’s  primary  endpoint,  conducted  by  the 
Independent  Data  Safety  Monitoring  Board,  was  successfully  achieved  in  November  2016.  The  interim  analysis  showed  that  the 
predefined Bayesian futility rule used to determine the probability of the trial’s success using the trial’s primary endpoint of Day 28 
overall  response  had  been  passed.  The  analysis  method  determined  the  likelihood  of  obtaining  a  statistically  significant  treatment 
effect at study completion, based on the data observed at this interim time point. The FDA has granted a Fast Track designation for the 

45

use  of  MSC-100-IV  to  improve  overall  response  rate  in  children  with  steroid  refractory  aGVHD.   Fast  Track  designation  has  the 
potential to shorten the time to FDA approval through priority review and a streamlined rolling review process.

In December 2016, we announced that we had entered into an equity purchase agreement with Mallinckrodt Pharmaceuticals to 
exclusively negotiate a commercial and development partnership for the treatment or prevention of MSC-100-IV in the treatment of 
aGVHD. Under the terms of the agreement, Mallinckrodt will have an exclusive period of up to nine months to conclude commercial 
and development agreements for the two product candidates in all territories outside of Japan and China.

During the conduct of our pediatric Phase 3 trial, we expect to have discussions with the FDA regarding the trial design for a 
potential Phase 3 trial to support approval of this product for adults with high risk liver or gut aGVHD, the patient groups who have 
the highest mortality risk. 

MPC-06-ID for the Treatment of Chronic Low Back Pain (“CLBP”) 

Overview

MPC-06-ID is our proprietary Phase 3 product candidate being evaluated for the treatment of CLBP caused by degenerative disc 
disease (“DDD”). MPC-06-ID consists of a unit dose of 6 million MPCs administered with hyaluronic acid (“HA”), and is injected by 
syringe directly into a targeted damaged disc.

In  CLBP,  damage  to  the  disc  is  the  result  of  a  combination  of  factors  related  to  aging,  genetics,  and  micro-  injuries,  which 
compromises the disc’s capacity to act as a fluid-filled cushion between vertebrae and to provide anatomical stability. Damage to the 
disc  also  results  in  an  inflammatory  response  with  ingrowth  of  nerves  that  results  in  chronic  pain.  The  combination  of  anatomic 
instability and nerve ingrowth results in CLBP and functional disability.

With  respect  to  mechanisms  of  action  in  CLBP,  extensive  pre-clinical  studies  have  established  that  MLCs  have  anti-
inflammatory effects and secrete multiple paracrine factors that stimulate new proteoglycan and collagen synthesis by chondrocytes in 
vitro and by resident cells in the nucleus and annulus in vivo. These effects together offer the potential to strengthen the load bearing 
function  of  the  disc  by  increasing  its  water  content,  improving  disc  anatomy,  and  improving  disc  stability,  while  also  reducing 
inflammation and pain.

Market Opportunity

In  2016,  over  7  million  people  in  the  U.S.  alone  were  estimated  to  suffer  from  CLBP  caused  by  DDD,  of  which  3.2  million 
patients have moderate disease. After failure of conservative measures (medication, injections, epidural steroid physical therapy, etc.), 
there is no treatment that prevents progression of disc degeneration, reduces pain and improves function over a sustained period of 6 to 
12 months. When disc degeneration has progressed to a point that pain and loss of function can no longer be managed by conservative 
means, major invasive surgery such as spinal fusion is the most commonly offered option.

All  therapies  for  progressive,  severe  and  debilitating  pain  due  to  degenerating  intervertebral  discs  treat  the  symptoms  of  the 
disease, but are not disease-modifying and thus do not address the underlying cause of the disease. Surgical intervention is not always 
successful in addressing the patient’s pain and functional deficit. Surgeons estimate that between 50% to 70% of patients ultimately 
fail  back  surgery,  with  failure  defined  as  either  not  achieving  at  least  a  50%  reduction  of  symptoms  within  four  months  or 
experiencing new-onset pain and spasm. Total costs of low back pain are estimated to be between US$100 billion and US$200 billion 
annually with two thirds of attributed to patients’ decreased wages and productivity.

As a result, we believe that the most significant unmet need and commercial opportunity in the treatment of CLBP is a therapy 
that  has  the  ability  to  reverse,  halt  or  slow  the  progression  of  the  disease  and  improve  physical  function.  MPC-06-ID  is  being 
developed  to  target  the  population  of  patients  suffering  from  moderate  to  severe  CLBP  due  to  moderately  degenerated  discs.  The 
target patient population has exhausted conservative treatment options, may have failed epidural steroid injections to alleviate pain and 
has no treatment option other than invasive and costly surgical interventions.

Completed Phase 2 Clinical Trial

The primary objective of our Phase 2 study was to evaluate the safety of MPCs in CLBP. Secondary objectives were to evaluate 
efficacy  parameters  such  as  radiographic,  low  back  pain,  function/disability,  medication  usage,  work  status  and  quality  of  life 
improvement  measures.  Patients  were  evaluated  at  1,  3,  6  and  12  months  after  treatment  with  longer  term  follow-up  evaluations 
continuing at 24 and 36 months. 

46

Eligible subjects were at least 18 years of age with chronic lumbar back pain for 6 months or greater duration due to moderate 
DDD  with  one  painful  lumbar  vertebral  level  between  L1  and  S1.  Subjects  had  to  have  failed  at  least  3  months  of  non-operative 
management  with  exposure  to  physical  therapy.  The  study  evaluated  intra-discal  injection  of  two  separate  doses:  6  million  MPCs, 
which is MPC-06-ID, and 18 million MPCs with both MPC doses administered with HA, and compared to saline (placebo control) or 
HA alone (vehicle control) injection, using a pre-specified Per Protocol (“PP”) population analysis. 100 subjects across 15 sites were 
randomized with 20 receiving saline, 20 receiving HA, 30 receiving MPC-06-ID with HA, and 30 receiving 18 million MPCs with 
HA. The mean duration of DDD in these patients was approximately 6 years. Baseline pain, function scores, and radiographic scores 
were similar among all groups.

In  July  2016,  24-month  results  from  the  Phase  2  trial  were  presented  at  the  24th  Annual  Scientific  Meeting  of  the  Spine 

Intervention Society and received the 2016 Best Basic Science Abstract award at the meeting.    

In March 2017, in line with U.S. FDA guidance for the ongoing Phase 3 trial, the 24-month primary endpoint composite was 
additionally analyzed using an intent to treat (ITT) population. The 36-month analysis aimed to determine the proportion of patients 
who maintained treatment success beyond the 24-month primary evaluation.

Key 36-month trial results were:

•

•

•

the primary endpoint composite over 24 months was achieved by 41% of patients who received 6 million MPCs, 35% of 
the 18 million MPC group, 18% of the hyaluronic acid group, and 13% of the saline group, using the pre-specified PP 
population analysis 

•

•

pain  responder  criteria  (50%  pain  reduction  with  no  additional  intervention  at  both  12  and  24  months)  was 
achieved by 52% of the 6 million MPC group compared with 13% of the saline group (p<0.05) 

functional  responder  criteria  (15-point  reduction  in  Oswestry  disability  index  (“ODI”)  and  no  additional 
intervention at both 12 and 24 months) was achieved by 48% of the 6 million MPC group compared with 13% of 
the saline group (p<0.05) 

similar results were seen for the primary endpoint composite over 24 months using the ITT analysis, with 38% of the 6 
million MPC group achieving this outcome compared with 10% of the saline group (p<0.05) 

•

•

•

82%  of  the  6  million  MPC  group  who  achieved  the  primary  endpoint  composite  over  24  months  maintained 
treatment success using this composite endpoint at 36 months

86% of the 6 million MPC group who successfully met the pain responder criteria (50% pain reduction with no 
additional intervention at both 12 and 24 months) remained pain responders through 36 months 

92% of the 6 million MPC group who met the functional responder criteria (15-point reduction in ODI and no 
additional intervention at both 12 and 24 months) remained functional responders through 36 months 

there were no significant differences in measurements of safety between cell-treated patients and controls over 36 months

The 36-month Phase 2 trial results support the ongoing 360-patient Phase 3 trial of MPC-06-ID for CLBP by reinforcing the 
rationale for MPC dose selection, use of saline control, and the trial's primary endpoint composite over 24 months. If similar clinical 
durability is seen in the Phase 3 program, it is anticipated such data could translate into meaningful health economic benefits including 
increased productivity that may support attractive product reimbursement, and our ability to enter into a commercial partnership.

Current Status and Anticipated Milestones

The  first  of  two  Phase  3  clinical  trials  for  CLBP  is  actively  recruiting  360  patients  across  30  sites  in  the  United  States  and 
Australia,  randomized  2:1  to  receive  either  6  million  MPCs  or  saline  control.   The  trial's  primary  endpoint  of  Overall  Treatment 
Success (using a composite of 50% improvement in lower back pain and 15 point improvement in function at both 12 and 24 months) 
is an acceptable endpoint for product approval, as per guidance from the FDA. Enrollment of our ongoing Phase 3 trial is expected to 
be completed in Q4 CY2017. 

In December 2016, we announced that we had entered into an equity purchase agreement with Mallinckrodt Pharmaceuticals to 
exclusively negotiate a commercial and development partnership for the treatment or prevention of moderate/severe CLBP due to disc 
degeneration.  Under  the  terms  of  the  agreement,  Mallinckrodt  will  have  an  exclusive  period  of  up  to  nine  months  to  conclude 
commercial and development agreements for the two product candidates in all territories outside of Japan and China.

47

MPC-300-IV for the Treatment of Immune Mediated Diseases

The  diverse  and  potent  anti-inflammatory  properties  of  MPCs  are  the  foundation  for  their  usefulness  in  immune-mediated 
diseases  such  as  rheumatoid  arthritis  and  diabetic  kidney  disease  (or  diabetic  nephropathy),  where  monocytes,  macrophages  and 
activated pro-inflammatory T cells play a very active and destructive role in disease pathogenesis through activation of multiple pro-
inflammatory cytokine pathways.

More specifically, MPC-300-IV was designed for intravenous delivery to treat systemic and localized conditions of excessive 
inflammation,  whereby  our  MPCs  can  counteract  inflammatory  processes  by  down-  regulating  the  production  of  pro-inflammatory 
cytokines,  increasing  production  of  anti-inflammatory  cytokines,  and  enabling  recruitment  of  anti-inflammatory  cells  to  involved 
tissues.  For  example,  MPCs  produce  immunomodulatory  biomolecules  such  as  prostaglandin  E2,  or  PGE2  and  indoleamine2,  3-
dioxygenase,  or  IDO,  in  response  to  activation  by  pro-inflammatory  cytokines  such  as  tumor  necrosis  factor-alpha,  or  TNF-alpha; 
interleukin-1, or IL-1; interleukin-6, or IL-6; interleukin-17, or IL-17. These MPC-released biomolecules act along multiple pathways, 
such  as  polarizing  pro-inflammatory  M1  monocytes  to  anti-inflammatory  M2  monocytes,  neutralizing  harmful  macrophages,  and 
switching activated T helper cells 1 and 17, or Th1 and Th17, respectively, to Th2 cells and FOXP3 T regulatory cells.

MPC-300-IV for the Treatment of Rheumatoid Arthritis (“RA”) (Biologic Refractory)  

Overview

MPC-300-IV  is  our  proprietary  Phase  2  product  candidate  being  developed  for  biologic-refractory  rheumatoid  arthritis.  The 

product candidate is being evaluated at both 1 and 2 million MPC/kg dose(s) via intravenous infusion.

Pro-inflammatory  monocytes/macrophages  and  activated  T  cells  are  involved  in  the  pathogenesis  of  RA  via  activation  of 
multiple  pro-inflammatory  cytokine  pathways,  including  TNF-alpha,  interleukin-6,  and  interleukin-17.  Existing  biologic  therapies 
target any one of these cytokine pathways individually, however none target all of these pathways concomitantly. As a result, various 
segments of patients with RA will show moderate response to one or other of these biologic agents, but very few patients will have 
sustained remission due to continued expression of pro-inflammatory cytokines. In pre-clinical large animal trials, we have shown that 
a  single  intravenous  injection  of  our  proprietary  allogeneic  MPCs  results  in  concomitant  inhibition  of  TNF-alpha,  IL-6  and  IL-17 
inflammatory pathways in the inflamed joints resulting in substantial amelioration in clinical disease. Additionally, our data show that 
MPCs can reduce inflammation and reverse abnormal function of blood vessels, including the coronary arteries, in a sheep model of 
RA. A single intravenous infusion of allogeneic MPCs significantly reduced the systemic inflammation present in a sheep model of 
RA,  increased  circulating  levels  of  the  anti-inflammatory  cytokine  interleukin-10,  or  IL-10,  and  reversed  the  abnormal  endothelial 
dysfunction present in the coronary arteries and the digital arteries in these animals. Since patients with RA have an approximately 
50%  higher  risk  of  death  from  cardiovascular  disease  than  the  general  population,  these  results  suggest  that  the  anti-inflammatory 
effect of MPC therapy have potential to reduce cardiovascular risk associated with RA.

Market Opportunity

Major  advances  in  the  treatment  of  RA  using  biologic  agents  have  resulted  in  a  $19  billion  global  market  in  2016  that  is 
projected to grow to over $22.5 billion in 2025. There are approximately 6.0 million prevalent cases in the U.S., Japan and the five 
major European markets, with 2.9 million in the U.S. alone in 2016.

The  disease  is  associated  with  multiple  co-morbidities  and  psychosocial  impairments,  including  cardiovascular  disease, 
osteoporosis, interstitial lung disease, depression, work disability and decreased health-related quality of life. Rheumatoid arthritis is 
responsible for approximately 250,000 hospitalizations and 9 million physician visits per year in the U.S. 

If left untreated and/or high disease activity remains, RA can lead to joint destruction, deformity, disability, decreased quality of 
life, and increased mortality. On average, maintenance rates for anti-TNFα therapy at 1 year is ~65% and drops to ~40% at 5 years. 
Switching  to  a  second  or  third  anti-TNFα  product  results  in  significantly  lower  efficacy  than  is  seen  with  an  anti-TNF  agent  in 
biologically  naive  patients.  Additionally,  these  therapies  have  been  associated  with  significant  risk  of  opportunistic  infections  and 
malignancies. As doses are pushed in order to achieve acceptable response, such as ACR 50, ACR 70, or remission, such risks may 
increase with added economic burden.

RA patients who are refractory to existing biologic therapy are in need of effective new treatments and would benefit from an 
alternative  therapeutic  approach  which  is  both  safe  and  effective.   Despite  the  substantial  advances  in  RA  treatment  using  biologic 
agents such as anti-TNF agents, approximately one third of patients either do not respond sufficiently or cannot tolerate these agents 
due  to  infectious  or  other  complications.  In  the  United  States,  the  anti-TNF  refractory  population  is  the  fastest  growing  branded 
market segment, projected to increase by 8% annually and potentially higher with the expected market entry and greater availability of 
anti-TNF biosimilars.

48

Phase 2 Trial

Mesoblast’s Phase 2 trial recruited a total of 48 patients with active RA who were on a stable regimen of methotrexate and had 
an  inadequate  prior  clinical  response  to  at  least  one  anti-Tumor  Necrosis  Factor  (TNF)  agent.  Of  the  48  patients,  30  (63%)  had 
previously  received  1-2  biologic  agents.  Patients  were  randomized  to  a  single  intravenous  infusion  of  1  million  MPCs/kg  (1M/kg, 
n=16), 2 million MPCs/kg (2M/kg, n=16) or placebo (n=16). The study was comprised of a 12 week primary study period with a 40 
week follow-up for a study total duration of 52 weeks.

The  primary  objective  of  the  study  was  to  evaluate  safety  and  tolerability  of  a  single  intravenous  MPC  infusion  in  biologic 
refractory  RA  patients  through  a  12  week  primary  endpoint.  Additional  objectives  were  to  evaluate  pre-specified  clinical  efficacy 
endpoints  at  the  primary  12  week  timepoint,  as  well  as  to  assess  the  onset  and  time  course  of  effect  within  the  first  12  weeks  and 
subsequent durability of effects and safety profile through the full 52 week study. 

Pre-specified  efficacy  endpoints  included  the  following:  American  College  of  Rheumatology  (ACR)  composite  clinical 
response, which is an endpoint used in RA clinical trials to measure improvement in signs and symptoms of the disease in terms of 
20%,  50%  or  70%  improvement  from  baseline;  ACR-N  which  measures  the  mean  or  median  magnitude  of  benefit  using  an  ACR 
composite for a typical patient; the health assessment questionnaire-disability index (HAQ-DI), a standardized measure of functional 
status;  and  the  DAS28  composite  measurement  of  disease  activity;  no  adjustment  for  multiplicity  was  performed  as  these  efficacy 
endpoints were exploratory and the trial was not powered for efficacy.

Additionally,  continuous  variables  ACR-N,  HAQ-DI  and  DAS-28  were  evaluated  in  a  pre-specified  manner  since  the  use  of 
endpoints sensitive to change provide better discriminatory power for dose-response assessment, in line with the FDA Guidance For 
Industry Rheumatoid Arthritis: Developing Drug Products For Treatment, May 2013.

Analyses were performed for the whole study population and for the pre-specified exploratory subgroup based on whether the 

subjects had previously received 1-2 or more than 2 biologic agents.  

In February 2017, we announced 39-week data from this Phase 2 trial. The results showed that a single intravenous infusion of, 
MPC-300-IV  was  well  tolerated  and  demonstrated  a  durable  improvement  in  clinical  symptoms,  physical  function,  and  disease 
activity relative to placebo over this period of follow-up.

The key trial results were: 

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

a  single  intravenous  MPC  infusion  of  either  1  million  or  2  million  MPC/kg  resulted  in  durable  responses  through  nine 
months (39 weeks) in the 48-patient placebo-controlled, randomized Phase 2 trial in patients who have failed one or more 
TNF inhibitors;

the safety profile over 39 weeks was comparable among the placebo and both MPC treatment  groups, with no cell-related 
serious adverse events;

both MPC doses outperformed placebo at week 39 in each of ACR20/50/70 responses;

both MPC doses outperformed placebo at week 39 in the proportion of patients who achieved the target of low disease 
activity (DAS-28<3.2); disease remission (DAS 28 <2.6) was seen at similar levels across all groups;

use of continuous variables ACR-N, HAQ-DI and DAS-28, in line with FDA guidance for dose-finding Phase 2 trials of 
new RA therapies, identified  the 2 million MPC/kg dose as the most effective over 39 weeks;

while both MPC doses achieved higher median ACR-N scores compared with placebo at 39 weeks, the 2 million MPC/kg 
dose achieved the maximal ACR-N score earlier, at 12 weeks;

over  the  entire  39  weeks,  the  2  million  MPC/kg  MPC  group  had  a  significantly  greater  ACR-N  Area  Under  the  Curve 
(AUC) than placebo, indicating a more robust durable effect with the higher treatment dose;

at  39  weeks,  there  was  a  dose-dependent  treatment  effect  on  mean  change  from  baseline  in  function  (HAQ-DI)  and 
disease activity score (DAS-28), with the 2 million MPC/kg dose showing the greatest effect; and

49

•

MPC treatment effects for all parameters were greatest in patients who had failed 1-2 biologic agents.

In  August  2016,  we  released  the  12  week  results  in  this  Phase  2  trial.  These  results  showed  that  an  intravenous  infusion  of 
allogeneic  MPCs  was  well  tolerated  in  biologic  refractory  RA  patients,  without  serious  adverse  events  over  12  weeks.  A  single 
intravenous MPC infusion in biologic refractory RA patients resulted in dose-related improvements in clinical symptoms, function and 
disease activity, with the 2 million MPCs/kg dose providing the greatest responses.

Current Status and Anticipated Milestones

Our Phase 2 trial of MPC-300-IV in biologic refractory RA continues as we evaluate safety through 52 weeks and duration of 

responses. 

We  believe  the  safety  and  efficacy  results  of  this  trial  to  date  provide  support  for  our  MPCs  to  be  positioned  as  a  first-line 

treatment option in RA patients who have previously received a prior anti-TNF or other biologic agent.

Given the large market opportunity, we believe MPC-300-IV is well-positioned to advance through a strategic partnership into 

Phase 3 development for biologic refractory rheumatoid arthritis.

MPC-300-IV for the Treatment of Diabetic Complications, Including Kidney Disease

Overview

MPC-300-IV for the treatment of diabetic complications, including diabetic nephropathy, is our proprietary product candidate 

consisting of up to 300 million MPCs delivered intravenously.

The aberrant activation of the immune system that occurs in type 2 diabetes patients is associated with inflammation of various 
organs,  including  kidney,  liver  and  fat  tissues,  resulting  in  resistance  to  the  effects  of  insulin  in  the  fat  tissues,  and  poor  glucose 
control.  Inflammation  in  the  kidneys  and  liver  results  in  diabetic  nephropathy  and  diabetes-related  non-alcoholic  steatohepatitis,  or 
NASH.  We  are  developing  a  high-dose  product  for  intravenous  administration  to  target  the  polyvascular  complications  of  patients 
with type 2 diabetes, including diabetic nephropathy, NASH and retinopathy.

In  small  and  large  animal  models  of  diabetes,  a  single  intravenous  injection  of  MPCs  resulted  in  sustained  improvement  in 
glucose  control.  Additionally,  in  multiple  small  animal  models  of  diabetic  nephropathy,  intravenous  MPC  infusions  reduced 
inflammation in the kidneys and improved renal function and reduced albuminuria.

Market Opportunity

While all classes of current anti-diabetic agents are effective at improving glucose control, they are not effective in preventing or 
potentially  reversing  the  renal  complications  in  type  2  diabetes,  which  affect  approximately  40  to  50%  of  people  with  diabetes. 
Diabetic nephropathy is the single leading cause of end-stage renal disease, accounting for nearly half of all end-stage renal disease 
cases in the US. The prevalence of moderate to severe diabetic nephropathy in 2013 was estimated to be approximately 1.96 million.

The current standard of care of diabetic nephropathy (rennin-angiotensin system inhibition with angiotensin converting enzyme 
inhibitors of angiotensin II receptor blockers) only slows the rate of progression of the disease to renal failure by 16-25%, leaving a 
large  residual  risk  for  end-stage  renal  disease.  For  subjects  that  reach  end-stage  renal  disease  the  only  treatment  option  is  renal 
replacement (dialysis or kidney transplantation) at high cost in the US with medical costs of $100,000 for dialysis and $250,000 for 
kidney transplant. Furthermore, for those on dialysis the mortality rate is high with an approximately 40% fatality rate within 2 years 
after initiation of dialysis. To the extent MPC-300-IV can be shown to be effective in this population, additional applications would be 
possible for the over 20 million people in the U.S. who are estimated to have chronic kidney disease.

Phase 2 Trial 

Diabetic  nephropathy  is  thought  to  be  caused  by  ongoing  monocyte  inflammation  and  endothelial  dysfunction,  or  abnormal 
blood  vessels,  in  the  kidneys.  Our  bone  marrow-derived  MPCs  are  potent  modulators  of  monocyte  inflammation,  and  have  been 
shown in preclinical studies to reduce monocyte infiltration in diabetic kidneys and to reverse endothelial dysfunction. Consequently, 
we are developing MPC-300-IV for intravenous delivery in the treatment of diabetic nephropathy.

This trial of MPC-300-IV was a double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled, dose-escalating Phase 2 trial of 30 patients with 
type 2 diabetes and moderate to severe renal impairment, stage 3b-4 chronic kidney disease (“CKD”), who were already on a stable 

50

regimen  of  the  standard  of  care  therapy  for  diabetic  nephropathy,  which  consists  of  renin-angiotensin  system  inhibition  with 
angiotensin converting enzyme inhibitors or angiotensin II receptor blockers. Patients received a single infusion of 150 million MPCs, 
300 million MPCs, or saline control.

The objectives of the trial were to evaluate safety and to explore potential efficacy signals of MPC treatment on renal function. 
The pre-specified primary efficacy endpoint was to evaluate effects of MPC treatment relative to placebo on renal functional decline 
at 12 weeks, as defined by change in glomerular filtration rate (“GFR”), measured both by direct isotope scan and by serum-creatinine 
based  estimation,  and  then  for  an  additional  48  weeks  of  follow-up.  Pre-specified  secondary  analyses  included  GFR  differences 
between  treatment  and  placebo  groups  with  baseline  GFR>30ml/min/1.73m2  (stage  3b  CKD,  accounting  for  60%  of  enrolled 
patients),  and  treatment-related  effects  on  the  monocyte-derived  cytokine  interleukin-6,  or  IL-6,  a  major  inflammatory  marker 
associated with renal failure progression and adverse cardiovascular outcomes.

The primary efficacy endpoint of decline or change in GFR was in line with the 2012 joint workshop held by the United States 
Food and Drug Administration and the National Kidney Foundation which recommended that time to 30%-40% decline in GFR is an 
acceptable  primary  endpoint  for  evaluating  potential  benefits  of  new  therapies  for  this  patient  population.  This  joint  workshop 
recognized the significant unmet medical need and urgency to make new therapies accessible to patients who may benefit from them. 
This  revised  endpoint  could  make  new  treatments  available  earlier  to  patients  with  chronic  renal  failure  by  reducing  trial  size  and 
duration,  compared  with  the  previously  accepted  composite  endpoint  of  time  to  first  occurrence  of  doubling  of  serum  creatinine 
(equivalent to a 57% reduction in GFR), renal replacement or death.

In October 2016, we announced that results from our Phase 2 trial of MPC-300-IV, in patients with diabetic kidney disease have 
been  published  the  peer-reviewed  journal  EBioMedicine.  The  paper,  entitled  ‘Allogeneic  Mesenchymal  Precursor  Cells  (MPC)  in 
Diabetic Nephropathy: A Randomized, Placebo Controlled, Dose Escalation Study’, concluded that a single intravenous infusion of 
MPC-300-IV was well tolerated and had positive effects on renal function at the 12-week primary endpoint in a Phase 2 trial in adult 
patients with type 2 diabetic nephropathy.  Key trial results were:

•

•

•

•

the  safety  profile  for  MPC-300-IV  diabetic  kidney  disease  treatment  was  similar  to  placebo,  with  no  treatment-related 
adverse events;

efficacy  testing  showed  that  patients  receiving  a  single  MPC  infusion  at  either  dose  (150  million  MPCs  or  300  million 
MPCs) had improved renal function relative to placebo, as defined by preservation or improvement in GFR at 12 weeks;

the rate of decline in estimated GFR at 12 weeks was significantly reduced in the group receiving a single dose of 150 
million MPCs relative to the placebo group (p=0.05); and 

there was a trend toward more pronounced treatment effects relative to placebo in the pre-specified subgroup of patients 
with GFR>30ml/min/1.73m2 at baseline (p=0.07).

Results  from  the  trial  had  previously  been  presented  in  June  2015  at  the  75th  annual  meeting  of  the  American  Diabetes 

Association.

Current Status and Anticipated Milestones

The Phase 2 trial was conducted in Australia under an Australian Clinical Trial Application, or CTA. Both treatment cohorts 
have been followed up per protocol through 60 weeks. The positive responses we observed following a single intravenous injection of 
MPC-300-IV  will  facilitate  discussions  regarding  adaptive  Phase  2b/3  clinical  trial  designs  with  the  FDA  and  potential  strategic 
partner discussions.

Tier 2 Programs

MPC-25-IC for the Treatment of Acute Cardiac Ischemia

Enrollment has completed in our Phase 2 trial for MPC-25-IC for the treatment of acute myocardial infarction (“AMI”). This 
trial was a prospective, randomized, placebo-controlled, double blind clinical trial that will analyze the effect of intracoronary infusion 
of  MPCs  in  106  patients  with  a  first-time  acute  ST-elevation  myocardial  infarction.  The  therapy  was  initiated  directly  following 
revascularization of the left anterior descending artery, along with standard therapies for AMI. After successful revascularization, the 
patients  were  1:1:1  randomized  to  receive  12.5  or  25  million  MPC  or  placebo  via  intracoronary  infusion.  The  primary  endpoint  of 
safety was evaluated at 30 days. The secondary efficacy endpoint is defined as reduction in the left ventricular end-systolic volume at 
6  months.  Additional  efficacy  parameters  from  cardiac  magnetic  resonance  and  echocardiography  will  also  be  evaluated  at  this 
timepoint. Occurrence of MACE events will be evaluated over 24 months with full trial results released following this period.

51

MPC-25-Osteo for the Treatment of Spinal Fusion 

Our Phase 2 trial for MPC-25-Osteo for the treatment of spinal fusion is completed.   The study consisted of 24 patients with 
MPCs  (implanted  into  intervertebral  disc  space)  undergoing  1  or  2-level  lumbar  interbody  fusion  via  posterior  procedures  (TLIF, 
PLIF). Patients were randomized to 25 million MPC dose (n=8), 75 million MPC dose (n=8) or autograft from the hip (n=8). We have 
had an end-of-Phase 2 meeting with the FDA, and as a result of that meeting there is a consensus regarding the scope and design of a 
Phase 3 program using MPC-25-Osteo for the treatment of lumbar spinal fusion. 

MSC-100-IV for the Treatment of Crohn’s Disease (Biologic Refractory)

A 330 patient multi-centered, double-blind, randomized, placebo-controlled Phase 3 trial for MSC-100-IV for the treatment of 
Crohn’s Disease (“CD”) is ongoing.  The focus of this trial is on the safety and efficacy of MSC-100-IV in moderate to severe CD in 
patients  who  are  refractory  to  steroid,  immunosuppressant  and  biologic  therapy.  The  primary  endpoint  is  the  proportion  of  patients 
experiencing disease remission within 28 days of treatment, compared to those patients receiving placebo, as defined by an absolute 
Crohn’s Disease Activity Index score below 150.  When the trial is complete, we will evaluate whether the primary endpoint of day 28 
remission in biologic-refractory patients has been achieved, whether there is evidence of efficacy in high-risk groups such as those 
with fistulizing disease and multi-drug refractory patients, and whether maintenance dosing can result in longer duration of effect.

MPC-75-IA for the Treatment of Knee Osteoarthritis

Our  double-blind,  placebo-controlled,  17-patient  Phase  2a  trial  of  MPC-75-IA  for  prevention  of  radiographic  and  clinical 
features of knee osteoarthritis after traumatic injury has completed with the top-line results from this study released.   Results of the 
Phase  2a  trial  have  been  recently  published  in  the  peer-reviewed  journal  Arthritis  Research  &  Therapy.  The  results  showed  that  a 
single intra-articular injection of Mesoblast’s product candidate MPC-75-IA reduced cartilage loss and bone changes by six months, 
and improved pain and function for over two years, when compared to controls.

Complementary Technologies

In addition to establishing what we believe to be the most advanced regenerative medicine product portfolio in the industry, we 
have  also  strategically  targeted  the  acquisition  of  rights  to  technologies  that  are  complementary  to  and  synergistic  with  our  MLC 
platform. The aim of this activity is to maintain what we see as our technology leadership position in the regenerative medicine space, 
while simultaneously expanding our targeted disease applications and managing the life-cycle of our current lead programs.

Our complementary technologies and additional product candidates include the following.

•

•

•

•

•

Additional types of MLCs, including dental pulp stem cells and periodontal stem cells, that hold promise in regenerative 
applications for neurological networks and in dental applications.

Cell surface modification of MLCs using ex vivo fucosylation to improve homing characteristics to sites of inflammation.

Cell payloading technology, which allows us to load our MLCs and other cell types with molecules or nucleotides that can 
either  (i)  enhance  the  natural  function  of  our  cells  (e.g.,  increase  persistence  or  homing  and  engraftment)  or  (ii)  be 
delivered directly to sites of inflammation and tissue damage by our MLCs.

Protein  technologies,  which  are  focused  primarily  on  proteins  naturally  produced  by  our  MLCs,  that  can  be  developed 
independently  or  in  combination  with  our  MLCs.  For  example,  we  are  developing  a  product  candidate  based  on  a 
molecule  known  as  stromal  cell  derived  factor  1,  or  SDF-1,  that  has  shown  various  tissue  regeneration  capabilities  in 
preclinical studies. We have a proprietary variant of SDF-1 that has been engineered to be resistant to enzymatic cleavage 
and that has a longer half-life in vivo compared to the native molecule.

Gene targeting technologies, that allow us to target various helpful or harmful genes related to a given disease indication.

MLCs modified using our proprietary cell targeting technology, called ex vivo fucosylation, have successfully induced durable 
reversal of Type 1 diabetes in a preclinical study. The study results were published in the peer reviewed journal Stem Cells in 2015.  
The results showed that the cell targeting technology increased by three-fold the numbers of MLCs reaching the inflamed pancreas in 
autoimmune diabetic mice following intravenous infusion, compared with unmodified MLCs. This resulted in a markedly increased 
number  of  mice  who  reverted  to  having  normal  blood  glucose,  and  in  durable  reversal  of  Type  1  diabetes.   We  have  conducted  a 
placebo-controlled, randomized, dose-escalating Phase 2 clinical trial of our product candidate MPC-300-IV in patients with Type 2 
diabetes, the results of which were published in the peer-reviewed journal Diabetes Care in 2015. By enhancing targeting of the cells 
to the inflamed pancreas, we believe the ex vivo fucosylation technology has the potential to further augment the glucose lowering 
properties of MPC-300-IV, and to extend its use to patients with Type 1 diabetes. 

Manufacturing and Supply Chain

52

Our  manufacturing  strategy  for  our  cellular  product  candidates  focuses  on  the  following  important  factors:(i)  clear  product 
delineation  to  protect  pricing  and  partner  markets  by  creating  distinct  products  using  discrete  manufacturing  processes,  culture 
conditions, formulations, routes of administration, and/or dose regimens; (ii) establishing proprietary commercial scale-up and supply 
to meet increasing demand; (iii) implementing efficiencies and yield improvement measures to reduce cost-of-goods; (iv) maintaining 
regulatory compliance with best practices; and (v) establishing and maintaining multiple manufacturing sites for product supply risk 
mitigation.

The stem cell manufacturing and distribution process generally involves five major steps.

•

•

•

•

•

Procure  bone  marrow—acquire  bone  marrow  from  healthy  adults  with  specific  FDA-defined  criteria,  which  is 
accompanied by significant laboratory testing to establish the usability of the donated tissues.

Create master cell banks—isolate MLCs from the donated bone marrow and perform a preliminary expansion to create 
master cell banks. Each individual master cell bank comes from a single donor.

Expand  to  therapeutic  quantities—expand  master  cell  banks  to  produce  therapeutic  quantities,  a  process  that  can  yield 
thousands  of  doses  per  master  cell  bank,  with  the  ultimate  number  depending  on  the  dose  for  the  respective  product 
candidate being produced.

Formulate, package and cryopreserve.

Distribute—with  the  exception  of  procurement  and  creation  of  master  cell  banks,  our  manufacturing  is  conducted  in 
Lonza’s Singapore facility, and products will be cryopreserved, then shipped to Lonza or other storage sites in the U.S. 
and  other  jurisdictions  via  cryoshippers.  Those  distribution  centers  then  send  the  products  on  to  treatment  centers  in 
cryoshippers. Treatment centers either move the products into their own freezers, or receive the cryoshipper in “real time” 
and product stays in the cryoshipper until thawed for  patient use within a  well-defined window.  We  intend to continue 
utilizing this approach in the future, except that we intend to settle on a new network of distributors in various regions.

Our  product  candidates  are  currently  manufactured  in  two-dimensional,  or  2D,  planar,  10-layer  cell  factories,  using  media 

containing fetal bovine serum, or FBS.

The  relatively  small  patient  numbers  and  orphan  drug  designation  for  MSC-100-IV  for  aGVHD  lead  us  to  believe  that  2D 
manufacturing  will  provide  commercial  cost  of  goods  for  this  product  candidate  if  fully  approved.  We  also  believe  that  2D 
manufacturing is commercially feasible for Phase 3 trial supply and the initial launch of MPC-06-ID for CLBP.

However,  to  build  up  commercial  supply  for  certain  of  our  product  candidates  long-term,  we  are  developing  manufacturing 
processes using three-dimensional, or 3D, bioreactors with greater capacity to improve efficiency and yields, with resulting lower-cost 
of goods. We expect to evaluate products produced in 3D bioreactors in later stages of our Phase 3 clinical trials, which will serve as 
FDA required comparability studies to 2D if successful.   We are also focusing on the introduction of FBS-free media which has the 
potential  to  result  in  efficiency  and  yield  improvements  to  the  current  2D  process  which  may  prove  sufficient  for  commercial 
production  of  some  of  our  final  products.  We  intend  to  conduct  comparability  studies  to  illustrate  that  products  produced  with  this 
media  are  equivalent  to  those  produced  using  FBS  based  media.  While  we  remain  confident  in  our  ability  to  deliver  successful 
outcomes from each of these activities, any unexpected issues or challenges faced in doing so could delay our programs or prevent us 
from continuing our programs.

Our  manufacturing  activities  have  met  stringent  criteria  set  by  international  regulatory  agencies,  including  the  U.S.  FDA.  By 
using well-characterized cell populations, our manufacturing processes promote reproducibility and batch-to-batch consistency for our 
allogeneic  cell  product  candidates.  We  have  developed  robust  quality  assurance  procedures  and  lot  release  assays  to  support  this 
reproducibility and consistency.

Intellectual Property

We have a large patent portfolio of issued and pending claims covering compositions of matter, uses for our MLC cell-based 
technologies  and  other  proprietary  regenerative  product  candidates  and  technologies,  as  well  as  for  elements  of  our  manufacturing 
processes, with approximately 800 patents and patent applications across 69 patent families as of August 2017.

One of our major objectives is to continue to protect and expand our extensive estate of patent rights and trade secrets, which we 
believe  enables  us  to  deliver  commercial  advantages  and  long-term  protection  for  our  product  candidates  based  on  our  proprietary 
technologies,  and  support  our  corporate  strategy  to  target  large,  mature  and  emerging  healthcare  markets  for  our  exploratory 
therapeutic product candidates.

53

More specifically, our patent estate includes issued patent and patent applications in major markets, including, but not limited to, 
the United States, Europe, Japan and China. The patents that we have obtained, and continue to apply for, cover MLC technologies 
and product candidates derived from these technologies, irrespective of the tissue source, including bone marrow, adipose, placenta, 
umbilical cord and dental pulp.

These patents cover, among other technology areas, a variety of MLCs (including MPCs and MSCs), and the use of MLC for 
expansion of hematopoietic stem cells, or HSCs. Among the indication-specific issued or pending patents covering product candidates 
derived  from  our  MLCs  are  those  which  are  directed  to  our  Tier  1  product  candidates:  CLBP,  CHF,  aGVHD  and  chronic 
inflammatory conditions such as RA and DKD. We also have issued and pending patents covering our Tier 2 and pipeline indications, 
including inflammatory bowel disease (e.g., Crohn’s disease), neurologic diseases, eye diseases and orthopedic diseases.

Our patent portfolio also includes issued and pending coverage of proprietary manufacturing processes that are being used with 
our  current  two-dimensional  manufacturing  platform  as  well  as  the  3D  bioreactor  manufacturing  processes  currently  under 
development.  These  cell  manufacturing  patents  cover  isolation,  expansion,  purification,  scale  up,  culture  conditions,  aggregates 
minimization, cryopreservation, release testing and potency assays. In addition, we maintain as a trade secret, among other things, our 
proprietary FBS-free media used in our 3D bioreactor manufacturing processes.

We  maintain  trade  secrets  covering  a  significant  body  of  know-how  and  proprietary  information  relating  to  our  core  product 
candidates  and  technologies.  We  protect  our  confidential  know-how  and  trade  secrets  in  a  number  of  ways,  including  requiring  all 
employees  and  third  parties  that  have  access  to  our  confidential  information  to  sign  non-disclosure  agreements,  limiting  access  to 
confidential information on a need-to-know basis, maintaining our confidential information on secure computers, and providing our 
contract manufacturers with certain key ingredients for our manufacturing process.

In addition, in many major jurisdictions there are other means that may be available to us by which we would be able to extend 
the  period  during  which  we  have  commercial  exclusivity  for  our  product  candidates,  which  include,  but  are  not  limited  to  the 
exclusive right to reference our data, orphan drug exclusivity and patent term extensions.

As part of our strategy, we seek patent protection for our product candidates and technologies in major jurisdictions including 
the United States, Europe, Japan, China, and Australia and file independent and/or counterpart patents and patent applications in other 
jurisdictions  globally  that  we  deem  appropriate  under  the  circumstances,  including  India,  Canada,  Hong  Kong,  Israel,  Korea  and 
Singapore.  As  of  August  2017,  our  patent  portfolio  includes  the  following  patents  and  patent  applications  in  the  following  major 
jurisdictions: 77 granted U.S. patents and 52 pending U.S. patent applications; 43 granted Japanese patents and 33 pending Japanese 
patent  applications;  20  granted  Chinese  patents  and  18  pending  Chinese  patent  applications;  27  granted  European  patents  and  42 
pending European patent applications; and 49 granted Australian patents and 23 pending Australian patent applications.

Our  policy  is  to  patent  the  technology,  inventions  and  improvements  that  we  consider  important  to  the  development  of  our 
business, only in those cases in which we believe that the costs of obtaining patent protection is justified by the commercial potential 
of  the  technology  and  associated  product  candidates,  and  typically  only  in  those  jurisdictions  that  we  believe  present  significant 
commercial opportunities to us. In those cases where we choose neither to seek patent protection nor protect the inventions as trade 
secrets, we may publish the inventions so that it defensively becomes prior art in order for us to secure a freedom to operate position 
and to prevent third parties from patenting the invention.

We  also  seek  to  protect  as  trade  secrets  our  proprietary  and  confidential  know-how  and  technologies  that  are  either  not 
patentable or where we deem it inadvisable to seek patent protection. To this end, we generally require all third parties with whom we 
share  confidential  information  and  our  employees,  consultants  and  advisors  to  enter  into  confidentiality  agreements  prohibiting  the 
disclosure  of  confidential  information.  These  agreements  with  our  employees  and  consultants  engaged  in  the  development  of  our 
technologies  require  disclosure  and  assignment  to  us  of  the  ideas,  developments,  discoveries  and  inventions,  and  associated 
intellectual property rights, important to our business. Additionally, these confidentiality agreements, among others, require that our 
employees, consultants and advisors do not bring to us, or use without proper authorization, any third party’s proprietary technology.

License and Collaboration Agreements 

JCR Pharmaceuticals Co., Ltd—Hematological Malignancies and Hepatocytes Collaboration in Japan

In  October  2013,  we  acquired  all  of  Osiris  Therapeutics,  Inc.’s  business  and  assets  related  to  culture  expanded  MSCs.  These 
assets included assumption of a collaboration agreement with JCR, or the JCR Agreement, which will continue in existence until the 
later  of  15  years  from  the  first  commercial  sale  of  any  product  covered  by  the  agreement  and  expiration  of  the  last  Osiris  patent 
covering any such product. JCR is a research and development oriented pharmaceutical company in Japan. Under the JCR Agreement, 
JCR  has  the  right  to  develop  our  MSCs  in  two  fields  for  the  Japanese  market:  exclusive  in  conjunction  with  the  treatment  of 
hematological malignancies by the use of HSCs derived from peripheral blood, cord blood or bone marrow, or the First JCR Field; 

54

and non-exclusive for developing assays that use liver cells for non-clinical drug screening and evaluation, or the Second JCR Field. 
Under  the  JCR  Agreement,  JCR  obtained  rights  in  Japan  to  our  MSCs,  for  the  treatment  of  aGVHD.  JCR  also  has  a  right  of  first 
negotiation to obtain rights to commercialize MSC- based products for additional orphan designations in Japan. We retain all rights to 
those products outside of Japan.

The Japanese Pharmaceuticals and Medical  Devices  Agency granted  JR-031 orphan  drug  status in December  2013, and, as a 
result,  it  underwent  a  priority  review.  JCR  filed  for  approval  in  September  2014  and  received  full  approval  in  September  2015  for 
TEMCELL.  JCR  has  expanded  its  manufacturing  facility  to  support  commercial  launch.  JR-031  is  the  first  culture-expanded 
allogeneic stem cell product to be approved in Japan.

Under  the  JCR  Agreement,  JCR  is  responsible  for  all  development  and  manufacturing  costs  including  sales  and  marketing 
expenses. With respect to the First JCR Field, we are entitled to future payments of up to US$2.5 million in the aggregate when JCR 
reaches certain development and commercial milestones and to escalating double- digit royalties in the twenties. These royalties are 
subject  to  possible  renegotiation  downward  in  the  event  of  competition  from  non-infringing  products  in  Japan.  With  respect  to  the 
Second JCR Field, we are entitled to a double digit profit share in the fifties.

Intellectual property is licensed both ways under the JCR Agreement, with JCR receiving exclusive and non-exclusive rights as 
described above from us and granting us non-exclusive, royalty-free rights (excluding in the First JCR Field and Second JCR Field in 
Japan)  under  the  intellectual  property  arising  out  of  JCR’s  development  or  commercialization  of  MSC-based  products  licensed  in 
Japan.

JCR has the right to terminate the JCR Agreement for any reason, and we have a limited right to terminate the JCR Agreement, 
including a right to terminate in the event of an uncured material breach by JCR. In the event of a termination of the JCR Agreement 
other than for our breach, JCR must provide us with its owned product registrations and technical data related to MSC-based products 
licensed in Japan and all licenses of our intellectual property rights will revert to us.

Lonza—Manufacturing Collaboration

In  September  2011,  we  entered  into  a  manufacturing  services  agreement,  or  MSA,  with  Lonza  Walkersville,  Inc.  and  Lonza 
Bioscience  Singapore  Pte.  Ltd.,  collectively  referred  to  as  Lonza,  a  global  leader  in  biopharmaceutical  manufacturing.  Under  the 
MSA,  we  pay  Lonza  on  a  fee  for  service  basis  to  provide  us  with  manufacturing  process  development  capabilities  for  our  product 
candidates,  including  formulation  development,  establishment  and  maintenance  of  master  cell  banks,  records  preparation,  process 
validation, manufacturing and other services.

We have agreed to order a certain percentage of our clinical requirements and commercial requirements from Lonza. Lonza has 
agreed not to manufacture or supply commercially biosimilar versions of any of our product candidates to any third party, during the 
term of the MSA, subject to our meeting certain thresholds for sales of our products.

We  can  trigger  a  process  requiring  Lonza  to  construct  a  purpose-built  manufacturing  facility  exclusively  for  our  product 
candidates. In return if we exercise this option, we will purchase agreed quantities of our product candidates from this facility. We also 
have a right to buy out this manufacturing facility at a pre-agreed price two years after the facility receives regulatory approval.

The MSA will expire on the later of December 31, 2020 or the three year anniversary of the date of the first commercial sale of 
product supplied under the MSA, unless it is sooner terminated. We have the option of extending the MSA for an additional 10 years, 
followed by the option to extend for successive three-year periods subject to Lonza’s reasonable consent. We may terminate the MSA 
with two years prior written notice, and Lonza may terminate with five years prior written notice. The MSA may also terminate for 
other reasons, including if the manufacture or development of a product is suspended or abandoned due to the results of clinical trials 
or  guidance  from  a  regulatory  authority.  In  the  event  we  request  that  Lonza  construct  the  manufacturing  facility  described  above, 
neither we nor Lonza may terminate before the third anniversary of the date the facility receives regulatory approval to manufacture 
our  product  candidates,  except  in  certain  limited  circumstances.  Upon  expiration  or  termination  of  the  MSA,  we  have  the  right  to 
require  Lonza  to  transfer  certain  technologies  and  lease  the  Singapore  facility  or  the  portion  of  such  facility  where  our  product 
candidates are manufactured, subject to good faith negotiations.

We currently rely, and expect to continue to rely, on Lonza for the manufacture of our product candidates for preclinical and 

clinical testing, as well as for commercial manufacture of our product candidates if marketing approval is obtained.

Singapore Economic Development Board (EDB)—Singapore Operations

In May 2014, the Economic Development Board of Singapore, or EDB, granted us certain financial incentives tied to revenues 
generated by our Singapore operations, among other things. These incentives include two separate 15-year periods (each broken into 

55

five-year  increments)  of  potential  incentives,  one  related  primarily  to  non-manufacturing  activities  and  the  other  related  to 
manufacturing activities. We will be eligible for these incentives if we meet certain investment or activity thresholds in Singapore, 
including  employment  levels,  amounts  of  business  or  manufacturing  related  expenses,  and  the  performance  of  various  services 
including business development, planning, manufacturing, intellectual property management, marketing and distribution.

For  example,  in  order  to  obtain  full  financial  benefits  from  the  EDB  for  our  manufacturing-related  incentives,  we  must 
manufacture at least 50% of the global volume of our first three commercial products in Singapore (subject to certain exceptions), and 
we  would  be  required  to  construct  and  operate  a  manufacturing  facility  in  Singapore,  and  hire  and  maintain  a  specified  number  of 
professionals (including supply chain personnel) in connection with the operation of that facility. The activities under our MSA with 
Lonza could be used to fulfill all or part of the requirements to obtain the EDB financial incentives.

Central Adelaide Local Health Network Incorporated—Mesenchymal Precursor Cell Intellectual Property

In  October  2004,  we,  through  our  wholly-owned  subsidiary,  Angioblast  Systems  Inc.,  now  Mesoblast,  Inc.,  acquired  certain 
intellectual  property  relating  to  our  MPCs,  or  Medvet  IP,  pursuant  to  an  Intellectual  Property  Assignment  Deed,  or  IP  Deed,  with 
Medvet Science Pty Ltd, or Medvet. Medvet’s rights under the IP Deed were transferred to Central Adelaide Local Health Network 
Incorporated,  or  CALHNI,  in  November  2011.  In  connection  with  our  use  of  the  Medvet  IP,  we  are  obligated  to  pay  CALHNI,  as 
successor in interest to Medvet, (i) certain aggregated milestone payments of up to US$2.5 million and single-digit royalties on net 
sales of products covered by the Medvet IP, for cardiac muscle and blood vessel applications and bone and cartilage regeneration and 
repair applications, subject to minimum annual royalties beginning in the first year of commercial sale of those products and (ii) and 
single-digit royalties on net sales of the specified products for applications outside the specified fields. Additionally, we are obligated 
to pay CALHNI a double-digit percentage in the teens of any revenue that we receive in exchange for a grant of a sublicense to the 
Medvet IP in the specified fields. Under the IP Deed, we also granted to Medvet a non-exclusive, royalty-free license to the Medvet IP 
for non-commercial, internal research and academic research.

Pursuant  to  the  IP  Deed,  we  were  assigned  the  rights  in  three  U.S.  patents  or  patent  applications  (including  all  substitutions, 
continuations, continuations-in-part, divisional, supplementary protection certificates, renewals, all letters patent granted thereon, and 
all  reissues,  reexaminations,  extensions,  confirmations,  revalidations,  registrations  and  patents  of  addition  and  foreign  equivalents 
thereof)  and  all  future  intellectual  property  rights,  including  improvements,  that  might  arise  from  research  conducted  at  CALHNI 
related to mesenchymal precursor cells and methods of isolating, culturing and expanding mesenchymal precursor cells and their use 
in any therapeutic area. We also acquired all related materials, information and know-how.

Case Western Reserve University—Mesenchymal Stem Cell Intellectual Property

In  October  2013,  our  wholly  owned  subsidiary,  Mesoblast  International  Sàrl,  acquired  certain  MSC-based  assets  from  Osiris 
including a technology transfer and license agreement between Osiris and Case Western Reserve University, or CWRU. Pursuant to 
the technology transfer and license agreement, or CWRU Agreement, we (i) were assigned certain patent rights relating to MSCs, or 
CWRU Assigned Patents, and (ii) obtained an exclusive, worldwide, sublicensable license to (A) information and know-how relating 
to  MSCs,  or  CWRU  Technology,  and  (B)  certain  patents  relating  to  (x)  MSCs,  or  CWRU  Licensed  Patents,  and  (y)  the  CWRU 
Assigned  Patents,  to  the  extent  the  CWRU  Assigned  Patents  are  not  owned  by  us  (collectively,  with  the  CWRU  Technology  and 
CRWU Licensed Patents, the CWRU Licensed Technology and Patents).

Pursuant to the CWRU License, we acquired sole and exclusive worldwide sublicensable rights to more than ten U.S. patents or 
patent applications (including any divisions, continuations, continuations-in-part, reissues, reexaminations or extensions thereof along 
with all foreign equivalents) and related technologies. These patents and technologies generally relate to isolated human mesenchymal 
stem  cells,  methods  for  isolating,  purifying,  and  culturally  expanding  human  mesenchymal  stem  cells  without  having  them 
differentiate,  and  characterization  of  and  uses  of  mesenchymal  stem  cells  including  related  research  reagents,  diagnostics  and 
therapeutic uses for such cells and other related materials, methods and subject matter.

CWRU  retained  a  right  to  use  the  CWRU  Licensed  Technology  and  Patents  for  nonclinical  research,  testing  or  educational 
purposes,  including  research  funded  by  a  commercial  entity  unless  the  commercial  entity  obtains  a  license  or  ownership  of  the 
research results. Under the CWRU Agreement, we are obligated to pay single-digit royalties on net sales of product covered by the 
CWRU  Licensed  Patents  and  a  double-digit  percentage  of  royalties  received  from  a  sublicensee  of  the  CWRU  Licensed  Patents. 
Additionally,  we  are  obligated  to  pay  single-digit  royalties  on  products  covered  by  certain  of  the  CWRU  Assigned  Patents.  The 
royalties that we are obligated to pay to CWRU on sales of products are not due for an initial period of sales of each such product, and 
are subject to a reduction in the event we have to pay royalties to a third party for the sale of those products. The royalties that we owe 
under the CWRU License on sales of products will also be reduced for costs arising from an infringement suit against us by a third 
party based on sales of covered products and for costs arising from any suit we file against a third party to protect any intellectual 
property right granted under the CWRU Agreement. Our payment obligations under the CWRU Agreement are subject to a minimum 
annual payment.

56

Either we or CWRU may initiate a suit based on the infringement of the CWRU Licensed Technology and Patents. In the event 
CWRU notifies us that a third party desires to obtain a sublicense to the CWRU Licensed Technology and Patents in a field that we 
are not practicing, we are obligated to negotiate in good faith a sublicense with the third party subject to certain limitations that protect 
our commercial interests.

The  CWRU  Agreement  continues  until  at  least  expiration  of  all  of  the  patents  within  the  CWRU  Licensed  Technology  and 
Patents, unless the CWRU Agreement is terminated at an earlier time. The last patent in this portfolio expires in July 2020. We have a 
right to terminate the CWRU License upon advance written notice to CWRU. CWRU has a more limited right to terminate the CWRU 
License that includes a right to terminate the CWRU License in the event we have materially breached the CWRU License and have 
not cured the breach within a specified time period.

Osiris Acquisition—Continuing Obligations

In October 2013, we and Osiris entered into a purchase agreement, as amended, or the Osiris Purchase Agreement, under which 
we acquired all of Osiris’ business and assets related to culture expanded MSCs. Pursuant to the Osiris Purchase Agreement, we also 
agreed to make certain milestone and royalty payments to Osiris pertaining to MSC-100-IV for the treatment of aGVHD and Crohn’s 
disease. Each milestone payment is for a fixed dollar amount and may be paid in cash or our ordinary shares or ADSs, at our option. 
The maximum amount of future milestone payments we may be required to make to Osiris is US$50 million. Any ordinary shares or 
ADSs  we  issue  as  consideration  for  a  milestone  payment  will  be  subject  to  a  contractual  one  year  holding  period,  which  may  be 
waived in our discretion. In the event that the price of our ordinary shares or ADSs decreases between the issue date and the expiration 
of any applicable holding period, we will be required to make an additional payment to Osiris equal to the reduction in the share price 
multiplied by the amount of issued shares under that milestone payment. This additional payment can be made either wholly in cash or 
50% in cash and 50% in our ordinary shares, in our discretion. We have also agreed to pay varying earnout amounts as a percentage of 
annual  net  sales  of  acquired  products,  ranging  from  low  single-digit  to  10%  of  annual  sales  in  excess  of  US$750  million.  These 
royalty payments will cease after the earlier of a ten year commercial sales period and the first sale of a competing product.

Competition

The  biotechnology  and  pharmaceutical  industries  are  highly  competitive  and  are  characterized  by  rapidly  advancing 
technologies  and  a  strong  emphasis  on  proprietary  products.  Any  product  candidates  that  we  and  our  collaborators  successfully 
develop and commercialize will compete with existing products and new products that may become available in the future.

We  believe  that  a  number  of  our  potential  competitors,  particularly  large  biopharmaceutical  companies,  have  significantly 
greater financial resources and general expertise in research and development, manufacturing, preclinical testing, conducting clinical 
trials, obtaining regulatory approvals and marketing approved products than we do. Our market has been characterized by significant 
consolidation by pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies, which is likely to result in even more resources being concentrated 
among a smaller number of our potential competitors.

Government Regulation

We  are  developing  cellular  therapy  product  candidates.  These  products  are  subject  to  extensive  legislation.  Governmental 
authorities  around  the  world,  including  the  FDA,  are  charged  with  the  administration  and  enforcement  of  numerous  laws  and 
regulations that impact all aspects of the development, production, importing, testing, approval, labeling, promotion, advertising, and 
sale of products such as ours.  Such governmental authorities are also charged with administering what is often a lengthy and technical 
review  and  approval  process  before  candidate  therapies  such  as  ours  may  be  marketed  for  any  use.  Authorization  or  approval  for 
marketing must generally be obtained from the local health authorities in each country in which the product is to be sold. Approval 
and  authorization  procedures  may  differ  from  country  to  country,  as  may  the  requirements  for  maintaining  approvals.  It  is  typical 
however for these procedures to require evidence of rigorous testing and documentation regarding the candidate therapy, which may 
include  significant  non-clinical  and  clinical  evaluations.  Extensive  controls  and  requirements  apply  to  the  non-clinical  and  clinical 
development  of  our  therapeutic  candidates.  Those  requirements  and  their  enforcement  and  implementation  by  local  regulatory 
authorities around the world significantly impact whether a product candidate can be developed into a marketable product, and notably 
impact the cost, resources and timing for any such development. Changes in regulatory requirements and differences in requirements 
from country to country may also increase the costs of bringing new technologies such as ours to market and maintaining approvals, if 
obtained. 

To obtain marketing approval of a new product, an extensive dossier of evidence establishing the safety, efficacy and quality of 
the product must be submitted for review by regulatory authorities. Dossier form and substance, while often similar may have notable 
differences  in  different  countries.  Submission  of  an  application  to  regulators  does  not  guarantee  approval  to  market  that  product, 
despite the fact that criteria for approval in many countries may be quite similar.  Some regulatory authorities may require additional 

57

data  and  analyses,  and  may  have  standards  that  apply  that  are  more  stringent  than  others  for  review  of  the  submitted  dossier  and 
content. Additionally, the review process, risk tolerance, and openness to new technologies may vary from country to country.

Obtaining marketing approval can take several months to several years, depending on the country, the quality of the data, the 
efficiencies and procedures of the reviewing regulatory authority and their familiarity with the product technology. Some countries, 
like  the  US,  may  have  accelerated  approval  processes  for  certain  categories  of  products,  for  example  products  which  represent  a 
breakthrough in the field, or which meet certain thresholds and have obtained certain designations of particular interest. Nevertheless, 
ultimate availability to patients may be affected, even post approval, by requirements in some countries to negotiate selling prices and 
reimbursement terms with government regulators or other payors.

Maintaining  marketing  approval  may  require  the  conduct  of  additional  post-approval  studies  in  some  situations,  and  the 
continued capture, monitoring and assessment of safety and other information about the product, as well as adherence to requirements 
to ensure the purity and integrity of manufactured product. The process for obtaining and maintaining regulatory authorizations and 
approvals to market our products and the subsequent compliance with appropriate federal, state, local and foreign laws and regulations 
require the expenditure of substantial time and the commitment of significant financial and other resources, and we may not be able to 
obtain the required regulatory approvals.

U.S. Product Development Process

All of our product candidates are regulated as biological products by the Center for Biologics Evaluation and Research in the 
FDA.   In the United States, biological products are subject to federal regulation under the federal FDCA, the Public Health Service 
(“PHS”) Act, and other federal, state, local and foreign statutes and regulations. Both the FDCA and the PHS Act, as applicable, and 
their corresponding regulations govern, among other things, the testing, manufacturing, safety, efficacy, labeling, packaging, storage, 
record  keeping,  distribution,  import,  export,  reporting,  advertising  and  other  promotional  practices  involving  drugs  and  biological 
products. Before clinical testing of a new drug or biological product may commence, the sponsor of the clinical study must submit an 
application  for  investigational  new  drug  (“IND”)  application,  to  FDA,  which  must  include,  among  other  information,  the  proposed 
clinical  study  protocol(s).  To  obtain  marketing  authorization  once  clinical  testing  has  concluded,  a  Biologics  License  Application 
(“BLA”) must be submitted for FDA approval.

 The process required by the FDA before a biological product may be marketed in the U.S. generally involves the following:

•

•

•

•

•

•

completion of nonclinical laboratory studies, meaning in vivo or in vitro experiments in which an investigational product 
is studied prospectively in a test system under laboratory conditions to determine its safety, must be conducted according 
to  cGLP (good laboratory practice) regulations, as well as, in the case of nonclinical laboratory studies involving animal 
test systems, in accordance with applicable requirements for the humane use of laboratory animals and other applicable 
regulations;

submission  to  the  FDA  of  an  application  for  an  IND,  which  must  become  effective  before  human  clinical  studies  may 
begin;

performance  of  adequate  and  well-controlled  human  clinical  studies  according  to  the  FDA’s  cGCPs  (good  clinical 
practices) and all other applicable regulatory requirements for the protection of human research subjects and their health 
information,  to  establish  the  safety,  purity  and  potency  of  the  proposed  product  for  its  intended  use  and  to  ensure  the 
product has an appropriate risk-benefit profile;

submission to the FDA of a BLA for marketing approval demonstrating the quality, safety, and efficacy of the product 
which  must  be  supported  by  substantial  evidence  from  adequate  and  well-controlled  clinical  investigations  as  well  as 
demonstration of mode of action through non-clinical studies, evidence to support appropriate manufacturing capabilities 
and controls, and evidence of the stability of the product in the form it is intended to be provided. ;

satisfactory completion of an FDA inspection of the manufacturing facility or facilities where the product is produced to 
assess  compliance  with  cGMP  (good  manufacturing  practices)  to  assure  that  the  facilities,  methods  and  controls  for 
production are adequate to preserve the product’s identity, strength, purity and potency;

potential FDA inspection of the nonclinical and likely inspection of select clinical study sites that generated the data in 
support of the BLA; and

•

FDA review and approval of the BLA. 

Human  testing  of  a  biological  product  candidate  is  preceded  by  preclinical  testing,  including  nonclinical  laboratory  studies  in 
which the product candidate is studied prospectively in a test system under laboratory conditions to determine its safety. A test system 
may  include  any  animal,  plant,  microorganism,  or  subparts  thereof  to  which  the  test  or  control  article  is  administered  or  added  for 
study.

58

The clinical study sponsor must submit the results of the preclinical tests, together with manufacturing information, analytical 
data, any available clinical data or literature and a proposed clinical protocol, to the FDA as part of the IND. Some preclinical testing 
may continue even after the IND is submitted. The IND automatically becomes effective 30 days after receipt by the FDA, unless the 
FDA places the clinical study subject to the IND on a clinical hold within that 30-day time period. In such a case, the IND sponsor and 
the FDA must resolve any outstanding concerns before the clinical study can begin. The FDA may also impose clinical holds on a 
product candidate at any time during clinical studies due to safety concerns or non-compliance. If the FDA imposes a clinical hold, 
studies may not recommence unless FDA removes the clinical hold and then only under terms authorized by the FDA. Accordingly, 
we cannot be sure that submission of an IND will result in the FDA allowing clinical studies to begin, or that, once begun, issues will 
not arise that suspend or terminate such studies.

Clinical studies involve the administration of the product candidate to subjects under the supervision of qualified investigators, 
generally physicians not employed by or under the study sponsor’s control. Clinical studies are conducted under protocols detailing, 
among other things, the objectives of the clinical study, dosing procedures, subject selection and exclusion criteria, and the parameters 
to be used to monitor subject safety, including stopping rules that assure a clinical study will be stopped if certain adverse events, or 
AEs, should occur. Each new protocol and certain amendments to the protocol must be submitted to the FDA. Clinical studies must be 
conducted  in  accordance  with  the  FDA’s  cGCP  regulations  and  guidance,  and  monitored  to  ensure  compliance  with  applicable 
regulatory requirements. These include the requirement that written informed consent is obtained from all subjects who participate in 
the study. Further, each clinical study must be reviewed and approved by an independent Institutional Review Board, or IRB, at or 
servicing each institution at which the clinical study will be conducted. An IRB is charged with protecting the welfare and rights of 
study participants and considers such items as whether the risks to individuals participating in the clinical studies are minimized and 
are reasonable in relation to anticipated benefits. The IRB also approves the form and content of the informed consent document that 
must be signed by each clinical study subject or his or her legal representative and must monitor the clinical study until completed. 
Throughout  the  study,  certain  information  about  certain  serious  adverse  events  must  be  reported  to  the  IRB,  in  some  cases  on  an 
expedited basis, and to FDA (as well as to regulators in other countries in which studies of the product are also being conducted). 

Human clinical studies are typically conducted in three sequential phases that may in some cases overlap or be combined:

•

•

•

Phase  1.  The  product  candidate  is  initially  introduced  into  a  small  number  of  human  subjects.  In  the  case  of  cellular 
therapy products, the initial human testing is conducted in patients with the disease or condition targeted by the biological 
product  candidate.  Phase  1  studies  are  intended  to  determine  the  metabolism  and  pharmacologic  actions  (including 
adverse  reactions),  the  side  effects  associated  with  increasing  doses,  immunogenicity,  and,  if  possible,  to  gain  early 
evidence  of   effectiveness.  The  information  obtained  in  Phase  1  should  be  sufficient  to  permit  the  design  of  well-
controlled, scientifically valid Phase 2 studies.

Phase 2. Controlled clinical studies are conducted in a larger number of human subjects to evaluate the effectiveness of 
the drug for a particular indication or indications in patients with the disease or condition under study. Phase 2 studies are 
intended  to  assess  side  effects  and  risks,  and  to  examine  exposure–response  relationships,  and  to  further  explore 
pharmacologic actions and immunogenicity associated with the drug.   These studies also provide helpful information for 
the design of phase 3 studies. 

Phase 3. Assuming preliminary evidence suggesting effectiveness has been obtained in phase 2 (generally considered to 
be  “proof  of  concept”),  controlled  studies  are  conducted  in  a  larger  group  of  subjects  to  gather  additional  information 
about  effectiveness  and  safety  in  order  to  evaluate  the  overall  benefit-risk  relationship  of  the  drug  and  to  provide  an 
adequate basis for physician labeling.

Post-approval  clinical  studies,  sometimes  referred  to  as  Phase  4  clinical  studies,  may  be  conducted  after  initial  marketing 
approval.  In  some  cases  FDA  may  require  a  Phase  4  study  to  be  performed  as  a  condition  of  product  approval.  Sponsors  also  can 
voluntarily conduct Phase 4 studies to gain additional experience from the treatment of patients in the intended therapeutic indication, 
particularly for long-term safety follow-up or in select populations. FDA regulations extend to all phases of clinical development, and 
apply to  sponsors  and  investigators  of clinical  studies.  FDA  oversight  includes inspection of  the sites  and investigators  involved  in 
conducting the studies.

Concurrent  with  clinical  studies,  companies  usually  complete  additional  animal  studies  and  must  also  develop  additional 
information about the physical characteristics of the biological product as well as finalize a process for manufacturing the product in 
commercial quantities in accordance with cGMP requirements. 

To help reduce the risk of the introduction of adventitious agents with use of biological products, the PHS Act emphasizes the 
importance of manufacturing control for products whose attributes cannot be precisely defined. The manufacturing process must be 
capable of consistently producing quality batches of the product candidate and, among other things; the sponsor must develop methods 
for  testing  the  identity,  purity  and  potency  of  the  final  biological  product.  All  such  testing  and  controls  requires  the  application  of 
significant human and financial resources.

59

Additionally, appropriate packaging must be selected and tested and stability studies must be conducted to demonstrate that the 

biological product candidate does not undergo unacceptable deterioration over its shelf life.

U.S. Review and Approval Processes

After the completion of clinical studies of a product candidate, FDA approval of a BLA must be obtained before commercial 
marketing  of  the  biological  product.  The  BLA  must  include  results  of  product  development,  laboratory  and  animal  studies,  human 
studies, information on the manufacture and composition of the product, proposed labeling and other relevant information. In addition, 
under  the  Pediatric  Research  Equity  Act  (“PREA”),  a  BLA  or  supplement  to  a  BLA  must  contain  data  to  assess  the  safety  and 
effectiveness  of  the  product  for  the  claimed  indications  in  all  relevant  pediatric  subpopulations  and  to  support  dosing  and 
administration  for  each  pediatric  subpopulation  for  which  the  product  is  safe  and  effective.  The  FDA  may  grant  deferrals  for 
submission of data or full or partial waivers. Unless otherwise required by regulation, PREA does not apply to any biological product 
for an indication for which orphan designation has been granted. The testing and approval processes require substantial time and effort 
and there can be no assurance that the FDA will accept the BLA for filing and, even if filed, that any approval will be granted on a 
timely basis, if at all.

Under the Prescription Drug User Fee Act (“PDUFA”), as amended, each BLA must be accompanied by a substantial user fee. 
PDUFA  also  imposes  an  annual  product  fee  for  biologics  and  an  annual  establishment  fee  on  facilities  used  to  manufacture 
prescription biologics. Fee waivers or reductions are available in certain circumstances, including a waiver of the application fee for 
the first application filed by a small business.

Additionally,  an  application  fee  is  not  assessed  on  BLAs  for  products  designated  as  orphan  drugs,  unless  the  product  also 

includes a non-orphan indication.

Within 60 days following submission of the application, the FDA reviews the BLA submitted to determine if it is substantially 
complete before the agency accepts it for filing. The FDA may refuse to file any marketing application that it deems incomplete or not 
properly reviewable at the time of submission and may request additional information. In this event, the BLA must be resubmitted 
with the additional information. The resubmitted application also is subject to review before the FDA accepts it for filing. Once the 
submission  is accepted  for filing, the FDA begins  an  in-depth  substantive  review of  the  BLA. The  FDA  reviews  the application  to 
determine, among other things, whether the proposed product is safe and effective, for its intended use, and has an acceptable purity 
profile, and whether the product is being manufactured in accordance with cGMP to assure and preserve the product’s identity, safety, 
potency  and  purity.  The  FDA  may  refer  applications  for  novel  products  or  products  that  present  difficult  questions  of  safety  or 
efficacy  to  an  advisory  committee,  typically  a  panel  that  includes  clinicians  and  other  experts,  for  review,  evaluation  and  a 
recommendation  as  to  whether  the  application  should  be  approved  and  under  what  conditions.  The  FDA  is  not  bound  by  the 
recommendations  of  an  advisory  committee,  but  it  considers  such  recommendations  carefully  when  making  decisions.  During  the 
product approval process, the FDA also will determine whether a Risk Evaluation and Mitigation Strategy, or REMS, is necessary to 
assure the safe use of the product. If the FDA concludes a REMS is needed, the sponsor of the BLA must submit a proposed REMS; 
the FDA will not approve the application without a REMS, if required.

Before approving a BLA, the FDA will typically inspect the facilities at which the product is manufactured. The FDA will not 
approve the product unless it determines that the manufacturing processes and facilities are in compliance with cGMP requirements 
and adequate to assure consistent production of the product within required specifications. Additionally, before approving a BLA, the 
FDA will typically inspect one or more clinical sites to assure that the clinical studies were conducted in compliance with IND study 
and cGCP requirements. To assure cGMP and cGCP compliance, an applicant must incur significant expenditure of time, money and 
effort in the areas of training, record keeping, production, and quality control.

Notwithstanding the submission of relevant data and information, the FDA may ultimately decide that the BLA does not satisfy 
its regulatory criteria for approval and deny approval. Data obtained from clinical studies are not always conclusive and the FDA may 
interpret data differently than we interpret the same data. If the agency decides not to approve the marketing application, it will issue a 
complete response letter describing specific deficiencies in the application identified by the FDA. Additionally, the complete response 
letter may recommend actions that the applicant might take to place the application in a condition for approval. Such recommended 
actions could include the conduct of additional studies. If a complete response letter is issued, the applicant may either resubmit the 
BLA, addressing all of the deficiencies identified in the letter, or withdraw the application.

If  a  product  receives  regulatory  approval,  the  approval  may  be  significantly  limited  to  specific  diseases  and  dosages  or  the 
indications for use may otherwise be limited, which could restrict the commercial value of the product. Further, the FDA may require 
that  certain  contraindications,  warnings  or  precautions  be  included  in  the  product  labeling.  The  FDA  may  impose  restrictions  and 
conditions on product distribution, prescribing, or dispensing in the form of a risk management plan, or otherwise limit the scope of 
any approval. In addition, the FDA may require post-approval clinical studies, to further assess a product’s safety and effectiveness, 
and testing and surveillance programs to monitor the safety of approved products that have been commercialized.

60

One  of  the  performance  goals  agreed  to  by  the  FDA  under  the  PDUFA  is  to  complete  its  review  of  90%  of  standard  BLAs 
within 10 months from filing and 90% of priority BLAs within six months from filing, whereupon a review decision is to be made. 
The  FDA  does  not  always  meet  its  PDUFA  goal  dates  and  its  review  goals  are  subject  to  change  from  time  to  time.  The  review 
process and the PDUFA goal date may be extended by three months if the FDA requests or the application sponsor otherwise provides 
additional information or clarification regarding information already provided in the submission within the last three months before 
the PDUFA goal date.

Post-Approval Requirements

Maintaining substantial compliance with applicable federal, state, and local statutes and regulations requires the expenditure of 
substantial  time  and  the  commitment  of  substantial  human  and  financial  resources.  Rigorous  and  extensive  FDA  regulation  of 
biological products continues after approval, particularly with respect to cGMP. We will rely, and expect to continue to rely, on third 
parties  for  the  production  of  clinical  and  commercial  quantities  of  any  products  that  we  may  commercialize.  Manufacturers  of  our 
products are required to comply with applicable requirements in the cGMP regulations, including quality control and quality assurance 
and maintenance of records and documentation.

Other  post-approval  requirements  applicable  to  drug  and  biological  products,  include  reporting  of  cGMP  deviations  that  may 
affect  the  identity,  potency,  purity  and  overall  safety  of  a  distributed  product,  record-keeping  requirements,  reporting  of  adverse 
effects, reporting updated safety and efficacy information, and complying with electronic record and signature requirements. After a 
BLA is approved, the product also may be subject to official lot release. As part of the manufacturing process, the manufacturer is 
required to perform certain tests on each lot of the product before it is released for distribution. If the product is subject to official 
release by the FDA, the manufacturer submits samples of each lot of product to the FDA together with a release protocol showing a 
summary of the history of manufacture of the lot and the results of all of the manufacturer’s tests performed on the lot. The FDA also 
may  perform  certain  confirmatory  tests  on  lots  of  some  products  before  releasing  the  lots  for  distribution  by  the  manufacturer.  In 
addition, the FDA conducts laboratory research related to the regulatory standards on the safety, purity, potency, and effectiveness of 
drug and biological products.

We  also  must  comply  with  the  FDA’s  advertising  and  promotion  requirements,  such  as  those  related  to  direct-  to-consumer 
advertising, the prohibition on promoting products for uses or in patient populations that are not described in the product’s approved 
labeling (known as “off-label use”), industry-sponsored scientific and educational activities, and promotional activities involving the 
internet and notably, social media. In addition, discovery of previously unknown problems or the failure to comply with the applicable 
regulatory requirements may result in restrictions on the marketing of a product or withdrawal of the product from the market as well 
as  possible  civil  or  criminal  sanctions.  Failure  to  comply  with  the  applicable  U.S.  requirements  at  any  time  during  the  product 
development process, approval process or after approval, may subject an applicant or manufacturer to administrative or judicial civil 
or  criminal  sanctions  and  adverse  publicity.  Sanctions  authorized  under  FDA’s  legal  authorities  could  include  refusal  to  approve 
pending applications, withdrawal of an approval, clinical hold, warning or untitled letters, product recalls, product seizures, total or 
partial suspension of production or distribution, injunctions, fines, mandated corrective advertising or communications with doctors, 
debarment, restitution, disgorgement of profits, or civil or criminal penalties.

Violations  of  the  FDCA  may  serve  as  a  basis  for  the  refusal  of,  or  exclusion  from,  government  contracts,  including  federal 
reimbursement programs, as well as other adverse consequences including lawsuits and actions by state attorneys general. Any agency 
or judicial enforcement action could have a material adverse effect on us. Drug and biological product manufacturers and other entities 
involved in the manufacture and distribution of approved drug or biological products are required to register their establishments with 
the FDA and certain state agencies, and are subject to periodic unannounced inspections by the FDA and certain state agencies for 
compliance with cGMPs and other laws. Accordingly, manufacturers must continue to expend time, money, and effort in the area of 
production  and  quality  control  to  maintain  cGMP  compliance.  Discovery  of  problems  with  a  product  after  approval  may  result  in 
restrictions  on  a  product,  manufacturer,  or  holder  of  an  approved  BLA,  including  withdrawal  of  the  product  from  the  market.  In 
addition,  changes  to  a  manufacturing  process  or  facility  generally  require  prior  FDA  approval  before  being  implemented  and  other 
types of changes to the approved product, such as adding new indications and additional labeling claims, are also subject to further 
FDA review and approval.

U.S. Patent Term Restoration and Marketing Exclusivity

Depending upon the timing, duration and specifics of the FDA approval of the use of our product candidates, some of our U.S. 
patents may be eligible for limited patent term extension under the Drug Price Competition and Patent Term Restoration Act of 1984, 
commonly referred to as the Hatch-Waxman Amendments. The Hatch-Waxman Amendments permit a patent restoration term of up to 
five years as compensation for patent term lost during product development and the FDA regulatory review process. However, patent 
term restoration cannot extend the remaining term of a patent beyond a total of 14 years from the product’s approval date. The patent 
term  restoration  period  is  generally  one-half  the  time  between  the  effective  date  of  an  IND  and  the  submission  date  of  a  new  drug 
application, or NDA, or BLA plus the time between the submission date of an NDA or BLA and the approval of that application. Only 

61

one patent applicable to an approved product is eligible for the extension and the application for the extension must be submitted prior 
to  the  expiration  of  the  patent.  The  U.S.  Patent  and  Trademark  Office,  in  consultation  with  the  FDA,  reviews  and  approves  the 
application for any patent term extension or restoration.

Under the Hatch-Waxman Amendments, a drug product containing a new chemical entity as its active ingredient is entitled to 
five years of market exclusivity, and a product for which the sponsor is required to generate new clinical data is entitled to three years 
of market exclusivity. A drug or biological product can also obtain pediatric market exclusivity in the U.S. Pediatric exclusivity, if 
granted, adds six months to existing exclusivity periods and patent terms. This six-month exclusivity, which runs from the end of other 
exclusivity protection or patent term, may be granted based on the voluntary completion of a pediatric study in accordance with an 
FDA-issued “Written Request” for such a study.

The Biologics Price Competition and Innovation Act of 2009 created an abbreviated approval pathway for biological products  
shown to be similar to, or interchangeable with, an FDA-licensed reference biological product. Biosimilarity, which requires that there 
be  no  clinically  meaningful  differences  between  the  biological  product  and  the  reference  product  in  terms  of  safety,  purity,  and 
potency,  can  be  shown  through  analytical  studies,  animal  studies,  and  a  clinical  study  or  studies.  Interchangeability  requires  that  a 
product is biosimilar to the reference product and the product must demonstrate that it can be expected to produce the same clinical 
results as the reference product and, for products administered multiple times, the biologic and the reference biologic may be switched 
after one has been previously administered without increasing safety risks or risks of diminished efficacy relative to exclusive use of 
the reference biologic. However, complexities associated with the larger, and often more complex, structure of biological products, as 
well as the process by which such products are manufactured, pose significant hurdles to implementation that are still being worked 
out by the FDA. 

A reference biologic is granted 12 years of exclusivity from the time of first licensure of the reference product.  

Government Regulation Outside of the U.S.

European Union Regulation

In addition to regulations in the U.S., we will be subject to a variety of regulations in other jurisdictions governing, among other 
things,  clinical  studies  and  any  commercial  sales  and  distribution  of  our  products.  In  particular,  we  view  the  EU  and  Japan  as 
important jurisdictions for our business. 

For  purposes  of  developing  our  products,  we  must  obtain  the  requisite  approvals  from  regulatory  authorities  in  each  country 
prior  to  the  commencement  of  clinical  studies  or  marketing  of  the  product  in  those  countries.  Certain  countries  outside  of  the  U.S. 
have a similar process that requires the submission of a clinical study application much like the IND prior to the commencement of 
human  clinical  studies.  In  the  EU,  for  example,  a  clinical  trial  application  (“CTA”),  must  be  submitted  to  each  country’s  national 
health authority and an independent ethics committee, much like the FDA and the IRB, respectively. Once the CTA is approved in 
accordance with a country’s requirements, clinical study development may proceed.

The EU has two main procedures for obtaining marketing authorizations in the EU Member States:   a centralized procedure or 
national  authorization  procedure,  under  the  latter  of  which  one  can  seek  go  through  the  mutual  recognition  procedure  or  the 
decentralized procedure. All biotechnology products are assessed through the centralized procedure. 

 Under the centralized authorization procedure, sponsors submit a single marketing-authorization application to the EMA. This 
allows  the  marketing-authorization  holder  to  market  the  product  and  make  it  available  to  patients  and  healthcare  professionals 
throughout  the  EU  on  the  basis  of  a  single  marketing  authorization.  EMA's  Committee  for  Medicinal  products  for  Human  Use 
(“CHMP”)  carries  out  a  scientific  assessment  of  the  application  and  give  a  recommendation  on  whether  the  medicine  should  be 
marketed or not. Once granted by the EMA, the centralized marketing authorization is valid in all EU Member States as well as in the 
European  Economic  Area  (“EEA”)  countries  Iceland,  Liechtenstein  and  Norway.  The  centralized  procedure  is  mandatory  for 
biotechnology products. 

Any  product  candidates  we  seek  to  commercialize  in  the  EU  are  subject  to  review  and  approval  by  the  European  Medicines 
Authority (“EMA”). Submissions for marketing authorization to the EMA must be received and validated by that body which appoints 
a Rapporteur and Co-Rapporteur to review it. The entire review process must be completed within 210 days, with a “clock-stop” at 
day 120 to allow the submitting company to respond to questions set forth in the Rapporteur and Co-Rapporteur’s assessment report. 
Once the company responds in full, the clock for review re-starts on day 121. If further clarification is needed, the EMA may request 
an Oral Explanation on day 180, and the company submitting the application must appear before the CHMP to provide the requested 
information. On day 210, the CHMP will vote to recommend for or against the approval of the application. The final decision of EMA 
for  marketing  authorization  following  a  positive  CHMP  recommendation  is  typically  made  within  60  days,  with  a  draft  decision 
within 15 days of the CHMP recommendation.  

62

After Marketing Authorizations have been granted, the company must submit periodic safety reports to the EMA (if approval 
was  granted  under  the  Centralized  Procedure)  or  to  the  National  Health  Authorities (if  approval was granted  under the  DCP  or  the 
MRP). In addition, pharmacovigilance measures must be implemented and monitored to ensure appropriate adverse event collection, 
evaluation and expedited reporting, as well as timely updates to any applicable risk management plans. For some medications, post 
approval  studies  may  be  required  to  complement  available  data  with  additional  data  to  evaluate  long  term  effects  or  to  gather 
additional efficacy data. 

European  marketing authorizations  have  an  initial duration  of five years. After  this  time, the marketing  authorization may be 
renewed by the competent authority on the basis of re-evaluation of the risk/benefit balance. Any marketing authorization which is not 
followed within three years of its granting by the actual placing on the market of the corresponding medicinal product ceases to be 
valid.

EU Exclusivity Periods 

To  obtain  regulatory  approval  of  an  investigational  biological  product  under  EU  regulatory  systems,  we  must  submit  a 
marketing authorization application (“MAA”). The application used to file the BLA in the U.S. is similar to that required in the EU, 
with the exception of, among other things, country-specific document requirements. The EU also provides opportunities for market 
exclusivity. For example, in the EU, upon receiving marketing authorization, new chemical entities generally receive eight years of 
data exclusivity and an additional two years of market exclusivity. If granted, data exclusivity prevents regulatory authorities in the 
EU from referencing the innovator’s data to assess a generic application. During the additional two-year period of market exclusivity, 
a  generic  marketing  authorization  can  be  submitted,  and  the  innovator’s  data  may  be  referenced,  but  no  generic  product  can  be 
marketed until the expiration of the market exclusivity. However, there is no guarantee that a product will be considered by the EU’s 
regulatory  authorities  to  be  a  new  chemical  entity,  and  products  may  not  qualify  for  data  exclusivity.  Products  receiving  orphan 
designation  in  the  EU  can  receive  10  years  of  market  exclusivity,  during  which  time  no  similar  medicinal  product  for  the  same 
indication may be placed on the market. An orphan product can also obtain an additional two years of market exclusivity in the EU for 
pediatric studies. No extension to any supplementary protection certificate can be granted on the basis of pediatric studies for orphan 
indications.

The criteria for designating an “orphan medicinal product” in the EU are similar in principle to those in the U.S. Under Article 3 
of Regulation (EC) 141/2000, a medicinal product may be designated as orphan if (1) it is intended for the diagnosis, prevention or 
treatment of a life-threatening or chronically debilitating condition; (2) either (a) such condition affects no more than five in 10,000 
persons  in  the  EU  when  the  application  is  made,  or  (b)  the  product,  without  the  benefits  derived  from  orphan  status,  would  not 
generate  sufficient  return  in  the  EU  to  justify  investment;  and  (3)  there  exists  no  satisfactory  method  of  diagnosis,  prevention  or 
treatment of such condition authorized for marketing in the EU, or if such a method exists, the product will be of significant benefit to 
those  affected  by  the  condition,  as  defined  in  Regulation  (EC)  847/2000.  Orphan  medicinal  products  are  eligible  for  financial 
incentives such as reduction of fees or fee waivers and are, upon grant of a marketing authorization, entitled to 10 years of market 
exclusivity  for  the  approved  therapeutic  indication.  The  application  for  orphan  drug  designation  must  be  submitted  before  the 
application for marketing authorization. The applicant will receive a fee reduction for the marketing authorization application if the 
orphan  drug  designation  has  been  granted,  but  not  if  the  designation  is  still  pending  at  the  time  the  marketing  authorization  is 
submitted. Orphan drug designation does not convey any advantage in, or shorten the duration of, the regulatory review and approval 
process.

The 10-year market exclusivity may be reduced to six years if, at the end of the fifth year, it is established that the product no 
longer  meets  the  criteria  for  orphan  designation,  for  example,  if  the  product  is  sufficiently  profitable  not  to  justify  maintenance  of 
market exclusivity. Additionally, marketing authorization may be granted to a similar product for the same indication at any time if:

•

•

•

The  second  applicant  can  establish  that  its  product,  although  similar,  is  safer,  more  effective  or  otherwise  clinically 
superior;

The applicant consents to a second orphan medicinal product application; or

The applicant cannot supply enough orphan medicinal product.

Japanese Regulation

In Japan, the Pharmaceuticals and Medical Device Agency (“PDMA”), a division of the Ministry of Health, Labour and Welfare 
(“MHLW”),  regulates  the  development  and  commercialization  of  medical  therapies.  Recently,  Japan’s  parliament  enacted  new 
legislation to promote the safe and accelerated development of treatments using stem cells.

The  Pharmaceuticals,  Medical  Devices  and  Other  Therapeutic  Products  (“PMD”)  Act,  took  effect  on  November  25,  2014  in 
Japan. The PMD Act established a framework for expedited approval in Japan for certain regenerative medical products. We intend to 

63

seek expedited conditional approvals in Japan for our cell therapy product candidates by capitalizing on our clinical data generated to 
date, our strong intellectual property, and our manufacturing know how.

Key takeaways of the PMD Act for us are:

•

•

•

•

•

•

Conditional product approvals may be based on existing Phase 2 trial results demonstrating probable efficacy and safety 
with bridging studies in Japanese patients;

Conditional approvals will allow sales of each product candidate for up to 7 years;

Conditionally approved products will be covered by health insurance;

Conditional approvals will cover allogeneic cell therapy product candidates manufactured under GMP outside of Japan; 
and

Full approval is expected to require further confirmation of safety and efficacy in a larger population.

The PMD Act may enable us to make our cell therapy product candidates available sooner to patients with unmet medical 
needs, and to achieve nearer term revenues in Japan ahead of other major jurisdictions.

For other countries outside of the EU and Japan, such as countries in Eastern Europe, Latin America or Asia, the requirements 
governing the conduct of clinical studies, product licensing, coverage, pricing and reimbursement vary from country to country. In all 
cases, again, the clinical studies are conducted in accordance with cGCP and the applicable regulatory requirements and the ethical 
principles that have their origin in the Declaration of Helsinki.

If  we  fail  to  comply  with  applicable  foreign  regulatory  requirements,  we  may  be  subject  to,  among  other  things,  fines, 

suspension or withdrawal of regulatory approvals, product recalls, seizure of products, operating restrictions and criminal prosecution.

Pharmaceutical Coverage, Pricing and Reimbursement

Significant  uncertainty  exists  as  to  the  coverage  and  reimbursement  status  of  any  product  candidates  for  which  we  obtain 
regulatory approval. In the U.S. and markets in other countries, sales of any products for which we receive regulatory approval for 
commercial sale will depend, in part, on the availability of coverage and adequate reimbursement from third-party payors. Third-party 
payors  include  government  programs  such  as  Medicare  or  Medicaid,  managed  care  plans,  private  health  insurers,  and  other 
organizations.  These  third-party  payors  may  deny  coverage  or  reimbursement  for  a  product  or  therapy  in  whole  or  in  part  if  they 
determine that the product or therapy was not medically appropriate or necessary. Third-party payors may attempt to control costs by 
limiting coverage to specific drug products on an approved list, or formulary, which might not include all of the FDA-approved drug 
products  for  a  particular  indication,  and  by  limiting  the  amount  of  reimbursement  for  particular  procedures  or  drug  treatments.  In 
addition,  in  the  United  States,  participation  in  government  health  programs  such  as  Medicare  and  Medicaid  are  subject  to  complex 
rules  and  controls  relating  to  price  reporting  and  calculation  of  prices  to  ensure  that  pricing  provided  to  government  entities  for 
periodic  reporting  purposes  is  aligned  and  compliant  with  numerous  complex  statutory  requirements.   The  infrastructure  and/or 
external  resources  necessary  to  ensure  continued  compliance  with  these  requirements  is  extensive  and  manufacturers  are  subject  to 
audit both by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services and by State Medicaid authorities.

The  cost  of  pharmaceuticals  and  devices  continues  to  generate  substantial  governmental  and  third  party  payor  interest.  We 
expect that the pharmaceutical industry will experience pricing pressures due to the trend toward managed healthcare, the increasing 
influence of managed care organizations and additional legislative proposals. Third-party payors are increasingly challenging the price 
and examining the medical necessity and cost-effectiveness of medical products and services, in addition to their safety and efficacy. 
We may need to conduct expensive pharmacoeconomic studies in order to demonstrate the medical necessity and cost- effectiveness 
of  our  products,  in  addition  to  the  costs  required  to  obtain  the  FDA  approvals.  Our  product  candidates  may  not  be  considered 
medically  necessary  or  cost-effective.  A  payor’s  decision  to  provide  coverage  for  a  drug  product  does  not  imply  that  an  adequate 
reimbursement rate will be approved. Adequate third-party reimbursement may not be available to enable us to maintain price levels 
sufficient to realize an appropriate return on our investment in product development.

Some third-party payors also require pre-approval of coverage for new or innovative devices or drug therapies before they will 
reimburse  healthcare  providers  who  use  such  therapies.  While  we  cannot  predict  whether  any  proposed  cost-containment  measures 
will be adopted or otherwise implemented in the future, these requirements or any announcement or adoption of such proposals could 
have a material adverse effect on our ability to obtain adequate prices for our product candidates and to operate profitably.

In international markets, reimbursement and healthcare payment systems vary significantly by country, and many countries have 
instituted price ceilings on specific products and therapies. There can be no assurance that our products will be considered medically 
reasonable  and  necessary  for  a  specific  indication,  that  our  products  will  be  considered  cost-effective  by  third-party  payors,  that 

64

coverage  or  an  adequate  level  of  reimbursement  will  be  available  or  that  the  third-party  payors  reimbursement  policies  will  not 
adversely affect our ability to sell our product profitably.

Healthcare Reform

In the U.S. and foreign jurisdictions, there have been a number of legislative and regulatory changes to the healthcare system 
that could affect our future results of operations. In particular, there have been and continue to be a number of initiatives at the U.S. 
federal  and  state  levels  that  seek  to  reduce  healthcare  costs.  In  the  U.S.,  the  Medicare  Prescription  Drug,  Improvement,  and 
Modernization  Act  of  2003,  or  the  Medicare  Modernization  Act,  changed  the  way  Medicare  covers  and  pays  for  pharmaceutical 
products. The Medicare Modernization Act expanded Medicare coverage for drug purchases by the elderly by establishing Medicare 
Part  D  and  introduced  a  new  reimbursement  methodology  based  on  average  sales  prices  for  physician  administered  drugs  under 
Medicare  Part  B.  In  addition,  this  legislation  provided  authority  for  limiting  the  number  of  drugs  that  will  be  covered  in  any 
therapeutic  class  under  the  new  Medicare  Part  D  program.  Cost  reduction  initiatives  and  other  provisions  of  this  legislation  could 
decrease the coverage and reimbursement rate that we receive for any of our approved products. While the Medicare Modernization 
Act  applies  only  to  drug  benefits  for  Medicare  beneficiaries,  private  payors  often  follow  Medicare  coverage  policy  and  payment 
limitations in setting their own reimbursement rates.

Therefore, any reduction in reimbursement that results from the Medicare Modernization Act may result in a similar reduction 

in payments from private payors.

In  March  2010,  President  Obama  signed  into  law  the  ACA,  a  sweeping  law  intended  to  broaden  access  to  health  insurance, 
reduce or constrain the growth of healthcare spending, enhance remedies against healthcare fraud and abuse, add new transparency 
requirements  for  healthcare  and  health  insurance  industries,  impose  new  taxes  and  fees  on  pharmaceutical  and  medical  device 
manufacturers and impose additional health policy reforms. We expect that the rebates, discounts, taxes and other costs resulting from 
the  ACA  over  time  will  have  a  negative  effect  on  our  expenses  and  profitability  in  the  future.  Furthermore,  expanded  government 
investigative authority and increased disclosure obligations may increase the cost of compliance with new regulations and programs. 

In addition, other legislative changes have been proposed and adopted since the ACA was enacted. For example, on August 2, 
2011,  President  Obama  signed  into  law  the  Budget  Control  Act  of  2011,  which,  among  other  things,  created  the  Joint  Select 
Committee on Deficit Reduction to recommend to Congress proposals in spending reductions. The Joint Select Committee on Deficit 
Reduction  did  not  achieve  a  targeted  deficit  reduction  of  at  least  $1.2  trillion  for  the  years  2013  through  2021,  triggering  the 
legislation’s  automatic  reduction  to  several  government  programs.  This  includes  aggregate  reductions  to  Medicare  payments  to 
providers of up to 2% per fiscal year, starting in 2013. Sequestration cuts went into effect on April 1, 2013, and the Bipartisan Budget 
Act of 2013 extended sequestration for Medicare for another two years, through 2023. A bill signed by President Obama on February 
15, 2014, further extended these cuts for an additional year, through fiscal year 2024. On January 21, 2014, President Obama signed 
the  fiscal  year  2014  omnibus  appropriations  bill,  modifying  for  fiscal  year  2014  and  fiscal  year  2015  the  cuts  that  went  into  effect 
under the sequester on March 1, 2013. On January 2, 2013, President Obama signed into law the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 
2012, which, among other things, reduced Medicare payments to several providers and increased the statute of limitations period for 
the  government  to  recover  overpayments  to  providers  from  three  to  five  years.  These  laws  may  result  in  additional  reductions  in 
Medicare and other healthcare funding, which could have a material adverse effect on our customers and accordingly, our financial 
operations.

The current presidential administration and Congress are also expected to attempt broad sweeping changes to the current health 
care laws.   We face uncertainties that might result from modifications or repeal of any of the provisions of the ACA including as a 
result of current and future executive orders and legislative actions.   The impact of those changes on us and potential effect on the 
pharmaceutical industry as a whole is currently unknown.  But, any changes to the ACA are likely to have an impact on our results of 
operations, and may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations.   We cannot predict what other health care programs 
and regulations will ultimately be implemented at the federal or state level or the effect of any future legislation or regulation in the 
United States may have on our business.  

While the status of the ACA under the current administration remains in question, it is possible that healthcare reform measures 
that have been and may be adopted in the future, may result in more rigorous coverage criteria and in additional downward pressure 
on the price that we receive for any approved product, and could seriously harm our future revenue. Any reduction in reimbursement 
from  Medicare  or  other  government  programs  may  result  in  a  similar  reduction  in  payments  from  private  payors,  and  formulary 
restrictions among private payors including the largest pharmacy benefit managers have increased over recent months, especially as 
regards  to  new  and  high  cost  market  entrants.  The  implementation  of  cost  containment  measures  or  other  healthcare  reforms  may 
prevent us from being able to generate revenue, attain profitability, or commercialize our products.

In  addition,  different  pricing  and  reimbursement  schemes  exist  in  other  countries.  In  the  European  Community,  governments 
influence  the  price  of  pharmaceutical  products  through  their  pricing  and  reimbursement  rules  and  control  of  national  healthcare 

65

systems that fund a large part of the cost of those products to consumers. Some jurisdictions operate positive and negative list systems 
under which products may be marketed only once a reimbursement price has been agreed upon. Some of these countries may require, 
as condition of obtaining reimbursement or pricing approval, the completion of clinical trials that compare the cost- effectiveness of a 
particular  product  candidate  to  currently  available  therapies.  Other  member  states  allow  companies  to  fix  their  own  prices  for 
medicines, but monitor and control company profits. The downward pressure on healthcare costs in general, particularly prescription 
drugs, has become very intense. As a result, increasingly high barriers are being erected to the entry of new products. In addition, in 
some countries, cross- border imports from low-priced markets exert a commercial pressure on pricing within a country.

Other Healthcare Laws and Compliance Requirements

In  the  U.S.,  the  research,  manufacturing,  distribution,  sale  and  promotion  of  drug  products,  including  biologics,  and  medical 
devices are potentially subject to regulation by various federal, state and local authorities in addition to the FDA, divisions of the U.S. 
Department  of  Health  and  Human  Services,  including  the  Office  of  Inspector  General  and  the  Centers  for  Medicare  and  Medicaid 
Services, the U.S. Department of Justice, state Attorneys General, and other state and local government agencies. For example, sales, 
marketing  and  scientific/educational  grant  programs  must  comply  with  fraud  and  abuse  laws  such  as  the  federal  Anti-Kickback 
Statute, as amended, the federal False Claims Act, as amended, and similar state laws. Pricing and rebate programs must comply with 
the Medicaid Drug Rebate Program requirements of the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1990, as amended, and the Veterans 
Health  Care  Act  of  1992,  as  amended.  If  products  are  made  available  to  authorized  users  of  the  Federal  Supply  Schedule  of  the 
General Services Administration, additional laws and requirements apply. All of these activities are also potentially subject to federal 
and state consumer protection and unfair competition laws.

The  federal  Anti-Kickback  Statute  prohibits  any  person,  including  a  prescription  drug  manufacturer  (or  a  party  acting  on  its 
behalf),  from  knowingly  and  willfully  soliciting,  receiving,  offering  or  providing  remuneration,  directly  or  indirectly,  to  induce  or 
reward either the referral of an individual, or the furnishing, recommending, or arranging for a good or service, for which payment 
may be made under a federal healthcare program such as the Medicare and Medicaid programs. This statute has been interpreted to 
apply to arrangements between pharmaceutical manufacturers on one hand and prescribers, purchasers, and formulary managers on 
the other. The term “remuneration” has been broadly interpreted to include anything of value, including for example, gifts, discounts, 
the  furnishing  of  supplies  or  equipment,  credit  arrangements,  payments  of  cash,  waivers  of  payments,  ownership  interests  and 
providing anything at less than its fair market value. Even the award of grant moneys, or the provision of in kind support, publicity 
and even authorship, in certain cases, may be deemed to be “remuneration.” Although there are a number of statutory exceptions and 
regulatory safe harbors protecting certain business arrangements from prosecution, the exception and safe harbors are drawn narrowly, 
and  practices  that  involve  remuneration  intended  to  induce  prescribing,  purchasing  or  recommending  may  be  subject  to  scrutiny  if 
they do not qualify for an exception or safe harbor. Our practices may not in all cases meet all of the criteria for safe harbor protection 
from federal Anti-Kickback Statute liability. The reach of the Anti-Kickback Statute was broadened by the recently enacted ACA, so 
that the government need no longer prove, for purposes of establishing intent under the federal Anti-Kickback Statute, that a person or 
entity had actual knowledge of the statute or specific intent to violate it. In addition, the ACA provides that a violation of the federal 
Anti-Kickback  Statute  constitutes  a  false  or  fraudulent  claim  for  purposes  of  the  federal  False  Claims  Act  (discussed  below). 
Additionally, many states have adopted laws similar to the federal Anti-Kickback Statute, and some of these state prohibitions apply 
to  the  referral  of  patients  for  healthcare  items  or  services reimbursed  by  any  third-party  payor,  including  private  payors.  In  at least 
some cases, these state laws do not contain safe harbors.

The federal False Claims Act imposes liability on any person or entity that, among other things, knowingly presents, or causes 
to be presented, a false or fraudulent claim for payment by a federal healthcare program. The qui tam provisions of the False Claims 
Act allow a private individual to bring civil actions on behalf of the federal government and share in any recovery. In recent years, the 
number of suits brought by private individuals has increased dramatically. In addition, various states have enacted false claims laws 
analogous to the False Claims Act. Many of these state laws apply where a claim is submitted to any third-party payor and not merely 
a federal healthcare program. There are many potential bases for liability under the False Claims Act. Liability arises, primarily, when 
an  entity  knowingly  submits,  or  causes  another  to  submit,  a  false  claim  for  reimbursement  to  the  federal  government.  The  False 
Claims  Act  has  been  used  to  assert  liability  on  the  basis  of  inadequate  care,  kickbacks  and  other  improper  referrals,  improperly 
reported  government  pricing  metrics  such  as  Best  Price  or  Average  Manufacturer  Price,  improper  use  of  Medicare  numbers  when 
detailing the provider of services, improper promotion of off-label uses (i.e., uses not expressly approved by FDA in a drug’s label), 
and allegations as to misrepresentations with respect to the services rendered. 

Substantial  resources  have  been  allocated  by  both  the  Department  of  Justice  and  the  Federal  Bureau  of  Investigation,  among 
other  branches  of  the  US  government  to  identify  and  investigate  possible  health  care  fraud  activities.  Recent  investigations  include 
those relating to allegedly egregious price increases by manufacturers and alleged fraud involving co-pay arrangements supported by 
sponsors. As new theories of liability arise, there is a corresponding cost of doing business in order to maintain compliance.

Our  future  activities  relating  to  the  reporting  of  discount  and  rebate  information  and  other  information  affecting  federal, 
provincial,  state  and  third  party  reimbursement  of  our  products,  and  the  sale  and  marketing  of  our  products  and  our  service 

66

arrangements or data purchases, among other activities, may be subject to scrutiny under these laws. We are unable to predict whether 
we would be subject to actions under the False Claims Act or a similar state law, or the impact of such actions. However, the cost of 
defending such claims, as well as any sanctions imposed, could adversely affect our financial performance. Also, the Health Insurance 
Portability  and  Accountability  Act  of  1996  (“HIPAA”),  created  several  new  federal  crimes  including  healthcare  fraud  and  false 
statements  relating  to  healthcare  matters.  The  healthcare  fraud  provision  of  HIPAA  prohibits  knowingly  and  willfully  executing  a 
scheme  to  defraud  any  healthcare  benefit  program,  including  private  third-party  payors.  The  false  statements  provision  prohibits 
knowingly and willfully falsifying, concealing or covering up a material fact or making any materially false, fictitious or fraudulent 
statement in connection with the delivery of or payment for healthcare benefits, items or services.

In addition, we may be subject to, or our marketing activities may be limited by, data privacy and security regulation by both the 
federal  government  and  the  states  in  which  we  conduct  our  business.  For  example,  HIPAA  and  its  implementing  regulations 
established uniform federal standards for certain “covered entities” (healthcare providers, health plans and healthcare clearinghouses) 
governing  the  conduct  of  certain  electronic  healthcare  transactions  and  protecting  the  security  and  privacy  of  protected  health 
information.  The  American  Recovery  and  Reinvestment  Act  of  2009,  commonly  referred  to  as  the  economic  stimulus  package, 
included expansion of HIPAA’s privacy and security standards called the Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical 
Health Act (“HITECH”), which became effective on February 17, 2010. Among other things, HITECH makes HIPAA’s privacy and 
security  standards  directly  applicable  to  “business  associates”—independent  contractors  or  agents  of  covered  entities  that  create, 
receive, maintain, or transmit protected health information in connection with providing a service for or on behalf of a covered entity. 
HITECH also increased the civil and criminal penalties that may be imposed against covered entities, business associates and possibly 
other  persons,  and  gave  state  attorneys  general  new  authority  to  file  civil  actions  for  damages  or  injunctions  in  federal  courts  to 
enforce the federal HIPAA laws and seek attorney’s fees and costs associated with pursuing federal civil actions.

There are also an increasing number of state “sunshine” laws that require manufacturers to make reports to states on pricing and 
marketing information. Several states have enacted legislation requiring pharmaceutical companies to, among other things, establish 
marketing  compliance  programs,  file  periodic  reports  with  the  state,  make  periodic  public  disclosures  on  sales,  marketing,  pricing, 
clinical trials and other activities, and/or register their sales representatives, as well as to prohibit certain other sales and marketing 
practices.  State  laws  are  not  harmonized  and  contain  different  reporting  requirements  and  restrictions  which  must  be  noted  and 
adhered  to.  In  addition,  beginning  in  2013,  a  similar  federal  requirement  began  requiring  manufacturers  to  track  and  report  to  the 
federal government certain payments and other transfers of value made to physicians and other healthcare professionals and teaching 
hospitals and ownership or investment interests held by physicians and their immediate family members. The efforts and resources 
needed to track and report payments go well beyond the United States as reporting is required also for payments made by affiliated 
entities  in  many  cases  to  US  covered  persons.   This  requires  extensive  administration  and  systems.  The  federal  government  began 
disclosing  the  reported  information  on  a  publicly  available  website  in  2014.  These  laws  may  affect  our  sales,  marketing,  and  other 
promotional activities by imposing administrative and compliance burdens on us. If we fail to track and report as required by these 
laws or otherwise comply with these laws, we could be subject to the penalty provisions of the pertinent state and federal authorities.

Because  of  the  breadth  of  these  laws  and  the  narrowness  of  available  statutory  and  regulatory  exemptions,  it  is  possible  that 
some  of  our  business  activities  could  be  subject  to  challenge  under  one  or  more  of  such  laws.  If  our  operations  are  found  to  be  in 
violation  of  any  of  the  federal  and  state  laws  described  above  or  any  other  governmental  regulations  that  apply  to  us,  we  may  be 
subject  to  penalties,  including  criminal  and  significant  civil  monetary  penalties,  damages,  fines,  imprisonment,  exclusion  from 
participation in government healthcare programs, injunctions, recall or seizure of products, total or partial suspension of production, 
denial or withdrawal of premarketing product approvals, private qui tam actions brought by individual whistleblowers in the name of 
the  government  or  refusal  to  allow  us  to  enter  into  supply  contracts,  including  government  contracts,  and  the  curtailment  or 
restructuring of our operations, any of which could adversely affect our ability to operate our business and our results of operations. 
To the extent that any of our products are sold in a foreign country, we may be subject to similar foreign laws and regulations, which 
may  include,  for  instance,  applicable  post-approval  requirements,  including  safety  surveillance,  anti-fraud  and  abuse  laws,  and 
implementation of corporate compliance programs and reporting of payments or transfers of value to healthcare professionals.

Employees

As  of  June  30,  2017,  we  had  75  employees,  44  of  whom  are  based  in  the  United  States,  22  of  whom  are based  in  Australia, 
including our CEO and certain executive team members, 8 of whom are based in Singapore, and 1 of whom is based in Switzerland. 
We had 108 and 115 employees as of June 30, 2016 and 2015, respectively. We have no collective bargaining agreements with our 
employees. We have not experienced any work stoppages to date and consider our relations with our employees to be good.

Facilities

See “Item 4.B Business Overview – Manufacturing and Supply Chain” and “Item 4.D – Property, Plants and Equipment”.

67

Legal Proceedings

From time to time, we may become involved in legal proceedings or be subject to claims arising in the ordinary course of our 
business. We are not presently party to any legal proceedings that, in the opinion of our management, would reasonably be expected to 
have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  business,  financial  condition,  operating  results  or  cash  flows  if  determined  adversely  to  us. 
Regardless  of  the  outcome,  litigation  can  have  an  adverse  impact  on  us  because  of  defense  and  settlement  costs,  diversion  of 
management resources and other factors.

Australian Disclosure Requirements

Business Strategies and Prospects for Future Years

We are focused on the following core strategic imperatives:

Continue to innovate and optimize our disruptive technology platform for cell-based therapeutics;

Develop a portfolio of clinically distinct products;

Focus on bringing late-stage products to market and portfolio prioritization;

Enabling manufacturing scale-up to meet demands of the portfolio;

Leverage talent base to continue to establish a culture of shared leadership and accountability;

Focus on strategic partnerships; 

Focus on prudent cash management; and

Continue to strengthen our substantial and robust intellectual property estate.

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

Dividends

No  dividends  were  paid  during  the  course  of  the  fiscal  year  ended  June  30,  2017.  There  are  no  dividends  or  distributions 

recommended or declared for payment to members, but not yet paid, during the year.

4.C

Organizational Structure

See “Item 4. Information on the Company – 4.B Business Overview – Overview”, “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note  12” 

and Exhibit 8.1 to this Annual Report.

4.D

Property, Plants and Equipment

We lease approximately 11,150 square feet of office space in Melbourne, Australia, where our headquarters are located. We pay 
approximately A$786,000 per year for this lease, which expires in April 2020. We also lease approximately 15,600 square feet in New 
York City, where significant development and commercial activities are conducted. We pay US$1,015,000 per year for this lease. We 
also  lease  laboratory  and  office  space  in  Singapore.  We  pay  approximately  S$334,000  per  year  for  this  lease,  which  expires  in 
December 2017. We also lease laboratory and office space in Texas and pay approximately US$209,000 per year for this lease. All of 
our  manufacturing  operations  are  currently  located  at  Lonza’s  manufacturing  facilities.  See  “Item  4.B  Business  Overview  – 
Manufacturing and Supply Chain.”

Item 4A. Unresolved Staff Comments

Not applicable.

Item 5.

Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

5.A

Operating Results

This operating and financial review should be read together with our consolidated financial statements in this Annual Report, 

which have been prepared in accordance with IFRS as published by the IASB.

68

Overview

We  are  a  global  leader  in  developing  innovative  cellular  medicines.  We  have  leveraged  our  proprietary  technology  platform 

based on specialized cells known as MLCs, to establish a broad portfolio of late-stage product candidates. 

Our allogenic “off-the-shelf” product candidates target advanced stages of diseases with high, unmet medical needs including 
cardiovascular conditions, immunologic and inflammatory conditions, orthopedic disorders, and oncology and hematology conditions. 
We also have a promising emerging pipeline of products for follow-on indications.

Each  MLC-derived  product  candidate  has  distinct  technical  characteristics,  target  indications,  reimbursement  strategy, 

commercialization potential, and partnering opportunities.

We have incurred net losses during most of our fiscal periods since our inception. For the year ended June 30, 2017, we had an 

accumulated deficit of $344.9 million. Our net loss for the year ended June 30, 2017 was $76.8 million.

Financial Overview

We have incurred significant losses since our inception. We anticipate that we may continue to incur significant losses for the 

foreseeable future. There can be no assurance that we will ever achieve or maintain profitability.

We expect our future capital requirements will continue as we:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

continue the research and clinical development of our product candidates;

initiate and advance our product candidates into larger clinical studies; 

seek to identify, assess, acquire, and/or develop other product candidates and technologies; 

seek  regulatory  and  marketing  approvals  in  multiple  jurisdictions  for  our  product  candidates  that  successfully  complete 
clinical studies;

establish  collaborations  with  third  parties  for  the  development  and  commercialization  of  our  product  candidates,  or 
otherwise build and maintain a sales, marketing, and distribution infrastructure to commercialize any products for which 
we may obtain marketing approval;

further  develop  and implement  our  proprietary  manufacturing  processes  and expand  our  manufacturing  capabilities  and 
resources for commercial production;

seek coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, including government and private payors for future products;

make  milestone  or  other  payments  under  our  agreements  pursuant  to  which  we  have  licensed  or  acquired  rights  to 
intellectual property and technology;

seek to maintain, protect, and expand our intellectual property portfolio; and

seek to attract and retain skilled personnel.

Over the short term (12 to 24 months) if we are able to successfully partner one or more of our products we would expect our 
research  and  development  expenditure  to  decrease.   We  expect  management  and  administration  expenses  to  remain  relatively 
consistent. Subject to us achieving successful regulatory approval, we expect an increase in our total expenses driven by an increase in 
our selling, general and administrative expenses as we move towards commercialization. Therefore we will need additional capital to 
fund  our  operations,  which  we  may  raise  through  a  combination  of  equity  offerings,  debt  financings,  other  third-party  funding, 
marketing  and  distribution  arrangements  and  other  collaborations,  strategic  alliances  and  licensing  arrangements.  As  described  in 
“Item 18 Financial Statements – Note 1(ii)”, a fully discretionary equity facility remains for up to A$120 million/US$90 million over 
24 months to provide additional funds as required. We do not know when, or if, we will generate revenues from our product sales 
significant enough to generate profits. We do not expect to generate significant revenue from product sales unless and until we obtain 
regulatory approval of and commercialize one or more of our cell-based product candidates. For further discussion on our ability to 
continue as a going concern, see “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note 1(ii).”

Commercialization and Milestone Revenue. Commercialization and milestone revenue relates to up-front, royalty and milestone 

payments recognized under development and commercialization agreements.

In the year ended June 30, 2011, we received up-front payments of $130.0 million under a development and commercialization 
agreement  (“DCA”),  with  Cephalon,  Inc.,  now  a  wholly  owned  subsidiary  of  Teva  Pharmaceutical  Industries  Ltd  (collectively 

69

“Teva”),  which  allowed  for  Teva  to  obtain  world-wide  rights  to  commercialize  our  mesenchymal  precursor  cell  (MPC)  technology 
platform for specific products in our cardiovascular portfolio. In June 2016, Teva exercised a contractual right under the DCA to end 
the joint development of the lead asset in our cardiovascular portfolio, product candidate MPC-150-IM, and we regained full world-
wide rights on this product candidate.

Revenues from such non-refundable, up-front payments are initially reported as deferred revenues on the consolidated balance 
sheet and are recognized in revenue as earned over the estimated development period. As the joint development of product candidate 
MPC-150-IM was ended in June 2016, we recognized in revenue the remaining full amount of deferred revenues during June 2016. 
There are no further performance obligations required of us in relation to this DCA. Prior to June 2016, management could not readily 
estimate  the  costs  required  to  complete  the  development  program  pursuant  to  the  DCA  and  concluded  that  the  revenue  was  earned 
over the estimated development period of MPC-150-IM. Therefore, during the period from the initial recognition date until June 2016, 
revenues from the up-front payments received were recognized on a straight line basis over the estimated development period of this 
product candidate.

In the year ended June 30, 2017, we recognized $0.5 million in milestone revenue upon our licensee, JCR, achieving a sales 
milestone on cumulative net sales of TEMCELL® Hs. Inj., a registered trademark of JCR Pharmaceuticals Co., Ltd (“TEMCELL”), in 
Japan. This amount was recorded in revenue as there are no further performance obligations required in regards to this item. In the 
year  ended  June  30,  2016,  we  recognized  $3.5  million  in  milestone  revenue  from  JCR  Pharmaceuticals  Co.  Ltd.  (“JCR”)  for  the 
receipt of full regulatory approval of TEMCELL which was a milestone under our agreement with JCR. These amounts were recorded 
in revenue as there are no further performance obligations required in regards to these items. 

We  commenced  earning  royalty  income  on  sales  of  TEMCELL  by  our  licensee  JCR  after  the  product’s  launch  in  Japan  on 

February 24, 2016. 

Interest  Revenue.  Interest  revenue  is  accrued  on  a  time  basis  by  reference  to  the  principal  outstanding  and  at  the  effective 

interest rate applicable.

Research and Development. Research and development expenditure is recognized as an expense as incurred.

Our research and development expenses consist primarily of:

•

•

•

•

third  party  costs  comprising  all  external  expenditure  on  our  research  and  development  programs  such  as  fees  paid  to 
Contract Research Organizations (“CROs”), and consultants who perform research on our behalf and under our direction, 
rent and utility costs for our research and development facilities, and database analysis fees;

product  support  costs  consisting  primarily  of  salaries  and  related  overhead  expenses  for  personnel  in  research  and 
development  functions  (for  example  wages,  salaries  and  associated  on  costs  such  as  superannuation,  share-based 
incentives and payroll taxes, plus travel costs and recruitment fees for new hires); 

intellectual  property  support  costs  comprising  payments  to  our  patent  attorneys  to  progress  patent  applications  and  all 
costs of renewing of our granted patents; and

Amortization of currently marketed products on a straight-line basis over the life of the asset.

Our  research  and  development  expenses  are  not  charged  to  specific  products  or  programs,  since  the  number  of  clinical  and 
preclinical product candidates or development projects tends to vary from period to period and since internal resources are utilized 
across multiple products and programs over any given period of time. As a result, our management does not maintain and evaluate 
research and development costs by product or program. Acquired in-process research and development is capitalized as an asset and is 
not amortized but is subject to impairment review during the development phase. Upon completion of its development, the acquired 
in-process research and development amortization will commence.

Manufacturing Commercialization. Manufacturing commercialization expenditure is recognized as an expense as incurred. Our 

manufacturing commercialization expenses consist primarily of:

•

•

•

•

salaries and related overhead expenses for personnel in manufacturing functions;

fees paid to our contract manufacturing organizations, which perform process development on our behalf and under our 
direction;

costs related to laboratory supplies used in our manufacturing development efforts; and

costs related to share-based incentives granted to personnel in manufacturing functions.

70

Management and Administration. Management and administration expenses consist primarily of salaries and related costs for 
employees  in  executive,  corporate  and  administrative  functions.  Other  significant  management  and  administration  expenses  include 
legal and professional services, rent and depreciation of leasehold improvements, insurance and information technology services.

Fair Value Remeasurement of Contingent Consideration. Remeasurement of contingent consideration pertains to the acquisition 
of assets from Osiris Therapeutics, Inc. (“Osiris”). The fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration is recognized as a net 
result  of  changes  to  the  key  assumptions  of  the  contingent  consideration  valuation  such  as  developmental  timelines,  probability  of 
success, market penetration, market population, product pricing and the increase in valuation as the time period shortens between the 
valuation date and the potential settlement dates of contingent consideration. As the net result of changes to the key assumptions and 
the time period shortening, we recognized a net remeasurement loss of $0.1 million and a net remeasurement gain of $28.1 million for 
the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, respectively.  

Other  Operating  Income  and  Expenses.  Other  operating  income  and  expenses  primarily  comprise  tax  incentives  and  foreign 

exchange gains and losses.

Tax  incentives  comprise  payments  from  the  Australian  government’s  Innovation  Australia  Research  and  Development  Tax 
Incentive program for research and development activities conducted in relation to our qualifying research that meets the regulatory 
criteria. The grant is available for our research and development activities in Australia as well as research and development activities 
outside of Australia to the extent such non-Australian based activities relate to intellectual property owned by our Australian resident 
entities do not exceed half the expenses for the relevant activities and are approved by the Australian government. A refundable tax 
offset  is  available  to  eligible  companies  with  an  annual  aggregate  turnover  of  less  than  A$20.0  million.  The  commercialization 
revenue is not subject to inclusion in the determination of the annual aggregate turnover measure. Eligible companies can receive a 
refundable tax offset for a percentage of their research and development spending. For the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, the 
rate of the refundable tax offset is 43.5% and 45%, respectively. We recognized income of $1.5 million and $3.8 million, respectively, 
from the Research and Development Tax Incentive program for the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016. 

Foreign  exchange  gains  and  losses  relate  to  unrealized  foreign  exchange  gains  and  losses  on  our  U.S.  dollar  deposits  plus 
realized gains and losses on any foreign currency payments to our suppliers due to movements in exchange rates. We recognized $Nil 
foreign exchange losses in the year ended June 30, 2017 and a foreign exchange loss of $1.1 million in the year ended June 30, 2016.

71

Results of Operations

Comparison of Our Results for the Year ended June 30, 2017 with the Year ended June 30, 2016

The following table summarizes our results of operations for the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, together with the changes 

in those items in dollars and as a percentage.

(in thousands except per share information)
Consolidated Income Statement Data:
Revenue:

Commercialization revenue
Milestone revenue
Interest revenue

Total revenue

Research & development
Manufacturing commercialization
Management and administration
Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration
Impairment of intangible assets
Other operating income and expenses
Loss before income tax
Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss attributable to the owners of Mesoblast Limited

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

 $

1,444 
500 
468 
2,412     

(58,914)    
(12,065)    
(23,007)    
(130)    
—     
1,489     
(90,215)    
13,400     
(76,815)   $

37,969 
3,500 
1,079 
42,548     

(50,013)    
(29,763)    
(22,500)    
28,112     
(61,919)    
2,714     
(90,821)    
86,694     
(4,127)    

(36,525)  
(3,000)  
(611)  
(40,136)  

(8,901)  
17,698 

(507)  
(28,242)  
61,919 
(1,225)  
606 
(73,294)  
(72,688)  

(96%)
(86%)
(57%)
(94%)

18%
(59%)
2%
NM
NM
(45%)
(1%)
(85%)
NM

Losses per share from continuing operations attributable to the
   ordinary equity holders:
Basic - losses per share
Diluted - losses per share

Cents

Cents

Cents

% Change

(19.43)   
(19.43)   

(1.14)   
(1.14)   

(18.29)  
(18.29)  

NM
NM

* NM = not meaningful.

Revenue

Revenues were $2.4 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with $42.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, a 
decrease  of  $40.1  million.  The  following  table  shows  the  movement  within  revenue  for  the  years  ended  June  30,  2017  and  2016, 
together with the changes in those items.

(in thousands)
Revenue:

Commercialization revenue
Milestone revenue
Interest revenue
Revenue

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

1,444    $
500 
468     
2,412    $

37,969     
3,500 
1,079     
42,548     

(36,525)  
(3,000)  
(611)  
(40,136)  

(96%)
(86%)
(57%)
(94%)

Commercialization revenues were $1.4 million in the year ended June 30, 2017, a decrease of $36.5 million as compared with 
$38.0 million in the year ended June 30, 2016.  This $36.5 million decrease in the year ended June 30, 2017 is due to the recognition 
of $37.5 million of revenue for the year ended June 30, 2016, being the recognition of the remaining unamortized portion of the initial 
up-front  payments  of  $130.0  million  received  under  the  DCA  with  Teva  over  our  initial  estimated  development  program  term, 
compared with $Nil in the year ended June 30, 2017 as we had fully recognized the remaining deferred revenue amounts relating to 
the $130 million up-front payment in June 2016, when we regained full world-wide rights from Teva on our product candidate MPC-
150-IM. This decrease of commercialization revenue in the year ended June 30, 2017 was offset by an increase of $1.0 million relating 
to royalty income earned on sales of TEMCELL in Japan since the launch of the product on February 24, 2016 by our licensee JCR, 
with  $1.4  million  of  royalty  revenue  recognized  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  compared  with  $0.4  million  of  royalty  revenue 
recognized in the year ended June 30, 2016.  

72

 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
        
     
   
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
   
 
   
 
     
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
  
  
   
Milestone revenue was $0.5 million in the year ended June 30, 2017, a decrease of $3.0 million as compared with $3.5 million 
in the year ended June 30, 2016. The difference of $3.0 million is due to the recognition of $3.5 million in milestone revenue in the 
year ended June 30, 2016 upon our licensee, JCR, receiving full regulatory approval of MSC product TEMCELL in Japan, which is a 
milestone under our agreement with JCR. In the year ended June 30, 2017, we recognized $0.5 million in milestone revenue upon our 
licensee, JCR, reaching a cumulative net sales milestone for sales of TEMCELL in Japan.  

The $0.6 million decrease in interest revenue from the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016 
was primarily driven by us retaining higher cash reserves in the year ended June 30, 2016, when compared with the year ended June 
30, 2017. The decrease was also driven by us retaining a higher proportion of cash reserves in US$ instead of A$ in the year ended 
June 30, 2017, when compared with the year ended June 30, 2016. This change in cash reserve holdings decreased revenue as yield on 
US$  cash  deposits  are  lower  than  yields  on  A$  cash  deposits.  We  increased  the  proportion  of  cash  reserves  held  in  US$  to  reduce 
currency risk. Currency risk is minimized by ensuring the proportion of cash reserves held in each currency matches the expected rate 
of spend of each currency. 

Research and development

Research and development expenses were $58.9 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with $50.0 million for the 
year ended June 30, 2016, an increase of $8.9 million.  The $8.9 million net increase in research and development expenses primarily 
reflects an increase in expenditures on our clinical program for MPC-150-IM, which were partially offset by a reduction in product 
support costs as management reduced costs in line with our corporate strategy.

(in thousands)
Research and development:

Third party costs
Product support costs
Intellectual property support costs
Amortization of current marketed products

Research and development

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

37,249    $
17,122     
3,208     
1,335     
58,914    $

26,189     
20,643     
2,737     
444     
50,013     

11,060   
(3,521)  
471   
891   
8,901   

42%
(17%)
17%
201%
18%

Third  party  costs,  which  consist  of  all  external  expenditure  on  our  research  and  development  programs,  increased  by  $11.0 

million in the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016.

Within  this  $11.0  million  increase,  there  was  a  $11.6  million  increase  in  third  party  costs  for  the  advancement  of  our  Tier  1 
products due to clinical advancement during the period for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with the year ended June 30, 2016, 
primarily due to the increase in clinical program costs for MPC-150-IM (CHF) as we regained full world-wide rights from Teva on 
this product candidate in the month of June 2016 and consequently we were responsible for all research and development expenditure 
incurred  on  this  product  candidate  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  whereas  Teva  was  responsible  for  the  majority  of  research  and 
development expenses in the year ended June 30, 2016.   In the year ended June 30, 2017 we also incurred costs on our MPC-06-ID 
(CLBP), MSC-100-IV (aGVHD) and MPC-300-IV (inflammatory conditions) Tier 1 products.  The increase in Tier 1 third party costs 
were  offset  by  a  $0.6  million  decrease  in  third  party  costs  for  our  Tier  2  and  pipeline  products  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017, 
compared with the year ended June 30, 2016 as we prioritized our funds towards Tier 1 products.

Product  support  costs,  which  consist  primarily  of  salaries  and  related  overhead  expenses  for  personnel  in  research  and 
development  functions,  have  decreased  by  $3.5  million  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30, 
2016.   In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  operational  streamlining  initiatives  from  the  June  2016  strategic  review  were  maintained 
resulting in full time equivalents reducing by 26.1 (35%) from 74.5 for the year ended June 30, 2016 to 48.4 for the year ended June 
30,  2017.  This  led  to  cost  savings  of  $4.0  million  in  salaries  and  associated  costs  and  $0.5  million  in  travel  expenses,  for  the  year 
ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016. The cost savings of $4.5 million in the year ended June 30, 2017 
were  offset  by  an  increase  of  $0.7  million  in  share  based  payment  expenses  and  an  increase  of  $0.3  million  in  consultancy  fees 
primarily due to an increase in the associated clinical program costs for CHF in the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with the year 
ended June 30, 2016.   

Also included in research and development expenses are intellectual property support costs, which consist of payments to our 
patent attorneys to progress patent applications and all costs of renewing our granted patents.  These costs have risen by $0.5 million 
in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016  due  to  increased  activities  across  our  entire  patent 
portfolio. 

73

 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
   
Amortization of current marketed products increased by $0.9 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with the year 
ended  June  30,  2016  due  to  the  TEMCELL  asset  becoming  available  for  use  in  Japan  since  the  launch  of  the  product  in  February 
2016. 

Manufacturing commercialization

Manufacturing  commercialization  expenses,  which  consist  of  fees  paid  to  our  contract  manufacturing  organizations  and 
laboratory supplies used in manufacturing commercialization of our MPC and MSC based products, decreased by $17.7 million from 
the  year  ended  June  30,  2016  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017.  The  decrease  was  primarily  due  to  a  reduction  in  the 
number of production runs completed in the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016 due to the clinical 
supply demands for all ongoing trials being met and a tax related credit for MSC-based product expenditure incurred in prior years.

(in thousands)
Manufacturing commercialization:

MSC platform technology
MPC platform technology
Manufacturing support costs

Manufacturing commercialization

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

(285)   $
10,058     
2,292     
12,065    $

17,993     
8,235     
3,535     
29,763     

(18,278)  
1,823   
(1,243)  
(17,698)  

(102%)
22%
(35%)
(59%)

The  MSC-based  manufacturing  commercialization  expenses  decreased  by  $18.3  million  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017 
compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.  $17.1  million  of  this  decrease  was  a  result  of  no  MSC-based  production  being 
undertaken in the year ended June 30, 2017 whereas 81% of production runs in the year ended June 30, 2016 were for MSC-based 
clinical supply. The remaining decrease of $1.2 million relates to a Goods and Services-Tax (“GST”) credit received in the year ended 
June 30, 2017 for MSC-based product expenditure incurred in prior years. 

The  MPC-based  manufacturing  commercialization  expenses  increased  by  $1.8  million  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017 
compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.  There  was  a  $4.1  million  increase  as  a  result  of  purchases  of  materials  for  future 
production runs and 100% of the production runs being for MPC-based clinical supply in the year ended June 30, 2017 whereas 19% 
of production was for MPC-based clinical supply in the year ended June 30, 2016. This was offset by a $2.3 million decrease due to a 
reduction in process development activities in year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016. 

Manufacturing  support  expenses,  which  consist  primarily  of  salaries  and  related  overhead  expenses  for  personnel  in 
manufacturing  commercialization  functions,  decreased  by  $1.2  million  from  $3.5  million  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016  to  $2.3 
million for the year ended June 30, 2017 as a result of operational streamlining and management’s cost containment efforts. Full time 
equivalents decreased by 2.9 (27%) from 10.8 for the year ended June 30, 2016 to 7.9 for the year ended June 30, 2017 resulting in 
cost savings of $0.4 million in salaries and $0.3 million in share based payments. Management’s cost reduction efforts also resulted in 
a decrease of $0.5 million across consulting and travel expenditure.  

Management and administration

Management and administration expenses were $23.0 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with $22.5 million for 
the  year  ended  June  30,  2016,  an  increase  of  $0.5  million.  This  increase  was  primarily  due  to  an  increase  in  labor  and  associated 
expenses and legal and professional fees offset by a reduction in corporate overheads.  

(in thousands)
Management and administration:
Labor and associated expenses
Corporate overheads
Legal and professional fees

Management and administration

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

10,678    $
8,689     
3,640     
23,007    $

9,295     
10,274     
2,931     
22,500     

1,383   
(1,585)  
709   
507   

15%
(15%)
24%
2%

Labor and associated expenses increased by $1.4 million from $9.3 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 to $10.7 million for 
the  year  ended  June  30,  2017.   In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  operational  streamlining  initiatives  from  the  June  2016  strategic 
review were maintained resulting in full time equivalents reducing by 2.3 (8%) from 27.2 for the year ended June 30, 2016 to 24.9 for 
the year ended June 30, 2017. This led to cost savings of $0.4 million in salaries and associated benefits, $0.2 million in consultancy 
expenses  and  $0.1  million  in  directors’  fees  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.  This 

74

 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
decrease was offset by an increase of $0.5 million in short term incentives and an increase of $1.4 million in share based payments in 
the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.  Labor  and  associated  expenses  also  experienced 
unfavorable exchange rate fluctuations of $0.2 million in the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016, 
as  the  A$  strengthened  against  the  US$  given  the  majority  of  management  and  administration  expenses  are  incurred  in  A$  by  our 
headquarter office located in Australia.

Corporate overhead expenses decreased by $1.6 million from $10.3 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 to $8.7 million for 
the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  as  operational  streamlining  from  the  strategic  review  in  June  2016  enabled  us  to  reduce  rent, 
accommodation costs, travel expenses and other staff associated costs. 

Legal and professional fees increased by $0.7 million from $2.9 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 to $3.6 million for the 

year ended June 30, 2017 primarily due to Sarbanes Oxley Act implementation activities.

Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration

Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration was a $0.1 million loss for the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with a 
$28.1 million gain for the year ended June 30, 2016, a decrease of $28.2 million. The $0.1 million loss for the year ended June 30, 
2017  is  due  to  the  remeasurement  of  contingent  consideration  pertaining  to  the  acquisition  of  assets  from  Osiris.  This  loss  is  a  net 
result  of  changes  to  the  key  assumptions  of  the  contingent  consideration  valuation  such  as  developmental  timelines,  probability  of 
success, market penetration, market population and the increase in valuation as the time period shortens between the valuation date 
and the potential settlement dates of contingent consideration. 

Within the $28.1 million gain for the year ended June 30, 2016, we recognized a gain of $34.5 million due to a reduction in 
contingent consideration expected to be paid to Osiris on the MSC-assets due to a greater certainty over the commencement of the 
earn out period.   This change in assumption results in a reduction in the valuation of contingent consideration as an earlier earn out 
period results in royalties being applicable to sales in years that are prior to peak year sales. The remaining net loss of $6.4 million was 
recognized during the year ended June 30, 2016 as a result of changes to the key assumptions of contingent consideration valuation 
such  as  developmental  timelines,  market  population,  market  penetration,  product  pricing  and  the  increase  in  valuation  as  the  time 
period shortens between the valuation date and the potential settlement dates of contingent consideration. 

With respect to future milestone payments, contingent consideration will be payable in cash or shares at our discretion.   With 

respect to commercialization, product royalties will be payable in cash which will be funded from royalties received from net sales.

Impairment of intangible assets

Impairment of intangible assets were $61.9 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $Nil for the year ended 
June 30, 2017. As a consequence of the June 2016 strategic review we recognized a $61.9 million non-cash impairment charge in the 
year ended June 30, 2016 relating to our product candidates, MPC-MICRO-IO for the treatment of age-related macular degeneration 
and  MPC-CBE  for  the  expansion  of  hematopoietic  stem  cells  within  cord  blood.   As  of  June  30,  2016  we  had  completed  the 
enrollment of Phase IIa MPC-MICRO-IO clinical trial and we were in a Phase III MPC-CBE clinical trial. We had suspended further 
patient enrollment of both programs as we prioritized the funding of our Tier 1 product candidates. Existing and future cash resources 
will  be  primarily  directed  to  the  delivery  of  Tier  1  product  candidates  for  the  foreseeable  future  and  therefore  we  are  unable  to 
ascertain  when  MPC-MICRO-IO  and  MPC-CBE  patient  enrollment  will  be  restarted.   Accordingly,  impairment  losses  for  the  full 
carrying amounts of the intangible assets relating to product candidates MPC-MICRO-IO and MPC-CBE were recognized in line with 
our accounting policy. 

These  product  candidates  will  remain  technically  viable  and  available  to  consider  for  future  resource  allocation  and  we  will 
continue to seek potential partners for them.  The decision to impair the assets was required given resources have not been allocated to 
continue the development and commercialization efforts of these assets for the foreseeable future.

This accounting charge for the year ended June 30, 2016 was non-cash and does not impact our liquidity or cash flows from our 

operating activities.  There were no impairment losses recognized for the year ended June 30, 2017.

75

Other operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses were $1.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with $2.7 million for the 
year  ended  June  30,  2016,  a  decrease  of  $1.2  million.  The  following  table  shows  movements  within  other  operating  income  and 
expenses for the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, together with the changes in those items:

(in thousands)
Other operating income and expenses:

Year ended
June 30,

2017

2016

$ Change

  % Change

Research and development tax incentive income
Foreign exchange (losses)/gains (net)

Other operating income and expenses

  $

  $

1,532    $
(43)    
1,489    $

3,840     
(1,126)    
2,714     

(2,308)  
1,083   
(1,225)  

(60%)
(96%)
(45%)

Research and development tax incentive income decreased by $2.3 million from $3.8 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 
to $1.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2017 due to a reduction in expenditure that is eligible for the Australian tax incentive. We 
have  recognized  incentive  income  pertaining  to  the  eligible  expenditure  undertaken  in  each  of  these  periods.   At  each  period  end, 
management estimates the refundable tax incentive available to us based on available information at the time. We employ independent 
tax  specialists  to  review,  on  an  annual  basis,  the  quantum  of  our  previous  research  and  development  tax  claim  and  our  on-going 
eligibility to claim the research and development tax incentive in Australia.

Within  the  $1.5  million  research  and  development  tax  incentive  recorded  in  other  income  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017, 
there is a reversal of $0.1 million of income due to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive 
income for the year ended June 30, 2016.

Of the $3.8 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2016, $1.1 
million relates to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive income that we would receive from 
the Australian Government for the year ended June 30, 2015.

We are subject to foreign exchange gains and losses on foreign currency cash balances, creditors and debtors and for the year 
ended June 30, 2017 these balances were minimal and therefore only minor foreign exchange losses have been recognized. In the year 
ended  June  30,  2016  we  recognized  a  foreign  exchange  loss  of  $1.1  million,  primarily  relating  to  depreciation  recognized  on  US$ 
deposits held in Mesoblast Limited.

Loss after income tax

(in thousands)
Loss before income tax

Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss after income tax

Year ended
June 30,

2017
(90,215)  $
13,400     
(76,815)  $

2016
(90,821)   
86,694     
(4,127)   

$

 $

$ Change

  % Change

606   
(73,294) 
(72,688) 

(1%)
(85%)
NM

Loss before income tax was $90.2 million for the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with $90.8 million for the year ended 
June 30, 2016, a decrease in the loss of $0.6 million. This decrease is the net effect of the changes in revenues and expenses which 
have been fully discussed above.

Non-cash income tax benefits of $13.4 million  and $86.7 million were recognized in the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, 

in relation to the net of deferred tax assets and liabilities recognized on the balance sheet during these periods, respectively.   

Following our strategic review in June 2016 and the resulting operational streamlining, we recognized deferred tax assets for 
operating tax losses and deductible temporary differences in the jurisdictions where there are offsetting taxable temporary differences 
(deferred tax liabilities). Prior to this strategic review, we were in the process of consolidating certain intellectual property assets and 
consequently taxable temporary differences were not available to offset deferred tax assets in the same jurisdiction. 

Deferred  tax  assets  are  recognized  for  unused  tax  losses  to  the  extent  that  it  is  probable  that  future  taxable  profit  will  be 
available  against  which  the  unused  tax  losses  can  be  utilized.  Deferred  tax  assets  are  offset  against  taxable  temporary  differences 
(deferred tax liabilities) when the deferred tax balances relate to the same tax jurisdiction in accordance with our accounting policy. 

76

 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
As of June 30, 2017 and 2016, our cumulative operating losses have a total potential tax benefit of $113.1 million and $84.7 
million  at  local  tax  rates  (excluding  other  temporary  differences),  respectively,  which  may  be  available  for  use  once  we  are  in  a 
taxable profit position. These losses were incurred in different jurisdictions and can only be offset against profits earned in the relevant 
jurisdiction. Further, in order to use these tax losses it is necessary to satisfy certain tests and, as a result, we cannot assure you that the 
tax losses will be available to offset profits if and when we earn them. 

Comparison of Our Results for the Year ended June 30, 2016 with the Year ended June 30, 2015

The following table summarizes our results of operations for the year ended June 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes 

in those items in dollars and as a percentage.

(in thousands except per share information)
Consolidated Income Statement Data:
Revenue:

Commercialization revenue
Milestone revenue
Interest revenue

Total revenue

Research & development
Manufacturing commercialization
Management and administration
Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration
Impairment of intangible assets
Other operating income and expenses
Loss before income tax
Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss attributable to the owners of Mesoblast Limited

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

 $

37,969 
3,500 
1,079 
42,548     

(50,013)    
(29,763)    
(22,500)    
28,112     
(61,919)    
2,714     
(90,821)    
86,694     
(4,127)   $

15,004 
2,000 
2,757 
19,761     

(62,649)    
(23,783)    
(29,540)    
(15,336)    
—     
15,303     
(96,244)    
—     
(96,244)    

22,965 
1,500 
(1,678)  
22,787 

12,636 
(5,980)  
7,040 
43,448 
(61,919)  
(12,589)  
5,423 
86,694 
92,117 

153%
75%
(61%)
115%

(20%)
25%
(24%)
NM
NM
(82%)
(6%)
NM
(96%)

Losses per share from continuing operations attributable to the
   ordinary equity holders:
Basic - losses per share
Diluted - losses per share

Cents

Cents

Cents

% Change

(1.14)   
(1.14)   

(29.99)   
(29.99)   

28.85 
28.85 

(96%)
(96%)

* NM = not meaningful.

Revenue

Revenues were $42.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $19.8 million for the year ended June 30, 2015, 
an increase of $22.7 million. The following table shows the movement within revenue for the year ended June 30, 2016 and 2015, 
together with the changes in those items.

(in thousands)
Revenue:

Commercialization revenue
Milestone revenue
Interest revenue
Revenue

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

37,969    $
3,500 
1,079     
42,548    $

15,004     
2,000 
2,757     
19,761     

22,965   
1,500   
(1,678)  
22,787   

153%
75%
(61%)
115%

Commercialization revenues were $38.0 million in the year ended June 30, 2016, an increase of $23.0 million as compared with 
$15.0 million in the year ended June 30, 2015.  This increase in the year ended June 30, 2016 relates primarily to the recognition in 
revenues of $22.6 million of the remaining full deferred revenue amounts relating to the up-front payments of $130.0 million received 
in the year ended June 30, 2011 under the DCA with Teva as we regained full world-wide rights on our product candidate MPC-150-
IM in the month of June 2016. The recognition of commercialization revenue relating to the deferred revenue amounts in the years 

77

 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
        
     
   
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
     
       
       
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
  
  
   
ended June 30, 2016 and 2015 had no impact to cash flows as the cash receipt pertaining to these deferred revenues recognized was 
received  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2011.  There  are  no  further  performance  obligations  required  of  us  in  relation  to  this  product 
candidate under the DCA. Within the increase of commercialization revenue in the year ended June 30, 2016 was an increase of $0.4 
million relating to royalty income earned on sales of TEMCELL® HS Inj. in Japan since the launch of the product on February 24, 
2016 by our licensee JCR, compared with $Nil for the year ended June 30, 2015.

We  recognized  $3.5  million  in  milestone  revenue  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016  upon  our  licensee,  JCR,  receiving  full 
regulatory approval of MSC product TEMCELL® HS Inj. in Japan, which is a milestone under our agreement with JCR.  In the year 
ended June 30, 2015 we recognized milestone revenue of $2.0 million as JCR filed for marketing approval for TEMCELL® HS Inj. in 
Japan which constitutes a milestone under our agreement with JCR.

The $1.7 million decrease in interest revenue from the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with June 30, 2015 was primarily 
driven by us retaining a higher proportion of cash reserves in US$ instead of A$ in the year ended June 30, 2016, when compared with 
the year ended June 30, 2015.  This change in cash reserve holdings decreased revenue as yields on US$ cash deposits are lower than 
yields  on  A$  cash  deposits.  We  increased  the  proportion  of  cash  reserves  held  in  US$  to  reduce  currency  risk.   Currency  risk  is 
minimized by ensuring the proportion of cash reserves held in each currency matches the expected rate of spend of each currency.

Research and development

Research and development expenses were $50.0 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $62.6 million for the 
year ended June 30, 2015, a decrease of $12.6 million.  The $12.6 million net decrease in research and development expenses reflects 
a reduction in expenditures of our Tier 2 products and product support costs.

(in thousands)
Research and development:

Third party costs
Product support costs
Intellectual property support costs
Amortization of current marketed products

Research and development

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

26,189    $
20,643     
2,737     
444     
50,013    $

30,612     
29,361     
2,676     
—     
62,649     

(4,423)  
(8,718)  
61   
444   
(12,636)  

(14%)
(30%)
2%
NM
(20%)

Third  party  costs,  which  consist  of  all  external  expenditure  on  our  research  and  development  programs,  decreased  by  $4.4 

million in the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 2015.

Within  this  $4.4  million  decrease,  there  was  a  $1.0  million  increase  in  third  party  costs  for  the  advancement  of  our  Tier  1 
products due to clinical advancement during the period for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 2015.  
In the year ended June 30, 2016 we incurred costs on our MPC-06-ID, MSC-100-IV, and MPC-150-IM Tier 1 products as well as our 
MPC-300-IV Tier 1 product which was promoted from Tier 2 to Tier 1 on June 30, 2015.  This increase in Tier 1 costs was offset by a 
$5.0 million decrease in third party costs for our Tier 2 and pipeline products for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with the 
year ended June 30, 2015. The $5.4 million decrease in third party costs for our Tier 2 and pipeline products was primarily due to a 
$1.8 million decrease in costs on our MPC-300-IV product for the treatment of biologic refractory rheumatoid arthritis as the phase 2 
trial incurred costs in the year ended June 30, 2015 and was promoted to Tier 1 on June 30, 2015 and a $1.5 million decrease in costs 
on our MPC-300-IV product for the treatment of diabetic complications, including type 2 diabetes and kidney disease as the phase 2 
trials incurred costs in the year ended June 30, 2015 before completing enrollment in June 2015. Tier 1 programs were also prioritized 
ahead of Tier 2 clinical trials and pipeline activities in the year ended June 30, 2016.

Product  support  costs,  which  consist  primarily  of  salaries  and  related  overhead  expenses  for  personnel  in  research  and 
development functions, have decreased by $8.7 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 2015.  
A  cost  saving  of  $4.3  million  was  realized  in  salaries  and  $1.5  million  was  realized  in  share  based  payments  primarily  due  to  the 
elimination of vacant positions.  In the year ended June 30, 2016, full time equivalents decreased by 8.1 from 82.6 for the year ended 
June  30,  2015  to  74.5  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.   Additionally,  consultancy  expenses,  travel  and  recruitment  expenses 
decreased by $2.0 million, $0.8 million and $0.1 million, respectively, for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended 
June 30, 2015 due to management’s cost reduction efforts.

Also included in research and development expenses are intellectual property support costs, which consist of payments to our 
patent attorneys to progress patent applications and all costs of renewing our granted patents.  These costs increased by $0.1 million in 

78

 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
   
 
the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 2015 due to a one off catch up of patent attorney costs relating to 
the prior year. 

Manufacturing commercialization

Manufacturing  commercialization  expenses,  which  consist  of  fees  paid  to  our  contract  manufacturing  organizations  and 
laboratory supplies used in manufacturing commercialization of our MPC and MSC based products, increased by $6.0 million from 
$23.8 million for the year ended June 30, 2015 to $29.8 million for the year ended June 30, 2016. This increase was primarily due to a 
55% growth in the number of production runs completed in the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 2015 
in order to meet the clinical supply demands of our Tier 1 products.

(in thousands)
Manufacturing commercialization:

MSC platform technology
MPC platform technology
Manufacturing support costs

Manufacturing commercialization

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

17,993    $
8,235     
3,535     
29,763    $

11,388     
8,855     
3,540     
23,783     

6,605   
(620)  
(5)  
5,980   

58%
(7%)
(0%)
25%

The  MSC-based  manufacturing  commercialization  expenses  increased  by  $6.6  million  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016 
compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015  as  81% of  the  production  runs  in the  year ended  June  30,  2016 were  for  MSC-based 
clinical supply whereas 55% of production was for MSC-based process development activities and clinical supply in the year ended 
June 30, 2015.

The  MPC-based  manufacturing  commercialization  expenses  decreased  by  $0.6  million  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016 
compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015  as  19% of  the  production  runs  in the  year ended  June  30,  2016 were  for  MPC-based 
production  whereas  45%  of  production  was  for  MPC-based  clinical  supply  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015.   The  balance  of 
expenditure incurred in both the years ended June 30, 2016 and 2015 was for process development activities.

Manufacturing  support  expenses,  which  consist  primarily  of  salaries  and  related  overhead  expenses  for  personnel  in 
manufacturing  commercialization  functions,  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015  were 
relatively consistent decreasing less than 1%. There was an overall net decrease in manufacturing support expenses due to a reduction 
in the valuation of share based payments resulting from changes in the key assumptions such as the share price and risk free rate. This 
decrease was offset by a minimal increase in labor and associated costs and consultancy expenses. Within this increase, there was an 
increase in full time equivalents of 1.1 from 9.7 for the year ended June 30, 2015 to 10.8 for the year ended June 30, 2016. 

Management and administration

Management and administration expenses were $22.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $29.5 million for 
the year ended June 30, 2015, a decrease of $7.0 million. This decrease was primarily due to lower share based payment expenses 
because  of  lower  valuations,  a  savings  in  labor  and  associated  costs,  a  reduction  in  legal  and  professional  advisor  activities  and 
favorable exchange rate fluctuations as the US$ strengthened against the A$ given that the majority of management and administration 
expenses are incurred in A$ by our headquarter office located in Australia.

(in thousands)
Management and administration:
Labor and associated expenses
Corporate overheads
Legal and professional fees

Management and administration

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

  $

  $

9,295    $
10,274     
2,931     
22,500    $

14,309     
9,707     
5,524     
29,540     

(5,014)  
567   
(2,593)  
(7,040)  

(35%)
6%
(47%)
(24%)

Labor and associated expenses decreased by $5.0 million from $14.3 million for the year ended June 30, 2015 to $9.3 million 
for the year ended June 30, 2016.  Within this $5.0 million decrease is a decrease in share based payment expenses of $2.1 million due 
to a reduction in the valuation of equity settled share based payments resulting from changes in the key assumptions such as the share 
price and risk free rate. There was an increase in full time equivalents of 0.5 from 26.7 for the year ended June 30, 2015 to 27.2 for the 
year ended June 30, 2016, however overall there was a savings in labor and associated costs of $1.1 million during the year ended 
June  30,  2016.   Labor  and  associated  expenses  also  benefited  by  $0.7  million  from  exchange  rate  fluctuations  as  described  above, 

79

 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
consultancy  and  recruitment  expenses  decreased  $1.1  million  due  to  management’s  cost  reduction  efforts  and  other  associated 
expenses decreased $0.1 million. 

Corporate overhead expenses increased by $0.6 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with the year ended June 30, 

2015.  This $0.6 million increase was due to one off costs related to office space and increase in non-cash depreciation charges.

Legal and professional fees decreased by $2.6 million from $5.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2015 to $2.9 million for the year 
ended June 30, 2016 due to reductions on legal, taxation and accounting compliance advice associated with the intellectual property 
management  program  and  reductions  on  audit  and  legal  fees  associated  with  the  “United  States  Initial  Public  Offering”  readiness 
incurred in the year ended June 30, 2015. We also benefited from exchange rate fluctuations as indicated above.

Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration

Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration was a $28.1 million gain for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with 
a $15.3 million loss for the year ended June 30, 2015, an increase of $43.4 million. Within the $28.1 million gain for the year ended 
June 30, 2016, we recognized a gain of $34.5 million due to a reduction in contingent consideration expected to be paid to Osiris on 
the  MSC-assets  due  to  a  greater  certainty  over  the  commencement  of  the  earn  out  period.   This  change  in  assumption  results  in  a 
reduction in the valuation of contingent consideration as an earlier earn out period results in royalties being applicable to sales in years 
that are prior to peak year sales. The remaining loss of $6.4 million was recognized during the year ended June 30, 2016 as a net result 
of changes to the key assumptions of contingent consideration valuation such as developmental timelines, market population, market 
penetration,  product  pricing  and  the  increase  in  valuation  as  the  time  period  shortens  between  the  valuation  date  and  the  potential 
settlement dates of contingent consideration. 

The $15.3 million loss for the year ended June 30, 2015 was due to the remeasurement of contingent consideration pertaining to 
the  acquisition  of  assets  from  Osiris.   This  loss  was  as  a  result  of  changes  to  the  key  assumptions  of  the  contingent  consideration 
valuation such as product pricing, market population, the value of payments for contractual commitments and the increase in valuation 
as the time period shortens between the valuation date and the potential settlement dates of contingent consideration. 

With respect to future milestone payments, contingent consideration will be payable in cash or shares at our discretion.   With 

respect to commercialization, product royalties will be payable in cash which will be funded from the profits generated.

Impairment of intangible assets

Impairment of intangible assets were $61.9 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $Nil for the year ended 
June 30, 2015. As a consequence of the June 2016 strategic review we recognized a $61.9 million non-cash impairment charge in the 
year ended June 30, 2016 relating to our product candidates, MPC-MICRO-IO for the treatment of age-related macular degeneration 
and MPC-CBE for the expansion of hematopoietic stem cells within cord blood.  As of June 30, 2016 we completed the enrollment of 
Phase IIa MPC-MICRO-IO clinical trial and we were in a Phase III MPC-CBE clinical trial. We suspended further patient enrollment 
of both programs as we prioritize the funding of our Tier 1 product candidates.    Existing and future cash resources will be primarily 
directed to the delivery of Tier 1 product candidates for the foreseeable future and therefore we are unable to ascertain when MPC-
MICRO-IO and MPC-CBE patient enrollment will be restarted.   Accordingly, impairment losses for the full carrying amounts of the 
intangible assets relating to product candidates MPC-MICRO-IO and MPC-CBE were recognized in line with our accounting policy. 

These  product  candidates  will  remain  technically  viable  and  available  to  consider  for  future  resource  allocation  and  we  will 
continue to seek potential partners for them.  The decision to impair the assets was required given resources have not been allocated to 
continue the development and commercialization efforts of these assets for the foreseeable future.

This accounting charge for the year ended June 30, 2016 was non-cash and does not impact our liquidity or cash flows from our 

operating activities.  There were no impairment losses recognized for the year ended June 30, 2015.

80

Other operating income and expenses

Other operating income and expenses were $2.7 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $15.3 million for the 
year  ended  June  30,  2015,  a  decrease  of  $12.6  million.  The  following  table  shows  movements  within  other  operating  income  and 
expenses for the year ended June 30, 2016 and 2015, together with the changes in those items:

(in thousands)
Other operating income and expenses:

Year ended
June 30,

2016

2015

$ Change

  % Change

Research and development tax incentive income
Foreign exchange (losses)/gains (net)
Other revenue

Other operating income and expenses

  $

  $

3,840    $
(1,126)    
—     
2,714    $

4,418     
10,478     
407     
15,303     

(578)  
(11,604)  
(407)  
(12,589)  

(13%)
(111%)
(100%)
(82%)

Research and development tax incentive income decreased by $0.6 million from $4.4 million for the year ended June 30, 2015 
to  $3.8  million  for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016.  We  have  recognized  incentive  income  pertaining  to  the  eligible  expenditure 
undertaken in each of these periods.  At each period end, management estimates the refundable tax incentive available to us based on 
available information at the time. We employ independent tax specialists to review, on an annual basis, the quantum of our previous 
research and development tax claim and our on-going eligibility to claim the research and development tax incentive in Australia.

Of the $3.8 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2016, $1.1 
million  relates  to  a  change  in  the  original  estimate  of  the  research  and  development  tax  incentive  income  we  estimated  we  would 
receive from the Australian government for the year ended June 30, 2015.

Of the $4.4 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2015, $0.5 
million relates to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive income that we would receive from 
the Australian Government for the year ended June 30, 2014.

For the year ended June 30, 2015, we recognized a net foreign exchange gain of $10.5 million due to movements in exchange 
rates as the US$ appreciated against the A$. Within Mesoblast Limited (exclusive of its consolidated subsidiaries), we held certain 
cash  and  term  deposit  balances  in  US$,  resulting  in  foreign  exchange  gains  on  the  revaluation  of  foreign  currency  denominated 
monetary assets and liabilities into our functional currency of A$.

In July 2015, we transferred the majority of US$ deposits to a wholly owned subsidiary of Mesoblast Limited that has a US$ 
functional currency.  We are subject to foreign exchange gains and losses on foreign currency cash balances, creditors and debtors. In 
the year ended June 30, 2016 we recognized a foreign exchange loss of $1.1 million, primarily relating to depreciation recognized on 
US$ deposits held in Mesoblast Limited.

Other revenue decreased by $0.4 million as we recognized a one-off insurance recovery in the year ended June 30, 2015.

Loss after income tax

(in thousands)
Loss before income tax

Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss after income tax

Year ended
June 30,

2016
(90,821)   $
86,694     
(4,127)   $

2015
(96,244)    
—     
(96,244)    

  $

  $

$ Change

  % Change

5,423   
86,694   
92,117   

(6%)
NM
(96%)

Loss before income tax was $90.8 million for the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with $96.2 million for the year ended 
June 30, 2015, a decrease in the loss of $5.4 million. This decrease is the net effect of the changes in revenues and expenses which 
have been fully discussed above.

A non-cash income tax benefit of $86.7 million was recognized in the year ended June 30, 2016 compared with $Nil for the year 

ended June 30, 2015.  

In the three month period ended March 31, 2016 a deferred tax asset of $4.2 million was recorded following our conclusion to 
retain existing intellectual property assets in the jurisdiction that the intellectual property assets were expected to be consolidated.  The 

81

 
 
 
 
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
    
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
deferred tax asset was increased by a further $0.7 million in the three months ended June 30, 2016 for operating tax losses attributable 
to that period.

Historically  we  have  had  a  plan  to  consolidate  certain  intellectual  property  assets  and  consequently  taxable  temporary 
differences have not been available to offset deferred tax assets in the same jurisdiction.  However, following the June 2016 strategic 
review and the resulting operational streamlining we are no longer actively pursuing the consolidation of these intellectual property 
assets.  As a result we recognized $60.0 million of deferred tax assets for operating tax losses and deductible temporary differences in 
the jurisdictions where there are offsetting taxable temporary differences (deferred tax liabilities). 

Deferred  tax  assets  are  recognized  for  unused  tax  losses  to  the  extent  that  it  is  probable  that  future  taxable  profit  will  be 
available  against  which  the  unused  tax  losses  can  be  utilized.  Deferred  tax  assets  are  offset  against  taxable  temporary  differences 
(deferred tax liabilities) when the deferred tax balances relate to the same tax jurisdiction in accordance with our accounting policy. 

We also recognized an income tax benefit of $21.8 million due to a reversal of deferred tax liabilities recognized on intellectual 
property  assets.  This  reversal  was  triggered  by  a  non-cash  impairment  charge  on  intellectual  property  assets  during  the  year  ended 
June 30, 2016 relating to our product candidates, MPC-MICRO-IO for the treatment of age-related macular degeneration and MPC-
CBE for use in BMT, consisting of hematopoietic stem cells expanded ex vivo by incubation with MPCs, administered intravenously. 

As  of  June  30,  2016  and  2015,  our  cumulative  operating  losses  have  a  total  potential  tax  benefit  of  $84.7  million  and  $69.9 
million  at  local  tax  rates  (excluding  other  temporary  differences),  respectively,  which  may  be  available  for  use  once  we  are  in  a 
taxable profit position. These losses were incurred in different jurisdictions and can only be offset against profits earned in the relevant 
jurisdiction. Further, in order to use these tax losses it is necessary to satisfy certain tests and, as a result, we cannot assure you that the 
tax losses will be available to offset profits if and when we earn them. 

Certain Differences Between IFRS and U.S. GAAP

IFRS differs from U.S. GAAP in certain respects. Management has not assessed the materiality of differences between IFRS 

and U.S. GAAP. Our significant accounting policies are described in “Item 18 Financial Statements – Note 21”.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure about Market Risk

The  following  sections  provide  quantitative  information  on  our  exposure  to  interest  rate  risk,  share  price  risk,  and  foreign 
currency exchange risk. We make use of sensitivity analyses which are inherently limited in estimating actual losses in fair value that 
can occur from changes in market conditions. For further assessment on our market risks, see “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note 
10 (a).”

Interest rate risk

We are not exposed to typical interest rate risk, which is the impact of interest rates on the cost of servicing and repaying debt. 
Our exposure to interest rate risk arises through movements in regards to interest income we earn on our deposits. The interest income 
derived from these balances can fluctuate due to interest rate changes. This interest rate risk is managed by spreading the maturity date 
of our deposits across various periods.  Our strategy of entering into new deposits as old deposits mature and reinvesting surplus funds 
ensures  that  we  spread  the  timing  of  new  deposits  which  assists  us  to  achieve  the  average  interest  rates  available  in  the  market 
throughout the year. We also ensure that sufficient funds are available, in at-call accounts, to meet our working capital requirements.

Foreign currency exchange risk

We  have  foreign  currency  amounts  owing  primarily  in  our  Australian  parent  entity,  whose  functional  currency  is  the  A$, 
relating to clinical, regulatory and overhead activities.  These foreign currency balances give rise to a currency risk, which is the risk 
of the exchange rate moving, in either direction, and the impact it may have on our financial performance.

We manage the currency risk by evaluating levels to hold in each currency by assessing our future activities which will likely be 

incurred in those currencies.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Our  management’s  discussion  and  analysis  of  our  financial  condition  and  results  of  operations  is  based  on  our  consolidated 
financial  statements,  which  we  have  prepared  in  accordance  with  IFRS.  The  preparation  of  these  consolidated  financial  statements 
requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent 

82

assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, as well as the reported revenues and expenses during the reporting periods. 
We evaluate these estimates and judgments on an ongoing basis. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other 
factors that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the 
carrying  value  of  assets  and  liabilities  that  are  not  readily  apparent  from  other  sources.  Our  actual  results  may  differ  from  these 
estimates under different assumptions or conditions.

While  our  significant  accounting  policies  are  more  fully  described  in  our  consolidated  financial  statements  included  in  the 
annual  report,  we  believe  that  the  following  accounting  policies  are  the  most  critical  for  fully  understanding  and  evaluating  our 
financial condition and results of operations.

Revenue Recognition

Revenues comprise the fair value of the consideration received or receivable.

Commercialization and milestone revenue

Commercialization and milestone revenue generally includes non-refundable up-front license and collaboration fees; milestone 
payments, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones; as well as 
royalties on product sales of licensed products, if and when such product sales occur; and revenue from the supply of products.

Where  such  arrangements  can  be  divided  into  separately  identifiable  components  (each  component  constituting  a  separate 
earnings  process),  the  arrangement  consideration  is  allocated  to  the  different  components  based  on  their  relative  fair  values  and 
recognized over the respective performance period in accordance with IAS 18 Revenue. Where the components of the arrangement 
cannot be divided into separate units, the individual deliverables are combined as a single unit of accounting and the total arrangement 
consideration is recognized over the estimated collaboration period. Such analysis requires considerable estimates and judgments to be 
made  by  us,  including  the  relative  fair  values  of  the  various  elements  included  in  such  agreements  and  the  estimated  length  of  the 
respective performance periods.

Amounts  received  prior  to  satisfying  the  revenue  recognition  criteria  are  recorded  as  deferred  revenue  in  our  consolidated 
balance sheets. Amounts expected to be recognized as revenue within the 12 months following the balance sheet date are classified as 
deferred  revenue,  within  current  liabilities.  Amounts  not  expected  to  be  recognized  as  revenue  within  the  12  months  following  the 
balance sheet date are classified as deferred revenue, within non-current liabilities.

Cephalon arrangement

In  December  2010,  we  entered  into  a  development  and  commercialization  agreement  (“DCA”),  with  Cephalon,  Inc.,  now  a 
wholly-owned subsidiary of Teva, which allowed for Teva to obtain world-wide rights to commercialize specific products based on 
our  proprietary  adult  stem  cell  technology  platform.  As  part  of  the  DCA,  we  received  $130.0  million  as  a  non-refundable  up-front 
payment. In the month of June 2016, Teva exercised a contractual right under the DCA to end the joint development of the lead asset 
in our cardiovascular portfolio, product candidate MPC-150-IM, and we regained full world-wide rights on this product candidate.

As the joint development of product candidate MPC-150-IM was ended in June 2016, we brought the remaining full amounts of 
deferred revenues to account, resulting in a total of $37.5 million of commercialization revenue recognized during the year ended June 
30, 2016. The recognition of commercialization revenue relating to the deferred revenue amounts in the year ended June 30, 2016 had 
no impact to cash flows as the cash receipt pertaining to these deferred revenues recognized was received in the year ended June 30, 
2011. There are no further performance obligations required of us in relation to this product candidate. 

For the year ended June 30, 2015 we recognized $15.0 million of revenue, being the amortization of the initial payment over the 
estimated  development  program  term.  During  the  period  from  the  initial  recognition  date  until  June  2016,  the  revenue  was  being 
recognized on a straight line basis over the estimated development period of product candidate, MPC-150-IM and had no impact to 
cash flows as the cash receipt pertaining to this revenue recognized was received in the year ended June 30, 2011. Our accounting 
policy requires us to review the estimated development program term on a quarterly basis.  

JCR arrangement

In  October  2013,  we  acquired  all  of  Osiris’  culture-expanded,  MSC-based  assets.  These  assets  included  assumption  of  a 
collaboration agreement with JCR, a research and development oriented pharmaceutical company in Japan. Revenue recognized under 
this model is limited to the amount of cash received or for which we are entitled, as JCR has the right to terminate the agreement at 
any time.

83

Under  the  JCR  Agreement,  JCR  is  responsible  for  all  development  and  manufacturing  costs  including  sales  and  marketing 
expenses.  Under  the  JCR  Agreement,  JCR  has  the  right  to  develop  our  MSCs  in  two  fields  for  the  Japanese  market:  exclusive  in 
conjunction with the treatment of hematological malignancies by the use of hematopoietic stem cells derived from peripheral blood, 
cord blood or bone marrow, or the First JCR Field; and non-exclusive for developing assays that use liver cells for non-clinical drug 
screening and evaluation, or the Second JCR Field. With respect to the First JCR Field, we are entitled to payments when JCR reaches 
certain commercial milestones and to escalating double-digit royalties. These royalties are subject to possible renegotiation downward 
in the event of competition from non-infringing products in Japan. With respect to the Second JCR Field, we are entitled to a double 
digit profit share. Royalty revenue is recognized upon the sale of the related products provided we have no remaining performance 
obligations under the arrangement.

In the year ended June 30, 2017, we recognized $1.4 million, in commercialization revenue relating to royalty income earned on 
sales of TEMCELL in Japan since the launch of the product on February 24, 2016, by our licensee JCR, compared with $0.4 million 
for the year ended June 30, 2016. These amounts were recorded in revenue as there are no further performance obligations required in 
regards to these items. 

In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  we  recognized  $0.5  million  in  milestone  revenue  upon  our  licensee,  JCR,  reaching  a 
cumulative  net  sales  milestone  for  sales  of  TEMCELL  in  Japan.  In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016,  we  recognized  $3.5  million  in 
milestone  revenue  from  JCR  for  the  receipt  of  full  regulatory  approval  of  TEMCELL  in  Japan,  which  is  a  milestone  under  our 
agreement with JCR. These amounts were recorded in revenue as there are no further performance obligations required in regards to 
these milestones. 

Government grant income

Revenue from government grants is recognized in the consolidated income statement on a systematic basis over the periods in 
which the entity recognizes as expense the related costs for which the grants are intended to compensate in accordance with IAS 20 
Accounting for Government Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance.

The Australian government allows a refundable tax offset to eligible companies with an annual aggregate turnover of less than 
A$20.0 million. Eligible companies can receive a refundable tax offset for a percentage of their research and development spending at 
the rate of 45% for periods prior to June 30, 2016 and an expected rate of 43.5% for periods from July 1, 2016. We have assessed our 
research and development activities and expenditure to determine which of these spending are likely to be eligible under the incentive 
scheme. At each period end, we estimate and recognize the refundable tax offset available to us based on available information at the 
time.

The  receivable  for  reimbursable  amounts  that  have  not  been  collected  is  reflected  in  trade  and  other  receivables  on  our 

consolidated balance sheets.

Goodwill

We have recognized goodwill as a result of two separate acquisitions. Goodwill of $118.4 million was recognized on acquisition 
of Angioblast Systems Inc. in 2010, $13.9 million was recognized on the acquisition of assets from Osiris in 2013 and $2.1 million 
was recognized on finalization of the MSC business combination of Osiris in 2015. In all cases the goodwill recognized represented 
excess in the purchase price over the net identifiable assets and in-process research and development acquired in the transaction. We 
have a single operating unit and all goodwill has been allocated to that unit.

The goodwill resulting from these acquisitions is tested for impairment in accordance with IAS 36 Impairment of Assets which 
requires testing be performed at any time during an annual period, provided the test is performed at the same time every year. We test 
for impairment annually in the fourth quarter. Additionally, assets must be tested for impairment if there is an indication that an asset 
may be impaired. The recoverable amounts of our assets and cash-generating units have been determined based on fair value less costs 
to sell calculations, which require the use of certain assumptions. See Note 6 of our consolidated financial statements and the related 
note thereto included in our annual report for more information regarding the assumptions used in determining the fair value less costs 
to sell.

In-process research and development

IFRS  requires  that  acquired  in-process  research  and  development  be  measured  at  fair  value  and  carried  as  an  indefinite  life 
intangible asset subject to impairment reviews. We have recognized in-process research and development as a result of two separate 
acquisitions. In-process research and development of $387.0 million was recognized on the acquisition of Angioblast Systems Inc. in 
2010 and $126.7 million was recognized on the acquisition of assets from Osiris in 2013 and $24.0 million was reclassified to current 

84

marketed products upon the TEMCELL asset becoming available for use in Japan. In 2016, we fully impaired $61.9 million of in-
process  research  and  development  relating  to  our  product  candidates,  MPC-MICRO-IO  for  the  treatment  of  age-related  macular 
degeneration  and  MPC-CBE  for  the  expansion  of  hematopoietic  stem  cells  within  cord  blood,  as  we  suspended  further  patient 
enrollment of the Phase IIa MPC-MICRO-IO clinical trial and the Phase III MPC-CBE clinical trial as we prioritize the funding of our 
Tier 1 product candidates. The remaining carrying amount of in-process research and development as at June 30, 2017 and June 30, 
2016  was  $427.8  million.  We  still  believe  these  product  candidates  remain  viable  upon  further  funding,  or  partnership,  and 
accordingly these products should not be regarded as abandoned, where typically, abandoned programs would be closed down and the 
related research and development efforts are considered impaired and the asset is fully expensed.

All in-process research and development recognized on our balance sheet is a result of a business acquisition and is considered 
to  be  an  indefinite  life  intangible  asset  on  the  basis  that  it  is  incomplete  and  cannot  be  used  in  its  current  form.  Indefinite  life 
intangible assets are not amortized but rather are tested for impairment annually in the fourth quarter of each year in accordance with 
IAS 36 Impairment of Assets which requires testing annually, or whenever there is an indication that an asset may be impaired. There 
was no impairment charge recognized during the year ended June 30, 2017.

In-process research and development will continue to be tested for impairment until the related research and development efforts 
are either completed or abandoned. At the time of completion, when the asset becomes available for use, all costs recognized in in-
process research and development that related to the completed asset are transferred to the intangible asset category, current marketed 
products, at the asset’s historical cost. 

Current marketed products

Current marketed products contain products that are currently being marketed.   The assets are recognized on our balance sheet 
as a result of business acquisitions or reclassifications from in-process research and development upon completion.  Upon completion, 
when assets become available for use, assets are reclassified from in-process research and development to current marketed products 
at the historical value that they were recognized at within the in-process research and development category.

Upon  reclassification  to  the  current  market  products  category,  management  determines  the  remaining  useful  life  of  the 
intangible assets and amortizes them from the date they become available for use. In order for management to determine the remaining 
useful life of the asset, management would consider the expected flow of future economic benefits to the entity with reference to the 
product  life  cycle,  competitive  landscape,  obsolescence,  market  demand,  any  remaining  patent  useful  life  and  any  other  relevant 
factors. 

Management has chosen to amortize all intangible assets with a finite useful life on a straight-line basis over the useful life of 
the  asset.   Current  marketed  products  are  tested  for  impairment  in  accordance  with  IAS  36  Impairment  of  Assets  which  requires 
testing whenever there is an indication that an asset may be impaired.

We  reclassified  $24.0  million  from  in-process  research  and  development  to  current  marketed  products  upon  the  TEMCELL 

asset becoming available for use in Japan.

Impairment of assets

Goodwill  and  intangible  assets  that  have  an  indefinite  useful  life  are  not  subject  to  amortization  and  are  tested  annually  for 
impairment or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that they might be impaired. Other assets are tested for 
impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable.

We impair assets in accordance with IAS 36 Impairment of Assets. IAS 36 Impairment of Assets outlines that an impairment 
loss  must  be  recognized  if  an  asset’s  carrying  amount  exceeds  its  recoverable  amount.  The  recoverable  amount  is  the  higher  of  an 
asset’s  fair  value  less  costs  to  sell  and  its  value  in  use.  For  the  purposes  of  assessing  impairment,  assets  are  grouped  at  the  lowest 
levels for which there are separately identifiable cash inflows which are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or 
groups of assets (cash-generating units). The recoverable amounts of our assets and cash-generating units have been determined based 
on  fair  value  less  costs  to  sell  calculations,  which  require  the  use  of  certain  assumptions.  See  Note  6  of  our  consolidated  financial 
statements  and  the  related  note  thereto  included  in  our  annual  report  for  more  information  regarding  the  assumptions  used  in 
determining the fair value less costs to sell.

Management  maintains  internal  valuations  of  each  asset  annually  (or  more  frequently  should  indicators  of  impairment  be 
identified) and valuations from independent experts are requested periodically, within every three year period. The internal valuations 
are  continually  reviewed  by  management  and  consideration  is  given  as  to  whether  there  are  indicators  of  impairment  which  would 
warrant impairment testing. An external valuation of our assets was carried out by an independent expert as at June 30, 2017 with the 

85

recoverable amount of each asset exceeding its carrying amount and therefore no impairment charge was recognized during the year 
ended June 30, 2017. 

As a consequence of the June 2016 strategic review we recognized non-cash impairment charges of $61.9 million in the year 
ended June 30, 2016 relating to our product candidates, MPC-MICRO-IO for the treatment of age-related macular degeneration and 
MPC-CBE  for  the  expansion  of  hematopoietic  stem  cells  within  cord  blood.  As  of  June  30,  2016  we  had  completed  the  Phase  IIa 
MPC-MICRO-IO clinical trial and MPC-CBE was in a Phase III clinical trial. In June 2016, we suspended further patient enrollment 
of both programs as we prioritized the funding of our Tier 1 product candidates.   Existing and future cash resources will be deployed 
on delivery of Tier 1 product candidates for the foreseeable future and therefore we are unable to ascertain when MPC-MICRO-IO 
and  MPC-CBE  patient  enrollment  will  be  restarted.   Accordingly  impairment  losses  for  the  full  carrying  amounts  of  the  intangible 
assets  relating  to  product  candidates  MPC-MICRO-IO  and  MPC-CBE  were  recognized  in  June  2016  in  line  with  our  accounting 
policy.   These product candidates will remain technically viable and available to consider for future resource allocation and on this 
basis we have not abandoned the programs.  The decision to impair the assets was required given resources have not been allocated to 
continue the development and commercialization efforts of these assets for the foreseeable future. This accounting charge was non-
cash and has not impacted our liquidity or cash flows from our operating activities.

Excluding the abovementioned impairment charges, the recoverable amount of our cash generating unit, including goodwill and 
in-process  research  and  development,  exceeded  the  carrying  amounts  in  the  impairment  testing  completed  and  therefore  no 
impairment charges were recorded.

Investments and other financial assets

We invest our cash in term deposits and other similar low risk products. We classify investments as either a cash equivalent or a 
short-term investment in accordance with IAS 7 Statement of Cash Flows. For a deposit to be classified as a cash equivalent it should 
be held for the purpose of meeting short-term cash commitments rather than for investment or other purposes and IAS 7 outlines that: 

•

•

It must be readily convertible to a known amount of cash (qualifies when it has a short maturity, of say, 3 months or less 
from the date of acquisition); and

It must be subject to insignificant risk of change of value.

We review the terms and conditions of each deposit to determine if it is a cash equivalent in accordance with IAS 7.

Deposits with maturity dates between 3 months and 12 months are classified as short term investments. The carrying amount of 
short-term investments approximates fair value due to the short maturities of these instruments, and there are no unrealized gains or 
losses associated with these instruments. Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in 
an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. As such, fair value is a market-based measurement that 
should be determined based on assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset and liability.

As at June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016, we did not hold any deposits with maturity dates between 3 months and 12 months and 

therefore we did not hold any deposits classified as short term investments.

Fair Value Measurements

For  financial  instruments  that  are  measured  on  the  balance  sheet  at  fair  value,  IFRS  7  requires  disclosure  of  the  fair  value 

measurements by level of the following fair value measurement hierarchy:

•

•

•

Level 1: The fair value of financial instruments traded in active markets (such as publicly traded derivatives, and trading 
and available-for-sale securities) is based on quoted market prices at the end of the reporting period. The quoted market 
price used for financial assets held by us is the current bid price. These instruments are included in level 1.

Level  2:  The  fair  value  of  financial  instruments  that  are  not  traded  in  an  active  market  (for  example,  foreign  exchange 
contracts) is determined using valuation techniques which maximize the use of observable market data and rely as little as 
possible  on  entity-specific  estimates.  If  all  significant  inputs  required  to  fair  value  an  instrument  are  observable,  the 
instrument is included in level 2.

Level 3: If one or more of the significant inputs is not based on observable market data, the instrument is included in level 
3. This is the case for provisions (contingent consideration) and equity securities (unlisted). 

Our level 3 asset consists of an investment in unlisted equity securities in the biotechnology sector. Level 3 assets were 100% of 

total assets measured at fair value as at June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016.

86

Our level 3 liabilities consist of a contingent consideration provision related to the acquisition of Osiris’ MSC business. Level 3 
liabilities were 100% of total liabilities measured at fair value as at June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016. There were no transfers between 
any of the levels for recurring fair value measurements during the year.

The  following  table  summarizes  the  assumptions,  techniques,  and  significant  unobservable  inputs  used  in  level  3  fair  value 

measurements:

 (in U.S. dollars, 
in thousands, except percent data)
Description
Contingent consideration provision

Fair value
as of June 30,

    Valuation   Unobservable  

Range of inputs
(weighted average)
for the year ended
June 30,

  2017
  63,595 

    2016
  63,716 

technique
Discounted 
cash flows

inputs(1)
Risk adjusted
discount rate

2017
11%-13%
(12.5%)

2016
11%-13%
(12.5%)

Expected unit
revenues

n/a

n/a

Relationship of
unobservable inputs to
fair value
Year ended June 30, 2017: A 
change in the discount rate by 
0.5% would increase/decrease 
the fair value by 1%.

Year ended June 30, 2016: A 
change in the discount rate by 
0.5% would increase/decrease 
the fair value by 2%.
Year ended June 30, 2017: A 
10% increase in the price 
assumptions adopted would 
increase the fair value by 5%.

Year ended June 30, 2016: A 
10% increase in the price 
assumptions adopted would 
increase the fair value by 6%.

(1)

There were no significant inter-relationships between unobservable inputs that materially affect fair values.

Net deferred tax assets

We record deferred tax assets if, based upon the available evidence, it is more likely than not that we will recognize some or all 
of the deferred tax assets. Deferred tax assets were recognized for unused tax losses based on the scheduling of reversals of deferred 
tax liabilities and to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses can be 
utilized. We have recorded deferred tax assets that relate to operating tax losses and deductible temporary differences to offset taxable 
temporary differences (deferred tax liabilities) following our conclusion in the year ended June 30, 2016 to retain existing intellectual 
property assets in their relative jurisdictions as we are no longer planning to consolidate intellectual property assets. There have been 
no significant developments on this conclusion during the year ended June 30, 2017. 

Accrued research and development and manufacturing commercialization expenses

As  part  of  the  process  of  preparing  our  financial  statements,  we  are  required  to  estimate  our  accrued  expenses.  This  process 
involves  reviewing  open  contracts  and  purchase  orders,  communicating  with  our  personnel  to  identify  services  that  have  been 
performed on our behalf and estimating the level of service performed and the associated cost incurred for the service when we have 
not yet been invoiced or otherwise notified of the actual cost. The majority of our service providers invoice us monthly in arrears for 
services performed or when contractual milestones are met. We make estimates of our accrued expenses as of each balance sheet date 
in our financial statements based on facts and circumstances known to us at that time. We periodically confirm the accuracy of our 
estimates with the service providers and make adjustments if necessary.

Examples of estimated accrued expenses include fees paid to:

•

•

•

•

CROs in connection with clinical studies;

investigative sites in connection with clinical studies;

vendors in connection with preclinical development activities; and

vendors related to product manufacturing, process development and distribution of clinical supplies.

87

 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We  base  our  expenses  related  to  clinical  studies  on  our  estimates  of  the  services  received  and  efforts  expended  pursuant  to 
contracts  with  multiple  CROs  that  conduct  and  manage  clinical  studies  on  our  behalf.  The  financial  terms  of  these  agreements  are 
subject  to  negotiation,  vary  from  contract  to  contract  and  may  result  in  uneven  payment  flows.  There  may  be  instances  in  which 
payments made to our vendors will exceed the level of services provided and result in a prepayment of the clinical expense. Payments 
under  some  of  these contracts depend  on factors  such as  the  successful  enrollment  of  subjects  and the  completion  of clinical  study 
milestones.

In  accruing  service  fees,  we  estimate  the  time  period  over  which  services  will  be  performed  and  the  level  of  effort  to  be 
expended in each period. If the actual timing of the performance of services or the level of effort varies from our estimate, we adjust 
the  accrual  or  prepaid  accordingly.  To  date,  there  have  been  no  material  differences  from  our  estimates  to  the  amount  actually 
incurred.

Australian Disclosure Requirements

Significant Changes in the State of Affairs

No significant changes occurred within our state of affairs during the year ended June 30, 2017.

Likely Developments and Expected Results of Operations

Our continued progress in clinical developments brings our leading Tier 1 product candidates closer to potential approval, with 
upcoming  significant  milestones  expected  in  the  coming  financial  year.  With  control  of  our  valuable  CHF  product  candidate,  the 
Company can refine the clinical pathway to global commercialization for this asset. We believe we have enhanced opportunities for 
partnering based on cumulative Phase 2/3 clinical results.

Environmental Regulations

Our  operations  are  not  subject  to  any  significant  environmental  regulations  under  either  Commonwealth  of  Australia  or 
State/Territory legislation. We consider that adequate systems are in place to manage our obligations and are not aware of any breach 
of environmental requirements pertaining to us.

5.B

Liquidity and Capital Resources 

Sources of Liquidity

We have incurred losses from operations since our inception in 2004 and as of June 30, 2017, we had an accumulated deficit of 
$344.9 million. We had cash and cash equivalents of $45.8 million as of June 30, 2017 and incurred net cash outflows from operations 
of $95.5  million  for  the  year  then  ended.  In  August  2017,  we  announced  a  fully  underwritten  entitlement  offer  to  existing  eligible 
shareholders  (on  a  1  for  12  basis)  in  Australia  and  New  Zealand  and  institutional  shareholders  in  certain  other  countries  in  private 
placements. US$38.2 million of net proceeds from the entitlement offer is expected to be received and recognized in cash and cash 
equivalents in September 2017.

We  have  committed  to  partner  one  or  more  of  our  four  Tier  1  product  candidates  resulting  in  a  non-dilutive  funding  for 
operations. This may include MSC-100-IV for steroid-refractory graft versus host disease (“GVHD”) and MPC-06-ID for CLBP, in 
relation  to  which  we  have  entered  into  an  agreement  with  Mallinckrodt  in  order  to  exclusively  negotiate  a  commercial  and 
development  partnership.  We  are  also  continuing  to  work  on  various  cost  containment  and  deferment  strategies,  including  the 
reprioritization of projects. A fully discretionary equity facility remains for up to A$120.0 million / US$90.0 million over 24 months 
to provide additional funds as required.  We may also consider issuing new capital to fund future operational requirements.

There is uncertainty related to our ability to partner programs and raise capital at terms to meet our requirements.  Additionally, 
there is uncertainty related to our ability to sustainably implement further cost reductions and defer programs on a timely basis while 
achieving expected outcomes.

The continuing viability of us and our ability to continue as a going concern and meet our debts and commitments as they fall 
due are dependent upon entering into an arrangement with a third party partner on one or more of our four Tier 1 product candidates 
that would result in non-dilutive funding and/or raising further capital, together with various cost containment and deferment strategies 
being completed including the reprioritization of certain projects.

Management  and  the directors  believe  that  we  will  be  successful  in  the  above  matters  and,  accordingly,  have  prepared  the 
financial report on a going concern basis, notwithstanding that there is a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt on our 
ability to continue as a going concern and that we may be unable to realize our assets and liabilities in the normal course of business. 

88

References to matters that may cast significant doubt about our ability to continue as a going concern also raise substantial doubt 
as contemplated by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards. For our audited financial statements, see 
“Item 18 Financial Statements” included in our Form 20-F.

Audit Report

Our  auditor  has  included  an  “emphasis  of  matter”  paragraph  in  the  audit  report  relating  to  our  ability  to  continue  as  a  going 

concern (refer Note 1(ii)).

Cash flows

(in thousands)
Cash Flow Data:
Net cash (outflows) in operating activities
Net cash inflows/(outflows) in investing activities
Net cash inflows in financing activities
Net (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

2017

Year ended June 30,
2016

2015

(95,471)   
142 
60,005 
(35,324)   

(87,996)   
(1,727)   
62,066    
(27,657)   

(101,036)
(5,064)
45,852 
(60,248)

Comparison of Cash flows for the Year ended June 30, 2017 with the Year ended June 30, 2016

Net cash outflows in operating activities

Net cash outflows for operating activities were $95.5 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with $88.0 million for 
the year ended June 30, 2016, an increase of $7.5 million. The increase of $7.5 million is due to a reduction in cash inflows of $4.1 
million and an increase in cash outflows of $3.4 million in the year ended June 30, 2017 compared with the year ended June 30, 2016. 

The $4.1 million reduction of inflows comprised: inflows from milestone payments received decreased by $3.0 million after our 
licensee, JCR, reached a cumulative net sales milestone for sales of TEMCELL in Japan, during the year ended June 30, 2017 where 
our  licensee,  JCR,  reached  a  milestone  for  receiving  full  regulatory  approval  of  MSC  product  TEMCELL  in  Japan  during  the  year 
ended June 30, 2016; interest receipts reduced by $0.6 million as our cash reserves in the year ended June 30, 2017 have decreased 
when compared with the year ended June 30, 2016; inflows decreased by $1.7 million as receipts for the research and development tax 
incentive  were  lower  during  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  when  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016;  these  decreases  in 
inflows were offset by an increase of $1.2 million in receipts from royalty income earned on sales of TEMCELL in Japan during the 
year ended June 30, 2017. 

Outflows  increased  by  $3.4  million  due  to  fully  absorbing  the  incremental  clinical  program  costs  for  MPC-150-IM  (CHF) 
during the year ended June 30, 2017 as we were responsible for all research and development expenditure incurred on this product 
candidate in the year ended June 30, 2017 whereas Teva was responsible for the majority of research and development expenses in the 
year ended June 30, 2016. These increases in outflows were offset by cost savings due to operational streamlining efforts that reduced 
full  time  equivalents  and  associated  labor  costs  as  well  as  a  decrease  in  payments  to  suppliers  in  relation  to  manufacturing  and 
commercialization costs.   

Net cash inflows in investing activities

Net cash inflows for investing activities were $0.2 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with cash outflows of 
$1.7 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, a decrease of $1.9 million. The $1.9 million decrease in cash outflows was comprised 
of: a $0.8 million reduction in payments for investments in the year ended June 30, 2017; a decrease of $0.2 million for payments for 
licenses  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017;  a  decrease  of  $0.4  million  related  to  lower  payments  for  fixed  assets,  such  as  plant  and 
equipment, in the year ended June 30, 2017; and cash outflows were further decreased with an increase in cash inflows of $0.5 million 
for rental deposits received as proceeds were returned to us in the year ended June 30, 2017 on completion of part of the sublease 
agreement of our New York office space.     

Net cash inflows in financing activities

Net cash inflows for financing activities were $60.0 million for the year ended June 30, 2017, compared with cash inflows for 
financing activities of $62.1 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, a decrease of $2.1 million. The net cash inflows in the year 
ended  June  30,  2017  include  a  $21.6  million  receipt  of  net  proceeds  from  Mallinckrodt  Pharmaceuticals  on  January  6,  2017,  in  a 
private placement, and a $38.5 million receipt of net proceeds from an institutional private placement on March 27, 2017. In the year 

89

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
     
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
ended June 30, 2016, we received net proceeds of $61.8 million from our initial public offering (“IPO”) of the Company’s ordinary 
shares on Nasdaq. Additionally, there was $0.1 million in receipts from employee share option exercises and $0.2 million of payments 
for other associated capital raising costs in the year ended June 30, 2017. 

Comparison of Cash flows for the Year ended June 30, 2016 with the Year ended June 30, 2015

Net cash outflows in operating activities

Net cash outflows for operating activities were $88.0 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $101.0 million 
for the year ended June 30, 2015, a decrease of $13.0 million.  The decrease of $13.0 million was due to a decrease in cash outflows of 
$13.7 million net by a decrease in cash inflows of $0.7 million in the year ended June 30, 2016 compared to the year ended June 30, 
2015.

The $13.7 million reduction in cash outflows comprised: $9.5 million due to a decrease in payments to suppliers in relation to 
research and development costs, primarily for our Tier 2 products, and a decrease in management and administration costs as well as 
payments to employees as a result of management’s ongoing cost reduction efforts in the year ended June 30, 2016; $4.1 million due 
to  payments  to  Osiris  related  to  fair  value  in  excess  of  amounts  originally  recorded  for  contingent  consideration  subsequent  to  the 
business  combination  measurement  period  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015;  and  outflows  for  income  tax  paid  decreased  by  $0.1 
million the year ended June 30, 2016. 

The $0.7 million reduction in cash inflows comprised: interest receipts decreased by $1.9 million as we held a higher proportion 
of  cash  reserves  in  US$  compared  with  A$  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016,  when  compared  with  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015; 
inflows decreased by $0.4 million as we received a one-off insurance recovery in the year ended June 30, 2015; these decreases in 
inflows  were  offset  by  an  increase  in  milestone  payments  received  of  $1.5  million  after  our  licensee,  JCR,  received  full  regulatory 
approval  of  MSC  product  TEMCELL  in  Japan,  during  the  year  ended  June  30,  2016;  and  an  increase  of  inflows  from 
commercialization  payments  received  by  $0.1  million  for  royalty  income  earned  on  sales  of  TEMCELL  in  Japan  during  the  year 
ended June 30, 2016.

Net cash outflows in investing activities

Net cash outflows for investing activities were $1.7 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $5.1 million for 
the year ended June 30, 2015, a decrease of $3.4 million. The $3.4 million decrease in cash outflows was comprised of: $2.1 million 
due to a reduction in payments for business combinations in the year ended June 30, 2016; $1.5 million due to lower payments for 
fixed assets, such as plant and equipment for our clinical trials as well as office and computer equipment for our staff in the year ended 
June 30, 2016; $0.8 million due to a reduction in payments for financial derivatives; these decreases in cash outflows were offset by an 
increase in outflows of $0.8 million for payments for investments in the year ended June 30, 2016 and a reduction of cash inflows by 
$0.2 million as rental deposits paid as security for the sublease agreement for our New York offices were received in the year ended 
June 30, 2015.  

Net cash inflows in financing activities

     Net cash inflows from financing activities were $62.1 million for the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with $45.9 million 
for  the  year  ended  June  30,  2015,  an  increase  of  $16.2  million.   This  increase  primarily  relates  to  a  $68.3  million  receipt  of  gross 
proceeds from our initial public offering (“IPO”) of the Company’s ordinary shares on Nasdaq in November 2015 which was offset by 
a $6.5 million payment for share issue costs in the year ended June 30, 2016, compared with a $45.0 million receipt of gross proceeds 
from Celgene Corporation in a private placement which was offset by a $0.4 million payment for share issue costs in the year ended 
June 30, 2015. This increase in inflows from net proceeds from share issues was offset by a $1.0 million decrease in receipts from 
employee share option exercises. 

Operating Capital Requirements

To  date,  revenues  have  not  been  significant.  We  do  not  know  when,  or  if,  we  will  generate  revenues  from  our  product  sales 
significant enough to generate profits. We do not expect to generate significant revenue from product sales unless and until we obtain 
regulatory  approval  of  and  commercialize  more  of  our  cell-based  product  candidates.  We  anticipate  that  we  will  continue  to  incur 
losses  for  the  foreseeable  future,  and  we  expect  the  losses  to  increase  as  we  continue  the  development  of,  and  seek  regulatory 
approvals  for,  our  cell-based  product  candidates,  and  begin  to  commercialize  any  approved  products  either  directly  ourselves  or 
through a collaborator or partner. We are subject to all of the risks inherent in the development of new cell-based products, and we 
may  encounter  unforeseen  expenses,  difficulties,  complications,  delays  and  other  unknown  factors  that  may  adversely  affect  our 
business.  We expect to  incur additional  costs  associated  with operating as  a  U.S.  public  company.  We anticipate  that  we  will  need 
substantial additional funding in connection with our continuing operations.

90

Over the short term (12 to 24 months) if we are able to successfully partner one or more of our products we would expect our 
research  and  development  expenditure  to  decrease.  We  expect  management  and  administration  expenses  to  remain  relatively 
consistent. Subject to us achieving successful regulatory approval we expect an increase in our total expenses driven by an increase in 
our selling, general and administrative expenses as we move towards commercialization. Therefore we will need additional capital to 
fund  our  operations,  which  we  may  raise  through  a  combination  of  equity  offerings,  debt  financings,  other  third-party  funding, 
marketing and distribution arrangements and other collaborations, strategic alliances and licensing arrangements.

Additional capital may not be available on reasonable terms, if at all. If we are unable to raise additional capital in sufficient 
amounts  or  on  terms  acceptable  to  us,  we  may  have  to  significantly  delay,  scale  back  or  discontinue  the  development  or 
commercialization of one or more of our product candidates. If we raise additional funds through the issuance of debt or additional 
equity  securities,  it  could  result  in  dilution  to  our  existing  shareholders,  increased  fixed  payment  obligations  and  the  existence  of 
securities  with  rights  that  may  be  senior  to  those  of  our  ordinary  shares.  If  we  incur  indebtedness,  we  could  become  subject  to 
covenants  that  would  restrict  our  operations  and  potentially  impair  our  competitiveness,  such  as  limitations  on  our  ability  to  incur 
additional  debt,  limitations  on  our  ability  to  acquire,  sell  or  license  intellectual  property  rights  and  other  operating  restrictions  that 
could  adversely  impact  our  ability  to  conduct  our  business.  Any  of  these  events  could  significantly  harm  our  business,  financial 
condition and prospects.

5.C

Research and Development, Patents and Licenses 

For a description of the amount spent during each of the last three fiscal years on company-sponsored research and development 
activities,  as  well  as  the  components  of  research  and  development  expenses,  see  “Item  5.A  Operating  Results  –  Results  of 
Operations.”

For a description of our research and development process, see “Item 4.B Business Overview.”

5.D

Trend Information 

As a biotechnology company which primarily is still in the development stage, we are subject to costs of our clinical trials and 
other  work  necessary  to  support  an  application  for  regulatory  approval  of  our  product  candidates.  Health  regulators  have  increased 
their focus on product safety. In addition regulators have also increased their attention whether or not a new product offers evidence of 
substantial treatment effect. These developments have led to requests for more clinical trial data, for the inclusion of a higher number 
of patients in clinical trials, and for more detailed analyses of the trials. In light of these developments, we expect these aspects of our 
research and development expenses may need to increase as we continue to fund our programs to the market. Notwithstanding this 
upward  trend,  our  research  and  development  expenses  may  still  fluctuate  from  period  to  period  due  to  varied  rates  of  patient 
enrollment and the timing of our clinical trials as our existing trials are completed and new trials commence. We cannot predict with 
any degree of accuracy the outcome of our research or commercialization efforts.

5.E

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements 

We  did  not  have  during  the  periods  presented,  and  we  do  not  currently  have,  any  off-balance  sheet  arrangements,  other  than 

operating leases as mentioned below, as defined under SEC rules.

5.F

Contractual Obligations and Commitments 

Lease commitment – as lessee:

We  lease  various  offices  under  non-cancellable  operating  leases  expiring  within  1  to  5  years.  The  leases  have  varying  terms, 
escalation clauses and renewal rights. On renewal, the terms of the leases are renegotiated. Excess office space is sub-let to a third 
party also under a non-cancellable operating lease.

 (in thousands)
Operating leases
Total commitments

Total

  Within one year  

5,574   
5,574   

1,733   
1,733   

Later than one 
year but no later 
than three years  

Later than three 
years but no 
later than five 
years

2,954   
2,954   

887   
887   

Later than five 
years

— 
—  

Lease commitments include amounts in A$ and Singapore dollars which have been translated to US$ as of June 30, 2017 using 

foreign exchange rates published by the Reserve Bank of Australia.

91

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lease commitment – as lessor:

Future minimum lease payments expected to be received in relation to a non-cancellable sub-lease of operating leases are set out 

below:

(in thousands)
Operating leases
Total commitment

Total

  Within one year  

Later than one 
year but no later 
than three years  

Later than three 
years but no 
later than five 
years

390   
390   

161   
161   

229   
229   

—   
—   

Later than five 
years

— 
—  

Sub-lease commitment includes amounts in A$ which have been translated to US$ as of June 30, 2017 using foreign exchange 

rate published by the Reserve Bank of Australia.

In  addition  to  the  obligations  in  the  table  above,  as  of  June  30,  2017  we  also  had  the  following  significant  contractual 

obligations described below.

Contingent liabilities

We  will  be  required  to  make  a  milestone  payment  to  Central  Adelaide  Local  Health  Network  Incorporated,  or  CALHNI,  of 
$0.25 million on completion of each Phase 3 (human) clinical trial and $0.35 million on each FDA marketing approval for products in 
the orthopedic field. We will pay CALHNI a commercial arm’s length royalty based on net sales by us of licensed products in the 
orthopedic field each quarter.

We  may  also  be  required  to  pay  consideration  to  CALHNI  upon  successful  completion  of  subsequent  clinical  milestones  in 

fields other than orthopedic. 

We have entered into a number of agreements with other third parties pertaining to intellectual property. Contingent liabilities 
may arise in the future if certain events or developments occur in relation to these agreements. As of June 30, 2017 we have assessed 
these contingent liabilities to be remote.

Capital commitments

We did not have any commitments for future capital expenditure outstanding as of June 30, 2017.

Item 6.

Directors, Senior Management and Employees

(Start of the Remuneration Report for Australian Disclosure Requirements)

Our board of directors (“the Board”) presents the 2016/17 Remuneration Report, which has been prepared in accordance with 
the relevant Corporations Act 2001 (“Corporations Act”) and accounting standard requirements.   The remuneration report has been 
audited  as  required  by  s308  (3C)  of  the  Corporations  Act.   The  remuneration  report  sets  out  remuneration  information  for  our 
company’s key management personnel (“KMP”) for the financial year ended June 30, 2017.

The Board is committed to the principle that KMP remuneration be closely tied to our financial and operational performance.  

Key Remuneration Considerations for the financial year end June 30, 2017

Our corporate focus throughout this year was on delivering operational streamlining activities to enable significant absorption of 
the incremental costs of the MPC-150-IM program in advanced chronic heart failure (CHF) while still delivering critical milestones on 
our Tier 1 programs.   One of the key operational streamlining activities undertaken was a staff restructure undertaken in July 2016. 
This  restructure  led  to  headcount  reducing  from  108  employees  at  June  30,  2016  to  75  employees  at  June  30,  2017.  This  smaller 
workforce  maintained  momentum  throughout  the  year  and  delivered  significant  results  in  our  Tier  1  programs  including  successful 
interim futility analyses for our GVHD and CHF programs. For the financial year ended June 30, 2017, the Board assessed our overall 
Group performance as meeting 70% of objectives.

The previous financial year ended June 30, 2016 was a challenging one. Our team had achieved several significant operational 

goals, while overall performance on our KPIs was assessed as achieving 60% of targets.  As the board of directors (“the Board”) 

92

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
reflected on performance for the year and the circumstances in the company at the time, they determined that performance had not met 
a sufficient threshold for an STI payment to executives. As a result, no executives received an STI payment for performance relating 
to the financial year ended June 30, 2016.  

Our executives started this financial year facing clear performance imperatives: maintain patient recruitment and regulatory 

timelines on all Tier 1 programs, successfully bring the heart-failure program in house, identify partners committed to product 
commercialization, and continue research and technology transfer activities for commercial manufacturing among other goals – all 
while managing in a manner to allow us to spend as little cash as possible. To incentivize around these objectives in a cash-
constrained environment the Board moved beyond our STI program to look at how our LTI program could be leveraged for greater 
impact. Under the previous structure, executive LTI grants were issued with a price premium performance hurdle and vested in three 
tranches over three years subject to continued service. 

A new vesting framework was introduced in which we tailored individual executive LTI grants to vest with the achievement of 
significant objectives relevant to each executive’s role. Collectively these milestones are expected to generate return in the interests of 
shareholders over the longer term, resulting in an even stronger alignment between executive rewards and shareholder returns. Upon 
the Board’s determination that a milestone has been achieved, the options relevant to that milestone will be designated as having 
vested. For the introductory grant under this new framework executive LTI grants were increased to maintain performance-based 
remuneration after a year in which executives did not receive an STI payment.

At the Board level, a reduced fee structure took effect from July 1, 2016 in which the Board Chair fee was reduced and all 

committee fees were suspended.  This fee structure was adopted to conserve cash, with consideration of the Group’s lower market 
capitalization at June 30, 2016, and remains in effect.

6.A

Directors and Senior Management

Mesoblast is a development stage biotechnology company with headquarters and operations in Australia and significant clinical 
trial and manufacturing operations in the United States and Singapore. Our principal activity is the research and development of our 
Mesenchymal Lineage Adult Stem Cell (MLC) technology platform characterized by distinct properties which enable allogeneic or 
“off-the-shelf” use.  Given our business activity and current development stage, we generate losses each year and are net users of cash.

We operate at the forefront of a highly specialized industry in which our people are the key to developing our proprietary adult 
stem  cell  technologies.  As  we  seek  to  attract  and  retain  established  leaders  and  emerging  experts  in  an  innovative  field,  our 
remuneration framework is designed to be competitive worldwide and in particular within the United States life sciences industry – 
where  the  majority  of  our  employees  are  based.  This  remuneration  framework  also  allows  us  to  meet  both  the  expectations  of  our 
global shareholder base and the Australian regulatory framework by which Mesoblast is governed.

Board of Directors

Brian Jamieson, FCA

Chairman of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Mr.  Jamieson  has  served  on  our  board  of  directors  as  Chairman  since  2007.  He  was  Chief  Executive  of  Minter  Ellison 
Melbourne and a partner of the Minter Ellison Revenue Group from 2002 to 2005. He retired as Chief Executive of Minter Ellison 
Melbourne  on  December  31,  2005.  Prior  to  joining  Minter  Ellison,  Mr.  Jamieson  was  Chief  Executive  Officer  at  KPMG  Australia 
from  1998  to  2000,  Managing  Partner  of  KPMG  Melbourne  and  Southern  Regions  from  1993  to  1998  and  Chairman  of  KPMG 
Melbourne from 2001 to 2002. He was also a KPMG Board Member in Australia, and a member of the USA Management Committee. 
Mr. Jamieson is Chairman of Sigma Pharmaceuticals Limited and a Non-Executive Director of the Tatts Group Limited. He is also a 
Director and Treasurer of the Bionics Institute. He is a fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in Australia. With his over 40 
years of experience in providing advice and audit services to a diverse range of public and large private companies, together with his 
service  as  a  chairman  and  director  at  other  companies,  Mr.  Jamieson  provides  leadership,  global  management,  accounting  and 
regulatory expertise.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
Chairman, Sigma Pharmaceuticals Ltd (since 2005)
Non-executive Director, Tatts Group Ltd (since 2005)

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
Non-executive Director, Tigers Realm Coal Ltd (2011 – 2014)
Non-executive Director, OZ Minerals Ltd (2004 – 2015)

93

William Burns, BA

Non-Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Mr.  Burns  has  served  on  our  board  of  directors  since  2014  and  was  appointed  Vice  Chairman  in  2016.  He  spent  his  entire 
management career at the Beecham Group and F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ltd. He was Chief Executive Officer of Roche Pharmaceuticals 
from  2001  to  2009,  when  he  joined  the  board  of  directors  of  F.  Hoffmann-La  Roche  Ltd.  until  he  retired  in  2014.  He  is  a  Non-
Executive Lead Independent Director of Shire PLC, has been a Non-Executive Director of Chugai Pharmaceutical Co., Genentech, 
Crucell, and Chairman of Biotie Therapies Corp. from 2014 until its sale to Acorda Therapeutics Inc. in 2016. Mr. Burns is also a 
member  of  the  Oncology  Advisory  Board  of  the  Universities  of  Cologne/Bonn  in  Germany.  In  2014,  Mr.  Burns  was  appointed  a 
trustee of the Institute of Cancer Research, London, UK, and in 2016 a Governor of The Wellcome Trust in London. His extensive 
experience  in  the  pharmaceutical  industry,  specifically  as  a  member  of  the  board  of  directors  of  other  pharmaceutical  companies, 
provides pharmaceutical, healthcare, industry, leadership and management expertise.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
Non-executive Director, Shire Plc. (since 2010)

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
Chairman, Biotie Therapies Corp. (2014 – 2016)
Director, Roche Holdings AG (2010 – 2014)
Director, Chugai Pharmaceuticals Co. (2002 – 2014)

Donal O’Dwyer, BE, MBA

Non-Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Mr. O’Dwyer has served on our board of directors since 2004. He has over 25 years of experience as a senior executive in the 
global cardiovascular and medical devices industries. From 1996 to 2003, Mr. O’Dwyer worked for Cordis Cardiology, the cardiology 
division  of  Johnson  &  Johnson’s  Cordis  Corporation,  initially  as  its  president  (Europe)  and  from  2000  as  its  worldwide  president. 
Prior  to  joining  Cordis,  Mr.  O’Dwyer  worked  with  Baxter  Healthcare,  rising  from  plant  manager  in  Ireland  to  president  of  the 
Cardiovascular  Group,  Europe,  now  Edwards  Lifesciences.  Mr.  O’Dwyer  is  a  qualified  civil  engineer  with  an  MBA.  He  is  on  the 
board of directors of a number of life sciences companies including Cochlear Limited, Atcor Medical Holdings Ltd, Fisher & Paykel 
Healthcare  Ltd  and  NIB  Health  Funds  Ltd.  With  his  experience  as  a  senior  executive  and  a  director,  as  well  as  his  extensive 
experience  in  the  cardiovascular  and  medical  devices  industries,  Mr.  O’Dwyer  provides  business,  science,  engineering  and 
management expertise.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
Non-executive Director, Cochlear Ltd (since 2005)
Non-executive Director, Atcor Medical Holdings Ltd (since 2004)
Non-executive Director, Fisher & Paykel Healthcare (since 2013)
Non-executive Director, NIB Holding Ltd (since 2016)

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
None

Eric Rose, MD

Non-Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Dr.  Rose  has  served  on  our  board  of  directors  since  2013.  He  is  currently  Executive  Chairman  of  SIGA  Technologies.  From 
2008 through 2012, Dr. Rose served as the Edmond A. Guggenheim Professor and Chairman of the Department of Health Evidence 
and  Policy  at  the  Mount  Sinai  School  of  Medicine.  From  1994  through  2007,  Dr.  Rose  served  as  Chairman  of  the  Department  of 
Surgery and Surgeon-in-Chief of the Columbia Presbyterian Center of New York Presbyterian Hospital. From 1982 through 1992, he 
led the Columbia Presbyterian heart transplantation program in the United States. Dr. Rose currently sits on the board of directors of 
ABIOMED.   His  experience  as  a  surgeon,  researcher  and  businessman  provides  medical,  pharmaceutical,  scientific  and  industry 
expertise.

94

Other current directorships of listed public companies
Executive Chairman, SIGA Technologies, Inc. (since 2007)
Non-executive Director, ABIOMED, Inc. (2007 – 2012, 2014 – present)

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
None

Michael Spooner, BCom, ACA, MAICD

Non-Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Mr.  Spooner  has  served  on  our  board  of  directors  since  2004.  During  this  period  he  has  filled  various  roles  including  as 
Chairman from the date of our Australian IPO in 2004 until 2007, Chair of the Audit and Risk Committee as well as a member of our 
Nomination and Remuneration Committee. Over the past several years, Mr. Spooner has served on the board of directors in various 
capacities  at  several  Australian  and  international  biotechnology  companies,  including  BiVacor  Pty  Ltd  (2009-2013),  Advanced 
Surgical  Design  &  Manufacture  Limited  (2010-2011),  Peplin,  Inc.  (2004-2009),  Hawaii  Biotech,  Inc.  (2010-2012),  Hunter 
Immunology  Limited  (2007-2008),  and  Ventracor  Limited  (2001-2003).  He  is  the  chairman  of  Simavita  Limited  since  May  2016. 
Prior  to  returning  to  Australia  in  2001,  Mr.  Spooner  spent  much  of  his  career  internationally  where  he  served  in  various  roles 
including  as  a  partner  to  PA  Consulting  Group,  a  UK-based  management  consultancy  and  a  Principal  Partner  and  Director  of 
Consulting  Services  with  PricewaterhouseCoopers  (Coopers  &  Lybrand)  in  Hong  Kong.  In  addition  Mr.  Spooner  has  owned  and 
operated several international companies providing services and has consulted to a number of U.S. and Asian public companies. Mr. 
Spooner provides executive management, commercial, business strategy and accounting expertise as well as established relationships 
with investment firms and business communities worldwide.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
Chairman, Simavita Ltd (since 2016)

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
None

Ben-Zion Weiner, BSc, MSc, PhD

Non-Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Dr. Weiner has served on our board of directors since 2012. In a 37-year career at Teva Pharmaceutical Industries Ltd, he held 
various senior research and development positions, including Senior Vice President of Global Research and Development. Dr Weiner 
twice received the Rothschild Prize for industrial innovation - for the development of Copaxone for the treatment of multiple sclerosis, 
and alpha D3 for kidney and bone disorders. He is on the Board of Directors at Novaremed Ltd., the scientific advisory board at E-
QURE  Corp.  and  Breed  IT,  Corp.  and  has  served  on  the  Board  of  Directors  at  Geffen  Biomed  Investments  Ltd  (2010-2013),  XTL 
Biopharmaceuticals  Limited  (2012-2013)  and  Breed  IT,  Corp  (2014).  His  extensive  experience  in  the  pharmaceutical  industry  and 
pharmaceutical companies provides pharmaceutical development, industry, scientific and management expertise.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
None

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
Director, BreedIT (2014)

95

Senior Management

Silviu Itescu, MBBS (Hons), FRACP, FACP, FACRA

Chief Executive Officer

Executive Member of the Board of Directors

Experience and expertise

Dr.  Itescu  is  our  Chief  Executive  Officer  (“CEO”).  He  has  served  our  board  of  directors  since  our  founding  in  2004,  was 
Executive Director from 2007 to 2011, and became CEO and Managing Director in 2011. Prior to founding Mesoblast in 2004, Dr. 
Itescu established an international reputation as a physician scientist in the fields of stem cell biology, autoimmune diseases, organ 
transplantation, and heart failure. He has been a faculty member of Columbia University in New York, and of Melbourne and Monash 
universities in Australia. In 2011, Dr. Itescu was named BioSpectrum Asia Person of the Year. In 2013, he received the inaugural Key 
Innovator Award from the Vatican’s Pontifical Council for Culture for his leadership in translational science and clinical medicine in 
relation to adult stem cell therapy. Dr. Itescu has consulted for various international pharmaceutical companies, has been an adviser to 
biotechnology  and  health  care  investor  groups,  and  has  served  on  the  board  of  directors  of  several  publicly  listed  life  sciences 
companies.

Other current directorships of listed public companies
None

Former directorships of listed public companies within the last 3 years
None

Paul Hodgkinson, MA (Hons) FCA

Chief Financial Officer

Mr.  Hodgkinson  has  served  as  our  Chief  Financial  Officer  (“CFO”)  since  June  2014.  He  has  16  years  of  international 
pharmaceutical experience in the areas of finance, strategic planning, business development and licensing, manufacturing and supply 
chain,  and  procurement.  From  2011  through  2014,  Mr.  Hodgkinson  served  as  the  Country  Chief  Financial  Officer  for  the  Novartis 
Australia and New Zealand, or ANZ, group of companies and divisions, which was comprised of Alcon, Sandoz, and the Novartis 
Vaccines  and  Diagnostics,  Consumer  Health,  Animal  Health,  and  Pharmaceuticals  divisions.  From  1998  to  2006,  Mr.  Hodgkinson 
held  a  number  of  leadership  roles  with  AstraZeneca  in  the  United  Kingdom,  including  Global  Licensing  Finance  Director,  before 
serving  as  CFO  for  AstraZeneca  Australia  from  2006  through  2011.  Mr.  Hodgkinson  is  a  member  of  the  Institute  of  Chartered 
Accountants in Australia, is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants of England and Wales and holds a Master’s degree in 
engineering from Cambridge University. He has also undertaken executive leadership programs at the Harvard Business School and 
INSEAD.

Peter Howard, BSc, LLB (Hons)

General Counsel

Mr. Howard has served as our General Counsel and Corporate Executive since July 2011. As external counsel and partner at 
Australian law firm, Middletons (now, K&L Gates), Mr. Howard has been integrally involved with Mesoblast since its inception and 
public  listing  on  the  ASX  in  2004.  More  generally,  Mr.  Howard  has  extensive  experience  with  many  biopharmaceutical  firms  and 
major  research  institutions,  covering  public  listings,  private  financings,  strategic,  licensing,  intellectual  property  and  mergers  and 
acquisition  activities.  He  has  done  so  in  several  roles,  including  as  a  partner  at  a  major  law  firm,  entrepreneur,  director  and  senior 
executive.

Donna Skerrett, MD

Chief Medical Officer

Dr.  Skerrett  has  served  as  our  Chief  Medical  Officer  since  2011,  and  she  previously  held  roles  at  Mesoblast  in  Clinical  and 
Regulatory  Affairs  since  2004.  Dr.  Skerrett  has  20  years  of  combined  experience  in  transfusion  medicine,  cellular  therapy,  and 
transplantation. Prior to joining Mesoblast, Dr. Skerrett was Director of Transfusion Medicine and Cellular Therapy at Weill Cornell 
Medical Center in New York from 2004 to 2011, and she served as Associate Director of Transfusion Medicine and Director of Stem 
Cell  Facilities  at  Columbia  University’s  New  York-Presbyterian  Hospital  from  1999  to  2004.  She  has  been  an  advisor  to  the  New 
York  State  Department  of  Health  on  the  Progenitor  Cell  Committee  since  1989  and  has  been  Chair  of  the  Governor’s  Council  on 
Blood and Transfusion Services since 2007, and serves on the Executive Committee of the Alliance for Regenerative Medicine.

96

Paul Simmons, PhD

Head of Research and New Product Development

Dr.  Simmons  has  served  as  our  Head  of  Research  and  New  Product  Development  since  2011.  He  has  nearly  30  years  of 
experience in stem cell research, especially research in basic hematopoiesis and in precursor cells for the stromal system of the bone 
marrow, and served as President of the International Society of Stem Cell Research, or ISSCR, from 2006 to 2007. Prior to joining 
Mesoblast, Dr. Simmons held the C. Harold and Lorine G. Wallace Distinguished University Chair at the University of Texas Health 
from 2008 to 2011 and served as the inaugural Professor and Director of the Centre for Stem Cell Research at the Brown Foundation 
Institute of Molecular Medicine from 2006 to 2011. Dr. Simmons is, or has served as, an associate editor, a member of the editorial 
board,  or  a  reviewer  on  multiple  scientific  and  medical  journals  including  Experimental  Hematology,  Cytotherapy  and  Stem  Cell 
Research, Cell Stem Cell, Stem Reports, Science and Nature.

John McMannis, PhD

Head of Manufacturing

Dr. McMannis has served as our Head of Manufacturing since 2011. He has 27 years of experience in clinical cellular therapy 
trials in both academic and commercial environments. Before joining Mesoblast, Dr. McMannis served at the University of Texas MD 
Anderson Cancer Center as a Professor of Medicine from 1999 to 2011, and as the Director of the Cell Therapy Laboratory from 1999 
to 2011, and as the Technical Director of the Cord Blood Bank from 2008 to 2011. Before his tenure at the University of Texas MD 
Anderson  Cancer  Center,  Dr.  McMannis  was  a  Senior  Director  Technical  Affairs  at  the  Immunotherapy  Division  of  Baxter  and 
Therapy  Scientist  at  COBE  BCT  (now  Terumo  BCT).  Dr.  McMannis  has  served  on  the  scientific  advisory  boards  at  BioSafe  SA, 
Biolife Solutions, Inc., and General Electric and on the board of directors for the American Association of Blood Banks, or AABB, 
and the National Marrow Donor Program, or NMDP, which operates the “Be the Match” donor program.

Geraldine Storton, Bsc, MMS, MBA

Head of Regulatory Affairs and Quality Management

Ms.  Storton  is  a  seasoned  pharmaceutical  executive  with  more  than  24  years’  experience  across  the  full  value  chain  of 
Pharmaceutical and Medical Device Research and Development, production and commercialization worldwide. She has an extensive 
background in regulatory affairs and quality, most recently as a consultant to cell therapy companies. Prior to this, Ms. Storton held 
executive  roles  at  Hospira,  and  its  predecessor  companies  in  both  regulatory  affairs  and  quality,  with  a  focus  on  major  program 
management. As Vice President, Program Management, Quality, at Hospira headquarters in Chicago, she led a company-wide quality 
remediation  program  to  improve  compliance  in  manufacturing  across  15  facilities  worldwide.  As  Regional  Director,  Commercial 
Quality ANZ, Asia and Japan, Ms. Storton was responsible for quality oversight and management of all products sold in Asia Pacific 
countries. Her responsibilities included regulatory compliance, batch release, field actions, complaints management, change control, 
due diligence and new product launch. As director of global regulatory operations, Ms. Storton managed development and registration 
of new products and on-market management of the existing product portfolio for all Hospira’s products developed or manufactured 
within Asia Pacific for global distribution. She joined Mesoblast in December 2015.

Michael Schuster, MBA

Pharma Partnering

Mr.  Schuster,  who  joined  Mesoblast  in  2004,  leads  the  Group's  partnering  discussions.  Previously  he  was  the  head  of  the 
Group's investor relations outreach program and was part of the founding executive team at both Mesoblast Limited and Angioblast 
Systems, Inc. Mr. Schuster was Executive Vice President of Global Therapeutic Programs from 2010 to 2013 and was the Director of 
Business Development and Vice President of Operations from 2004 to 2010. He holds an undergraduate degree in science from Tufts 
University,  a  Master’s  degree  in  Immunology  &  Microbiology  from  New  York  Medical  College,  and  an  MBA  from  Fordham 
University in New York.

There  are  no  family  relationships  among  any  of  our  directors  and  senior  management.  The  business  address  of  each  of  our 

directors and senior management is Mesoblast Limited, Level 38, 55 Collins Street, Melbourne, VIC 3000, Australia.

Key Management Personnel

Mesoblast has developed into a late stage biopharmaceutical company with three programs in active Phase 3 clinical studies to 

treat serious and life-threatening illnesses. Throughout this evolution the CEO and our board of directors have set the strategy and 
direction of our company. With 75 employees globally, our company has a flat structure with 13 employees directly reporting to the 
CEO, 8 of whom form the executive management team.

97

Key  management  personnel,  as  defined  in  the  International  Accounting  Standards  24  ‘Related  Party  Disclosures’  and  the 
Australian  Corporations  Act  2001,  have  authority  and  responsibility  for  planning,  directing  and  controlling  the  activities  of  our 
company, directly or indirectly, and include any director (whether executive or otherwise).  With this definition in mind, the Board has 
determined  that  in  addition  to  themselves  and  the  CEO,  the  Chief  Financial  Officer  (CFO),  Paul  Hodgkinson,  should  also  be 
designated as key management personnel.

In summary, our key management personnel for the financial year ended June 30, 2017 are listed in table below:

Name
Non-executive directors

Brian Jamieson

William Burns

Donal O’Dwyer

Eric Rose

Michael Spooner

Ben-Zion Weiner

Executive director

Silviu Itescu

Other executive KMP

Position

Change from last year

Chair, board of directors
Member, Nomination and Remuneration Committee
Member, Audit and Risk Committee

No change

Vice Chair
Member, Science and Technology Committee

Transitioned from Non-executive 
Director to Vice Chair, effective 
September 1, 2016

Non-executive Director
Chair, Nomination and Remuneration Committee
Member, Audit and Risk Committee

Non-executive Director
Chair, Science and Technology Committee

Non-executive Director
Chair, Audit and Risk Committee
Member, Nomination and Remuneration Committee

No change

No change

No change

Non-executive Director
Member, Science and Technology Committee

No change

Chief Executive Officer 
Executive Director

No change

Paul Hodgkinson

Chief Financial Officer

No change

Directors’ Interests

The relevant interest of each director, as defined by section 608 of the Corporations Act, in the share capital of Mesoblast, as 
notified  by  the  directors  to  the  ASX  in  accordance  with  section  205G(1)  of  the  Corporations  Act,  at  the  date  of  this  report  is  as 
follows:

Director
William Burns
Silviu Itescu
Brian Jamieson
Donal O'Dwyer
Eric Rose
Michael Spooner
Ben-Zion Weiner

Mesoblast Limited 
ordinary shares 
28,000 
68,244,642 
625,000 
875,730 
— 
1,050,000 
40,000 

Options over 
Mesoblast Limited 
Ordinary Shares 
80,000 
— 
— 
255,912 
80,000 
— 
80,000  

98

 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
Meeting of Directors

The number of meetings our board of directors (including committee meetings of directors) held during the year ended June 30, 

2017 and the number of meetings attended by each director were:

Board of Directors

Audit and Risk 
Committee

Nomination and 
Remuneration 
Committee

Science and 
Technology 
Committee

Director
William Burns
Silviu Itescu
Brian Jamieson
Donal O'Dwyer
Eric Rose
Michael Spooner
Ben-Zion Weiner

A*
14
14
14
14
14
14
14

B*
10
14
14
13
13
13
12

A
    —  
    —  
5
5
    —  
5
    —  

B
    —  
    —  
5
5
    —  
5
    —  

A
    —  
    —  
4
4
    —  
4
    —  

B
    —  
    —  
4
4
    —  
4
    —  

A
1
1
    —  
    —  
1
    —  
1

B
1
1
    —  
    —  
1
    —  
1

A = Number of meetings held during the time the director held office or was a member of the committee.

B = Number of meetings attended by board/committee members

* =  This includes both in-person scheduled meetings as well teleconference meetings organized on an ad-hoc basis.   There were a 

total of 11 scheduled meetings for the year.  Each director attended every in-person, scheduled meeting.  

— = Not a member of the relevant committee

NB: Certain directors attended various committee meetings by invitation in addition to those shown above. 

6.B

Compensation

Remuneration Governance

Role of the Board of Directors and the Nomination and Remuneration Committee

The  Board  is  responsible  for  Mesoblast’s  remuneration  strategy  and  approach.   The  Board  established  the  Nomination  and 

Remuneration Committee as a committee of the Board.  It is primarily responsible for making recommendations to the Board on:

•

•

•

•

•

•

Board appointments

Non-executive director fees

Executive remuneration framework

Remuneration for executive directors, namely the CEO, and other key executives

Short-term and long-term incentive awards

Share ownership plans

The Nomination and Remuneration Committee’s objective is to ensure remuneration policies are fair and competitive and have 
regard  for  industry  benchmarks  whilst  being  aligned  with  the  objectives  of  our  company.  The  Nomination  and  Remuneration 
Committee seeks independent advice from remuneration consultants as and when it deems necessary (see below).

Use of Remuneration Consultants

During the financial year ended June 30, 2017, the Nomination and Remuneration Committee engaged KPMG to provide the 

following remuneration advice to assist the Board in decision making: 

•

•

review of the Remuneration Report for the financial year ended June 30, 2016; and

disclosure advice for KMP.  

The  advice  provided  by  KPMG  does  not  constitute  a  ‘remuneration  recommendation’  as  defined  in  section  9B  of  the 
Corporations Act as it relates to the provision of information and/or advice on the taxation, legal or accounting implications of specific 
elements of the remuneration framework.

99

 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Executive Director Remuneration

Our aim is to establish a board of directors comprised of global expertise in the biopharmaceutical industry and capital markets.  
We have six NEDs, three based in Australia, one in the United States, one in Switzerland and one in Israel. Our NED fees are based 
on the responsibilities and work involved with directing a company of Mesoblast’s technological and geographical complexity, our 
financial position, regulatory and compliance context, and market practice.

NED Fees and Other Benefits

NEDs receive fixed fees for their services, as approved by shareholders at the 2013 Annual General Meeting, not to exceed a 
maximum fee pool of A$1,250,000. A board and committee fee structure was adopted on November 1, 2013 based on advice provided 
by Towers Watson in October 2012 with reference to companies of comparable size and complexity.

In consideration of our lower market capitalization at June 30, 2016, and with a goal of conserving cash, NEDs proposed that a 
reduced fee structure take effect from July 1, 2016.  Under this revised fee structure the Board Chair fee is reduced to A$250,000 per 
annum and committee fees are suspended for all other NEDs.  This fee structure remains in place.   

Position
Chair
Vice Chair*
Member
* William Burns transitioned from Non-executive Director to Vice Chair, effective September 1, 2016

— 
— 
— 

Board of
Directors
A$250,000
A$175,000
A$128,250

From July 1, 2016 to June 30, 2017
Nomination
and
Remuneration
Committee

Audit and
Risk
Committee

Science and
Technology
Committee

— 
— 
—  

— 
— 
— 

The Mesoblast Constitution allows the Board to approve a Special Exertion payment to NEDs who perform duties in excess of 
their expected role. Effective January 1, 2016, the Board approved payment of a special exertion fee to Eric Rose of US$ 12,500 per 
month in recognition of a significantly higher level of involvement in our company.   Initially approved through June 30, 2016, the 
Board approved extending this fee through December 31, 2016.   For the purposes of the Corporations Act, this payment is made as 
part of  Dr.  Rose’s  director’s  remuneration.   The Board  considers  the payment reasonable given  Mesoblast’s circumstances  (i.e. the 
nature  of  the  industry  that  Mesoblast  operates  in,  and  nature  and  position  of  Mesoblast  within  the  industry)  and  the  director’s 
circumstances (i.e. the position and responsibilities of the director). 

NEDs  do  not  receive  performance-related  remuneration  and  are  not  provided  with  retirement  benefits  other  than  statutory 
superannuation.  NEDs are reimbursed for costs directly related to conducting Mesoblast business. The key terms of NED service are 
documented in a letter of appointment to the Board.

Performance Review

The Board conducts periodic performance reviews of the Board and its operations as a whole. The last review was conducted 
during the financial year ended June 30, 2016. This review encompassed feedback on the Chairman and individual NEDs as well as 
consideration  of  Board  succession  planning,  diversity  and  the  breadth  and  sufficiency  of  skills  represented  on  the  Board.  Our  next 
review is scheduled to be finalized by November 2017 with a similar scope of topics as previously covered.

Executive Remuneration – Framework 

Mesoblast’s  executive  remuneration  framework  is  designed  to  attract,  reward  and  retain  a  highly  specialized  group  of 

individuals working at the top of their respective fields in varied geographic locations.  

100

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
Mesoblast  applies  the  following  market  and  performance-based  remuneration  framework  for  all  employees.   This  provides 
cohesion across our global team through shared objectives and consistent communication.  Our application of this framework for our 
KMP in the financial year ended June 30, 2017 is detailed in a subsequent section labelled ‘Executive Remuneration – Outcomes’.

Description

Fixed Pay

to  each 
the 

role’s 
Set  according 
responsibilities, 
incumbent’s 
experience  and  qualifications,  their 
performance 
role  and 
regional market relativities.

the 

in 

Performance-based Remuneration

Short-term Incentives
Set at a target relative to fixed pay 
individual 
for 
and 
paid 
annual 
against 
performance 
individual  key 
corporate  and 
(KPIs).  
performance 
Executive  KPIs  are 
typically 
milestone  related  as  befitting  a 
development stage company.

indicators 

Long-term Incentives

Set  at  a  target  relative  to  fixed 
pay  based  on  value  at  the  time 
of  grant  with  consideration  to 
internal  relativities.   Delivers 
value  to  the  participant  through 
share 
growth.  Only 
price 
available to select roles.

Considerations

Supplemented  by  statutory  and 
customary benefits relevant to each 
region 
in 
Australia;  medical  insurance  in  the 
US.)

(e.g.,  superannuation 

STIs  are  typically  set  at  a  smaller 
target 
proportion  of  our 
remuneration 
to 
conserve cash outflow.

than  LTIs 

total 

The  Board  exercises  discretion 
to  adjust  LTI  grants  from  the 
remuneration  mix  as 
target 
needed.  
if  a 
instance, 
decline  in  share  price  would 
incongruous  LTI 
produce  an 
of 
number 
quantum 
options).

(i.e., 

For 

Review

Oversight

Reviewed  annually  for  changes  in 
the 
market 
individual’s 
and 
growth in the role.

and 
performance 

relativities 

approved 

Individual  outcomes  are  reviewed 
and 
the 
by 
Nomination  & 
Remuneration 
Committee and then the Board.

first 

Annual  outcomes  are  assessed  by 
the  CEO  (for  his  direct  reports) 
and the Board (for the CEO) based 
on  Group  performance  against 
KPIs. 

Grants  are  reviewed  annually 
based  on  the  nature  of  the  role, 
its  contribution  to  long  term 
objectives 
individual 
and 
performance.

Individual  outcomes  are  reviewed  and  approved  first  by  the 
Nomination & Remuneration Committee and then the Board.

Delivered as

Cash.

Cash.

Mesoblast  equity  with  vesting 
conditions that vary according to 
role.

KMP Target Remuneration Mix

The CEO and CFO are designated as KMP due to the particular nature of their roles in planning, directing and controlling the 

activities of our company.  Their target remuneration mix is as follows:

Name
Silviu Itescu
Paul Hodgkinson

Fixed Remuneration %    

At-Risk STI %

At-Risk LTI %

2017

2016

2017

2016

2017

2016

50     
40     

50     
40     

50     
20     

50     
20     

—     
40     

— 
40  

The  Board  has  customized  the  CEO’s  remuneration  mix  in  comparison  with  other  executive  KMP  in  recognition  that  he 
continues to be Mesoblast’s single largest shareholder. The Board believes the CEO has sufficient exposure to our company’s share 
performance to align his interests in value creation, and he therefore does not currently participate in the LTI. The Board reviews the 
CEO’s remuneration package annually, including the remuneration mix.

The Nomination and Remuneration Committee retained KPMG to conduct a benchmarking study on CEO remuneration in July 
2015.   The  findings  of  this  exercise  show  the  CEO’s  total  remuneration  package  is  positioned  below  the  25th  percentile  of  the 
comparator  group  based  on  the  exchange  rate  at  that  time.  The  comparator  group  included  other  pre-revenue  biopharmaceutical 
companies in the US with comparable expenditure levels with regard to market capitalization.  

101

 
 
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
   
The  CFO’s  remuneration  mix  is  a  more  typical  executive  remuneration  package,  reflecting  a  significant  emphasis  on  LTI  as 

befitting a company in the development stage when conserving cash is a priority.

Performance-Based Remuneration

Short-Term Incentives (STIs)

To align the organization around key shorter-term objectives that drive long-term shareholder value, our Board sets annual key 
performance indicators (“KPI”) for the CEO which also serve as our company’s objectives.  At the end of the financial year the Board 
assesses the overall Company performance, and the CEO’s individual performance against these KPIs. The achievement of these KPIs 
is  assessed  in  the  context  of  total  corporate  performance  against  budget  which  ensures  cost  control  is  always  a  key  part  of  the 
performance framework and is regularly measured and reported.

The Board approved KPIs for the CEO in the following performance categories for the financial year ended June 30, 2017.  The 
Board assessed the CEO’s performance on these KPIs for the financial year ended June 30, 2017 as achieving 75% of his target STI. 
The  CFO  was  assessed  as  achieving  70%  of  his  target  STI.   The  Board’s  assessment  rationale  is  summarized  below  with  details 
provided  in  the  section  “Important  Corporate  Developments  –  Fiscal  year  2017  to  date”  in  “Item  4.A  History  and  Development  of 
Mesoblast”. 

KPI
Product management of Tier 1 and Tier 2 studies -  each 
with individual enrolment, partnering and regulatory 
targets

Manufacturing achievements
     • Advances in technology transfer
     • Progress with commercial manufacturing 
capabilities
Strategy, Financial and Risk Management
     • company performance versus budget
     • development of strategic and capital market 
initiatives

Organizational development

  Percentage

Achievement

Justification

Successful 
interim analyses 
and progress 
with patient 
enrollment.  
Equity purchase 
agreement with 
Mallinckrodt.
Progress with 
three-
dimensional 
bioreactors

Raise capital 
and control 
expenditure
Reduced 
headcount from 
108 to 75

Partially 
achieved

Substantially 
achieved

Substantially 
achieved

Achieved

50

10

35

5

102

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following table outlines a summary of the 2017 Short-Term Incentive Plan:

What is the 2017 STI?

An  incentive  plan  under  which  eligible  employees  are  (subject  to  satisfaction  of  specified 
performance measures) granted a cash amount, which is based on a percentage range of each 
participant’s  fixed  remuneration  (determined  according  to  role  and  ability  to  influence  our 
performance).  Performance  is  assessed  against  a  combination  of  company  and  individual 
measures.

When  is  the  2017  STI  grant  paid  to 
eligible employees?

The STI amount will be paid, in the three month period ended September 30, 2017, to each 
participant  who  satisfies  applicable  performance  measures,  following  assessment  of 
performance against the applicable measures for the financial year ended June 30, 2017.

Who participates in the 2017 STI?

All employees hired on or before March 31, 2017, including the CEO and CFO, are eligible 
for consideration. Employees hired during the year are recognized on a pro-rata basis.

Why  does  our  board  of  directors 
consider  the  2017  STI  an  appropriate 
incentive?

The STI is a globally recognized form of reward for management, aimed at ensuring focus 
and alignment our goals and strategy. Based on both company and individual measures, and 
in conjunction with other factors, our board of directors believes that it helps encourage and 
reward high performance.

What  are  the  performance  conditions 
under the 2017 STI?

Individual  performance  is  measured  against  the  achievement  of  individual  KPIs,  key 
corporate and budgetary milestones and achievement of strategic goals all of which lead to 
long-term shareholder value creation.

What  is  the  relationship  between  our 
performance and allocation of STIs?

At  the  end  of  the  financial  year  our  board  of  directors  assesses  our  overall  company 
performance based on the achievement of our CEO’s KPIs. This assessment will adjust how 
much  of  our  bonus  pool  is  eligible  for  allocation.   For  the  financial  year  ended  June  30, 
2017, the Board assessed our overall Company performance as meeting 70% of objectives. 
People Leaders evaluate employees and make recommendations of the bonus amount each 
employee should receive based on the bonus pool they have available for allocation and with 
reference  to  individual  target  bonus  opportunities  and  individual  performance  against 
objectives. 

What  is  the  period  over  which  our 
performance is assessed?

The  assessment  period  is  the  financial  year  preceding  the  payment  date  of  the  STI  (July  1 
through June 30).

Long-Term Incentives (LTIs). 

In  designing  a  LTI  mechanism  that  is  appropriate  to  our  global  team  where  59%  of  our  employees  are  based  in  the  United 

States, we seek to balance:

•

•

•

•

Australian practice  and  governance  expectations,  where LTI  are  expected  to  have  performance  hurdles  other  than  price 
and employment milestones alone;

United States practices, where options are a widely distributed remuneration component, typically issued without a price 
premium, performance hurdles or milestones, and which vest on a more regular basis (e.g. rolling monthly basis);

a strong preference for a single reward mechanism to maintain executive cohesion and teamwork; and

alignment with driving shareholder value.

Since July 1, 2015 Mesoblast has used a single LTI plan, our Employee Share Option Plan (“ESOP”).  The ESOP was approved 
by shareholders at the AGM held in November 2016.  LTIs consist of options over ordinary shares of our company under the rules of 
the ESOP. Recognizing that option grants in the US where the majority of our LTI participants reside typically have a ten year term, 
grants  made  since  July  10,  2015  have  had  a  seven  year  term.   The  Board  considers  the  appropriate  term  at  the  time  each  grant  is 
approved.

As a development stage company, the achievement of significant milestones are key drivers in helping us get to major objectives 
such  as  product  approval.  For  the  financial  year  ended  June  30,  2017  the  Board  introduced  a  milestone  vesting  framework  for 
executive LTI grants. We believe this approach is appropriate at this time. In this structure, we tailor individual LTI grants to vest with 
the achievement of objectives relevant to each executive’s role at an exercise price per share that is equal to the fair market value at 
grant  date.   Upon  the  Board’s  determination  that  the  milestone  has  been  achieved,  the  options  are  designated  as  vested.  We  have 

103

adopted  this  approach  to  strengthen  the  link  between  our  executive  LTI  rewards  and  achievements  which  we  expect  to  generate 
shareholder returns.  

LTI  allocations  are  determined  with  consideration  to  the  nature  of  the  role  within  our  organization,  market  value  of  LTI 
allocations for comparable roles, previous grants made and the remuneration mix described above where a modified Black-Scholes 
calculation is used to determine the value of the option. If LTI valuations decline due to a decline in our share price the Board has 
taken a view that this should not automatically drive an increase in LTI grants to maintain the desired remuneration mix. In recent 
years  LTI  grants  have  remained  stable  in  number  of  options  reflecting  the  Board’s  assessment  that  this  grant  size  will  deliver  the 
desired value to the participants over time.  

In determining executive LTI allocations for the financial year ended June 30, 2017, the executive remuneration outcome of the 
previous financial year was considered.   For the financial year ended June 30, 2016, the Board determined that while the Group had 
achieved significant operational outcomes, when assessed in the context of our cash position at that time, performance had not met a 
sufficient threshold for an STI payment to executives. As a result, no executives received an STI payment for the financial year ended 
June 30, 2016.  In recognition of the significant performance expectations on the executive team, the Board introduced the milestone 
vesting framework and enhanced the number of options granted to achieve the desired remuneration mix for the financial year ended 
June 30, 2017. 

Outside  this  executive  milestone  framework  we  issue  traditional  LTIs  to  select  other  participants  at  a  price  per  share  that  is 
typically 10% higher than the five day volume weighted average share price calculated at grant date.   The options generally vest in 
three equal tranches over three years.  This is an important remuneration component in the biotechnology sector in which allows us to 
attract and retain the people we need.  We believe this approach is appropriate at this stage and that applying additional performance 
hurdles to our traditional LTI grants would make it problematic for us to attract and retain the people we need, particularly in the US, 
and would ultimately be negative for our company.  This is an area we continue to review and assess.

The following is a summary of the key features of the LTI instrument, our ESOP:

What is the ESOP?

An  incentive  plan  under  which  eligible  participants  are  granted  options  over  our  ordinary 
shares.

Why  does  our  board  of  directors 
consider the ESOP an appropriate long-
term incentive?

The  ESOP  is  designed  to  reward  participants  for  out-performance  and  to  align  long-term 
interests  of  shareholders  and  participants,  by  linking  a  significant  proportion  of  at-risk 
remuneration to our future performance.  

Who participates in the ESOP?

All  eligible  participants,  who  are  in  positions  to  influence  achievement  of  our  long-  term 
outcomes and where warranted by market practice for attraction and retention.  

What are the key features of the ESOP? Pricing and vesting conditions are determined by a participant’s designation as either an: 

In  what  circumstances  are  ESOP 
entitlements forfeited?

•
•

executive participant
other participant  

The  ESOP  will  be  forfeited  upon  cessation  of  employment  prior  to  the  conclusion  of  the 
performance  period  in  circumstances  where  a  participant  is  a  “bad  leaver”.   Bad  leaver  is 
defined as part of the ESOP rules and includes serious misconduct. If the Board designate a 
former  employee  as  a  bad  leaver  they  forfeit  all  rights,  entitlements  and  interests  in  any 
unexercised options, both vested and unvested. Otherwise a leaver may retain vested options 
subject  to  exercising  the  option  within  60  days  of  cessation  of  employment  or  within  a 
longer  period  if  so  determined  by  the  Board.   Unvested  options  lapse  immediately  upon 
cessation of employment.

104

What  are  the  performance  conditions 
under the ESOP?

In the financial year ended June 30, 2017, executive LTI grants were issued with an exercise 
price  per  share  that  was  equal  to  the  fair  market  value  at  grant  date  and  vest  with  the 
achievement  of  milestones  relevant  to  each  executive’s  role.  Typically  each  executive  has 
two or three milestones, each of which is assigned to a tranche of options. Milestones from 
our initial grant under this framework relate to achievements such as: progress with patient 
enrollment  for  a  specific  program,  signing  a  partnering  agreement,  completing  an  interim 
analysis, submitting a regulatory filing. 
Traditional options granted to other participants are issued with an exercise price per share 
that  is  typically  10%  higher  than  the  five  day  volume  weighted  average  share  price 
calculated at grant date and vest over three years.  
In addition participants have to remain in employment with the Group for the LTIs to vest.

Why  did  our  board  of  directors  choose 
the 
performance 
above 
conditions/hurdles? 

A  participant’s  designation  as  an  executive  participant  or  other  participant  is  determined 
according to their seniority and the nature of their responsibilities.   The milestones selected 
as  vesting  milestones  for  our  executives  are  expected  to  generate  positive  shareholder 
returns, thereby creating direct alignment between executive and shareholder rewards.

What  is  the  relationship  between  our 
performance and allocation of options

What is the maximum number of 
options that may be granted to a 
participant in the ESOP?

When do the options vest?

Equity-based remuneration is an integral part of remuneration in the biotechnology industry 
as they reward share price growth and seek to conserve cash. With the executive milestone 
vesting  framework,  executives  must  achieve  their  milestones,  to  the  satisfaction  of  the 
Board,  for  the  Options  to  vest.   The  value  of  the  remuneration  fluctuates  with  our  share 
price. The Board believes that share price growth is an appropriate measure of success as it 
is  the  prime  driver  of  investment  in  the  biotechnology  sector,  and  is  simply  and  clearly 
rewarded  using  equity-based  remuneration.  In  the  financial  year  ended  June  30,  2017 
executive  LTI  grants  were  increased  to  maintain  performance-based  remuneration  after  a 
year in which executives did not receive an STI payment.

The maximum number of options that may be granted to each participant is determined by 
the Board, subject to applicable legal thresholds.

For  executive  participants  with  milestone  vesting  grants,  the  Board  has  authority  to 
designate that options have vested when the related milestone has been met.
For other participants, options typically vest in three equal tranches, one year, two years and 
three years after the date of grant, provided performance conditions are met.

How are the shares provided to 
participants under the ESOP?

Shares are issued to the participant upon the holder exercising their option and paying the 
exercise price to us (once all vesting conditions are satisfied).

Is the benefit of participation in the 
ESOP affected by changes in the share 
prices?

Yes, the value participants receive through participation in the ESOP will be reduced if the 
share price falls during the performance period and will increase if the share price rises over 
the performance period.

Employment Agreements

The employment of our CEO and CFO are formalized in employment agreements, the key terms of which are as follows:

Name
CEO (Silviu Itescu)

CFO (Paul Hodgkinson)

Term

Notice period

Termination benefit

 Initial term of 3 years 
commencing April 1, 2014, and 
continuing subject to a 12 
months’ notice period.
 An ongoing employment 
agreement until notice is given 
by either party.

12 months 

12 months base salary

6 months 

6 months base salary

On termination of employment, key management personnel are entitled to receive their statutory entitlements of accrued annual 

and long service leave, together with any superannuation benefits.

There is no entitlement to a termination payment in the event of resignation or removal for misconduct.  

105

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The employment of the executive team is also formalized in employment contracts.  Three members of the executive team have 
employment  contracts  with  initial  terms  ranging  from  15  to  25  months,  all  of  which  have  been  fulfilled,  and  with  notice  periods 
ranging  from  six  to  twelve  months.  The  remaining  members  have  continuous  employment  contracts  with  no  fixed  term  and  notice 
periods ranging from two to six months.

Executive Remuneration – Outcomes

Relationship between performance and executive KMP remuneration

Mesoblast  is  specializing  in  the  development  of  biologic  products  for  the  broad  field  of  regenerative  medicine  based  on  its 
proprietary  cell-based  technologies.   When  assessing  company  performance  in  light  of  remuneration,  traditional  financial  metrics, 
such  as  profitability,  total  shareholder  return  (TSR),  short-term  share  price  movements,  and  earnings  per  share  (EPS)  are  not 
meaningful, nor do they accurately reflect the performance of our company.  Our long term value creation occurs through progressive 
achievement of well-defined milestones that are critical for achieving product approval and commercialization, in a timely fashion and 
within  budget.   Annually  the  Board  prioritizes  the  milestones  for  the  coming  year  as  outlined  in  the  discussion  on  STIs.   These 
milestones form the CEO’s KPIs which establish the basis for all STI payments.

As of June 30, 2017 we have cash and cash equivalents of US$45.8 million. During the year Mesoblast entered into an equity 
purchase  agreement  with  Mallinckrodt  Pharmaceuticals  in  which  20.04  million  new  shares  were  issued  raising  US$21.7  million  in 
December 2016, we successfully completed a fully underwritten institutional placement of 26.25 million new shares raising US$40 
million in March 2017.   Subsequent to the year ended June 30, 2017 we announced a fully underwritten entitlement offer to existing 
eligible shareholders (on a 1 for 12 basis) in Australia and New Zealand and institutional shareholders in certain other countries in 
private placements. US$38.2 million of net proceeds from the entitlement offer is expected to be received and recognized in cash and 
cash equivalents in September 2017. Under our agreement with JCR, we receive royalties and other payments at predefined thresholds 
of cumulative net sales of TEMCELL® HS. Inj., a registered product of JCR Pharmaceuticals Co Ltd launched, for the treatment of 
acute graft versus host disease in children and adults in Japan.  The funding framework detailed above has enabled us to fund clinical 
programs  towards  well-defined  milestones.  To  date  we  have  not  utilized  any  debt  financing  and  our  sources  of  funding  for  the 
programs  have  predominantly  been  through  capital  raisings  from  institutional  and  sophisticated  investors,  the  signing  of  a 
collaboration with Teva, the execution of share placement agreements with Celgene Corporation and Mallinckrodt Pharmaceuticals, 
an initial public offering on the NASDAQ and to a lesser extent milestone receipts and royalties, government grants and research and 
development tax credits.  

The table and chart below detail Company performance on a market capitalization basis, against executive key management 

personnel short-term at-risk compensation:

Share price (ASX:MSB)
  – closing at June 30
  – high for the year
  – low for the year
  – share price volatility (annual)
Market capitalization at June 30 (in millions)
  – increase/(decrease) – in $ millions
  – increase/(decrease) – as %
Short-term incentives – % of target paid to CEO
Short-term incentives – as % of base salary paid to CEO
Short-term incentives – % of target paid to CFO
Short-term incentives – as % of base salary paid to CFO

2017

2016

2015

2014

2013

A$2.08
A$3.44
A$1.03
52%
A$891
A$479
116%  
75%
75%
70%
35%

A$1.08
A$4.06
A$1.01
60%
A$412
(A$855)
(67%)
—
—
—
—

A$3.76
A$5.88
A$3.17
46%
A$1,267
(A$170)
(12%)
90%
90%
100%
50%

A$4.47
A$6.8
A$4.18
36%
A$1,438
(A$240)
(14%)
87.5%
87.5%
n/a
n/a

A$5.30
A$7.49
A$4.22
39%
A$1,677
(A$93)
(5%)
85%
85%
n/a
n/a

106

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
KMP Remuneration Details

Details of the remuneration of our key management personnel for the year ended June 30, 2017 are set out below (amounts are 

presented in Australian dollar):

2017

Short-term benefits

Post-
employment
benefits
Super-

annuation    

Long-
term     

benefits
Long
service
leave
$

Share-
based
payments
Options    

Other
Termi-
nation
benefits   

Total
$

Cash 
Bonus(1)    

Annual 
Leave    

Non- 
monetary 
benefits    Other   

Salary & 
fees
$

$

$
  1,010,000   757,500   46,610   
   439,143   148,750    5,721   
—    —   
   167,208   
—    —   
   250,000   
—    —   
   128,250   
—    —   
   128,250   
—    —   
   128,250   
—    —   
   227,222   

$

$
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   

$

$

$
19,616   16,880   
—    —   1,850,606 
30,416    6,641   676,692    —   1,307,363 
—    —    18,448    —    185,656 
—    —    269,616 
—    —    140,434 
—    —    140,434 
—    —    18,448    —    146,698 
—    —    18,448    —    245,670 

19,616    —   
12,184    —   
12,184    —   

  2,478,323   906,250   52,331   

  US$   1,869,399   683,584   39,473   

—    —   

94,016   23,521   732,036    —   4,286,477 

—    —   

70,915   17,742   552,174    —   3,233,287  

(1)
(2)

 STI bonus payable for performance in the year ended June 30, 2017, not paid as at June 30, 2017.
 The US$ results has been translated at the average weighted exchange rate of 0.7543 for the year ended June 30, 2017.

Details of the remuneration of our key management personnel for the year ended June 30, 2016 are set out below (amounts are 

Short-term benefits

Cash 
Bonus    

Annual 
Leave    

Non- 
monetary 
benefits    Other   

Post-
employment  
benefits
Super-

annuation    

Long-
term

Salary & 
fees
$

$

$
  1,010,000    —   81,546   
   433,057    —   17,168   
   138,250    —    —   
   328,320    —    —   
   160,750    —    —   
   163,250    —    —   
   138,250    —    —   
   250,531    —    —   

$

$
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   
—    —   

benefits    Share-
based
payments
Options    

   Other     
Termi-
nation
benefits   

Long
service
leave
$

Total
$

$

$

$
19,308   24,028   
—    —   1,134,882 
30,108    3,063    12,850    —    496,246 
—    —    42,737    —    180,987 
—    —    347,628 
—    —    176,021 
—    —    178,759 
—    —    42,737    —    180,987 
—    —    42,737    —    293,268 

19,308    —   
15,271    —   
15,509    —   

  2,622,408    —   98,714   

  US$   1,908,062    —   71,823   

—    —   

99,504   27,091   141,061    —   2,988,778 

—    —   

72,398   19,710   102,635    —   2,174,628  

  Currency 
Name
Silviu Itescu (CEO)
  A$
Paul Hodgkinson (CFO)   A$
  A$
William Burns
  A$
Brian Jamieson
  A$
Donal O’Dwyer
  A$
Michael Spooner
  A$
Ben-Zion Weiner
Eric Rose
  A$
Total directors and
   executive KMP
Total directors and
   executive KMP(2)

  A$

presented in Australian dollar):

2016

  Currency 
Name
Silviu Itescu (CEO)
  A$
Paul Hodgkinson (CFO)   A$
  A$
William Burns
  A$
Brian Jamieson
  A$
Donal O’Dwyer
  A$
Michael Spooner
  A$
Ben-Zion Weiner
Eric Rose
  A$
Total directors and
   executive KMP
Total directors and
   executive KMP(1)

  A$

(1)

The US$ results has been translated at the average weighted exchange rate of 0.7276 for the year ended June 30, 2016.

107

 
 
 
  
  
 
      
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Relative proportions of fixed versus variable remuneration expenses

For the year ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, the following table shows the relative proportions of remuneration that are linked to 

performance and those that are fixed based on the amounts disclosed as statutory expense above:

Name
Silviu Itescu (CEO)
Paul Hodgkinson (CFO)

Fixed remuneration

At risk - STI

At risk - LTI

2017
%  

2016
%  

2017
%  

2016
%  

2017
%  

59   
37   

100   
97   

41   
11   

—   
—   

—   
52   

2016
%  
— 
3  

Performance-Based Remuneration

The proportion of at-risk performance remuneration that was awarded and forfeited during the periods presented was as follows:

Name
For the year ended June 30, 2017
Silviu Itescu
Paul Hodgkinson
For the year ended June 30, 2016
Silviu Itescu (for the year ended June 30, 2016)
Paul Hodgkinson (for the year ended June 30, 2016)

Share Based Compensation

Total 
Opportunity
A$

1,010,000 
212,500 

1,010,000 
212,500 

  At-Risk STI %  

Awarded %    

Forfeited %  

75 
70 

— 
— 

25 
30 

100 
100  

Share options granted to key management personnel in the year ended June 30, 2017, were 450,000 share options granted to Mr. 
Hodgkinson. There were no other grants made to key management personnel, including to our directors, in the year ended June 30, 
2017. There has been no modification to any terms and conditions of share-based payment transactions during the year ended June 30, 
2017.

Share options granted to key management personnel in the year ended June 30, 2016 were 400,000 share options granted to Mr. 
Hodgkinson. There were no other grants made to key management personnel, including to our directors, in the year ended June 30, 
2016.  There  was  no  modification  to  any  terms  and  conditions  of  share-based  payment  transactions  during  the  year  ended  June  30, 
2016.

Details of options over our ordinary shares provided as remuneration to each director and member of key management personnel 

for the years ended June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016 are set out in the tables below:

Remuneration Values

The following table provides the remuneration values:

For the year ended June 30, 2017
William Burns
Eric Rose
Ben-Zion Weiner
Donal O'Dwyer
Paul Hodgkinson
For the year ended June 30, 2016
William Burns
Eric Rose
Ben-Zion Weiner
Donal O'Dwyer
Paul Hodgkinson

Remuneration 
consisting of
options or loan-
funded(1)

Values of options
or loan-funded 
granted(2)

Value of options
or loan-funded 
exercised(3)

Value of options
or loan-funded 
lapsed(4)

9.9%  
7.5%  
12.6%  
— 
51.8% 

— 
14.6%  
23.6%  
— 
2.6% 

—   
—   
—   
—  
A$605,025   

—   
—   
—   
A$689,028   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   A$1,079,474   
—   

A$492,000   

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 
—  

108

 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

The  percentage  of  the  value  of  remuneration  consisting  of  options,  based  on  the  value  of  options  expensed  during  the  year 
presented in accordance with IFRS 2 Share-based Payments.

The  accounting  value  at  acceptance  date  of  options  that  were  granted  during  the  year  presented  as  part  of  remuneration, 
determined using Black-Scholes valuation model and in accordance with IFRS 2 Share-based Payments. The acceptance date is 
the  date  at  which  the  entity  and  the  employee  agree  to  a  share-based  payment  arrangement,  being  when  the  entity  and  the 
employee have a shared understanding of the terms and conditions of the arrangement.

The  intrinsic  value  at  exercise  date  of  options  that  were  exercised  during  the  year  presented,  having  been  granted  as  part  of 
remuneration previously.

The intrinsic value at lapse date of options that lapsed during the year presented because a performance condition was not met, 
but valued as if the performance condition had been met.

Reconciliation of Options held by KMP

The following table shows a reconciliation of options held by each KMP from the beginning to the year ended June 30, 2017:

Balance 
at the 
start of 
the year    

Granted 
during 
the year    

Year 

Vested

    Exercised    

Forfeited

Balance at the end of the year

granted    Number     Number     Number     %     Number     Number     %    
— 
53,334 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
   (255,912)
— 

   — 
   67 
   — 
   — 
   — 

   — 
   — 
   — 
   — 
   — 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

Vested and 
exercisable    

— 
53,334 
— 
255,912 

Vested and 

unexercisable    Unvested  
— 
— 
   26,666 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

— 

53,334 

   67 

— 
   450,000 
— 
— 

53,334 
   150,000 
   133,334 
   450,000 

   67 
   33 
   33 
   100 

— 

— 
— 
— 
— 

— 

   — 

53,334 

— 

   26,666 

— 
— 
— 
— 

   — 
   — 
   — 
   — 

53,334 
150,000 
133,334 
300,000 

— 
— 
— 
150,000 

   26,666 
   300,000 
   266,666 
—  

    —      
— 
  2015       80,000 
— 
  2011       511,824 
— 

Name
Silviu Itescu
William Burns
Brian Jamieson     —      
Donal O'Dwyer
Michael Spooner     —      
Ben-Zion 
Weiner
  2015       80,000 
Eric Rose
Paul Hodgkinson   2017      
— 
Paul Hodgkinson   2016       400,000 
Paul Hodgkinson   2015       450,000 

  2015       80,000 

Terms and conditions of share-based payment arrangements

The  terms  and  conditions  of  each  grant  of  options  affecting  remuneration  in  the  current  or  a  future  reporting  period  are  as 

follows:

Grant date
13/01/2017(1)

27/04/2016

10/07/2015

25/03/2015(2)
25/11/2014

Vesting date
  one third - 31/03/2017
one third - 31/08/2017
one third - 30/09/2017
  one third - 07/03/2017
one third - 07/03/2018
one third - 07/03/2019
  one third - 02/07/2016
one third - 02/07/2017
one third - 02/07/2018
25/03/2015 
  one third - 25/11/2015
one third - 25/11/2016
one third - 25/11/2017

Expiry date

  Exercise price

Value per option 
at acceptance 
date

12/01/2024 

A$1.67 

A$1.34   

Vested %  
33 

06/03/2023 

A$2.82 

A$1.05   

30/06/2022 

A$4.22 

A$1.40   

23/07/2019 
24/11/2019 

A$4.71 
A$4.02 

A$0.92   
A$1.30   

33 

33 

100 
67  

(1) These  options  vest  on  the  achievement  of  milestones  relevant  to  the  KMPs  role.  The  milestones  of  this  grant  relate  to  capital 
raising, compliance and partnering. The Board has authority to designate that options have vested when the related milestones are 
met.

109

 
   
 
   
   
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2) These options have vested and were initially held in escrow. As of June 30, 2017, 67% of the options have reached the end of the 
escrow period and are exercisable. 33% of the options have not reached the end of the escrow period, and therefore they may not 
be exercised until the escrow period concludes.

Shares provided on exercise of remuneration options:

No. of
options
exercised
during the
period

No. of
ordinary
shares in
Mesoblast
Limited
issued

Value per
share at
exercise date 
(closing price)  

Exercise
price per
option

    Exercise Date  

255,912     

255,912    April 26, 2017 

A$3.28 

US$0.444

287,903     

287,903   

July 6, 2015 

A$3.81 

US$0.046

For the year ended June 30, 2017
Donal O’Dwyer (for the year ended June 30, 2017)
For the year ended June 30, 2016
Donal O’Dwyer (for the year ended June 30, 2016)

Options Granted as Remuneration

The following table presents options that have been granted over unissued shares during or since the end of the year ended June 
30,  2017,  to  our  key  management  personnel  and  our  next  4  highest  remunerated  officers  that  are  not  also  designated  as  key 
management personnel.

Name
KMP
Silviu Itescu
Paul Hodgkinson
Other than KMP
Kenneth Borow(1)
Peter Howard(1)
Peter Howard(1)
Michael Schuster(1)
Donna Skerrett(1)

Issue Date

Exercise
Price

Number of
shares, under
option

—   
January 13, 2017   

  December 6, 2016   
  October 31, 2016   
  December 6, 2016   
  December 6, 2016   
  December 6, 2016   

—   
A$1.67   

A$1.21   
A$2.82   
A$1.21   
A$1.21   
A$1.21   

— 
450,000 

750,000 
200,000 
600,000 
550,000 
425,000  

(1)

Four most highly remunerated officers that are not also designated as key management personnel.

Shareholdings

The table below shows a reconciliation of ordinary shares held by each KMP from the beginning to the end of the 2017 financial year 
in accordance with the Corporations Regulations (section 18).

Name
Silviu Itescu
William Burns
Brian Jamieson
Donal O'Dwyer
Michael Spooner(1)
Ben-Zion Weiner
Eric Rose
Paul Hodgkinson

Balance at the start 
of the year

Received during the 
year upon exercise 
of options

Other changes 
during the year

Balance at the end 
of the year

68,244,642   
28,000   
625,000   
619,818   
1,081,335   
40,000   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
255,912   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

68,244,642 
28,000 
625,000 
875,730 
1,081,335 
40,000 
— 
—  

(1) Of this balance, Mr. Spooner has a relevant interest of 1,050,000 ordinary shares.

Voting and comments made at our company’s 2016 Annual General Meeting (“AGM”) 

We received 99.3% of the votes cast in person or by proxy on a poll in favor of adopting the 2015/2016 remuneration report, 

and the same resolution was passed on a show of hands at the meeting.  

110

 
 
   
   
      
    
  
  
 
   
   
      
    
  
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
    
 
    
 
  
   
 
 
 
 
   
    
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Employee Profile 

As of June 30, 2017, we had 75 (2016: 108) employees globally: 

Employees by 
Education 

19 

5 

27 

24 

Bachelors degree

Masters degree

Other

Phd/MD

Employees by 
Gender 

Employees by 
Experience 

16 

14 

15 

25 

5 

Academia

Corporate/Professional

Other

Pharma - Big Pharma

Pharma - Specialty Biotech

Employees by 
Region 

34 

Female

Male

41 

44 

Australia

Asia/EU

USA

22 

9 

44  (or  59%)  of  our  employees  are  based  in  the  United  States  where  our  operational  activities  are  concentrated.    Australia 
consists  primarily  of  corporate  headquarter  activities  with  22  (or  29%)  employees,  including  the  CEO  and  other  executive  team 
members. 

Of  the  remaining  employees,  8  (or  11%)  are  located  in  Singapore  where  our  research  and  technology  transfer  activities  are 

performed and 1 is in Switzerland. 

111 

 
                   
 
 
               
                  
         
 
Non-Executive Director Profile 

As at June 30, 2017, we have six non-executive Directors (“NED”) with diverse industry and regional experience, as the charts 

below illustrate: 

NEDs by Region 

NEDs by Experience 

1 

1 

3 

Israel

Switzerland

USA

Australia

1 

1 

1 

1 

3 

Big Pharma/Medical Tech

Australian Capital Markets

Professional Services

Medical Doctor

(End of Remuneration Report) 

112 

 
     
 
 
 
 
 
Australian Disclosure Requirements

Shares under option

Unissued ordinary shares of Mesoblast Limited under option at the date of this Directors’ report are as follows:

Issue date
9/07/2012
24/05/2013
3/09/2013
4/09/2013
24/02/2014
25/08/2014
5/09/2014
9/10/2014
25/11/2014
12/12/2014
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
12/05/2015
10/07/2015
26/08/2015
27/04/2016
27/04/2016
30/06/2016
31/10/2016
06/12/2016
06/12/2016
13/01/2017
28/06/2017
Sub-total
07/07/2010
07/07/2010
Sub-total
Grand Total

Exercise price of options

Expiry date of options

Number of shares under 
option

A$6.69 
A$6.36 
A$5.92 
A$6.28 
A$6.38 
A$4.67 
A$4.71 
A$4.54 
A$4.02 
A$4.51 
A$5.00 
A$5.00 
A$5.00 
A$5.00 
A$5.00 
A$5.00 
A$4.71 
A$4.71 
A$4.46 
A$4.71 
A$4.30 
A$4.22 
A$4.07 
A$2.82 
A$2.76 
A$2.22 
A$2.82 
A$1.33 
A$1.21 
A$1.67 
A$2.23 

US$0.305 
US$0.340 

8/07/2018 
23/05/2018 
9/02/2018 
27/08/2018 
31/12/2018 
24/08/2019 
30/06/2019 
8/10/2019 
24/11/2019 
31/10/2019 
30/06/2018 
25/01/2018 
20/01/2019 
25/01/2019 
25/01/2018 
25/01/2019 
23/07/2019 
30/06/2019 
30/06/2019 
23/07/2019 
16/02/2020 
30/06/2022 
16/08/2022 
6/03/2023 
17/04/2023 
6/10/2019 
6/03/2023 
5/12/2023 
5/12/2023 
12/01/2024 
27/06/2024 

26/10/2018 
26/10/2019 

100,000 
325,000 
1,465,000 
125,000 
650,000 
75,000 
1,545,000 
60,000 
240,000 
50,000 
650,000 
235,000 
135,000 
300,000 
165,000 
200,000 
300,000 
400,000 
600,000 
150,000 
200,000 
2,620,000 
91,667 
3,621,667 
200,000 
1,500,000 
200,000 
2,045,000 
4,400,000 
450,000 
300,000 
23,398,334 
154,064 
447,848 
601,912 
24,000,246

No option holder has any right under the options plan to participate in any other of our share issues.

Shares issued on exercise of options during the year

Detail of shares or interests issued as a result of the exercise of options during or since the end of the financial year are:

Grant date
27/04/2016
07/12/2010
Total

Number of shares issued

Issue Price

Amount unpaid per share

16,667 
255,912 
272,579 

A$2.82 
US$0.444 

— 
— 
—

Indemnification of Officers

During the financial year, we paid premiums in respect of a contract insuring our directors and company secretary, and all of our 
executive officers. The liabilities insured are to the extent permitted by the Corporations Act 2001. Further disclosure required under 
section 300(9) of the Corporations Act 2001 is prohibited under the terms of the insurance contract.

113

Proceedings on Our Behalf 

The Corporations Act 2001 allows specified persons to bring, or intervene in, proceedings on our behalf. No proceedings have 

been brought or intervened in on our behalf with leave of the Court under section 237 of the Corporations Act 2001. 

Non-Audit Services 

We may decide to employ the auditor on assignments additional to their statutory audit duties where the auditor’s expertise and 

experience are relevant and considered to be important. 

The board of directors has considered the position and in accordance with advice received from the audit committee, is satisfied 
that  the  provision  of  the  non-audit  services  is  compatible  with  the  general  standard  of  independence  for  auditors  imposed  by  the 
Corporations Act 2001. The directors are satisfied that the provision of the non-audit services as set out below, did not compromise 
the auditor independence requirements of the Corporations Act 2001 because the services are not deemed to undermine the general 
principles relating to auditor independence as set out in APES 110 Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants. 

During both the current and prior financial years, no fees were paid or payable for non-audit services provided by the auditor of 

the parent entity, its related practices and non-related audit firms. 

Auditor’s Independence Declaration 

A copy of the auditor’s independence declaration  under Section 307C of the  Corporations  Act  in relation to the audit for the 

year ended June 30, 2017 is included in Exhibit 99.2 of this annual report on Form 20-F.(1) 

Rounding of Amounts 

Our company is of a kind referred to in ASIC Corporations (Rounding in Financial/Directors’ Reports) Instrument 2016/191, 
issued  by  the  Australian  Securities  and  Investments  Commission,  relating  to  the  ‘rounding  off’  of  amounts  in  the  directors’  report. 
Unless mentioned otherwise, amounts within this report have been rounded off in accordance with that Legislative Instrument to the 
nearest thousand dollars, or in certain cases, to the nearest dollar. 

The components of our directors’ report are incorporated in various places within this annual report on the Form 20-F. A table 

charting these components is included within ‘Exhibit 99.1 Appendix 4E’.(2) 

Directors’ Resolution 

This report is made in accordance with a resolution of the directors. 

/s/ Brian Jamieson 
Brian Jamieson 
Chairman 

Dated: August 30, 2017 

/s/ Silviu Itescu 
Silviu Itescu 
Chief Executive Officer 

(1)  A copy of the Auditor’s Independence Declaration is included at page 141. 

(2)  Appendix 4E was filed with the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) on August 30, 2017. 

114 

 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.C

Board Practices

Our board of directors currently consists of seven members, including six non-executive directors and one executive director, 

our Chief Executive Officer.

Our  directors  are  generally  elected  to  serve  three-year  terms  in  a  manner  similar  to  a  “staggered”  board  of  directors  under 
Delaware law. At every annual general meeting, one-third of the previously elected directors or, if their number is not a multiple of 
three then the number nearest to but not exceeding one-third, must retire from office and are eligible for re-election. The directors who 
retire in this manner are required to be the directors or director longest in office since last being elected. Additionally, no director, 
except  the  Managing  Director  (currently  designated  as  our  chief  executive  officer,  Silviu  Itescu),  may  hold  office  for  a  period  in 
excess  of  three  years,  or  beyond  the  third  annual  general  meeting  following  the  director’s  last  election,  whichever  is  the  longer, 
without submitting himself or herself for re-election. As a result of the staggered terms, not all of our directors will be elected in any 
given year. The current terms of Messrs.  O’Dwyer and Weiner will expire at the annual shareholders’ meeting in 2017.

Name
Brian Jamieson
William Burns
Donal O’Dwyer
Eric Rose
Michael Spooner
Ben-Zion Weiner

First election at
AGM
2007
2014
2004
2013
2004
2012

Last election at
AGM
2015
2016
2014
2016
2015
2014

End of current
term
2018
2019
2017
2019
2018
2017

We believe that each of our directors has relevant industry experience. The membership of our board of directors is directed by 

the following requirements:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

our Constitution specifies that there must be a minimum of 3 directors and a maximum of 10, and our board of directors
may determine the number of directors within those limits;

we may appoint or remove any director by resolution passed in the general meeting of shareholders;

our directors may appoint any person to be a director, and that person only holds office until the next general meeting at
which time the director may stand for election by shareholders at that meeting;

it is the intention of our board of directors that its membership consists of a majority of independent directors who satisfy
the criteria for independence recommended by the ASX’s Corporate Governance Principles and Recommendations;

the  chairperson  of  our  board  of  directors  should  be  an  independent  director  who  satisfies  the  criteria  for  independence
recommended by the ASX’s Corporate Governance Principles and Recommendations;

Australia's Corporations Act requires that at least two of our directors must be resident Australians; and

our  board  of  directors  should,  collectively,  have  the  appropriate  level  of  personal  qualities,  skills,  experience,  and  time
commitment to properly fulfill its responsibilities or have ready access to such skills where they are not available.

Our board of directors is responsible for, and has the authority to determine, all matters relating to our corporate governance, 

including the policies, practices, management and operation. The principal roles and responsibilities of our board of directors are to:

•

•

•

•

•

facilitate board of directors and management accountability to our company and its shareholders;

ensure timely reporting to shareholders;

provide strategic guidance to us, including contributing to the development of, and approving, the corporate strategy;

oversee management and ensure there are effective management processes in place;

monitor:

o

o

o

o

o

organizational performance and the achievement of our strategic goals and objectives;

financial performance including approval of the annual and half-year financial reports and liaison with our auditors;

progress  of  major  capital  expenditures  and  other  significant  corporate  projects  including  any  acquisitions  or
divestments;

compliance with our code of conduct;

progress in relation to our diversity objectives and compliance with its diversity policy;

115

•

•

•

•

•

review and approve business plans, the annual budget and financial plans including available resources and major capital 
expenditure initiatives;

approve major corporate initiatives;

enhance and protect the reputation of the organization;

oversee the operation of our system for compliance and risk management reporting to shareholders; and

ensure appropriate resources are available to senior management.

None of our directors have any service contracts with Mesoblast that provide for benefits upon termination of employment.

Committees

To  assist  our  board  of  directors  with  the  effective  discharge  of  its  duties,  it  has  established  a  Nomination  and  Remuneration 
Committee, an Audit and Risk Management Committee and a Science and Technology Committee. Each committee operates under a 
specific charter approved by our board of directors.

Nomination  and  Remuneration  Committee.  The  members  of  our  Nomination  and  Remuneration  Committee  are  Messrs. 
Jamieson, O’Dwyer (Chairman) and Spooner, all of whom are independent, non-executive directors. The remuneration committee is a 
committee of our board of directors, and is primarily responsible for making recommendations to our board of directors on:

•

•

•

•

•

•

board appointments;

non-executive director fees;

the executive remuneration framework;

remuneration of executive directors, including the CEO and other key executives;

short-term and long-term incentive awards; and

share ownership plans.

The  committee’s  objective  is  to  ensure  remuneration  policies  are  fair  and  competitive  and  in  line  with  similar  industry 
benchmarks while aligned with our objectives. The remuneration committee seeks independent advice from remuneration consultants 
as and when it deems necessary. See “Management—Remuneration.”

Audit and Risk Management Committee. The members of our Audit and Risk Management Committee are Messrs. Jamieson, 
O’Dwyer and Spooner (Chairman), all of whom are independent, non-executive directors. This committee oversees, reviews, acts on 
and  reports  on  various  auditing  and  accounting  matters  to  our  board  of  directors,  including  the  selection  of  our  independent 
accountants,  the  scope  of  our  annual  audits,  fees  to  be  paid  to  the  independent  accountants,  the  performance  of  our  independent 
accountants  and  our  accounting  practices.  In  addition,  the  committee  oversees,  reviews,  acts  on  and  reports  on  various  risk 
management matters to our board of directors.

The effective management of risk is central to our ongoing success. We have adopted a risk management policy to ensure that:

•

•

•

•

appropriate  systems  are  in  place  to  identify,  to  the  extent  that  is  reasonably  practical,  all  material  risks  that  we  face  in 
conducting our business;

the financial impact of those risks is understood and appropriate controls are in place to limit exposures to them;

appropriate responsibilities are delegated to control the risks; and

any material changes to our risk profile are disclosed in accordance with our continuous disclosure reporting requirements 
in Australia.

It is our objective to appropriately balance, protect and enhance the interests of all of our shareholders. Proper behavior by our 

directors, officers, employees and those organizations that we contract to carry out work is essential in achieving this objective.

116

We have established a code of conduct, which sets out the standards of behavior that apply to every aspect of our dealings and 

relationships, both within and outside Mesoblast. The following standards of behavior apply:

•

•

•

•

•

•

patient well-being;

comply with all laws that govern us and our operations;

act honestly and with integrity and fairness in all dealings with others and each other;

avoid or manage conflicts of interest;

use our assets properly and efficiently for the benefit of all of our shareholders; and

seek to be an exemplary corporate citizen.

Science  and  Technology  Committee.  The  members  of  the  Science  and  Technology  Committee  are  Messrs.  Itescu,  Rose 
(Chairman), Burns and Weiner. The Science and Technology Committee is a committee of our board of directors, and is primarily 
responsible for making recommendations to our board of directors pertaining to our strategic direction and investment in research and 
development and technology, by:

•

•

•

•

•

identifying areas and activities that are critical to the success of our regenerative medicine discovery, development and
licensing efforts;

evaluating the effectiveness of our regenerative medicine development and licensing strategies and operations;

keeping our board of directors apprised of this evaluation process and findings;

making appropriate recommendations to our board of directors on modifications of strategies and operations; and

identifying additional areas of focus as appropriate.

6.D

Employees

The  table  below  sets  forth  the  breakdown  of  the  total  year-end  number  of  our  employees  by  main  category  of  activity  and 

geographic area for the past three years:

As of June 30, 2017
USA
Australia
Singapore
Switzerland
Total

As of June 30, 2016
USA
Australia
Singapore
Switzerland
Total

As of June 30, 2015
USA
Australia
Singapore
Switzerland
Total

Research & 
Development   Commercial Manufacturing 
5 
— 
2 
— 
7 

1 
— 
— 
— 
1 

29 
8 
5 
— 
42 

Research & 
Development   Commercial Manufacturing 
9 
— 
2 
— 
11 

49 
11 
6 
— 
66 

1 
1 
— 
— 
2 

Corporate

Total

9 
14 
1 
1 
25 

44 
22 
8 
1 
75

Corporate

Total

12 
15 
1 
1 
29 

71 
27 
9 
1 
108

Research & 
Development   Commercial

60 
9 
6 
— 
75 

— 
2 
— 
— 
2 

  Manufacturing 
9 
— 
1 
— 
10 

Corporate

Total

11 
15 
1 
1 
28 

80 
26 
8 
1 
115

We  have  no  collective  bargaining  agreement  with  our  employees.  We  have  not  experienced  any  work  stoppages  to  date  and 

consider our relations with our employees to be good.

See “Item 6.A Directors and Senior Management – Employee Profile”.

117

6.E

Share Ownership

The  following  table  sets  forth  information  regarding  the  beneficial  ownership  of  our  ordinary  shares  based  on  428,221,398 

ordinary shares outstanding at June 30, 2017 by each of our directors and key management personnel.

We  have  determined  beneficial  ownership  in  accordance  with  the  rules  of  the  SEC  and  generally  means  that  a  person  has  a 
beneficial  ownership  of  a  security  if  he,  she  or  it  possesses  sole  or  shared  voting  or  investment  power  of  that  security,  including 
options that are exercisable within 60 days of June 30, 2017. Ordinary shares subject to options currently exercisable or exercisable 
within 60 days of June 30, 2017 are deemed to be outstanding for computing the percentage ownership of the person holding these 
options and the percentage ownership of any group of which the holder is a member, but are not deemed outstanding for computing 
the percentage of any other person.

Based upon information known to us, as of June 30, 2017 we had 17 shareholders in the United States. These shareholders held 

an aggregate of 54,084,938 of our ordinary shares, or approximately 13% of our outstanding ordinary shares.

Unless otherwise indicated, to our knowledge each shareholder possesses sole voting and investment power over the ordinary 
shares listed subject to community property laws, where applicable. None of our shareholders has different voting rights from other 
shareholders. Unless otherwise indicated, the principal address of each of the shareholders below is c/o Mesoblast Limited, Level 38, 
55 Collins Street, Melbourne 3000, Australia.

Name
Directors and key management personnel:
Silviu Itescu(1)
William Burns(2)
Brian Jamieson(3)
Paul Hodgkinson(4)
Eric Rose(5)
Donal O'Dwyer(6)
Ben-Zion Weiner(7)
Michael Spooner
All directors and key management personnel as a group
   (8 persons)

Ordinary Shares
beneficially owned
%

Number

68,244,642 
81,334 
625,000 
583,334 
53,334 
1,131,642 
93,334 
1,050,000 

15.9%
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 

71,862,620 

16.8%

*

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

(5)

(6)

Less than 1% of the outstanding ordinary shares.

Includes (a) 67,756,838 ordinary shares owned by Dr. Itescu and (b) 487,804 ordinary shares owned by Josaka Investments Pty
Ltd, the trustee of Dr. Itescu’s self-managed superannuation fund.

Includes (a) 28,000 ordinary shares owned by Mr. Burns, (b) 53,334 ordinary shares subject to options exercisable at a price of
A$4.02 per share until November 24, 2019.

Includes  (a)  150,000  ordinary  shares  owned  by  Mr.  Jamieson,  (b)  475,000  ordinary  shares  owned  by  Mr.  Jamieson  through
Timaru Close Pty Ltd.

Includes 583,334 ordinary shares subject to options of which; 300,000 are exercisable at a price of A$4.71 per share until July
23, 2019; 66,667 are exercisable at a price of A$4.22 per share until June 20, 2022; 66,667 are exercisable at a price of A$2.82
per share until March 6, 2023; and 150,000 are exercisable at a price of A$1.67 per share until January 12, 2024.

Includes 53,334 ordinary shares subject to options exercisable at a price of A$4.02 per share until November 25, 2019.

Includes (a) 555,912 ordinary shares owned by Mr. O’Dwyer, (b) 319,818 ordinary shares owned by Dundrum Investments Ltd.
as trustee for The O’Dwyer Family Trust, and (c) 255,912 ordinary shares subject to options of which 127,956 are exercisable at
a price of US$0.31 per share until October 26, 2018 and 127,956 are exercisable at a price of US$0.34 per share until October
26, 2019. Mr. O’Dwyer and his spouse are the sole shareholders of Dundrum Investments Ltd.

(7)

Includes (a) 40,000 ordinary shares owned by Dr. Weiner, (b) 53,334 ordinary shares subject to options exercisable at a price of
A$4.02 per share until November 24, 2019.

118

Item 7.

Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions

7.A

Major Shareholders

 The following table and accompanying footnotes present certain information regarding the beneficial ownership of our ordinary 
shares based on 428,221,398 ordinary shares outstanding at June 30, 2017 by each person known by us to be the beneficial owner of 
more than 5% of our ordinary shares. 

Name

5% or Greater Shareholders:
Silviu Itescu(1)
Cephalon, Inc.(2)
M&G Investment Group(3)
Capital Research Global Investors(4)
Thorney Holdings(5)

Ordinary Shares
beneficially owned

Number

%

68,244,642     
55,785,806     
54,026,630     
30,364,000     
24,696,000     

15.9%
13.0%
12.6%
7.1%
5.8%

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

(5)

Includes (a) 67,756,838 ordinary shares owned by Dr. Itescu and (b) 487,804 ordinary shares owned by Josaka Investments Pty 
Ltd, the trustee of Dr. Itescu’s self-managed superannuation fund.

The address for Cephalon Inc. is 41 Moores Road, Frazer, PA 19355.

Includes ordinary shares owned indirectly through custodial accounts, over which shares M&G Investment Group retains voting 
and  dispositive  power.  The  address  for  M&G  Investment  Group  is  Laurence  Pountney  Hill,  London  4C4R  0HH,  United 
Kingdom.

Includes  ordinary  shares  owned  indirectly  through  custodial  accounts,  over  which  shares  Capital  Research  Global  Investors 
retains voting and dispositive power. The address for Capital Research Global Investors is 333 South Hope Street, Los Angeles, 
California, 90071.

Includes ordinary shares owned indirectly through custodial accounts, over which shares Thorney Holdings retains voting and 
dispositive power. The address for Thorney Holdings is 55 Collins Street, Level 39, Melbourne, Victoria 3000, Australia.

To our knowledge, there have not been any significant changes in the ownership of our ordinary shares by major shareholders 

over the past three years, except as follows (which is based on substantial shareholder notices filed with the ASX).

•

•

The Capital Group Companies, Inc. reported on March 24, 2015 that, after acquiring 4,021,588 ordinary shares between 
January 31, 2014 and March 23, 2015, in total it held 25,488,187 ordinary shares, or 7.9% of the total voting power as of 
that date.  It reported on February 16, 2016 that since March 24, 2015 it had acquired 3,461,051 ordinary shares. It 
reported on February 13, 2017 that since February 16, 2016 it had acquired 1,414,762 ordinary shares, and it held 
30,364,000 ordinary shares (including 452,000 ADSs, each representing 5 ordinary shares), or 7.9% of the total voting 
power as of that date.

Thorney Opportunities Ltd reported on April 17, 2015 that, after acquiring 821,593 ordinary shares between April 14, 
2014 to April 13, 2015, in total it held 18,851,000 ordinary shares, or 5.81% of the total voting power as of that date.  It 
reported on March 31, 2017 that, between April 17, 2015 to March 31, 2017, it acquired 5,845,000 ordinary shares, and in 
total it held 24,696,000 ordinary shares, or 5.8% of the total voting power as of that date.

• M&G  Investment  Group  reported  on  November  25,  2015  that,  after  acquiring  14,625,593  ordinary  shares  (including 
1,497,235 ADSs, each representing 5 ordinary shares acquired in the November 13, 2015 Nasdaq IPO) between February 
21, 2012 and November 25, 2015, in total it held 46,643,788 ordinary shares, or 12.3% of the total voting power as of that 
date.   It reported on March 30, 2017 that it acquired 7,196,982 ordinary shares between November 26, 2015 and March 
30,  2017, and  that  in total  it held  54,026,630 ordinary  shares  (including 1,543,700  ADSs,  each  representing  5  ordinary 
shares), or 13.4% of the total voting power as of that date.

119

 
 
 
 
   
 
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
7.B

Related Party Transactions

The  Company  has  not  entered  into  any  related  party  transactions  during  the  years  ended  June  30,  2017  and  2016  other  than 

compensation made to Directors and other members of key management personnel, see “Item 6.B Compensation”.

7.C

Interests of Experts and Counsel

Not applicable.

Item 8.

Financial Information

8.A

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

See “Item 18. Financial Statements.”

Dividend policy

Since our inception, we have not declared or paid any dividends on our shares. We intend to retain any earnings for use in our 
business  and  do  not  currently  intend  to  pay  cash  dividends  on  our  ordinary  shares.  Dividends,  if  any,  on  our  outstanding  ordinary 
shares will be declared by and subject to the discretion of our board of directors, and subject to Australian law.

Any dividend we declare will be paid to the holders of ADSs, subject to the terms of the deposit agreement, to the same extent 
as holders of our ordinary shares, to the extent permitted by applicable law and regulations, less the fees and expenses payable under 
the deposit agreement. Any dividend we declare will be distributed by the depositary bank to the holders of our ADSs, subject to the 
terms of the deposit agreement. See “Item 12.D. Description of American Depositary Shares.”

8.B Significant Changes

In  August  2017,  the  Group  announced  a  fully  underwritten  entitlement  offer  to  existing  eligible  shareholders  (on  a  1  for  12 
basis) in Australia and New Zealand and institutional shareholders in certain other countries in private placements. US$38.2 million of 
net proceeds from the entitlement offer is expected to be received and recognized in cash and cash equivalents in September 2017. 

There were no other events that have arisen subsequent to June 30, 2017 and prior to the signing of this report that would likely 

have a material impact on the financial results presented. 

120

Item 9.

The Offer and Listing

9.A

Offer and Listing Details

Our shares have been listed in Australia on the Australian Securities Exchange (ASX) since December 2004.

American  Depositary  Shares  (“ADSs”),  each  representing  five  ordinary  shares,  are  available  in  the  US  through  an  American 
Depositary  Receipts  (“ADR”)  program.  This  program  was  established  under  the  deposit  agreement  which  we  entered  into  with 
JPMorgan  Chase  Bank  N.A.  as  depositary  and  our  ADR  holders.  Our  ADRs  have  been  listed  on  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market 
since August 2015, and are traded under the symbol “MESO”.

The NASDAQ Global Select Market

Since November 2015, our ordinary shares in the form of ADSs have been trading on the Nasdaq Global Select Market under 
the symbol “MESO.” The following table sets forth the high and low market prices for our ADSs reported on Nasdaq for the periods 
indicated in U.S. dollars.

Period

Annual:
     Fiscal year ended
         June 30, 2016
         June 30, 2017

Quarterly:
     Fiscal year ended June 30, 2016

    Second quarter ended December 31, 2015
    Third quarter ended March 31, 2016
    Fourth quarter ended June 30, 2016

     Fiscal year ended June 30, 2017

    First quarter ended September 30, 2016
    Second quarter ended December 31, 2016
    Third quarter ended March 31, 2017
    Fourth quarter ended June 30, 2017

Most recent six months:
         Month ended February 28, 2017
         Month ended March 31, 2017
         Month ended April 30, 2017
         Month ended May 31, 2017
         Month ended June 30, 2017
         Month ended July 31, 2017

US$ High

US$ Low

15.56   
12.50   

8.46   
10.89   
9.79   

6.57   
5.90   
9.78   
12.50   

6.59   
9.78   
12.50   
12.02   
9.64   
8.55   

3.50 
3.90 

4.50 
4.26 
3.50 

3.90 
4.01 
5.28 
7.55 

5.39 
6.43 
8.84 
7.60 
7.55 
6.85  

121

 
   
 
 
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Australian Securities Exchange

Since  December  2004,  our  ordinary  shares  have  been  listed  in  Australia  on  the  ASX  trading  under  the  symbol  “MSB”.  The 
following  table  sets  forth  the  high  and  low  market  prices  for  our  ordinary  shares  reported  on  the  ASX  for  the  periods  indicated  in 
Australian dollars.

A$ High

A$ Low

7.49     
6.80     
5.88     
4.06     
3.44     

4.06     
3.50     
3.03     
2.70     

1.93     
1.55     
2.50     
3.44 

1.71     
2.50     
3.44     
3.23     
2.25     
2.36 

4.22 
4.18 
3.17 
1.01 
1.03 

2.91 
1.35 
1.14 
1.01 

1.03 
1.07 
1.43 
1.93 

1.43 
1.63 
2.28 
1.96 
1.93 
1.72  

Period

Annual:
     Fiscal year ended
         June 30, 2013
         June 30, 2014
         June 30, 2015
         June 30, 2016
         June 30, 2017

Quarterly:
     Fiscal year ended June 30, 2016

    First quarter ended September 30, 2015
    Second quarter ended December 31, 2015
    Third quarter ended March 31, 2016
    Fourth quarter ended June 30, 2016

     Fiscal year ended June 30, 2017

    First quarter ended September 30, 2016
    Second quarter ended December 31, 2016
    Third quarter ended March 31, 2017
    Fourth quarter ended June 30, 2017

Most recent six months:
         Month ended February 28, 2017
         Month ended March 31, 2017
         Month ended April 30, 2017
         Month ended May 31, 2017
         Month ended June 30, 2017
         Month ended July 31, 2017

9.B

Plan of Distribution

Not applicable.

9.C

Markets

See “Item 9.A Offer and Listing Details.”

9.D

Selling Shareholders

Not applicable.

9.E

Dilution

Not applicable.

9.F

Expenses of the Issue

Not applicable.

122

 
   
 
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
  
 
   
      
  
   
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
   
  
Item 10. Additional Information

10.A

Share Capital

Not applicable.

10.B

Memorandum and Articles of Association

Our Constitution is similar in nature to the bylaws of a U.S. corporation. It does not provide for or prescribe any specific 

objectives or purposes of Mesoblast. Our Constitution is subject to the terms of the ASX Listing Rules and the Australian 
Corporations Act. It may be modified or repealed and replaced by special resolution passed at a meeting of shareholders, which is a 
resolution passed by at least 75% of the votes cast by shareholders (including proxies and representatives of shareholders) entitled to 
vote on the resolution.

Under Australian law, a company has the legal capacity and powers of an individual both within and outside Australia. The 

material provisions of our Constitution are summarized below. This summary is not intended to be complete nor to constitute a 
definitive statement of the rights and liabilities of our shareholders, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the complete text of 
our Constitution, a copy of which is on file with the SEC.

Directors

Interested Directors

Except as permitted by the Corporations Act and the ASX Listing Rules, a director must not vote in respect of any contract or 

arrangement in which the director has any direct or indirect material personal interest or any lesser interest according to our 
Constitution. Such director must not be counted in a quorum, must not vote on the matter and must not be present at the meeting while 
the matter is being considered.

Pursuant to our Constitution, a director is liable to us for any profits derived with regard to any matter in which the director has 

a material interest unless the director:

•

•

declares  the  director’s  interest  in  the  matter  as  soon  as  practicable  after  the  relevant  facts  come  to  the  director’s 
knowledge; and
does not contravene our Constitution or the Corporations Act in relation to the matter.

Unless a relevant exception applies, the Corporations Act requires our directors to provide disclosure of certain interests and 
prohibits directors of companies listed on the ASX from voting on matters in which they have a material personal interest and from 
being present at the meeting while the matter is being considered. In addition, unless a relevant exception applies, the Corporations 
Act and the ASX Listing Rules require shareholder approval of any provision of financial benefits (including the issue by us of 
ordinary shares and other securities) to our directors, including entities controlled by them and certain members of their families.

Borrowing Powers Exercisable by Directors

Pursuant to our Constitution, our business is managed by our board of directors. Our board of directors has the power to raise or 

borrow money, and incur liens on or grant a security interest in any of our property or business or any uncalled portion of any partly 
paid shares, and may issue debentures or give any other security for any of our debts, liabilities or obligations or of any other person, 
in each case, in the manner and on terms it deems fit.

Election, Removal and Retirement of Directors

We may appoint or remove any director by resolution passed in the general meeting of shareholders. Additionally, our directors 

are elected to serve three-year terms in a manner similar to a “staggered” board of directors under Delaware law. At every annual 
general meeting, one-third of the previously elected directors or, if their number is not a multiple of three then the number nearest to 
but not exceeding one-third, must retire from office and are eligible for re-election. Additionally, no director except the Managing 
Director (currently designated as our chief executive officer, Silviu Itescu) may hold office for a period in excess of three years, or 
beyond the third annual general meeting following the director’s last election, whichever is the longer, without submitting himself or 
herself for re-election.

A director who is appointed during the year by the other directors only holds office until the next general meeting at which time 

the director may stand for election by shareholders at that meeting.

123

In addition, provisions of the Corporations Act apply where at least 25% of the votes cast on a resolution to adopt our 

remuneration report (which resolution must be proposed each year at our annual general meeting) are against the adoption of the 
report at two successive annual general meetings. Where these provisions apply, a resolution must be put to a vote at the second 
annual general meeting to the effect that a further meeting, or a spill meeting, take place within 90 days. At the spill meeting, the 
directors in office when the remuneration report was considered at the second annual general meeting (other than the Managing 
Director) cease to hold office and resolutions to appoint directors (which may involve re-appointing the former directors) are put to a 
vote.

Voting restrictions apply in relation to the resolutions to adopt our remuneration report and to propose a spill meeting. These 

restrictions apply to our key management personnel and their closely related parties. See “Rights and Restrictions on Classes of 
Shares—Voting Rights” below.

Pursuant to our Constitution, no person is eligible to be elected as a director unless a notice of the director’s candidature is 
given to us at least 35 business days (30 business days for a meeting shareholders have requested directors to call) before the meeting. 
This restriction does not apply to a retiring director or to the election of a director previously appointed by the directors during the 
year.

Share Qualifications

There are currently no requirements for directors to own our ordinary shares in order to qualify as directors.

Rights and Restrictions on Classes of Shares

Subject to the Corporations Act and the ASX Listing Rules, the rights attaching to our ordinary shares are detailed in our 
Constitution. Our Constitution provides that any of our ordinary shares may be issued with preferred, deferred or other special rights, 
whether in relation to dividends, voting, return of share capital, payment of calls or otherwise as our board of directors may determine 
from time to time. Subject to the Corporations Act, the ASX Listing Rules and any rights and restrictions attached to a class of shares, 
we may issue further ordinary shares on such terms and conditions as our board of directors resolve. Currently, our outstanding 
ordinary share capital consists of only one class of ordinary shares.

Dividend Rights

Our board of directors may from time to time determine to pay dividends to shareholders. All unclaimed dividends may be 

invested or otherwise made use of by our board of directors for our benefit until claimed or otherwise disposed of in accordance with 
our Constitution.

Voting Rights

Under our Constitution, any resolution to be considered at a meeting of the shareholders shall be decided on a show of hands 

unless a poll is demanded by the shareholders at or before the declaration of the result of the show of hands. A poll may be demanded 
by the chairman of the meeting; by at least five shareholders present and having the right to vote on at the meeting; any shareholder or 
shareholders representing at least 5% of the votes that may be cast on the resolution on a poll; or any shareholder or shareholders 
holding our shares conferring a right to vote at the meeting on which an aggregate sum has been paid up equal to not less than 5% of 
the total sum paid up on all the shares conferring that right. On a show of hands, each shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting has 
one vote regardless of the number of ordinary shares held by such shareholder. If voting takes place on a poll, rather than a show of 
hands, each shareholder entitled to vote has one vote for each ordinary share held and a fractional vote for each ordinary share that is 
not fully paid, such fraction being equivalent to the proportion of the amount that has been paid to such date on that ordinary share.

Under Australian law, an ordinary resolution is passed on a show of hands if it is approved by a simple majority (more than 

50%) of the votes cast by shareholders present (in person or by proxy) and entitled to vote. If a poll is demanded, an ordinary 
resolution is passed if it is approved by holders representing a simple majority of the total voting rights of shareholders present (in 
person or by proxy) who (being entitled to vote) vote on the resolution. Special resolutions require the affirmative vote of not less than 
75% of the votes cast by shareholders present (in person or by proxy) at the meeting.

Pursuant to our Constitution, each shareholder entitled to attend and vote at a meeting may attend and vote in person or by 
proxy or attorney and by representative. Shareholders may not vote electronically. Under Australian law, shareholders of a public 
listed company are not permitted to approve corporate matters by written consent. Our Constitution does not provide for cumulative 
voting.

124

Note that ADS holders may not directly vote at a meeting of the shareholders but may instruct the depositary to vote the 

number of deposited ordinary shares their ADSs represent. Under voting by a show of hands, multiple “yes” votes by ADS holders 
will only count as one “yes” vote and will be negated by a single “no” vote, unless a poll is demanded.

There are a number of circumstances where the Corporations Act or the ASX Listing Rules prohibit or restrict certain 
shareholders or certain classes of shareholders from voting. For example, key management personnel whose remuneration details are 
included elsewhere in this prospectus are prohibited from voting on the resolution that must be proposed at each annual general 
meeting to adopt our remuneration report, as well as any resolution to propose a spill meeting. An exception applies to exercising a 
directed proxy which indicates how the proxy is to vote on the proposed resolution on behalf of someone other than the key 
management personnel or their closely related parties; or that person is chair of the meeting and votes an undirected proxy where the 
shareholder expressly authorizes the chair to exercise that power. Key management personnel and their closely related parties are also 
prohibited from voting undirected proxies on remuneration related resolutions. A similar exception to that described above applies if 
the proxy is the chair of the meeting.

Right to Share in Our Profits

Subject to the Corporations Act and pursuant to our Constitution, prior to our liquidation, our shareholders are entitled to 

participate in our profits only by payment of dividends. Our board of directors may from time to time determine to pay dividends to 
the shareholders; however, no dividend is payable except in accordance with the thresholds set out in the Corporations Act.

Rights to Share in the Surplus in the Event of Liquidation

Our Constitution provides for the right of shareholders to participate in a surplus in the event of our liquidation.

Redemption Provisions

There are no redemption provisions in our Constitution in relation to ordinary shares. Under our Constitution and subject to the 

Corporations Act, any preference shares may be issued on the terms that they are, or may at our option or at the option of the holder 
be, liable to be redeemed.

Sinking Fund Provisions

Our Constitution allows our directors to, at their discretion, set aside any sums they think proper out of our profits as reserves, 

which may be applied for any proper purpose.

Liability for Further Capital Calls

According to our Constitution, our board of directors may make any calls from time to time upon shareholders in respect of all 

monies unpaid on partly paid shares respectively held by them, subject to the terms upon which any of the partly paid shares have 
been issued. Each shareholder is liable to pay the amount of each call in the manner, at the time and at the place specified by our board 
of directors. Calls may be made payable by instalment.

Provisions Discriminating Against Holders of a Substantial Number of Shares

There are no provisions under our Constitution discriminating against any existing or prospective holders of a substantial 

number of our ordinary shares.

Variation or Cancellation of Share Rights

The rights attached to shares in a class of shares may only be varied or cancelled by a special resolution of shareholders, 

together with either:

•
•

a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of members holding shares in the class; or
the written consent of members with at least 75% of the votes in the class.

125

General Meetings of Shareholders

General meetings of shareholders may be called by our board of directors or, under the Corporations Act, by a single director. 
Except as permitted under the Corporations Act, shareholders may not convene a meeting. Under the Corporations Act, shareholders 
with at least 5% of the votes that may be cast at a general meeting may call and arrange to hold a general meeting. The Corporations 
Act requires the directors to call and arrange to hold a general meeting on the request of shareholders with at least 5% of the votes that 
may be cast at a general meeting. Notice of the proposed meeting of our shareholders is required at least 28 days prior to such meeting 
under the Corporations Act.

Quorum for General Meetings of Shareholders

No business shall be transacted at any general meeting unless a quorum is present at the time when the meeting proceeds to 
business. Under our Constitution, the presence, in person or by proxy, attorney or representative, of five shareholders constitutes a 
quorum, or if we have less than five shareholders, then the shareholders present at a meeting constitute a quorum. If a quorum is not 
present within 15 minutes after the time appointed for the meeting, the meeting must be either dissolved if it was summoned by 
shareholders or adjourned in any other case. A meeting adjourned for lack of a quorum is adjourned to the same day in the following 
week at the same time and place, unless otherwise decided by our directors. The reconvened meeting is dissolved if a quorum is not 
present within 15 minutes after the time appointed for the meeting.

Ownership Threshold

There are no provisions in our Constitution that require a shareholder to disclose ownership above a certain threshold. The 

Corporations Act, however, requires a substantial shareholder to notify us and the ASX once a 5% interest in our ordinary shares is 
obtained. Further, once a shareholder has (alone or together with associates) a 5% or greater interest in us, such shareholder must 
notify us and the ASX of any increase or decrease of 1% or more in its interest in our ordinary shares. Following our initial public 
offering in the United States, our shareholders are also subject to disclosure requirements under U.S. securities laws.

Issues of Shares and Change in Capital

Subject to our Constitution, the Corporations Act, the ASX Listing Rules and any other applicable law, we may at any time 
issue shares and grant options or warrants on any terms, with preferred, deferred or other special rights and restrictions and for the 
consideration and other terms that the directors determine. Our power to issue shares includes the power to issue bonus shares (for 
which no consideration is payable to Mesoblast), preference shares and partly paid shares.

Subject to the requirements of our Constitution, the Corporations Act, the ASX Listing Rules and any other applicable law, 

including relevant shareholder approvals, we may consolidate or divide our share capital into a smaller or larger number by resolution, 
reduce our share capital (provided that the reduction is fair and reasonable to our shareholders as a whole, does not materially 
prejudice our ability to pay creditors and obtains the necessary shareholder approval) or buy back our ordinary shares including under 
an equal access buy-back or on a selective basis.

Change of Control

Takeovers of listed Australian public companies, such as Mesoblast, are regulated by the Corporations Act, which prohibits the 

acquisition of a “relevant interest” in issued voting shares in a listed company if the acquisition will lead to that person’s or someone 
else’s voting power in Mesoblast increasing from 20% or below to more than 20% or increasing from a starting point that is above 
20% and below 90%, subject to a range of exceptions.

Generally, a person will have a relevant interest in securities if the person:

•
•
•

is the holder of the securities;
has power to exercise, or control the exercise of, a right to vote attached to the securities; or
has the power to dispose of, or control the exercise of a power to dispose of, the securities (including any indirect or direct 
power or control)

If, at a particular time, a person has a relevant interest in issued securities and the person:

•
•

has entered or enters into an agreement with another person with respect to the securities;
has given or gives another person an enforceable right, or has been or is given an enforceable right by another person, in 
relation to the securities; or

126

•

has granted or grants an option to, or has been or is granted an option by, another person with respect to the securities, and 
the other person would have a relevant interest in the securities if the agreement were performed, the right enforced or the 
option exercised;

then, the other person is taken to already have a relevant interest in the securities.

There are a number of exceptions to the above prohibition on acquiring a relevant interest in issued voting shares above 20%. 

In general terms, some of the more significant exceptions include:

•
•

•

•

•
•
•
•
•

•
•

when the acquisition results from the acceptance of an offer under a formal takeover bid;
when the acquisition is conducted on market by or on behalf of the bidder under a takeover bid and the acquisition occurs 
during the bid period;
when shareholders of Mesoblast approve an acquisition that would otherwise breach the prohibition, by resolution passed 
at general meeting;
an acquisition by a person if, throughout the six months before the acquisition, that person or any other person has had 
voting  power  in  Mesoblast  of  at  least  19%  and,  as  a  result  of  the  acquisition,  none  of  the  relevant  persons  would  have 
voting power in Mesoblast more than three percentage points higher than they had six months before the acquisition;
as a result of a rights issue;
as a result of dividend reinvestment schemes;
as a result of certain underwriting arrangements;
through operation of law;
an acquisition that arises through the acquisition of a relevant interest in another company listed on the ASX, certain other 
Australian financial markets or a foreign stock exchange approved in writing by ASIC;
arising from an auction of forfeited shares; or
arising through a compromise, arrangement, liquidation or buy-back.

A formal takeover bid may either be a bid for all securities in the bid class or a fixed proportion of such securities, with each 

holder of bid class securities receiving a bid for that proportion of their holding. Under our Constitution, a proportionate takeover bid 
must first be approved by resolution of our shareholders in a general meeting before it may proceed.

Breaches of the takeovers provisions of the Corporations Act are criminal offenses. In addition, ASIC and, on application by 

ASIC or an interested party, such as a shareholder, the Australian Takeovers Panel have a wide range of powers relating to breaches of 
takeover provisions, including the ability to make orders canceling contracts, freezing transfers of, and rights (including voting rights) 
attached to, securities, and forcing a party to dispose of securities including by vesting the securities in ASIC for sale. There are 
certain defenses to breaches of the takeover provisions provided in the Corporations Act.

Access to and Inspection of Documents

Inspection  of  our  records  is  governed  by  the  Corporations  Act.  Any  member  of  the  public  has  the  right  to  inspect  or  obtain 
copies of our share registers on the payment of a prescribed fee. Shareholders are not required to pay a fee for inspection of our share 
registers or minute books of the meetings of shareholders. Other corporate records, including minutes of directors’ meetings, financial 
records  and  other  documents,  are  not  open  for  inspection  by  shareholders.  Where  a  shareholder  is  acting  in  good  faith  and  an 
inspection is deemed to be made for a proper purpose, a shareholder may apply to the court to make an order for inspection of our 
books.

10.C

Material Contracts

We have not entered into any new material contracts since our final prospectus that was filed with the SEC on November 12, 

2015. See “Item 19. Exhibits.”

10.D

Exchange Controls 

The  Australian  dollar  is  freely  convertible  into  U.S.  dollars.  In  addition,  there  are  currently  no  specific  rules  or  limitations 
regarding the export from Australia of profits, dividends, capital or similar funds belonging to foreign investors, except that certain 
payments  to  non-residents  must  be  reported  to  the  Australian  Transaction  Reports  and  Analysis  Centre  (“AUSTRAC”),  which 
monitors  such  transaction,  and  amounts  on  account  of  potential  Australian  tax  liabilities  may  be  required  to  be  withheld  unless  a 
relevant taxation treaty can be shown to apply.

127

Regulation of acquisition by foreign entities

Under Australian law, in certain circumstances foreign persons are prohibited from acquiring more than a limited percentage of 
the shares in an Australian company without approval from the Australian Treasurer. These limitations are set forth in the Australian 
Foreign  Acquisitions  and  Takeovers  Act  1975.  These  limitations  are  in  addition  to  the  more  general  overarching  prohibition  of  an 
acquisition of more than a 20% interest in a public company (in the absence of an applicable exception) under the takeovers provisions 
of Australia's Corporations Act by any person whether foreign or otherwise.

Under the Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act, as currently in effect, any foreign person, together with associates, or parties 
acting in concert, is prohibited from acquiring 20% or more of the shares in any company having total assets of A$252 million or more 
(or A$1,094 million or more in case of U.S. investors or investors from certain other countries). No asset threshold applies in the case 
of  foreign  government  investors  and  acquiring  a  direct  interest  in  land  owning  entities  Australia  (generally  10%).   Different  rules 
apply to sensitive industries (such as media, telecommunications, and encryption and security technologies), companies owning land 
or that are agribusinesses. “Associates” is a broadly defined term under the Foreign Acquisitions and Takeovers Act and includes in 
relation to any person:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

any relative of the person;

any person with whom the person is acting or proposes to act in concert;

any person with whom the person carries on a business in partnership;

any entity of which the person is a 'senior officer' (such as a director or executive);

if the person is an entity, any holding entity or any senior officer of the holding entity;

any entity whose senior officers are accustomed or obliged to act in accordance with the directions, instructions or wishes of 
the person or if the person is an entity, its senior officers or vice versa;

any corporation in which the person holds a 'substantial interest' (i.e., 20%) or any person holding a substantial interest in the 
person if a corporation;

a trustee of a trust in which the person holds a substantial interest or if the person is the trustee of a trust, a person who holds 
a substantial interest in the trust;

if the person is a foreign government, government entities of that government.

The  Australian  Treasurer  also  has  power  in  certain  circumstances  to  make  an  order  specifying  that  two  or  more  persons  are 

associates.

In addition, a foreign person may not acquire shares in a company having total assets of A$252 million or more (or A$1,094 
million or more in case of U.S. investors or investors from certain other countries) if, as a result of that acquisition, the total holdings 
of  all  foreign  persons  and  their  associates  will  exceed  40%  in  aggregate  without  the  approval  of  the  Australian  Treasurer.  If  the 
necessary approvals are not obtained, the Treasurer may make an order requiring the acquirer to dispose of the shares it has acquired 
within a specified period of time. The same rule applies if the total holdings of all foreign persons and their associates already exceeds 
40% and a foreign person (or its associate) acquires any further shares, including in the course of trading in the secondary market of 
the ADSs. Different rules apply to government investors, and acquisitions of interests in sensitive business acquisitions, agribusiness 
and land owning entities.

Each  foreign  person  seeking  to  acquire  holdings  in  excess  of  the  above  caps  (including  their  associates,  as  the  case  may  be) 
would need to complete an application form setting out the proposal and relevant particulars of the acquisition/shareholding and pay 
the relevant application fees. The Australian Treasurer then has 30 days to consider the application and make a decision. However, the 
Australian  Treasurer  may  extend  the  period  by  up  to  a  further  90  days  by  publishing  an  interim  order.  The  Australian  Foreign 
Investment  Review  Board,  an  Australian  advisory  board  to  the  Australian  Treasurer  has  provided  a  guideline  titled Australia’s 
Foreign  Investment  Policy which  provides  an  outline  of  the  policy.  As  for  the  risk  associated  with  seeking  approval,  the  policy 
provides, among other things, that the Treasurer will reject an application if it is contrary to the national interest.

If the level of foreign ownership exceeds 40% at any time, we would be considered a foreign person under the Takeovers Act. In 
such event, we would be required to obtain the approval of the Australian Treasurer for our company, together with our associates, to 
acquire (i) more than 20% of an Australian company or business with assets totalling over A$252 million; or (ii) any direct or indirect 
ownership in Australian land; or (iii) any ‘direct interest’ in any agribusiness.

128

 
The  percentage  of  foreign  ownership  in  our  company  would  also  be  included  determining  the  foreign  ownership  of  any 
Australian company or business in which it may choose to invest. Since we have no current plans for any such acquisition and do not 
own any property, any such approvals required to be obtained by us as a foreign person under the Takeovers Act will not affect our 
current or future ownership or lease of property in Australia.

Our Constitution does not contain any additional limitations on a non-resident’s right to hold or vote our securities.

Australian law requires the transfer of shares in our company to be made in writing or electronically through the Clearing House 

Electronic Subregister System. No stamp duty will be payable in Australia on the transfer of ADSs.

10.E

Taxation

The following summary of the material Australian and U.S. federal income tax consequences of an investment in our ADSs or 
ordinary  shares  is  based  upon  laws  and  relevant  interpretations  thereof  in  effect  as  of  the  date  of  this  Form  20-F,  all  of  which  are 
subject  to  change,  possibly  with  retroactive  effect.  This  summary  does  not  deal  with  all  possible  tax  consequences  relating  to  an 
investment  in  our  ADSs  or  ordinary  shares,  such  as  the  tax  consequences  under  U.S.  state,  local  and  other  tax  laws  other  than 
Australian and U.S. federal income tax laws. 

Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations to U.S. Holders

The following summary describes the material U.S. federal income tax consequences to U.S. holders (as defined below) of the 
ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares and ADSs as of the date hereof. Except where noted, this summary deals only with 
our ordinary shares or ADSs acquired and held as capital assets within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Internal Revenue Code of 
1986, as amended, or the Code. This section does not discuss the tax consequences to any particular holder, nor any tax considerations 
that may apply to holders subject to special tax rules, such as:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

banks, insurance companies, regulated investment companies and real estate investment trusts;

financial institutions;

individual retirement and other tax-deferred accounts;

certain former U.S. citizens or long-term residents;

brokers or dealers in securities or currencies;

traders that elect to use a mark-to-market method of accounting;

partnerships  and  other  entities  treated  as  partnership  or  pass  through  entities  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax  purposes,  and 
partners or investors in such entities;

tax-exempt organizations (including private foundations);

persons subject to the alternative minimum tax;

persons that hold or dispose of ordinary shares or ADSs as a position in a straddle or as part of a hedging, constructive 
sale, conversion or other integrated transaction;

persons that have a functional currency other than the U.S. dollar;

persons that own (directly, indirectly or constructively) 10% or more of our equity; or

persons that are not U.S. holders (as defined below).

In this section, a “U.S. holder” means a beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs, other than a partnership or other entity 

treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, that is, for U.S. federal income tax purposes:

•

•

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States (for U.S. federal income tax purposes);

a  corporation  (or  other  entity  treated  as  a  corporation  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax  purposes)  created  or  organized  in  or 
under the laws of the United States or any state thereof or the District of Columbia;

129

•

•

an estate the income of which is includable in gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes regardless of its source; 
or

a trust (i) the administration of which is subject to the primary supervision of a court in the United States and for which 
one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions or (ii) that has an election in effect under 
applicable income tax regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.

The discussion below is based upon the provisions of the Code, and the U.S. Treasury regulations, rulings and judicial decisions 
thereunder as of the date hereof, and such authorities may be replaced, revoked or modified, possibly with retroactive effect, so as to 
result in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those discussed below. In addition, this summary is based, in part, upon 
the  terms  of  the  deposit  agreement  and  assumes  that  the  deposit  agreement,  and  all  other  related  agreements,  will  be  performed  in 
accordance with their terms.

If  a  partnership  or  an  entity  or  arrangement  treated  as  a  partnership  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax  purposes  acquires,  owns  or 
disposes  of  ordinary  shares  or  ADSs,  the  U.S.  federal  income  tax  treatment  of  a  partner  generally  will  depend  on  the  status  of  the 
partner and the activities of the partnership. Partners of partnerships that acquire, own or dispose of ordinary shares or ADSs should 
consult their tax advisors.

You  are  urged  to  consult  your  own  tax  advisor  with  respect  to  the  U.S.  federal,  as  well  as  state,  local  and  non-U.S.,  tax 
consequences  to  you  of  acquiring,  owning  and  disposing  of  ordinary  shares  or  ADSs  in  light  of  your  particular  circumstances, 
including the possible effects of changes in U.S. federal income and other tax laws and the effects of any tax treaties.

ADSs

Assuming  the  deposit  agreement  and  all  other  related  agreements  will  be  performed  in  accordance  with  their  terms,  a  U.S. 
holder of ADSs will be treated as the beneficial owner for U.S. federal income tax purposes of the underlying shares represented by 
the ADSs. The U.S. Treasury has expressed concerns that parties to whom American depositary shares are released before shares are 
delivered to the depositary, or intermediaries in the chain of ownership between holders of American depositary shares and the issuer 
of the security underlying the American depositary shares, may be taking actions that are inconsistent with claiming foreign tax credits 
by holders of American depositary shares. These actions would also be inconsistent with claiming the reduced rate of tax, described 
below, applicable to dividends received by certain non-corporate holders. Accordingly, the creditability of any foreign taxes and the 
availability  of  the  reduced  tax  rate  for  dividends  received  by  certain  non-corporate  U.S.  Holders,  each  described  below,  could  be 
affected by actions taken by such parties or intermediaries.

Distributions

Subject  to  the  passive  foreign  investment  company,  or  PFIC,  rules  discussed  below,  U.S.  holders  generally  will  include  as 
dividend  income  the  U.S.  dollar  value  of  the  gross  amount  of  any  distributions  of  cash  or  property  (without  deduction  for  any 
withholding tax), other than certain pro rata distributions of ordinary shares, with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs to the extent the 
distributions are made from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes. A 
U.S. holder will include the dividend income on the day actually or constructively received: (i) by the holder, in the case of ordinary 
shares,  or  (ii)  by  the  depositary,  in  the  case  of  ADSs.  To  the  extent,  if  any,  that  the  amount  of  any  distribution  by  us  exceeds  our 
current and accumulated earnings and profits, as so determined, the excess will be treated first as a tax-free return of the U.S. holder’s 
tax basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain. Notwithstanding the foregoing, we do not intend to determine 
our earnings and profits on the basis of U.S. federal income tax principles. Consequently, any distributions generally will be reported 
as  dividend  income  for  U.S.  information  reporting  purposes.  See  “—Backup  Withholding  Tax  and  Information  Reporting 
Requirements”  below.  Dividends  paid  by  us  will  not  be  eligible  for  the  dividends-received  deduction  generally  allowed  to  U.S. 
corporate shareholders.

The U.S. dollar amount of dividends received by an individual, trust or estate with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs will 
be  subject  to  taxation  at  a  maximum  rate  of  20%  if  the  dividends  are  “qualified  dividends.”  Dividends  paid  on  ordinary  shares  or 
ADSs  will  be  treated  as  qualified  dividends  if  (i)(a)  we  are  eligible  for  the  benefits  of  a  comprehensive  income  tax  treaty  with  the 
United  States  that  the  Secretary  of  the  Treasury  of  the  United  States  determines  is  satisfactory  for  this  purpose  and  includes  an 
exchange of information program or (b) the dividends are with respect to ordinary shares (or ADSs in respect of such shares) which 
are readily tradable on a U.S. securities market; (ii) certain holding period requirements are met; and (iii) we are not classified as a 
PFIC for the taxable year in which the dividend is paid or for the preceding taxable year. The Agreement between the Government of 
the United States of America and the Government of Australia for the Avoidance of Double Taxation and the Prevention of Fiscal 
Evasion with Respect to Taxes on Income, or the Treaty, has been approved for the purposes of the qualified dividend rules, and we 
expect to qualify for benefits under the Treaty. In addition, our ADSs are listed on the Nasdaq Global Select Market, and as such U.S. 
Treasury  Department  guidance  indicates  that  our  ADSs  will  be  readily  tradable  on  an  established  U.S.  securities  market.  Thus,  we 
believe that as long as we are not a PFIC, dividends we pay generally should be eligible for the reduced income tax rate on qualified 

130

dividends.  However,  the  determination  of  whether  a  dividend  qualifies  for  the  preferential  tax  rates  must  be  made  at  the  time  the 
dividend is paid. U.S. holders should consult their own tax advisors.

Includible  distributions  paid  in  Australian  dollars,  including  any  Australian  withholding  taxes,  will  be  included  in  the  gross 
income of a U.S. holder in a U.S. dollar amount calculated by reference to the spot exchange rate in effect on the date of actual or 
constructive receipt, regardless of whether the Australian dollars are converted into U.S. dollars at that time. If Australian dollars are 
converted into U.S. dollars on the date of actual or constructive receipt, the tax basis of the U.S. holder in those Australian dollars will 
be equal to their U.S. dollar value on that date and, as a result, a U.S. holder generally should not be required to recognize any foreign 
currency exchange gain or loss. If Australian dollars so received are not converted into U.S. dollars on the date of receipt, the U.S. 
holder will have a basis in the Australian dollars equal to their U.S. dollar value on the date of receipt. Any foreign currency exchange 
gain or loss on a subsequent conversion or other disposition of the Australian dollars generally will be treated as ordinary income or 
loss to such U.S. holder and generally will be income or loss from sources within the United States for foreign tax credit limitation 
purposes.

Dividends  received  by  a  U.S.  holder  with  respect  to  ordinary  shares  (or  ADSs  in  respect  of  such  shares)  will  be  treated  as 
foreign source income, which may be relevant in calculating the holder’s foreign tax credit limitation. The limitation on foreign taxes 
eligible for credit is calculated separately with respect to specific classes of income. For this purpose, dividends distributed by us with 
respect to ADSs or ordinary shares will generally constitute “passive category income” but could, in the case of certain U.S. holders, 
constitute “general category income.”

Subject to certain complex limitations, including the PFIC rules discussed below, a U.S. holder generally will be entitled, at its 
option, to claim either a credit against its U.S. federal income tax liability or a deduction in computing its U.S. federal taxable income 
in respect of any Australian taxes withheld. If a U.S. holder elects to claim a deduction, rather than a foreign tax credit, for Australian 
taxes  withheld  for  a  particular  taxable  year,  the  election  will  apply  to  all  foreign  taxes  paid  or  accrued  by  or  on  behalf  of  the  U.S. 
holder in the particular taxable year.

The availability of the foreign tax credit and the application of the limitations on its availability are fact specific and are subject 
to  complex  rules.  You  are  urged  to  consult  your  own  tax  advisor  as  to  the  consequences  of  Australian  withholding  taxes  and  the 
availability  of  a  foreign  tax  credit  or  deduction.  See  “—Australian  Tax  Considerations  Australian—Income  Tax—Taxation  of 
Dividends” below.

Sale, Exchange or Other Disposition of Ordinary Shares or ADSs

Subject to the PFIC rules discussed below, a U.S. holder generally will, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, recognize capital 
gain or loss, if any, on a sale, exchange or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs equal to the difference between the amount 
realized on the disposition and the U.S. holder’s tax basis (in U.S. dollars) in the ordinary shares or ADSs. This recognized gain or 
loss will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if the U.S. holder has held the ordinary shares or ADSs for more than one year. 
Generally,  for  U.S.  holders  who  are  individuals  (as  well  as  certain  trusts  and  estates),  long-term  capital  gains  are  subject  to  U.S. 
federal income tax at preferential rates. For foreign tax credit limitation purposes, gain or loss recognized upon a disposition generally 
will be treated as from sources within the United States. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations for U.S. federal 
income tax purposes.

You should consult your own tax advisor regarding the tax consequences if a foreign tax is imposed on a disposition of ADSs or 
ordinary shares, including availability of a foreign tax credit or deduction in respect of any Australian tax imposed on a sale or other 
disposition  of  ordinary  shares  or  ADSs.  See  “—Australian  Tax  Considerations—Australian  Income  Tax—Tax  on  Sales  or  Other 
Dispositions of Shares—Capital Gains Tax.”

Passive Foreign Investment Company

As a non-U.S. corporation, we will be a PFIC for any taxable year if either: (i) 75% or more of our gross income for the taxable 
year is passive income (such as certain dividends, interest, rents or royalties and certain gains from the sale of shares and securities or 
commodities  transactions,  including  amounts  derived  by  reason  of  the  temporary  investment  of  funds  raised  in  offerings  of  our 
ordinary shares or ADSs); or (ii) the average percentage value of our gross assets during the taxable year that produce passive income 
or are held for the production of passive income is at least 50% of the value of our total assets. For purposes of the PFIC asset test, 
passive assets generally include any cash, cash equivalents and cash invested in short-term, interest bearing debt instruments or bank 
deposits that is readily convertible into cash. If we own at least 25% (by value) of the stock of another corporation, we will be treated, 
for purposes of the PFIC income and asset tests, as owning our proportionate share of the other corporation’s assets and receiving our 
proportionate share of the other corporation’s income.

131

We do not believe that we were a PFIC for the taxable year ending June 30, 2017. However, if there is a change in the type or 
composition  of  our  gross  income,  or  our  actual  business  results  do  not  match  our  projections,  it  is  possible  that  we  may  become  a 
PFIC in future taxable years. Investors should be aware that our gross income for purposes of the PFIC income test depends on the 
receipt of Australian research and development tax incentive credits and other revenue, and there can be no assurances that such tax 
incentive credit programs will not be revoked or modified, that we will continue to conduct our operations in the manner necessary to 
be  eligible  for  such  incentives  or  that  we  will  receive  other  gross  income  that  is  not  considered  passive  for  purposes  of  the  PFIC 
income  test.  The  value  of  our  assets  for  purposes  of  the  PFIC  asset  test  will  generally  be  determined  by  reference  to  our  market 
capitalization,  which  may  fluctuate.  The  composition  of  our  income  and  assets  will  also  be  affected  by  how,  and  how  quickly,  we 
spend the cash raised in offerings of our ordinary shares or ADSs. Under circumstances where our gross income from activities that 
produce passive income significantly increases relative to our gross income from activities that produce non-passive income or where 
we decide not to deploy significant amounts of cash for active purposes, our risk of becoming classified as a PFIC may substantially 
increase. Since a separate factual determination as to whether we are or have become a PFIC must be made each year (after the close 
of such year), we cannot assure you that we will not be or become a PFIC in the current year or any future taxable year. There can be 
no assurance that we will not be a PFIC for any taxable year, as PFIC status is determined each year and depends on the composition 
of our income and assets and the value of our assets in such year. If we are a PFIC for any taxable year, upon request, we intend to 
provide U.S. holders with the information necessary to make and maintain a “Qualified Electing Fund” election, as described below.

Default PFIC Rules

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which you own our ordinary shares or ADSs, unless you make the mark-to-market 
election or the Qualified Electing Fund election described below, you will generally be (and remain) subject to additional taxes and 
interest charges, regardless of whether we remain a PFIC in any subsequent taxable year (i) on certain “excess” distributions we may 
make and (ii) on any gain realized on the disposition or deemed disposition of your ordinary shares or ADSs. Distributions in respect 
of your ordinary shares (or ADSs in respect of such shares) during the taxable year will generally constitute “excess” distributions if, 
in the aggregate, they exceed 125% of the average amount of distributions in respect of your ordinary shares (or ADSs) over the three 
preceding taxable years or, if shorter, the portion of your holding period before such taxable year.

To compute the tax on “excess” distributions or any gain: (i) the “excess” distribution or the gain will be allocated ratably to 
each  day  in  your  holding  period  for  the  ADSs  or  the  ordinary  shares;  (ii)  the  amount  allocated  to  the  current  taxable  year  and  any 
taxable year before we became a PFIC will be taxed as ordinary income in the current year; (iii) the amount allocated to other taxable 
years  will  be  taxable  at  the  highest  applicable  marginal  rate  in  effect  for  that  year;  and  (iv)  an  interest  charge  at  the  rate  for 
underpayment of taxes will be imposed with respect to any portion of the “excess” distribution or gain described under (iii) above that 
is allocated to such other taxable years. In addition, if we are a PFIC or, with respect to a particular U.S. holder, we are treated as a 
PFIC for the taxable year in which the distribution was paid or the prior taxable year, no distribution that you receive from us will 
qualify for taxation at the preferential rate for non-corporate holders discussed in “—Distributions” above. You should consult with 
your own tax advisor regarding the application of the default PFIC rules based on your particular circumstances.

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which a U.S. holder holds our ADSs or ordinary shares and any of our non-U.S. 
subsidiaries is also a PFIC (i.e., a lower-tier PFIC), such a U.S. holder would be treated as owning a proportionate amount (by value) 
of the shares of the lower-tier PFIC and would be subject to the rules described above on certain distributions by the lower-tier PFIC 
and  our  disposition  of  shares  of  the  lower-tier  PFIC,  even  though  such  U.S.  holder  would  not  receive  the  proceeds  of  those 
distributions or dispositions. You should consult with your own tax advisor regarding the application to you of the PFIC rules to any 
of our subsidiaries if we are a PFIC.

Mark-to-Market Election

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which you own our ADSs or ordinary shares, you will be able to avoid the rules 
applicable to “excess” distributions or gains described above if the ordinary shares or ADSs are “marketable” and you make a timely 
“mark-to-market” election with respect to your ordinary shares or ADSs. The ordinary shares or ADSs will be “marketable” stock as 
long  as  they  remain  regularly  traded  on  a  national  securities  exchange,  such  as  the  Nasdaq  Global  Select  Market,  or  a  foreign 
securities  exchange  regulated  by  a  governmental  authority  of  the  country  in  which  the  market  is  located  and  which  meets  certain 
requirements, including that the rules of the exchange effectively promote active trading of listed stocks. If such stock is traded on 
such a qualified exchange or other market, such stock generally will be “regularly traded” for any calendar year during which such 
stock is traded, other than in de minimis quantities, on at least 15 days during each calendar quarter, but no assurances can be given in 
this regard. Our ordinary shares are traded on the ASX, which may qualify as an eligible foreign securities exchange for this purpose.

If you are eligible to make a “mark-to-market” election with respect to our ordinary shares or ADSs and you make this election 
in a timely fashion, you will generally recognize as ordinary income or ordinary loss the difference between the fair market value of 
your ordinary shares or ADSs on the last day of any taxable year and your adjusted tax basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Any 
ordinary income resulting from this election will generally be taxed at ordinary income rates. Any ordinary losses will be deductible 

132

only to the extent of the net amount of previously included income as a result of the mark-to-market election, if any. Your adjusted tax 
basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs will be adjusted to reflect any such income or loss. Any gain recognized on the sale or other 
disposition of your ordinary shares or ADSs in a year when we are a PFIC will be treated as ordinary income, and any loss will be 
treated as an ordinary loss (but only to the extent of the net amount previously included as ordinary income as a result of the mark-to-
market election).

Because a mark-to-market election cannot be made for any lower-tier PFICs that we may own, a U.S. holder may continue to be 
subject to the PFIC rules with respect to its indirect interest in any investments held by us that are treated as an equity interest in a 
PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes, including shares in any of our subsidiaries that are treated as PFICs.

You should consult with your own tax advisor regarding the applicability and potential advantages and disadvantages to you of 
making a “mark-to-market” election with respect to your ordinary shares or ADSs if we are or become a PFIC, including the tax issues 
raised by lower-tier PFICs that we may own and the procedures for making such an election.

QEF Election

Alternative rules to those set forth under “Default PFIC Rules” above apply if an election is made to treat us as a “Qualified 
Electing  Fund,”  or  QEF,  under  Section  1295  of  the  Code.  A  QEF  election  is  available  only  if  the  U.S.  holder  receives  an  annual 
information  statement  from  us  setting  forth  its  ordinary  earnings  and  net  capital  gains,  as  calculated  for  U.S.  federal  income  tax 
purposes.

Upon  request  from  a  U.S.  holder,  we  will  endeavor  to  provide  to  the  U.S.  holder  within  90  days  after  the  request  an  annual 
information statement, in order to enable the U.S. holder to make and maintain a QEF election for us or for any of our subsidiaries that 
is or becomes a PFIC. However, there is no assurance that we will have timely knowledge of our or our subsidiaries’ status as a PFIC 
in the future or of the required information to be provided. You should consult your own tax advisor regarding the availability and tax 
consequences of a QEF election with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs or with respect to any lower-tier PFIC that we may own 
under your particular circumstances.

Reporting

If we are a PFIC for any taxable year during which you own our ordinary shares or ADSs, as a U.S. holder, you will generally 
be required to file IRS Form 8621 on an annual basis, and other reporting requirements may apply. The PFIC rules are complex and 
you should consult with your own tax advisor regarding whether we or any of our subsidiaries are a PFIC, the tax consequences of any 
elections that may be available to you, and how the PFIC rules may affect the U.S. federal income tax consequences of the receipt, 
ownership, and disposition of our ordinary shares or ADSs.

Tax on Net Investment Income

Certain non-corporate U.S. holders will be subject to a 3.8% tax on the lesser of (i) the U.S. holder’s “net investment income” 
for the relevant taxable year and (ii) the excess of the U.S. holder’s modified adjusted gross income for the taxable year over a certain 
threshold. A U.S. holder’s net investment income will generally include dividends received on the ordinary shares or ADSs and net 
gains from the disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs, unless such dividend income or net gains are derived in the ordinary course of 
the conduct of a trade or business (other than a trade or business that consists of certain passive or trading activities). A U.S. holder 
that  is  an  individual,  estate  or  trust  should  consult  the  holder’s  tax  advisor  regarding  the  applicability  of  the  tax  on  net  investment 
income to the holder’s dividend income and gains in respect of the holder’s investment in the ordinary shares or ADSs.

Backup Withholding Tax and Information Reporting Requirements

U.S. backup withholding tax and information reporting requirements generally apply to payments to non-corporate holders of 
ordinary  shares  or  ADSs.  Information  reporting  will  apply  to  payments  of  dividends  on,  and  to  proceeds  from  the  disposition  of, 
ordinary shares or ADSs by a paying agent within the United States to a U.S. holder, other than U.S. holders that are exempt from 
information reporting and properly certify their exemption. A paying agent within the United States will be required to withhold at the 
applicable statutory rate, currently 28%, in respect of any payments of dividends on, and the proceeds from the disposition of, ordinary 
shares  or  ADSs  within  the  United  States  to  a  U.S.  holder  (other  than  U.S.  holders  that  are  exempt  from  backup  withholding  and 
properly certify their exemption) if the holder fails to furnish its correct taxpayer identification number or otherwise fails to comply 
with  applicable  backup  withholding  requirements.  U.S.  holders  who  are  required  to  establish  their  exempt  status  generally  must 
provide a properly completed IRS Form W-9.

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld as backup withholding may be credited against a U.S. holder’s 
U.S. federal income tax liability. A U.S. holder generally may obtain a refund of any amounts withheld under the backup withholding 

133

rules in excess of such holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability by filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS in a timely 
manner and furnishing any required information.

Certain U.S. holders may be required to report information with respect to such holder’s interest in “specified foreign financial 
assets” (as defined in Section 6038D of the Code), including stock of a non-U.S. corporation that is not held in an account maintained 
by a U.S. “financial institution”. Persons who are required to report specified foreign financial assets and fail to do so may be subject 
to substantial penalties. U.S. holders are urged to consult their own tax advisors regarding foreign financial asset reporting obligations 
and their possible application to the holding of ordinary shares or ADSs.

The discussion above is not intended to constitute a complete analysis of all tax considerations applicable to an investment in 
our ordinary shares or ADSs. You should consult with your own tax advisor concerning the tax consequences to you in your particular 
situation.

Australian Tax Considerations

In this section, we discuss the material Australian income tax, stamp duty and goods and services tax considerations related to 
the acquisition, ownership and disposal by the absolute beneficial owners of the ordinary shares or ADSs. It is based upon existing 
Australian tax law as of the date of this annual report, which is subject to change, possibly retrospectively. This discussion does not 
address  all  aspects  of  Australian  tax  law  which  may  be  important  to  particular  investors  in  light  of  their  individual  investment 
circumstances, such as shares held by investors subject to special tax rules (for example, financial institutions, insurance companies or 
tax exempt organizations). In addition, this summary does not discuss any foreign or state tax considerations, other than stamp duty 
and goods and services tax. Prospective investors are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the Australian and foreign income 
and other tax considerations of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of the shares. This summary is based upon the premise that 
the holder is not an Australian tax resident and is not carrying on business in Australia through a permanent establishment (referred to 
as a “Foreign Shareholder” in this summary).

Australian Income Tax

Nature of ADSs for Australian Taxation Purposes

Ordinary  shares  represented  by  ADSs  held  by  a  U.S.  holder  will  be  treated  for  Australian  taxation  purposes  as  held  under  a 
“bare trust” for such holder. Consequently, the underlying ordinary shares will be regarded as owned by the ADS holder for Australian 
income tax and capital gains tax purposes. Dividends paid on the underlying ordinary shares will also be treated as dividends paid to 
the  ADS  holder,  as  the  person  beneficially  entitled  to  those  dividends.  Therefore,  in  the  following  analysis  we  discuss  the  tax 
consequences  to  non-Australian  resident  holders  of  ordinary  shares  which,  for  Australian  taxation  purposes,  will  be  the  same  as  to 
U.S. holders of ADSs.

Taxation of Dividends

Australia  operates  a  dividend  imputation  system  under  which  dividends  may  be  declared  to  be  “franked”  to  the  extent  of  tax 
paid on company profits. Fully franked dividends are not subject to dividend withholding tax. Dividends payable to non-Australian 
resident shareholders that are not operating from an Australian permanent establishment, or Foreign Shareholders, will be subject to 
dividend withholding tax, to the extent the dividends are not foreign (i.e., non-Australian) sourced and declared to be conduit foreign 
income, or CFI, and are unfranked. Dividend withholding tax will be imposed at 30%, unless a shareholder is a resident of a country 
with which Australia has a double taxation agreement and qualifies for the benefits of the treaty. Under the provisions of the current 
Double Taxation Convention between Australia and the United States, the Australian tax withheld on unfranked dividends that are not 
CFI paid by us to which a resident of the United States is beneficially entitled is limited to 15%.

If a company that is a non-Australian resident shareholder directly owns a 10% or more interest, the Australian tax withheld on 
unfranked dividends (that are not CFI) paid by us to which a resident of the United States is beneficially entitled is limited to 5%. In 
limited circumstances the rate of withholding can be reduced to zero.

Tax on Sales or Other Dispositions of Shares—Capital Gains Tax

Foreign  Shareholders  will  not  be  subject  to  Australian  capital  gains  tax  on  the  gain  made  on  a  sale  or  other  disposal  of  our 
ordinary shares, unless they, together with associates, hold 10% or more of our issued capital, at the time of disposal or for 12 months 
of the last 2 years prior to disposal.

Foreign Shareholders who own a 10% or more interest would be subject to Australian capital gains tax if more than 50% of our 
assets held directly or indirectly, determined by reference to market value, consists of Australian real property (which includes land 

134

and leasehold interests) or Australian mining, quarrying or prospecting rights. The Double Taxation Convention between the United 
States  and  Australia  is  unlikely  to  limit  the  amount  of  this  taxable  gain.  Australian  capital  gains  tax  applies  to  net  capital  gains  of 
Foreign Shareholders at the Australian tax rates for non-Australian residents, which start at a marginal rate of 32.5%. Net capital gains 
are calculated after reduction for capital losses, which may only be offset against capital gains.

The 50% capital gains tax discount is not available to non-Australian residents on gains accrued after May 8, 2012. Companies 

are not entitled to a capital gains tax discount.

Broadly, where there is a disposal of certain taxable Australian property, the purchaser will be required to withhold and remit to 
the  Australian  Taxation  Office  (“ATO”)  12.50%  of  the  proceeds  from  the  sale.  A  transaction  is  excluded  from  the  withholding 
requirements  in  certain  circumstances,  including  where  the  value  of  the  taxable  Australian  property  is  less  than  A$750,000,  the 
transaction is an on-market transaction conducted on an approved stock exchange, a securities lending, or the transaction is conducted 
using a broker operated crossing system.  There is also an exception to the requirement to withhold where the Commissioner issues a 
clearance  certificate  which  broadly  certifies  that  the  vendor  is  not  a  foreign  person.  The  Foreign  Shareholder  may  be  entitled  to 
receive a tax credit for the tax withheld by the purchaser which they may claim in their Australian income tax return.

Tax on Sales or Other Dispositions of Shares—Shareholders Holding Shares on Revenue Account

Some  Foreign  Shareholders  may  hold  ordinary  shares  on  revenue  rather  than  on  capital  account  for  example,  share  traders. 
These shareholders may have the gains made on the sale or other disposal of the ordinary shares included in their assessable income 
under the ordinary income provisions of the income tax law, if the gains are sourced in Australia.

Foreign Shareholders assessable under these ordinary income provisions in respect of gains made on ordinary shares held on 
revenue account would be assessed for such gains at the Australian tax rates for non-Australian residents, which start at a marginal 
rate  of  32.5%.  Some  relief  from  Australian  income  tax  may  be  available  to  such  non-Australian  resident  shareholders  under  the 
Double Taxation Convention between the United States and Australia.

To  the  extent  an  amount  would  be  included  in  a  Foreign  Shareholder’s  assessable  income  under  both  the  capital  gains  tax 
provisions and the ordinary income provisions, the capital gain amount would generally be reduced, so that the shareholder would not 
be subject to double tax on any part of the income gain or capital gain.

The  comments  above  in  “Tax  on  Sales  or  Other  Dispositions  of  Shares—Capital  Gains  Tax”  regarding  a  purchaser  being 
required  to  withhold  12.5%  tax  on  the  acquisition  of  certain  taxable  Australian  property  equally  applies  where  the  disposal  of  the 
Australian real property asset by a foreign resident is likely to generate gains on revenue account, rather than a capital gain.

Dual Residency

If  a  shareholder  were  a  resident  of  both  Australia  and  the  United  States  under  those  countries’  domestic  taxation  laws,  that 
shareholder may be subject to tax as an Australian resident. If, however, the shareholder is determined to be a U.S. resident for the 
purposes of the Double Taxation Convention between the United States and Australia, the Australian tax may be subject to limitation 
by the Double Taxation Convention. Shareholders should obtain specialist taxation advice in these circumstances.

Australian Death Duty

Australia does not have estate or death duties. As a general rule, no capital gains tax liability is realized upon the inheritance of a 
deceased person’s ordinary shares. The disposal of inherited ordinary shares by beneficiaries may, however, give rise to a capital gains 
tax liability if the gain falls within the scope of Australia’s jurisdiction to tax (as discussed above).

Stamp Duty

No Australian stamp duty is payable by Australian residents or non-Australian residents on the issue, transfer and/or surrender 
of the ADSs or the ordinary shares in Mesoblast, provided that the shares issued, transferred and/or surrendered do not represent 90% 
or more of the issued shares in Mesoblast.

Goods and Services Tax

The supply of ADSs and/or ordinary shares in Mesoblast will not be subject to Australian goods and services tax.

135

10.F

Dividends and Paying Agents

Not applicable.

10.G

Statement by Experts

Not applicable.

10.H

Documents on Display

Any statement in this Form 20-F about any of our contracts or other documents is not necessarily complete. If the contract or 
document is filed as an exhibit to the Form 20-F the contract or document is deemed to modify the description contained in this Form 
20-F. You must review the exhibits themselves for a complete description of the contract or document.

You may review a copy of our filings with the SEC, as well as other information furnished to the SEC, including exhibits and 
schedules filed with it, at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the 
SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information. In addition, the SEC maintains a website at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports 
and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC. These SEC filings are also available to the public from 
commercial document retrieval services.

We are required to file or furnish reports and other information with the SEC under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and 
regulations under that act. As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt from the rules under the Exchange Act prescribing the form and 
content of proxy statements and our officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and short swing profit 
recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

10.I

Subsidiary Information

For information about our subsidiaries, see “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note 12.”

Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

For information about our exposure to market risk and how we manage this risk, see “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note 10.”

Item 12. Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities

12.A

Debt Securities

Not applicable.

12.B

Warrants and Rights

Not applicable.

12.C

Other Securities

Not applicable.

136

12.D

American Depositary Shares

Fees Payable by ADR Holders

Holders of our ADRs may have to pay our ADS depositary, JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. (JPMorgan), fees or charges up to the 

amounts described in the following table:

Persons  depositing  or  withdrawing  ordinary  shares  or  ADS 
holders must pay:
$5.00  (or  less)  per  100  ADSs  (or  portion  of  100 
ADSs)

$0.05 (or less) per ADS
$1.50 per ADR
$0.04 (or less) per ADS per calendar year

Fees Payable by the Depositary to the Issuer

Description of service
 •  Issuance  of  ADSs,  including  issuances  pursuant  to  a 
deposits of shares, share or rights distributions, stock 
dividend, stock split, merger or any other transactions 
affecting the issuance of ADSs

•  Cancellation  of  ADSs  for  the  purpose  of  withdrawal 

of deposited securities

•  Cash distribution to ADS holders
•  Transfers of ADRs
•  Administrative services performed by the depositary

From  time  to  time,  the  depositary  may  make  payments  to  us  to  reimburse  and/or  share  revenue  from  the  fees  collected  from 
ADS holders, or waive fees and expenses for services provided, generally relating to costs and expenses arising out of establishment 
and maintenance of the ADS program. In performing its duties under the deposit agreement, the depositary may use brokers, dealers 
or other service providers that are affiliates of the depositary and that may earn or share fees or commissions.

137

 
Item 13

Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies

Not applicable.

PART II

Item 14 Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds

Not applicable.

Item 15

Controls and Procedures

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our  management,  with  the  participation  of  our  Chief  Executive  Officer  and  our  Chief  Financial  Officer,  evaluated  the 
effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of June 30, 2017. “Disclosure controls and procedures,” as defined in Rules 
13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act, are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed by a company in the 
reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is (i) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods 
specified  in  the  Securities  and  Exchange  Commission’s  rules  and  forms  and  (ii)  accumulated  and  communicated  to  the  company's 
management,  including  its  principal  executive  officer  and  principal  financial  officer,  as  appropriate  to  allow  timely  decisions 
regarding required disclosure.

Based  on  the  evaluation  of  our  disclosure  controls  and  procedures,  our  Chief  Executive  Officer  and  Chief  Financial  Officer 

concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of June 30, 2017. 

Management’s Report on Internal Controls over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in 
Rule 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Our management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal 
control over financial reporting as of June 30, 2017 based on the criteria set forth in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013) 
issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on the assessment, our management has 
concluded that its internal control over financial reporting was effective as of June 30, 2017.

Previously Identified Material Weaknesses in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting 

We previously identified and disclosed in Form 20-F for the period ended June 30, 2016, a material weakness in our internal 
control over financial reporting relating to us not having designed and implemented controls to maintain appropriate segregation of 
duties in our manual and computer based business processes which could have a pervasive impact over the preparation of the financial 
statements. 

Remediation Efforts to Address the Previously Disclosed Material Weaknesses 

Our management, with oversight from our Audit Committee, has implemented the following remediation steps to address the 

previously disclosed material weaknesses and to improve our internal control over financial reporting:

•

•

Segregated  duties  and  introduced  periodic  monitoring  of  potential  segregation  of  duties  conflicts  within  key  financial 
reporting processes; and
Implemented additional internal monitoring activities, including enhancing the analytical procedures related to journal entries 
and balance sheet reconciliations, to add depth to our review process and improve our segregation of duties.

As noted above, our management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as 
of June 30, 2017 and has concluded that its internal control over financial reporting was effective as of June 30, 2017.   Accordingly, 
we concluded the previously reported material weakness has been remediated as of June 30, 2017.  

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

Other than the remediation of the previously disclosed material weakness discussed above, there were no changes to our internal 
control  over  financial  reporting  that  occurred  during  the  period  covered  by  this  Form  20-F  that  have  materially  affected,  or  are 
reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. 

138

Limitations on Controls 

Our  disclosure  controls  and  procedures  and  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  are  designed  to  provide  reasonable 
assurance  of  achieving  the  desired  control  objectives.  Our  management  recognizes  that  any  control  system,  no  matter  how  well 
designed and operated, is based upon certain judgments and assumptions and cannot provide absolute assurance that its objectives will 
be met. Similarly, an evaluation of controls cannot provide absolute assurance that misstatements due to error or fraud will not occur 
or that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, have been detected.

Item 16A Audit Committee Financial Expert

The  Board  of  Directors  of  Mesoblast  Ltd  has  determined  that  Brian  Jamieson  and  Michael  Spooner  each  possess  specific 
accounting  and  financial  management  expertise  and  that  each  is  an  Audit  Committee  Financial  Expert  as  defined  by  the  SEC.  The 
Board of Directors has also determined that Donal O’Dwyer, a member of the Audit and Risk Management Committee, has sufficient 
experience and ability in finance and compliance matters to enable him to adequately discharge his responsibilities. All members of 
the Audit and Risk Management Committee are “independent” according to the listing standards of the Nasdaq Global Select Market.

Item 16B Code of Ethics

Our Code of Conduct covers conflicts of interest, confidentiality, fair dealing, protection of assets, compliance with laws and 
regulations,  whistle  blowing,  security  trading  and  commitments  to  stakeholders.  In  summary,  the  code  requires  that  at  all  times  all 
Company personnel act with the utmost integrity, objectivity and in compliance with the letter and the spirit of the law and Company 
policies. This document is accessible on our internet website at: http://www.mesoblast.com/company/corporate-governance/code-of-
conduct.

Item 16C Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Pre-Approval of Audit and Non-Audit Services

The Audit and Risk Management Committee’s pre-approval is required for all services provided by PwC. These services may 
include audit services, audit-related services, tax services and permissible non-audit services, and are subject to a specific budget. The 
Audit and Risk Management Committee uses a combination of two approaches – general pre-approval and specific pre-approval – in 
considering whether particular services or categories of services are consistent with the SEC’s rules on auditor independence. Under 
general pre-approval proposed services may be pre-approved without consideration of specific case-by-case services.

Audit and Non-Audit Services Fees

See “Item 18. Financial Statements – Note 18”. For the purpose of SEC classification, there were no audit-related, tax or other 

fees that were paid or payable to PwC during the year ended June 30, 2017 and 2016.

Item 16D Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees

Not applicable.

Item 16E Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers

Not applicable.

Item 16F Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant

Not applicable.

Item 16G Corporate Governance

Under Nasdaq Stock Market Rule 5615(a)(3), foreign private issuers, such as our company, are permitted to follow certain home 
country corporate governance practices instead of certain provisions of the Nasdaq Stock Market Rules. For example, we may follow 
home country practice with regard to certain corporate governance requirements, such as the composition of the board of directors and 
quorum requirements applicable to shareholders’ meetings. In addition, we may follow home country practice instead of the Nasdaq 
Stock Market Rules requirement to hold executive sessions and to obtain shareholder approval prior to the issuance of securities in 
connection with certain acquisitions or private placements of securities. Further, we may follow home country practice instead of the 

139

Nasdaq  Stock  Market  Rules  requirement  to  obtain  shareholder  approval  prior  to  the  establishment  or  amendment  of  certain  share 
option, purchase or other compensation plans. A foreign private issuer that elects to follow a home country practice instead of any 
Nasdaq  rule  must  submit  to  Nasdaq,  in  advance,  a  written  statement  from  an  independent  counsel  in  such  issuer’s  home  country 
certifying that the issuer’s practices are not prohibited by the home country’s laws. We submitted such a written statement to Nasdaq. 

Other  than  as  set  forth  below,  we  currently  intend  to  comply  with  the  corporate  governance  listing  standards  in  the  Nasdaq 
Stock Market Rules to the extent possible under Australian law. However, we may choose to change such practices to follow home 
country practice in the future.

The Nasdaq Stock Market Rules require that a listed company specify that the quorum for any meeting of the holders of share 
capital be at least 33 1/3% of the outstanding shares of the company’s common voting stock. We follow our home country practice, 
rather than complying with this rule. Consistent with Australian law, our bylaws do not require a quorum of at least 33 1/3% of the 
issued voting shares of Mesoblast for any general meeting of its shareholders. Our constitution provides that   a quorum for a general 
meeting of our shareholders constitutes five shareholders present in person, by proxy, by attorney, or, where the shareholders is a body 
corporate, by representative.   This provision and our practice of holding meetings with this quorum are not prohibited by the ASX 
Listing Rules or any other Australian law.

Item 16H Mine Safety Disclosure

Not applicable.

Item 17

Financial Statements

See “Item 18. Financial Statements.”

Item 18

Financial Statements

PART III

The following financial statements are filed as part of this annual report on Form 20-F.

Australian Disclosure Requirements

The financial statements cover Mesoblast Limited and its subsidiaries. The financial statements were authorized for issue by the 

board of directors on August 30, 2017. The directors have the power to amend and reissue the financial statements.

All press releases, financial reports and other information are available on our website: www.mesoblast.com

140

Auditor’s Independence Declaration 

As lead auditor for the audit of Mesoblast Limited for the year ended 30 June 2017, I declare that to 
the best of my knowledge and belief, there have been:  

(a)

no contraventions of the auditor independence requirements of the Corporations Act 2001 in
relation to the audit; and

(b)

no contraventions of any applicable code of professional conduct in relation to the audit.

This declaration is in respect of Mesoblast Limited and the entities it controlled during the period. 

Jon Roberts 

Partner 
PricewaterhouseCoopers 

Melbourne
30 August 2017

PricewaterhouseCoopers, ABN 52 780 433 757
2 Riverside Quay, SOUTHBANK  VIC  3006, GPO Box 1331, MELBOURNE  VIC  3001 
T: 61 3 8603 1000, F: 61 3 8603 1999, www.pwc.com.au 

Liability limited by a scheme approved under Professional Standards Legislation. 

141

Index to Financial Statements

Consolidated Income Statement ..........................................................................................................................................................
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income............................................................................................................................
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity ....................................................................................................................................
Consolidated Balance Sheet ................................................................................................................................................................
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows ...............................................................................................................................................
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements .......................................................................................................................................

143
144
145
146
147
148

142

Mesoblast Limited
Consolidated Income Statement

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands, except per share amount)
Revenue
Research & development
Manufacturing commercialization
Management and administration
Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration
Impairment of intangible assets
Other operating income and expenses
Loss before income tax
Income tax benefit/(expense)
Loss attributable to the owners of Mesoblast Limited

Losses per share from continuing operations attributable to the
   ordinary equity holders of the Group:
Basic - losses per share
Diluted - losses per share

Note
3

3
3
3
3
4

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

2,412 
(58,914)
(12,065)
(23,007)
(130)
— 
1,489 
(90,215)
13,400 
(76,815)

42,548     
(50,013)    
(29,763)    
(22,500)    
28,112     
(61,919)    
2,714     
(90,821)    
86,694     
(4,127)    

19,761 
(62,649)
(23,783)
(29,540)
(15,336)
— 
15,303 
(96,244)
— 
(96,244)

Cents

Cents

Cents

(19.43)
(19.43)

(1.14)    
(1.14)    

(29.99)
(29.99)

The above consolidated income statement should be read in conjunction with the accompanying Notes.

143

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
 
 
     
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
Mesoblast Limited
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Loss for the year
Other comprehensive (loss)/income
Items that may be reclassified to profit and loss
Changes in the fair value of available-for-sale financial
   assets
Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations
Other comprehensive (loss)/income for the period,
   net of tax
Total comprehensive loss attributable to the
   owners of Mesoblast Limited

Note

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

(76,815)    

(4,127)    

(96,244)

7(b)
7(b)

31     
316     

(334)    
(705)    

— 
(25,783)

347     

(1,039)    

(25,783)

(76,468)    

(5,166)    

(122,027)

The above consolidated statement of comprehensive income should be read in conjunction with the accompanying Notes.

144

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
      
      
  
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
Mesoblast Limited
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Balance as of July 1, 2014
Loss for the year
Other comprehensive loss
Total comprehensive loss for the period
Transactions with owners in their
   capacity as owners:
Contributions of equity net of transaction costs

Transfer exercised options
Fair value of share-based payments
Reclassification of modified options to liability

Balance as of June 30, 2015

Balance as of July 1, 2015
Loss for the period
Other comprehensive income
Total comprehensive profit/(loss) for the
   period
Transactions with owners in their
   capacity as owners:
Contributions of equity net of transaction costs

Transfer exercised options
Fair value of share-based payments
Reclassification of modified options to liability

Balance as of June 30, 2016

Balance as of July 1, 2016
Loss for the period
Other comprehensive income
Total comprehensive profit/(loss) for the
   period
Transactions with owners in their
   capacity as owners:
Contributions of equity net of transaction costs

Transfer exercised options
Fair value of share-based payments
Reclassification of modified options to liability

Balance as of June 30, 2017

  Note  Issued Capital  
662,722   
—   
—   
—   

  7(a)   

  17   

45,873   
45,873   
596   
—   
—   
596   
709,191   

Share Option
Reserve

Investment
Revaluation
Reserve

Foreign Currency
Translation
Reserve

Retained
Earnings     Total

55,754    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    
(596)   
6,976    
(1,394)   
4,986    
60,740    

—    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

(12,201)   (167,716)    538,559 
—     (96,244)    (96,244)
—     (25,783)
(25,783)   
(25,783)    (96,244)   (122,027)

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—     45,873 
—     45,873 
—    
— 
6,976 
—    
(1,394)
—    
5,582 
—    
(37,984)   (263,960)    467,987 

709,191   
—   
—   

60,740    
—    
—    

—    
—    
(334)   

(37,984)   (263,960)    467,987 
(4,127)
(1,039)

(4,127)   
—    

—    
(705)   

— 

— 

(334)

(705)

(4,127)

(5,166)

  7(a)   

  17   

60,947   
60,947   
134   
—   
—   
134   
770,272   

770,272   
—   
—   

—    
—    
(134)   
3,149    
1,244    
4,259    
64,999    

64,999    
—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
(334)   

(334)   
—    
31    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—     60,947 
—     60,947 
—    
— 
3,149 
—    
1,244 
—    
4,393 
—    
(38,689)   (268,087)    528,161 

(38,689)   (268,087)    528,161 
—     (76,815)    (76,815)
347 
—    
316    

— 

— 

31 

316 

  (76,815)

  (76,468)

  7(a)   

  17   

60,140   
60,140   
13   
—   
—   
13   
830,425   

—    
—    
(13)   
5,036    
(103)   
4,920    
69,919    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
(303)   

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—     60,140 
—     60,140 
—    
— 
5,036 
—    
—    
(103)
4,933 
—    
(38,373)   (344,902)    516,766  

The above consolidated statement of changes in equity should be read in conjunction with the accompanying Notes.

145

   
   
   
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
    
     
     
     
     
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
Mesoblast Limited
Consolidated Balance Sheet

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Assets
Current Assets
Cash & cash equivalents
Trade & other receivables
Prepayments
Total Current Assets

Non-Current Assets
Property, plant and equipment
Available-for-sale financial assets
Other non-current assets
Intangible assets
Total Non-Current Assets
Total Assets

Liabilities
Current Liabilities
Trade and other payables
Provisions
Total Current Liabilities

Non-Current Liabilities
Deferred tax liability
Provisions
Total Non-Current Liabilities
Total Liabilities
Net Assets

Equity
Issued Capital
Reserves
(Accumulated losses)/retained earnings
Total Equity

Note

5(a)
5(b)
5(b)

6(a)
5(c)
5(d)
6(b)

5(e)
6(d)

6(e)
6(d)

7(a)
7(b)

As of June 30,

2017

2016

45,761 
3,743 
14,105 
63,609 

1,814 
1,997 
1,916 
586,350 
592,077 
655,686 

21,805 
14,865 
36,670 

49,293 
52,957 
102,250 
138,920 
516,766 

80,937 
4,054 
3,832 
88,823 

3,063 
1,966 
2,343 
587,823 
595,195 
684,018 

27,155 
2,260 
29,415 

62,693 
63,749 
126,442 
155,857 
528,161 

830,425 
31,243 
(344,902)
516,766 

770,272 
25,976 
(268,087)
528,161  

The above consolidated balance sheet should be read in conjunction with the accompanying Notes.

146

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
      
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
      
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
      
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
Mesoblast Limited
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Cash flows from operating activities
Commercialization revenue received
Milestone revenue received
Research and development tax incentive received
Payments to suppliers and employees (inclusive of goods and
   services tax)
Payments for fair value adjustments to contingent consideration
   subsequent to the business combination measurement period
Interest received
Other income received
Income taxes (paid)/refunded
Net cash (outflows) in operating activities

Cash flows from investing activities
Payments for financial derivatives
Payments for business combination
Payments for investments
Payments for licenses
Investment in fixed assets
Rental deposits received
Net cash inflows/(outflows) in investing activities

Cash flows from financing activities
Proceeds from issue of shares
Payments for share issue costs
Net cash inflows by financing activities

Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
FX gains/(losses) on the translation of foreign bank accounts
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

Note

2017

Year ended June 30,
2016

2015

1,332 
500 
2,813 

99 
3,500 
4,466 

— 
2,000 
4,456 

(100,598)

(97,190)

(106,760)

— 

483 
— 
(1)
(95,471)

— 
— 
— 
— 
(311)
453 
142 

61,932 
(1,927)
60,005 

(35,324)
80,937 
148 
45,761 

— 

(4,112)

1,129 
— 
— 
(87,996)

3,043 
405 
(68)
(101,036)

— 
— 
(805)
(200)
(722)
— 
(1,727)

68,549 
(6,483)
62,066 

(27,657)
110,701 
(2,107)
80,937 

(851)
(2,086)
— 
(195)
(2,204)
272 
(5,064)

46,291 
(439)
45,852 

(60,248)
185,003 
(14,054)
110,701  

8(b)

7(a)

8(a)

The above consolidated statement of cash flows should be read in conjunction with the accompanying Notes.

147

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
Mesoblast Limited
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Mesoblast  Limited  (“the  Company”)  and  its  subsidiaries  (“the  Group”)  are  primarily  engaged  in  the  development  of 
regenerative medicine products. The Group’s primary proprietary regenerative medicine technology platform is based on specialized 
cells  known  as  mesenchymal  lineage  adult  stem  cells.  The  Company  was  formed  in  2004  as  an  Australian  company  and  has  been 
listed on the Australian Securities Exchange (the “ASX”) since 2004. In November 2015, the Company listed in the United States of 
America (“U.S.”) on the Nasdaq Global Select Market (“Nasdaq”) and from this date has been dual-listed in Australia and the U.S.

These financial statements and notes are presented in U.S. dollars (“$” or “USD” or “US$”), unless otherwise noted, including 

certain amounts that are presented in Australian dollars (“AUD” or “A$”).

1. Significant changes in the current reporting period

(i) Significant events

The  financial  position  and  performance  of  the  Group  was  not  affected  by  any  significant  changes  in  the  year  ended  June  30, 

2017.

(ii) Going concern

For the financial years ended June 30, 2017, 2016 and 2015, the Group has incurred a total comprehensive loss after income tax 
of $76.5 million, $5.2 million and $122.0 million, respectively, and net cash outflows from operations of $95.5 million, $88.0 million 
and $101.0 million, respectively. As of June 30, 2017 the Group held total cash and cash equivalents of $45.8 million. In August 2017, 
the Group announced a fully underwritten entitlement offer to existing eligible shareholders (on a 1 for 12 basis) in Australia and New 
Zealand  and  institutional  shareholders  in  certain  other  countries  in  private  placements.  US$38.2  million  of  net  proceeds  from  the 
entitlement offer is expected to be received and recognized in cash and cash equivalents in September 2017.

The  Group  has  committed  to  partner  one  or  more  of  its  four  Tier  1  product  candidates  resulting  in  non-dilutive  funding  for 
operations. This may include MSC-100-IV for steroid-refractory graft versus host disease (“GVHD”) and MPC-06-ID for chronic low 
back pain, in relation to which the Group has entered into an agreement with Mallinckrodt Pharmaceuticals (“Mallinckrodt”) in order 
to  exclusively  negotiate  a  commercial  and  development  partnership.   The  Group  is  also  continuing  to  work  on  various  cost 
containment and deferment strategies, including the reprioritization of projects. A fully discretionary equity facility remains for up to 
A$120  million/US$90  million  over  24  months  to  provide  additional  funds  as  required.  The  Group  may  also  consider  issuing  new 
capital to fund future operational requirements.

There  is  uncertainty  related  to  the  Group’s  ability  to  partner  programs  and  raise  capital  at  terms  to  meet  the  Group’s 
requirements.  Additionally,  there  is  uncertainty  related  to  the  Group’s  ability  to  sustainably  implement  further  cost  reductions  and 
defer programs on a timely basis while achieving expected outcomes.

The continuing viability of the Group and its ability to continue as a going concern and meet its debts and commitments as they 
fall  due  are  dependent  upon  entering  into  an  arrangement  with  a  third  party  partner  on  one  or  more  of  its  four  Tier  1  product 
candidates  that  would  result  in  non-dilutive  funding  and/or  raising  further  capital,  together  with  various  cost  containment  and 
deferment strategies being completed including the reprioritization of certain projects.

Management and the directors believe that the Group will be successful in the above matters and, accordingly, have prepared the 
financial report on a going concern basis, notwithstanding that there is a material uncertainty that may cast significant doubt on the 
Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and that it may be unable to realize its assets and liabilities in the normal course of 
business.

References  to  matters  that  may  cast  significant  doubt  about  the  Group’s  ability  to  continue  as  a  going  concern  also  raise 

substantial doubt as contemplated by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (“PCAOB”) standards.

2. Segment information

Operating segments are identified on the basis of whether the allocation of resources and/or the assessment of performance of a 
particular  component  of  the  Company’s  activities  are  regularly  reviewed  by  the  Company’s  chief  operating  decision  maker  as  a 
separate operating segment. By these criteria, the activities of the Company are considered to be one segment being the development 
of adult stem cell technology platform for commercialization, and the segmental analysis is the same as the analysis for the Company 
as a whole. The chief operating decision maker (Chief Executive Officer) reviews the consolidated income statement, balance sheet, 
and statement of cash flows regularly to make decisions about the Company’s resources and to assess overall performance.

148

3. Loss before income tax

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Revenue
Commercialization revenue
Milestone Revenue
Interest Revenue
Total Revenue

Clinical trial research & development
Manufacturing production & development

Employee benefits
Salaries and employee benefits
Defined contribution superannuation expenses
Equity settled share-based payment transactions(1)
Total Employee benefits

Depreciation and amortization of non-current assets
Plant and equipment depreciation
Intellectual property amortization
Total Depreciation and amortization of non-current assets

Other Management & administration expenses
Overheads & administration
Consultancy
Legal, patent and other professional fees
Intellectual property expenses (excluding the amount
   amortized above)
Total Other Management & administration expenses

Fair value remeasurement of contingent consideration
Remeasurement of contingent consideration
Total Fair value remeasurement of contingent
   consideration

Other operating income and expenses
Research & development tax incentive(2)
Foreign exchange gains/(losses)
Other revenue
Total Other operating income and expenses

  Note

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

1,444 
500 
468 
2,412 

(38,141)
(8,313)

(20,039)
(362)
(5,276)
(25,677)

(1,578)
(1,479)
(3,057)

(8,128)
(3,329)
(4,452)

(2,889)
(18,798)

37,969 
3,500 
1,079 
42,548 

(30,270)
(21,506)

(24,350)
(362)
(3,389)
(28,101)

(1,625)
(567)
(2,192)

(10,361)
(3,396)
(3,888)

(2,562)
(20,207)

15,004 
2,000 
2,757 
19,761 

(33,877)
(16,965)

(30,945)
(441)
(6,976)
(38,362)

(1,474)
(127)
(1,601)

(10,587)
(5,857)
(6,294)

(2,429)
(25,167)

  5(f)(iii)

(130)

28,112 

(15,336)

(130)

28,112 

(15,336)

1,532 
(43)
— 
1,489 

3,840 
(1,126)
— 
2,714 

4,418 
10,478 
407 
15,303 

Impairment of intangible assets
Impairment of in-process research and development acquired
Total Impairment of intangible assets
Total loss before income tax

  6(b)

— 
— 
(90,215)

(61,919)
(61,919)
(90,821)

— 
— 
(96,244)

(1)

Share-based payment transactions

For  the year  ended June  30,  2017,  2016  and  2015,  share-based  payment  transactions  have been  reflected  in the  Consolidated 
Statement of Comprehensive Income functional expense categories as follows: 

149

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
(in U.S. dollars)
Research and development
Manufacturing and commercialization
Management and administration

(2) Research and development tax incentive

Year Ended June 30,

2017

2015

2016
  2,837,231   2,461,110    3,022,572 
   420,762    681,355     717,912 
  2,017,172    246,197    3,235,490 
  5,275,165    3,388,662    6,975,974  

The  Group’s  research  and  development  activities  are  eligible  under  an  Australian  Government  tax  incentive  for  eligible 
expenditures from July 1, 2011. Management has assessed these activities and expenditures to determine which are likely to be 
eligible under the incentive scheme. At each period end management estimates the refundable tax offset available to the Group 
based on available information at the time. The Group uses the assistance of independent tax specialists to review, on an annual 
basis, the quantum of our previous research and development tax claim and our on-going eligibility to claim this tax incentive in 
Australia. For year ended June 30, 2017, 2016 and 2015, the Group has recognized income of $1.5 million, $3.8 million and 
$4.4 million, respectively.

Of the $1.5 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2017, $(0.1) 
million relates to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive income the Group estimated it 
would receive from the Australian Government for the year ended June 30, 2016.

Of the $3.8 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2016, $1.1 
million relates to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive income the Group estimated it 
would receive from the Australian Government for the year ended June 30, 2015.

Of the $4.4 million research and development tax incentive recorded in other income for the year ended June 30, 2015, $0.5 
million relates to a change in the original estimate of the research and development tax incentive income the Group estimated it 
would receive from the Australian Government for the year ended June 30, 2014.

4. Income tax benefit/(expense)

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

(a)Reconciliation of income tax to prima facie tax payable
  Loss from continuing operations before income tax
  Tax benefit at the Australian tax rate of 30% (2016: 30%)
  Tax effect of amounts which are not deductible/(exempt)

   in calculating taxable income:

  Share-based payments expense
  Research and development tax concessions
  Contingent consideration
  Other sundry items
  Current year tax expense/(benefit)
  Adjustments for current tax of prior periods
  Differences in overseas tax rates
  Tax benefit not recognized
  Previously unrecognized tax losses now recouped to reduce 

deferred tax expense/(benefit)

  Alternative minimum tax charge (USA)
  USA City and State tax benefit/(charge)
  USA City and State tax benefit — not recognized

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

(90,215)   
(27,065)   

(90,821)   
(27,246)   

(96,244)
(28,872)

1,488 
2,442 
39 
497 
(22,599)   
(5,870)   
7,797 
7,272 

— 
— 
— 
— 

884 
699 
(11,221)   
(1,873)   
(38,757)   
(2,224)   
9,192 
5,851 

(60,756)   

— 
— 
— 

2,048 
1,343 
4,439 
1,298 
(19,744)
3,633 
11,528 
4,583 

— 
— 
(323)
323 

—  

Income tax expense/(benefit) attributable to loss before 
income tax

(13,400)

(86,694)

150

 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
   
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
(b)Income tax expense/(benefit)
  Current tax
  Current tax
  Total current tax expense/(benefit)

  Deferred tax

(Increase)/decrease in deferred tax assets
Increase/(decrease) in deferred tax liabilities

  Total deferred tax expense/(benefit)

Income tax expense/(benefit)

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

—    
— 

—    
— 

(13,204)   
(196)   
(13,400)   
(13,400)   

(65,022)   
(21,672)   
(86,694)   
(86,694)   

— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
—  

Deferred tax assets have been brought to account only to the extent that it is foreseeable that they are recoverable against future 

tax liabilities.

Following the Group’s strategic review in June 2016 and the resulting operational streamlining, the Group recognized deferred 
tax  assets  for  operating  tax  losses  and  deductible  temporary  differences  in  the  jurisdictions  where  there  are  offsetting  taxable 
temporary  differences  (deferred  tax  liabilities).  Prior  to  this  strategic  review,  the  Group  was  in  the  process  of  consolidating  certain 
intellectual property assets and consequently taxable temporary differences were not available to offset deferred tax assets in the same 
jurisdiction. 

Deferred  tax  assets  are  recognized  for  unused  tax  losses  to  the  extent  that  it  is  probable  that  future  taxable  profit  will  be 
available  against  which  the  unused  tax  losses  can  be  utilized.  Deferred  tax  assets  are  offset  against  taxable  temporary  differences 
(deferred tax liabilities) when the deferred tax balances relate to the same tax jurisdiction in accordance with our accounting policy. 

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

(c) Amounts that would be recognized directly in equity if

   brought to account

  Aggregate current and deferred tax arising in the reporting

   period and not recognized in net loss or other
   comprehensive income but which would have been
   directly applied to equity had it been brought to account:

  Current tax recorded in equity (if brought to account)
  Deferred tax recorded in equity (if brought to account)

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

(d)Amounts recognized directly in equity
  Aggregate current and deferred tax arising in the reporting

   period and not recognized in net loss or other
   comprehensive income but debited/credited to equity

  Current tax recorded in equity
  Deferred tax recorded in equity

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

(e) Deferred tax assets not brought to account
  Unused tax losses
  Potential tax benefit at local tax rates
  Other temporary differences
  Potential tax benefit at local tax rates

151

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

(764)   
960 
196 

(148)   
808 
660 

(137)
516 
379  

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

—    
— 

—    
— 

— 
—  

2017

As of June 30,
2016

2015

34,896 

27,060 

69,929 

3,908 
38,804 

3,432 
30,492 

16,507 
86,436  

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
    
     
  
   
     
     
  
   
   
  
  
 
 
   
     
     
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
 
   
 
   
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
    
     
  
 
 
     
     
  
   
   
  
  
 
 
   
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
 
    
     
  
 
 
     
     
  
   
   
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
     
 
    
 
 
   
     
 
    
 
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
 
 
   
  
  
As of June 30, 2017, 2016 and 2015, the Group has deferred tax assets not brought to account of $38.8 million, $30.5 million 
and $86.4 million, respectively. Deferred tax assets have been brought to account only to the extent that it is foreseeable that they are 
recoverable against future tax liabilities. 

5. Financial assets and liabilities

This note provides information about the Group's financial instruments, including:

•

•

•

•

an overview of all financial instruments held by the Group;

specific information about each type of financial instrument;

accounting policies; and

information used to determine the fair value of the instruments, including judgments and estimation uncertainty involved.

The Group holds the following financial instruments:

Financial assets
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
As of June 30, 2017
Cash & cash equivalents
Trade & other receivables
Available-for-sale financial asset
Other non-current assets

As of June 30, 2016
Cash & cash equivalents
Trade & other receivables
Available-for-sale financial asset
Other non-current assets

(1)

(2)

Fair value through other comprehensive income

Fair value through profit or loss

Financial liabilities
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
As of June 30, 2017
Trade and other payables
Contingent considerations

As of June 30, 2016
Trade and other payables
Contingent considerations

(1)

(2)

Fair value through other comprehensive income

Fair value through profit or loss

Notes

5(a)
5(b)
5(c)
5(d)

5(a)
5(b)
5(c)
5(d)

Notes

5(e)
5(f)

5(e)
5(f)

Assets at
FVOCI(1)

Assets at
FVTPL(2)

Assets at
amortized 
cost

Total

— 
— 
1,997 
— 
1,997 

— 
— 
1,966 
— 
1,966 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 
— 
— 

45,761 
3,743 
— 
1,916 
51,420 

80,937 
4,054 
— 
2,343 
87,334 

45,761 
3,743 
1,997 
1,916 
53,417 

80,937 
4,054 
1,966 
2,343 
89,300  

Liabilities at
FVOCI(1)

Liabilities at
FVTPL(2)

Liabilities at
amortized cost 

Total

— 
— 
— 

— 
— 
— 

— 
63,595 
63,595 

— 
63,716 
63,716 

21,805 
— 
21,805 

27,155 
— 
27,155 

21,805 
63,595 
85,400 

27,155 
63,716 
90,871  

The  Group’s  exposure  to  various  risks  associated  with  the  financial  instruments  is  discussed  in   Note  10.  The  maximum 

exposure to credit risk at the end of the reporting period is the carrying amount of each class of financial assets mentioned above.

152

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
a.

Cash and cash equivalents

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Cash at bank
Deposits at call(1)

As of June 30,

2017

2016

7,722 
38,039 
45,761 

21,860 
59,077 
80,937

(1) As  of  June  30,  2017  and  June  30,  2016,  interest-bearing  deposits  at  call  include  amounts  of  $0.5  million  and  $4.6  million,

respectively, held as security and are restricted for use.

(i) Classification as cash equivalents

Term deposits are presented as cash equivalents if they have a maturity of three months or less from the date of acquisition.

b.

Trade and other receivables and prepayments

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Income tax and tax incentives recoverable
Other receivables
Trade debtors
Foreign withholding tax recoverable
Security deposit
Sundry debtors
Other recoverable taxes (Goods and services tax and
   value-added tax)
Interest receivables
Trade and other receivables

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Clinical trial research and development expenditure
Other
Prepaid insurance and subscriptions
Prepayments

As of June 30,

2017

2016

1,631 
698 
474 
471 
250 
120 

87 
12 
3,743 

2,818 
13 
460 
471 
— 
242 

24 
26 
4,054

As of June 30,

2017

2016

13,571 
340 
194 
14,105 

2,684 
510 
638 
3,832

(i) Classification as trade and other receivables

Interest receivables are amounts due at maturity of term deposits. All trade and other receivable balances are within their due 

dates and none are considered to be impaired as of June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016.

(ii) Other receivables

These amounts generally arise from transactions outside the usual operating activities of the Group.

(iii) Fair values of trade and other receivables

Due to the short-term nature of the current receivables, their carrying amount is assumed to be the same as their fair value.

(iv) Impairment and risk exposure

Information  about  the  impairment  of  trade  and  other  receivables,  their  credit  quality  and  the  Group’s  exposure  to  credit  risk,

foreign currency risk and interest rate risk can be found in Note 10(b) and (c).

153

c.

Available-for-sale financial assets

Available-for-sale financial assets include the following classes of financial assets:

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Unlisted securities:
Equity securities

As of June 30,

2017

2016

1,997     
1,997     

1,966 
1,966  

(i) Classification of financial assets as available-for-sale

Investments are designated as available-for-sale financial assets if they do not have fixed maturities and fixed or determinable 
payments, and management intends to hold them for the medium to long-term. Financial assets that are not classified into any of the 
other categories (at FVPL, loans and receivables or held-to-maturity investments) are also included in the available-for-sale category.

The financial assets are presented as non-current assets unless they mature, or management intends to dispose of them within 

12 months of the end of the reporting period.

(ii) Impairment indicators for available-for-sale financial assets

A security is considered to be impaired if there has been a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value below its cost. See 

Note 21(m)(v) for further details about the Group’s impairment policies for financial assets.

(iii) Amounts recognized in other comprehensive income

For the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, the Group recognized a gain of $Nil in statement of comprehensive income and a 
loss of $0.3 million for change in fair value of the available-for-sale financial assets.  For the year June 30, 2015 there were no gains 
or losses recognized in other comprehensive income.  

(iv) Fair value, impairment and risk exposure

Information about the methods and assumptions used in determining fair value is provided in Note 5(f). None of the available-

for-sale financial assets are either past due or impaired.

All available-for-sale financial assets are denominated in USD.

d.

Other non-current assets

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Bank Guarantee
Letter of Credit

As of June 30,

2017

2016

738     
1,178     
1,916     

713 
1,630 
2,343  

(i) Classification of financial assets as other non-current assets

Bank guarantee

These  funds  are  held  in  an  account  named  Mesoblast  Limited  at  National  Australia  Bank  according  to  the  terms  of  a  Bank 
Guarantee  which  is  security  for  the  sublease  agreement  for  our  occupancy  of  Level  38,  55  Collins  Street,  Melbourne,  Victoria, 
Australia.  The  Bank  Guarantee  is  security  for  the  full  and  faithful  performance  and  observance  by  the  subtenant  of  the  terms, 
covenants and conditions of the sublease. The Bank Guarantee continues in force until it is released by the lessor.

Letter of credit

These funds held in an account named Mesoblast, Inc. at the Bank of America according to the terms of an irrevocable standby 
letter of credit which is security for the sublease agreement for our occupancy of 505 Fifth Avenue, New York, New York, United 
States of America. The letter of credit is security for the full and faithful performance and observance by the subtenant of the terms, 

154

 
 
 
 
   
 
   
      
  
   
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
covenants and conditions of the sublease. The letter of credit is deemed to automatically extend without amendment for a period of 
one year at each anniversary but will not automatically extend beyond the final expiration of July 31, 2021.

(ii) Impairment and risk exposure

No other non-current assets are either past due or impaired.

e.

Trade and other payables

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Trade payables and other payables

As of June 30,

2017

2016

21,805     
21,805     

27,155 
27,155  

The carrying amounts of trade and other payables are assumed to be the same as their fair values, due to their short-term nature.

f.

Recognized fair value measurements

(i) Fair value hierarchy

The  following  table  presents  the  Group's  financial  assets  and  financial  liabilities  measured  and  recognized  at  fair  value  as  of 
June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016 on a recurring basis, categorized by level according to the significance of the inputs used in making 
the measurements:

As of June 30, 2017
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Financial Assets
Available-for-sale financial assets:

Equity securities - biotech sector

Total Financial Assets

Financial Liabilities
Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:

Contingent consideration
Total Financial Liabilities

As of June 30, 2016
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Financial Assets
Available-for-sale financial assets:

Equity securities - biotech sector

Total Financial Assets

Financial Liabilities
Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:

Contingent consideration
Total Financial Liabilities

Notes

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

Total

5(c)

6(d)

—     
—     

—     
—     

1,997     
1,997     

1,997 
1,997 

—     
—     

—     
—     

63,595     
63,595     

63,595 
63,595  

Notes

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

Total

5(c)

6(d)

—     
—     

—     
—     

1,966     
1,966     

1,966 
1,966 

—     
—     

—     
—     

63,716     
63,716     

63,716 
63,716  

There were no transfers between any of the levels for recurring fair value measurements during the period.

The Group’s policy is to recognize transfers into and transfers out of fair value hierarchy levels as at the end of the reporting 

period.

Level 1: The fair value of financial instruments traded in active markets (such as publicly traded derivatives, and trading and 
available-for-sale  securities)  is  based  on  quoted  market  prices  at  the  end  of  the  reporting  period.  The  quoted  market  price  used  for 
financial assets held by the Group is the current bid price. These instruments are included in level 1.

155

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
 
  
   
   
 
   
   
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
 
  
   
   
 
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
 
  
   
   
 
   
   
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
   
     
       
       
       
 
 
  
   
   
Level 2: The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market (for example, foreign exchange contracts) 
is determined using valuation techniques which maximize the use of observable market   data and rely as little as possible on entity-
specific estimates. If all significant inputs required to fair value an instrument are observable, the instrument is included in level 2.

Level 3: If one or more of the significant inputs is not based on observable market data, the instrument is included in level 3. 

This is the case for provisions (contingent consideration) and equity securities (unlisted).

(ii) Valuation techniques used.

The Group used the discounted cash flow analysis to determine the fair value measurements of level 3 instruments.

(iii) Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs (level 3)

The following table presents the changes in level 3 instruments for the years ended June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016:

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Opening balance - July 1, 2015
Amount used during the year
Charged/(credited) to consolidated income statement:

Remeasurement(1)

Closing balance - June 30, 2016

Opening balance - July 1, 2016
Amount used during the year
Charged/(credited) to consolidated income statement:

Remeasurement(2)

Closing balance - June 30, 2017

Contingent
consideration
provision

91,890 
(62)

(28,112)
63,716 

63,716 
(251)

130 
63,595  

(1)

(2)

The remeasurement gain of $28.1 million recognized in the year ended June 30, 2016 includes a gain of $34.5 million relating to 
a reduction in contingent consideration expected to be paid to Osiris Therapeutics, Inc. (“Osiris”) on the MSC-assets due to a 
greater  certainty  over  the  commencement  of  the  earn  out  period.  This  change  in  assumption  results  in  a  reduction  in  the 
valuation of contingent consideration as an earlier earn out period results in royalties being applicable to sales in years that are 
prior to peak year sales. The remaining loss of $6.4 million was recognized during the year ended June 30, 2016 as a net result 
of changes to the key assumptions of contingent consideration valuation such as developmental timelines, market population, 
market penetration, product pricing and the increase in valuation as the time period shortens between the valuation date and the 
potential settlement dates of contingent consideration.  

In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017  a  loss  of  $0.1  million  was  recognized  on  the  remeasurement  of  contingent  consideration 
pertaining to the acquisition of assets from Osiris. This loss is a net result of changes to the key assumptions of the contingent 
consideration valuation such as developmental timelines, probability of success, market penetration, market population and the 
increase  in  valuation  as  the  time  period  shortens  between  the  valuation  date  and  the  potential  settlement  dates  of  contingent 
consideration.  

156

 
 
   
   
   
  
   
   
 
   
  
   
   
   
  
   
   
(iv) Valuation inputs and relationship to fair value

The following table summarizes the quantitative information about the significant unobservable inputs used in level 3 fair value 

measurements:

 (in U.S. dollars, 
in thousands, except percent data)
Description
Contingent consideration provision

Fair value
as of June 30,

    Valuation   Unobservable  

Range of inputs
(weighted average)
for the year ended
June 30,

  2017
  63,595 

    2016
  63,716 

technique
Discounted 
cash flows

inputs(1)
Risk adjusted
discount rate

2017
11%-13%
(12.5%)

2016
11%-13%
(12.5%)

Expected unit
revenues

n/a

n/a

Relationship of
unobservable inputs to
fair value
Year ended June 30, 2017: A 
change in the discount rate by 
0.5% would increase/decrease 
the fair value by 1%.

Year ended June 30, 2016: A 
change in the discount rate by 
0.5% would increase/decrease 
the fair value by 2%.
Year ended June 30, 2017: A 
10% increase/decrease in the 
price assumptions adopted 
would increase the fair value 
by 5%.

Year ended June 30, 2016: A 
10% increase/decrease in the 
price assumptions adopted 
would increase the fair value 
by 6%.

(1)

There were no significant inter-relationships between unobservable inputs that materially affect fair values.

(v) Valuation processes

In  connection  with  the  Osiris  acquisition,  on  October  11,  2013  (the  “acquisition  date”),  an  independent  valuation  of  the 

contingent consideration was carried out by an independent valuer.

 For the year ended 2017 , the Group has adopted a process to value contingent consideration internally. This valuation has been 
completed  by  the  Group’s  internal  valuation  team  and  reviewed  by  the  Chief  Financial  Officer  (the  "CFO").  The  valuation  team  is 
responsible for the valuation model. The valuation team also manages a process to continually refine the key assumptions within the 
model. This is done with input from the relevant business units. The key assumptions in the model have been clearly defined and the 
responsibility for refining those assumptions has been assigned to the most relevant business units. The remeasurement charged to the 
consolidated  income  statement  was  a  result  of  changes  to  key  assumptions  such  as  periods  applicable  to  royalty  payments, 
developmental timelines, probability of success, market population, market penetration, product pricing and the increase in valuation 
as the time period shortens between the valuation date and the potential settlement dates of contingent consideration.

The fair value of contingent consideration
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Fair value of cash or stock payable, dependent on
   achievement of future late-stage clinical or regulatory
   targets
Fair value of royalty payments from commercialization of the
   intellectual property acquired

As of June 30,

2017

2016

34,501     

30,327 

29,094     
63,595     

33,389 
63,716  

157

 
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
The main level 3 inputs used by the Group are evaluated as follows:

Risk adjusted discount rate: The discount rate used in the valuation has been determined based on required rates of returns of listed 
companies  in  the  biotechnology  industry  (having  regards  to  their  stage  of  development,  their  size  and 
number  of  projects)  and  the  indicative  rates  of  return  required  by  suppliers  of  venture  capital  for 
investments  with  similar  technical  and  commercial  risks.  This  assumption  is  reviewed  as  part  of  the 
valuation process outlined above.

Expected unit revenues:

Expected market sale price of the most comparable products currently available in the market place. This 
assumption is reviewed as part of the valuation process outlined above.

6. Non-financial assets and liabilities

a.

Property, plant and equipment

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Year Ended June 30, 2016
Opening net book amount
Additions
Exchange differences
Depreciation charge
Closing net book value

As of June 30, 2016
Cost
Accumulated depreciation
Net book value

Year Ended June 30, 2017
Opening net book amount
Additions
Exchange differences
Disposals
Depreciation charge
Closing net book value

As of June 30, 2017
Cost
Accumulated depreciation
Net book value

Plant and
Equipment  

Office Furniture
and Equipment  

Computer
Hardware
and 
Software

Total

2,646     
189     
(26)   
(1,057)   
1,752     

825     
4     
15     
(138)   
706     

927     
127     
(19)   
(430)   
605     

4,398 
320 
(30)
(1,625)
3,063 

4,118     
(2,366)   
1,752     

1,276     
(570)   
706     

2,752     
(2,147)   
605     

8,146 
(5,083)
3,063 

1,752     
17     
31 
—     
(1,049)   
751     

706     
—     
(25)   
—     
(134)   
547     

605     
296     
13     
(3)   
(395)   
516     

3,063 
313 
19 
(3)
(1,578)
1,814 

4,139     
(3,388)   
751     

1,255     
(708)   
547     

3,105     
(2,589)   
516     

8,499 
(6,685)
1,814  

(i) Depreciation methods and useful lives

Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method to allocate their cost or revalued amounts, net of their residual values, 

over the estimated useful lives. The estimated useful lives are:

•

•

•

Plant and equipment 10 – 15 years

Office furniture and equipment 5 – 10 years

Computer hardware and software 3 – 4 years

See Note 21(o) for other accounting policies relevant to property, plant and equipment.

158

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
b.

Intangible assets

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

Year Ended June 30, 2016
Opening net book value
Additions
Reclassifications(1)
Exchange differences
Amortization charge
Impairment charge(2)
Closing net book value

As of June 30, 2016
Cost
Accumulated amortization
Accumulated impairment
Net book amount

Year Ended June 30, 2017
Opening net book value
Exchange differences
Amortization charge
Closing net book value

As of June 30, 2017
Cost
Accumulated amortization
Accumulated impairment
Net book amount

  Goodwill

Acquired licenses
to patents

In-process
research and
development

acquired    

Current marketed
products

Total

    134,453     
—     
—    
—     
—     
—     
    134,453     

2,091      513,697     
—     
(23,999)   
—     
—     
(61,919)   
2,036      427,779     

75     
—     
(7)   
(123)   
—     

—      650,241 
75 
—     
— 
23,999     
(7)
—     
(567)
(444)   
(61,919)
—     
23,555      587,823 

    134,453     
—     
—     
    134,453     

2,769      489,698     
—     
(733)   
(61,919)   
—     
2,036      427,779     

23,999      650,919 
(1,177)
(61,919)
23,555      587,823 

(444)   
—     

    134,453     
—     
—     
    134,453     

2,036      427,779     
—     
6     
(144)   
—     
1,898      427,779     

23,555      587,823 
6 
—     
(1,335)   
(1,479)
22,220      586,350 

    134,453     
—     
—     
    134,453     

2,770      489,698     
—     
(872)   
(61,919)   
—     
1,898      427,779     

23,999      650,920 
(2,651)
(1,779)   
(61,919)
—     
22,220      586,350 

(1)

The  Group  reclassified  $24.0  million  from  in-process  research  and  development  (“IPRD”)  acquired  to  current  marketed 
products  upon  TEMCELL®  Hs.  Inj.  (“TEMCELL”),  a  registered  trademark  of  JCR  Pharmaceuticals  Co.,  Ltd.  (“JCR”),  
becoming available for use in Japan.

IPRD that was acquired as part of a business acquisition is not amortized as it is considered to be incomplete and cannot be used 
in its current form and therefore has an indefinite life. IPRD is tested for impairment annually, or when events or circumstances 
present an indication of impairment. IPRD will continue to be tested for impairment until the related research and development 
efforts  are  either  completed  or  abandoned.  Upon  completion  of  the  related  research  and  development  efforts,  when  the  asset 
becomes  available  for  use,  management  determines  the  remaining  useful  life  of  the  intangible  assets  and  amortizes  them 
accordingly.  In  order  for  management  to  determine  the  remaining  useful  life  of  the  asset,  management  would  consider  the 
expected  flow  of  future  economic  benefits  to  the  entity  with  reference  to  the  product  life  cycle,  competitive  landscape, 
obsolescence, market demand, any remaining patent useful life and various other relevant factors. 

In  the  case  of  abandonment,  the  related  research  and  development  efforts  are  considered  impaired  and  the  asset  is  fully 
expensed.

(2)

The Group recognized $61.9 million non-cash impairment charge during the year ended June 30, 2016 relating to the product 
candidates,  MPC-MICRO-IO  for  the  treatment  of  age-related  macular  degeneration  and  MPC-CBE  for  the  expansion  of 
hematopoietic stem cells within cord blood. As of June 30, 2016 the Group completed the Phase IIa MPC-MICRO-IO clinical 
trial and MPC-CBE was in a Phase III clinical trial. In June 2016, further patient enrollment of both programs was suspended as 
the  Group  prioritized  the  funding  of  the  Tier  1  product  candidates.  Existing  and  future  cash  resources  will  be  deployed  on 
delivery  of  Tier  1  product  candidates  for  the  foreseeable  future  and  therefore  the  Group  is  unable  to  ascertain  when  MPC-

159

   
   
   
 
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
 
     
       
       
       
       
 
 
     
       
       
       
       
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
      
      
  
MICRO-IO and MPC-CBE patient enrollment will be restarted.  Accordingly impairment losses for the full carrying amounts of 
the intangible assets relating to product candidates MPC-MICRO-IO and MPC-CBE were recognized in line with the Group’s 
accounting  policy.  These  product  candidates  will  remain  technically  viable  and  available  to  consider  for  future  resource 
allocation  and  on  this  basis  we  have  not  abandoned  the  programs.   The  decision  to  impair  the  assets  was  required  given 
resources have not been allocated to continue the development and commercialization efforts of these assets for the foreseeable 
future.  See  Note  21(j)  and  Note  2  for  the  accounting  policy  on  impairment  of  intangible  assets  and  segment  information, 
respectively.

(i) Carrying value of in-process research and development acquired by product

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Cardiovascular products
Intravenous products for metabolic diseases and
   inflammatory/immunologic conditions
Osiris MSC products

As of June 30,

2017

2016

    254,351      254,351 

70,730     

70,730 
    102,698      102,698 
    427,779      427,779  

For all products included within the above balances, the underlying currency of each item recorded is USD.

(ii) Amortization methods and useful lives

The Group amortizes intangible assets with a finite useful life using the straight-line method over the following periods:

•

•

Acquired licenses to patents 7 – 16 years

Current marketed products 15 – 20 years

See Note 21(p) for the other accounting policies relevant to intangible assets and Note 21(j) for the Group’s policy regarding 

impairments.

(iii) Significant estimate: Impairment of goodwill and assets with an indefinite useful life

The  Group  tests  annually  whether  goodwill  and  its  assets  with  indefinite  useful  lives  have  suffered  any  impairment  in 
accordance with its accounting policy stated in Note 21(j). The recoverable amounts of these assets and cash-generating units have 
been determined based on fair value less costs to dispose calculations, which require the use of certain assumptions.

(iv) Impairment tests for goodwill and intangible assets with and indefinite useful life

In-process  research  and  development  acquired  is  considered  to  be  an  indefinite  life  intangible  asset  on  the  basis  that  it  is 
incomplete and cannot be used in its current form (see Note 21(p)(iii)). The intangible asset’s life will remain indefinite until such 
time it is completed and commercialized or impaired. The carrying value of in-process research and development is a separate asset 
which has been subject to impairment testing at the cash generating unit level, which has been determined to be at the product level.

For  the  purpose  of  impairment  testing,  goodwill  is  monitored  by  management  at  the  operating  segment  level.  The  Group  is 
managed as one operating segment, being the development of adult stem cell technology platform for commercialization. The carrying 
value of goodwill has been allocated to the appropriate operating segment for the purpose of impairment testing.

The recoverable amount of both goodwill and in-process research and development was assessed as of June 30, 2017 based on 

the fair value less costs to dispose.

(v)  Key assumptions used for fair value less costs to dispose calculations

In determining the fair value less costs to dispose we have given consideration to the following indicators:

•

•

discounted expected future cash flows of programs; 

the scientific results and progress of the trials since acquisition;

160

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
 
   
•

•

•

•

the  valuation  of  the  Group  that  was  applicable  to  the  January  6,  2017  equity  placement  undertaken  with  Mallinckrodt 
Pharmaceuticals (NYSE: MNK) through issuing of the Group’s securities on the ASX; 

the  valuation  of  the  Group  that  was  applicable  to  the  March  31,  2017  equity  placement  undertaken  with  institutional 
investors through issuing of the Group’s securities on the ASX; 

the valuation of the Group’s assets from an independent valuation as of June 30, 2017; and

the market capitalization of the Group on the ASX (ASX:MSB) on the impairment testing date of June 30, 2017.

Costs of disposal were assumed to be immaterial.

Discounted cash-flows used a real pre-tax discount rate range of 14.4% to 19.3%, and include estimated real cash inflows and 

outflows for each program through to patent expiry, at which point a terminal value is assigned to the program. 

In  relation  to  cash  outflows  consideration  has  been  given  to  cost  of  goods  sold,  selling  costs  and  clinical  trial  schedules 
including estimates of numbers of patients and per patient costs. Associated expenses such as regulatory fees and patent maintenance 
have been included as well as any further preclinical development if applicable.

The  assessment  of  goodwill  showed  the  recoverable  amount  of  the  Group’s  operating  segment,  including  goodwill  and 
remaining in-process research and development, exceeds the carrying amounts, and therefore there is no impairment. Additionally the 
recoverable amount of remaining in-process research and development also exceeds the carrying amounts, and therefore there is no 
impairment.

There are no standard growth rates applied, other than our estimates of market penetration which increase initially, plateau and 

then decline.

The  assessment  of  the  recoverable  amount  of  each  product  has  been  made  in  accordance  with  the  discounted  cash-flow 
assumptions outlined above. The assessment showed that the recoverable amount of each product exceeds the carrying amount and 
therefore there is no impairment.

(vi) Impact of possible changes in key assumptions

The Group has considered and assessed reasonably possible changes in the key assumptions and has not identified any instances 

that could cause the carrying amount of our intangible assets at June 30, 2017 to exceed its recoverable amount.

Whilst  there  is  no  impairment,  the  key  sensitivities  in  the  valuation  remain  the  continued  successful  development  of  our 

technology platform.

c.

Deferred revenue

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Opening Balance
Amount recognized as revenue in the year(1)
Closing balance

 - To be recognized in the next twelve months
   (current deferred revenue)
 - To be recognized in the next twelve months
   (non-current deferred revenue)
Closing balance

As of June 30,

2017

2016

—     
—     
—     

37,509 
(37,509)
— 

—     

—     
—     

— 

— 
—  

(1)

Please refer to Note 21(e)(i) for the Group’s accounting policy relating to revenue recognition. 

161

 
 
 
 
   
 
   
   
   
 
   
      
  
   
   
   
d.

Provisions

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Contingent consideration
Employee benefits

As of

June 30, 2017
  Non-current  

Current

Total

Current

As of

June 30, 2016
  Non-current  

Total

11,054     
3,811     
14,865 

52,541     
416     

52,957 

63,595     
4,227     
67,822 

241     
2,019     
2,260 

63,475     
274     

63,749 

63,716 
2,293 
66,009  

(i) Information about individual provisions and significant estimates

Contingent consideration

The  contingent  consideration  provision  relates  to  the  Group’s  liability  for  certain  milestones  and  royalty  achievements 

pertaining to the acquired MSC assets from Osiris. Further disclosures can be found in Note 5(f)(iii).

Employee benefits

The  provision  for  employee  benefits  relates  to  the  Group’s  liability  for  annual  leave,  short  term  incentives  and  long  service 

leave.

Employee  benefits  include  accrued  annual  leave.  As  of  June  30,  2017  and  2016,  the  entire  amount  of  the  accrual  was  $0.7 
million  and  $0.6  million  respectively,  and  is  presented  as  current,  since  the  Group  does  not  have  an  unconditional  right  to  defer 
settlement for any of these obligations. However, based on past experience, the Group expects all employees to take the full amount of 
the accrued leave or require payment within the next 12 months.

 (ii) Movements

The contingent consideration provision relates to the Group’s liability for certain milestones and royalty achievements.  Refer 

to Note 5(f)(iii) for movements in contingent consideration for the years ended June 30, 2017 and 2016.

e.

Deferred tax balances

(i) Deferred tax balances

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Deferred tax assets
The balance comprises temporary differences attributable to:
Tax losses
Other temporary differences
Total deferred tax assets

Deferred tax liabilities
The balance comprises temporary differences attributable to:
Intangible assets
Total deferred tax liabilities
Net deferred tax liabilities

Deferred tax assets expected to be settled within 12 months
Deferred tax assets expected to be settled after 12 months

Deferred tax liabilities expected to be settled within 12 months
Deferred tax liabilities expected to be settled after 12 months

162

As of June 30,

2017

2016

74,660   
3,566   
78,226 

127,519   
127,519 
49,293 

—   
78,226   

147   
127,372   

57,650 
7,372 
65,022 

127,715 
127,715 
62,693 

— 
65,022 

— 
127,715  

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
      
      
      
      
  
   
   
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
   
   
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
    
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(ii) Movements

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
As of June 30, 2015
Charged/(credited) to:
- profit or loss(2)
As of June 30, 2016
Charged/(credited) to:
- profit or loss(2)
As of June 30, 2017

Tax losses(1) 
(DTA)

Other 
temporary 
differences(1) 
(DTA)

—     

—     

Intangible 
assets (DTL)  

149,387     

  Total (DTL)  
149,387 

(57,650)   
(57,650)   

(7,372)    
(7,372)   

(21,672)   
127,715     

(86,694)
62,693 

(17,010)   
(74,660)   

3,806     
(3,566)   

(196)    

127,519 

(13,400)
49,293  

(1) Deferred tax assets are netted against deferred tax liabilities. 
(2)

The total amount recognized in income tax benefit for the year ended June 30, 2017 was $13.4 million and $86.7 million for 
the year ended June 30, 2016. Refer to Note 4(b). 

7. Equity

a.

Contributed equity

(i) Share capital

Contributed equity
(i)     Share capital
Ordinary shares
Less: Treasury Shares
Total Contributed Equity

(ii) Movements in ordinary share capital

2017

2016
Shares No.

As of June 30,
2015

2017
2015
2016
(U.S. dollars, in thousands)

  428,221,398    381,373,137    336,997,729    830,425   770,272   709,191 
— 
  424,721,398    377,873,137    333,497,729    830,425   770,272   709,191  

(3,500,000)   (3,500,000)   (3,500,000)  

—   

—   

2017

As of June 30,
2016
Shares No.

2015

As of June 30,
    2016

2017
    2015
(U.S. dollars, in thousands)

  381,373,137   336,997,729   321,640,094    770,272    709,191    662,722 

Opening balance
Issues of ordinary shares during the period   
Exercise of share options(1)
Share issue for Nasdaq IPO
Consideration for available-for-sale financial
   assets
Share based compensation for services rendered   
Placement of shares under LFSP(2)
Placement of shares under a share placement
   agreement(3)
Share buy-back of LFSP(2)
Transaction costs arising on share issue(4)

272,579   

422,903    1,043,798    
—    

—    42,675,295   

149    
—     68,280    

268     1,312 
— 

—    
—    1,277,210   
—   
—    
—    2,000,000    

280,911   
—   

—     1,495    
—    
240    
—    
—    

— 
— 
— 

   46,294,771   
—   

—     45,000 
—    15,298,837     61,710    
— 
—    
—    
—    (2,985,000)  
(439)
      (1,959)   (9,096)  
   46,848,261    44,375,408    15,357,635     60,140     60,947     45,873 

Share options reserve transferred to equity on
   exercise of options
Ending balance

596 
  428,221,398   381,373,137   336,997,729    830,425    770,272    709,191  

134    

13    

(1) Options  are  issued  to  employees,  directors  and  consultants  in  accordance  with  the  Mesoblast  Employee  Share  Options  Plan 

(“ESOP”). The shares issued and share capital received upon the exercise of options are recorded above.

163

 
   
   
   
   
      
      
  
  
  
   
   
     
     
        
       
 
   
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
  
  
 
 
 
   
 
   
     
     
     
    
    
 
  
     
     
     
    
    
  
  
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
 
    
    
     
     
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
 
  
    
    
     
(2)

(3)

Shares are issued to employees and consultants in accordance with the Mesoblast Australian Loan Funded Share Plan (“LFSP”). 
Initially these shares are issued and held in trust. Therefore there is no dollar movement recorded in ordinary share capital at this 
time. If the shares are purchased in accordance with the conditions of the LFSP a dollar movement will be recorded at that date.

In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  20,044,771  shares  were  issued  to  Mallinckrodt  (NYSE:MNK)  on  January  6,  2017  under  a 
placement  agreement  pursuant  to  which  Mallinckrodt  purchased  Mesoblast  Limited  securities  and  received  a  period  of  up  to 
nine  months  to  exclusively  negotiate  a  commercial  and  development  partnership  for  two  of  Mesoblast’s  Tier  1  product 
candidates and 26,250,000 shares were issued on March 31, 2017 under an institutional private placement agreement. In the year 
ended  June  30,  2015,  15,298,837  shares  were  issued  to  Celgene  Corporation  (Nasdaq:CELG)  under  a  placement  agreement 
pursuant to which Celgene purchased Mesoblast Limited securities.

(4)

Payments for share issue costs in the year ended June 30, 2017 were $1.9 million. Payments for share issue costs in the year 
ended  June  30,  2016  were  $6.5  million  with  $2.8  million  paid  in  prior  periods  offset  by  $0.2  million  of  non-cash  items 
recognized as transaction costs on the balance sheet in association with the Nasdaq IPO equity raising.

(iii) Ordinary shares

Ordinary  shares  participate  in  dividends  and  the  proceeds  on  winding  up  of  the  Group  in  equal  proportion  to  the  number  of 
shares held. At shareholders meetings each ordinary share is entitled to one vote when a poll is called, otherwise each shareholder has 
one  vote  on  a  show  of  hands.  Ordinary  shares  have  no  par  value  and  the  Company  does  not  have  a  limited  amount  of  authorized 
capital.

(iii) Ordinary shares

Information relating to the Group’s employee share option plan, including details of shares issued under the scheme, is set out in 

Note 17.

b.

Reserves

(i) Reserves

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Share-based payments reserve
Investment Revaluation Reserve
Foreign currency translation reserve

As of June 30,

2017
69,919     
(303)   
(38,373)   
31,243     

2016
64,999   
(334) 
(38,689) 
25,976   

164

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 
   
(ii) Reconciliation of reserves

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Share-based payments reserve
Opening balance
Transfer to ordinary shares on exercise of options
Share option expense for the year
Reclassification of modified options to/(from) liability
Closing Balance

As of June 30,

2017

64,999 

(13)   

5,036 
(103)   

69,919 

2016

60,740 

(134)  
3,149 
1,244 
64,999 

Investment Revaluation Reserve
Opening balance
Changes in the fair value of available-for-sale financial assets
Closing Balance

(334)   
31 
(303)   

— 
(334)  
(334)  

Foreign currency translation reserve
Opening balance
Currency gain/(loss) on translation of foreign operations
   net assets
Closing Balance

(38,689)   

(37,984)  

316 

(705)

(38,373)   

(38,689)  

(iii) Nature and purpose of reserves

Share-based payment reserve

The share-based payments reserve is used to recognize:

•

•

the fair value(1) of options issued but not exercised; and

the fair value(1) of deferred shares granted but not yet vested.

(1) The fair value recognized is determined at the acceptance date, which is the date at which the entity and the employee 
agree to a share-based payment arrangement, being when the entity and the employee have a shared understanding of 
the terms and conditions of the arrangement.

Foreign currency translation reserve

Exchange  differences  arising  on  translation  of  a  foreign  controlled  entity  are  recognized  in  other  comprehensive  income  and 
accumulated in a separate reserve within equity. The cumulative amount is reclassified to profit or loss when the net investment is 
disposed of.

8. Cash flow information

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
(a) Reconciliation of cash and cash equivalents
Cash at bank
Deposits at call

As of June 30,

2017

7,722     
38,039     
45,761     

2015
2016
21,126   
21,860     
59,077     
89,575   
80,937      110,701   

165

 
   
 
 
 
   
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
     
       
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
   
 
 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
(b) Reconciliation of net cash flows used in operations
         with loss after income tax
Loss for the period
Add/(deduct) net loss for non-cash items as follows:    
Commercialization revenue
Depreciation and amortization
Foreign exchange (gains)/losses
Remeasurement of contingent consideration
Equity settled share-based payment
Deferred tax benefit
Impairment of intangible assets
Change in operating assets and liabilities:
(Increase)/decrease in trade and other receivables
Decrease/(increase) in prepayments
(Increase)/decrease in tax assets
(Decrease)/increase in trade creditors and accruals
(Decrease)/increase in provisions
Net cash outflows used in operations

Year Ended June 30,

2017
(76,815)   

2016
(4,127) 

2015
(96,244) 

—     
3,057     
38     
130     
5,276     
(13,400)   
—     

(37,509) 
2,192   
1,090   
(28,112) 
3,389   
(86,694) 
61,919   

(15,004) 
1,601   
(9,729) 
10,670   
6,976   
—   
—   

(859)   
(10,201)   
1,282     
(5,740)   
1,761     
(95,471)    

(531) 
697   
495   
(7,439) 
626   
38   
2,425   
7,721   
(3,159) 
(323) 
(87,996) (1)  (101,036) (2)

(1) Within operating cash flows are share issue costs of $0.3 million associated with the Nasdaq IPO equity raising incurred during 

the year ended June 30, 2016.

(2) Within operating cash flows are share issue costs of $2.4 million associated with the Nasdaq IPO equity raising incurred during 

the year ended June 30, 2015.

9. Significant estimates, judgments and errors

The  preparation  of  financial  statements  requires  the  use  of  accounting  estimates  which,  by  definition,  will  seldom  equal  the 

actual results. Management also needs to exercise judgment in applying the Group’s accounting policies.

This note provides an overview of the areas that involved a higher degree of judgment or complexity, and of items which are 
more likely to be materially adjusted due to estimates and assumptions turning out to be wrong. Detailed information about each of 
these estimates and judgments is included in Notes 1 to 8 together with information about the basis of calculation for each affected 
line item in the financial statements. In addition, this note also explains where there have been actual adjustments this year as a result 
of an error and of changes to previous estimates.

Significant estimates and judgments

The areas involving significant estimates or judgments are:

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

recognition of revenue (Note 3);

fair value of contingent liabilities and contingent purchase consideration in a business combination (Note 5(f) and 12);

fair value of goodwill and other intangible assets including in-process research and development (Note 6(b));

useful life of intangible assets (Note 6(b));

recognition of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities (Note 4(b));

accrued research and development and manufacturing commercialization expenses (Note 5(e)); and

fair value of share-based payments (Note 17).

Estimates and judgments are continually evaluated. They are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations 
of future events that may have a financial impact on the entity and that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.

166

 
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
 
      
    
 
    
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
      
    
 
    
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
10. Financial risk management

This  note  explains  the  Group’s  exposure  to  financial  risks  and  how  these  risks  could  affect  the  Group’s  future  financial 

performance. Current year profit and loss information has been included where relevant to add further context.

Risk
Market risk – currency risk

Exposure arising from
Future commercial transactions

Recognized financial assets and 
liabilities not denominated in the 
functional currency of each entity 
within the Group

Measurement
Cash flow forecasting
Sensitivity analysis

Management
The future cash flows of each 
currency are forecast and the 
quantum of cash reserves held 
for each currency are managed in 
line with future forecasted 
requirements.  Cross currency 
swaps are undertaken as 
required.

Term deposits at fixed rates

Sensitivity analysis

Vary length of term deposits

Market risk – interest rate 
risk

Credit risk

Cash and cash equivalents, and 
trade and other receivables

Aging analysis
Credit ratings

Liquidity risk

Cash and cash equivalents

Rolling cash flow forecasts

Only transact with ‘A’ rated 
banks

Future cash flows requirements 
are forecasted and capital raising 
strategies are planned to ensure 
sufficient cash balances are 
maintained to meet the Group’s 
future commitments

a. Market risk

(i) Currency risk

The  Group  has  certain  clinical,  regulatory  and  manufacturing  activities  which  are  being  conducted  internationally.  The  main 
currency  exposure  to  the  Group  is  the  clinical  trial  activities  which  are  primarily  occurring  in  the  United  States  of  America  and 
manufacturing  activities  occurring  in  Singapore.  As  a  result  of  these  activities,  the  Group  has  foreign  currency  amounts  owing 
primarily in USD and Singapore dollars (“SGD”), as well as some smaller amounts in various other currencies as tabled below. These 
foreign currency balances give rise to a currency risk, which is the risk of the exchange rate moving, in either direction, and the impact 
it may have on the Group’s financial performance.

The Group manages the currency risk by evaluating the trend of the relevant foreign currency rates (“FX rates”) to the AUD and 
making  decisions  as  to  the  levels  to  hold  in  each  currency  by  assessing  its  future  activities  which  will  likely  be  incurred  in  those 
currencies.

As of June 30, 2017, the Group held 95% of its cash in USD, and 5% in AUD. As of June 30, 2016, the Group held 71% of its 

cash in USD, and 29% in AUD.

167

The balances held at the end of the year that give rise to currency risk exposure are presented in USD in the following table, 
together with a sensitivity analysis which assesses the impact that a change of +/-20% in the exchange rate as of June 30, 2017 and 
June 30, 2016 would have had on the Group’s reported net profits/(losses) and/or equity balance.

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
As of June 30, 2017
Bank accounts - USD
Bank accounts - CHF
Bank accounts - SGD
Trade and other receivables - SGD
Trade and other receivables - USD
Trade and other receivables - CHF
Trade payables and accruals - USD
Trade payables and accruals - AUD
Trade payables and accruals - SGD
Trade payables and accruals - EUR
Trade payables and accruals - CHF
Provisions - SGD

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
As of June 30, 2016
Bank accounts - USD
Bank accounts - CHF
Bank accounts - SGD
Trade and other receivables - SGD
Trade and other receivables - CHF
Trade payables and accruals - USD
Trade payables and accruals - AUD
Trade payables and accruals - SGD
Trade payables and accruals - GBP
Trade payables and accruals - EUR
Trade payables and accruals - CHF
Trade payables and accruals - NZD
Provisions - SGD

Foreign
currency
balance held

+20%  

-20%

Profit/(Loss)
USD

Profit/(Loss)
USD

USD 447  $
CHF 183  $
SGD 325  $
SGD 48  $
USD 40  $
CHF 1  $
(USD 2,016)  $
(AUD 441)  $
(SGD 197)  $
(EUR 42)  $
(CHF 19)  $
(SGD 65)  $
   $

(74)  $
35    $
90    $
13    $
(7)  $
0    $
336    $
(115)  $
(54)  $
(7)  $
(4)  $
(18)  $
195    $

112 
(35)
(90)
(13)
10 
(0)
(504)
115 
54 
7 
4 
18 
(322)

Foreign
currency
balance held

+20%  

-20%

Profit/(Loss)
USD

Profit/(Loss)
USD

USD 359  $
CHF 77  $
SGD 95  $
SGD 63  $
CHF 7  $
(USD 2,090)  $
(AUD 285)  $
(SGD 162)  $
(GBP 31)  $
(EUR 15)  $
(CHF 7)  $
(NZD 1)  $
(SGD 26)  $
   $

(60)  $
15    $
26    $
17    $
1    $
348    $
(77)  $
(44)  $
(3)  $
3    $
(1)  $
(0)  $
(7)  $
218    $

90 
(15)
(26)
(17)
(1)
(522)
77 
44 
2 
(4)
1 
0 
7 
(364)

(ii) Interest rate risk

The  Group  is  not  exposed  to  typical  interest  rate  risk,  being  the  impact  of  fixed  versus  floating  interest  rates  on  debt.  The 
Group’s  exposure  is  to  interest  rate  movements  which  impacts  interest  income  earned  on  its  deposits.  The  interest  income  derived 
from these balances can fluctuate due to interest rate changes. This interest rate risk is managed by spreading the maturity date of our 
deposits across various periods. The Group ensures that sufficient funds are available, in at call accounts, to meet the working capital 
requirements of the Group.

168

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The  deposits  held  which  derive  interest  revenue  are  described  in  the  table  below,  together  with  the  maximum  and  minimum 
interest rates being earned as of June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016. The effect on profit is shown if interest rates change by 10%, in 
either direction, is as follows:

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands, except percent data)
USD
Funds invested - USD
Rate increase by 10%
Rate decrease by 10%

AUD

Funds invested - AUD

Rate increase by 10%
Rate decrease by 10%

(iii) Price risk

As of
June 30, 2017

As of
June 30, 2016

Low

  High

Low

  High

0.55%   
0.61%   
0.50%   

0.55%    USD 37,577    
USD 21    
0.61%   
(USD 21)  
0.50%   

0.55%   
0.61%   
0.50%   

0.90%  USD 47,796
USD 35
0.99%  
(USD 35)
0.81%  

Low

  High

Low

  High

2.42%
2.66%   
2.18%   

2.42%
2.66%   
2.18%   

  AUD 600    
AUD 1    
(AUD 1)  

3.00%
3.30%   
2.70%   

3.04%
3.34%  
2.74%  

AUD 
15,191
AUD 46
(AUD 46)

Price  risk  is  the  risk  that  future  cash  flows  derived  from  financial  instruments  will  be  altered  as  a  result  of  a  market  price 
movement, other than foreign currency rates and interest rates. The Group does not consider it has any exposure to price risk other 
than those already described above.

b.

Credit risk

Credit risk is the risk that one party to a financial instrument will fail to discharge its obligation and cause financial loss to the 

other party. The Group does not generally have trade receivables. The Group’s receivables are tabled below.

 (in U.S. dollars, in thousands)

Cash and cash equivalents
Deposits at call (Note 5(a)) - minimum A rated
Cash at bank (Note 5(a)) - minimum A rated
Trade and other receivables
Receivable from the Australian Government (Income Tax)
Receivable from other parties (non-rated)
Receivable from the Australian Government (Goods and
   Services Tax)
Receivable from the United States Government (Income Tax)    
Receivable from minimum A rated bank deposits (interest)
Receivable from the Swiss Government (Value-Added Tax)

As of June 30,

2017

2016

38,039     
7,722     

59,077   
21,860   

1,631     
1,067     

2,818   
495   

86     
27     
12     
1     

21   
8   
26   
3   

c.

Liquidity risk

Liquidity  risk  is  the  risk  that  the  Group  will  not  be  able  to  pay  its  debts  as  and  when  they  fall  due.  Liquidity  risk  has  been 

assessed in Note 1(ii). 

All financial liabilities, excluding contingent consideration, held by the Group as of June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016 are non-
interest bearing and mature within 6 months. The total contractual cash flows associated with these liabilities equate to the carrying 
amount disclosed within the financial statements.

11. Capital management

The Group’s objective when managing capital is to safeguard its ability to continue as a going concern, so that it can provide 
returns  for  shareholders  and  benefits  for  other  stakeholders.  See  Note  5(a)  for  the  cash  reserves  of  the  Group  as  at  the  end  of  the 
financial reporting period.

169

 
 
   
 
   
 
 
 
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
     
 
     
 
     
       
 
     
 
   
 
 
 
  
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
      
    
   
   
   
      
    
   
   
   
   
   
12. Interests in other entities

Material subsidiaries

The  Group’s  principal  subsidiaries  as  of  June  30,  2017  are  set  out  below.  Unless  otherwise  stated,  they  have  share  capital 
consisting  solely  of  ordinary  shares  that  are  held  directly  by  the  Group,  and  the  proportion  of  ownership  interests  held  equals  the 
voting rights held by the Group. The country of incorporation or registration is also their principal place of business.

Country of
incorporation

Class of
shares

Equity holding
As of June 30,

2017
%

2016
%

Mesoblast, Inc.
Mesoblast International Sàrl (includes Mesoblast
   International Sàrl Singapore Branch)
Mesoblast Australia Pty Ltd
Mesoblast UK Ltd
Mesoblast International (UK) Ltd

USA 

Ordinary   

Switzerland 
Australia 
  United Kingdom 
  United Kingdom 

Ordinary
Ordinary   
Ordinary   
Ordinary   

100 

100 

100 
100 
100 

100   

100 

100   
100   
100   

13. Contingent assets and liabilities

a.

Contingent assets

The Group did not have any contingent assets outstanding as of June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016.

b.

Contingent liabilities

(i) Central Adelaide Local Health Network Incorporated (“CALHNI”) (formerly Medvet)

Mesoblast will be required to make a milestone payment to CALHNI of $0.3 million on completion of Phase 3 (human) clinical 
trials and $0.4 million on FDA marketing approval for products in the orthopaedic field. The Group will pay CALHNI a commercial 
arm’s length royalty based on net sales by the Group of licensed products in the orthopaedic field each quarter.

The Group may also be required to pay consideration to CALHNI upon successful completion of subsequent clinical milestones 

in fields other than orthopedic. 

  (ii) Other contingent liabilities

The Group has entered into a number of agreements with third parties pertaining to intellectual property. Contingent liabilities 
may arise in the future if certain events or developments occur in relation to these agreements. As of June 30, 2017 the Group has 
assessed these contingent liabilities to be remote and specific disclosure is not required.

14. Commitments

a.

Capital commitments

The Group did not have any commitments for future capital expenditure outstanding as of June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016.

170

 
 
 
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
   
   
 
 
  
   
 
 
   
 
 
  
   
 
 
   
 
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
b.

Lease commitments: Group as lessee

The Group leases various offices under non-cancellable operating leases expiring within 1 to 5 years. The leases have varying 
terms, escalation clauses and renewal rights. On renewal, the terms of the leases are renegotiated. Excess office space is sub-let to a 
third party also under a non-cancellable operating lease.

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Operating leases
Total commitments

Total

  Within one

year

    Later than one    
year but no
later than
three years

Later than
three years
but no later
than five
years

Later than
five years

5,574     
5,574     

1,733     
1,733     

2,954     
2,954     

887     
887     

— 
—  

Lease commitments include amounts in AUD and Singapore dollars which have been translated to USD as of June 30, 2017 

foreign exchange rates published by the Reserve Bank of Australia.

c.

Lease commitments: Group as lessor

The Group sub-leases under non-cancellable operating leases expiring within 3 years. Future minimum lease payments expected 

to be received in relation to non-cancellable operating sub-leases are set out below:

Total

  Within one

year

    Later than one    
year but no
later than
three years

Later than
three years
but no later
than five
years

Later than
five years

390     
390     

161     
161     

229     
229     

—     
—     

— 
—  

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Operating leases
Total commitments

d.

Purchase commitments

The Group did not have any purchase commitments as of June 30, 2017. 

15. Events occurring after the reporting period

In  August  2017,  the  Group  announced  a  fully  underwritten  entitlement  offer  to  existing  eligible  shareholders  (on  a  1  for  12 
basis) in Australia and New Zealand and institutional shareholders in certain other countries in private placements. US$38.2 million of 
net proceeds from the entitlement offer is expected to be received and recognized in cash and cash equivalents in September 2017.

There were no other events that have occurred after June 30, 2017 and prior to the signing of this financial report that would 

likely have a material impact on the financial results presented.

16. Related party transactions

a.

Parent entity

The parent entity within the Group is Mesoblast Limited.

b.

Subsidiaries

Details of interests in subsidiaries are disclosed in Note 12 to the financial statements.

c.

Key management personnel compensation

The aggregate compensation made to Directors and other members of key management personnel of the Group is set out below:

171

 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
 
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
(in U.S. dollars)
Short-term employee benefits
Long-term employee benefits
Post-employment benefits
Share based payments

Year Ended June 30,
2016
2017

    2,592,456      1,979,885 
19,710 
72,398 
102,635 
    3,233,287      2,174,628  

17,742     
70,915     
552,174     

d.

Transactions with other related parties

Accounts receivable from revenues, accounts payable to expenses and loans from subsidiaries as at the end of the financial year 

have been eliminated on consolidation of the Group.

e.

Terms and conditions

All other transactions were made on normal commercial terms and conditions and at market rates, except that there are no fixed 

terms for the repayment of loans between the parties.

Outstanding balances are unsecured and are repayable in cash.

17. Share-based payments

The Company has adopted an Employee Share Option Plan (“ESOP”) and a Loan Funded Share Plan (“LFSP”) (together, “the 
Plans”)  to  foster  an  ownership  culture  within  the  Company  and  to  motivate  senior  management  and  consultants  to  achieve 
performance targets. Selected directors, employees and consultants may be eligible to participate in the Plans at the absolute discretion 
of  the  board  of  directors,  and  in  the  case  of  directors,  upon  approval  by  shareholders.  Due  to  changes  in  the  Australian  taxation 
regime, the Company no longer issues new LFSP since July 1, 2015.

Grant policy

In  accordance  with  the  Company’s  policy,  options  and  loan  funded  shares  are  typically  issued  in  three  equal  tranches.   For 
issues granted prior to July 1, 2015 the length of time from grant date to expiry date was typically 5 years. Grants since July 1, 2015, 
are issued with a seven year term. 

Options  issued  to  employees  generally  vest  based  on  service  or  time  conditions.  In  the  year  ended  June  30,  2017,  senior 
executives were issued options that vest based on performance conditions. For time based vesting options, the first tranche typically 
vests 12 months after grant date, the second tranche 24 months after grant date, and the third tranche 36 months after grant date.

The exercise price is determined by reference to the Company policy which is generally the volume weighted market price of a 
share sold on the ASX on the 5 trading days immediately before the Board approval date. In the case of options that have time based 
vesting conditions, the board of directors adds a 10% premium. Options with performance based vesting conditions are issued with no 
premium.  No  new  options  were  issued  to  the  directors  during  the  year.  The  board  of  directors’  policy  is  not  to  issue  options  at  a 
discount  to  the  market  price.  The  same  approach  is  used  to  determine  the  purchase  price  to  acquire  a  loan-funded  share  for  the 
purposes of the LFSP.

The aggregate number of options which may be issued pursuant to the ESOP must not exceed 10,000,000 with respect to US 
incentive stock options, and with respect to Australian residents, the limit imposed under the Australian Securities and Investments 
Commission Class Order 14/1000.

In addition, the LFSP which has not been issued since July 1, 2015, has the following characteristics:

On grant date, the Company issues new equity (rather than purchasing shares on market), and the loan funded shares are placed 
in a trust which holds the shares on behalf of the employee. The trustee issues a limited recourse, interest free, loan to the employee 
which is equal to the number of shares multiplied by the price. A limited-recourse loan means that the repayment amount will be the 
lesser of the outstanding loan value (the loan value less any amounts that may have already been repaid) and the market value of the 
shares that are subject to the loan. The price is the amount the employee must pay for each loan funded share if exercised.

The trustee continues to hold the shares on behalf of the employee until the employee chooses to settle the loan pertaining to the 

shares and all vesting conditions have been satisfied, at which point ownership of the shares is fully transferred to the employee.

172

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
   
 
 
Any dividends paid by the Company, while the shares are held by the trustee, are applied as a repayment of the loan at the after-

tax value of the dividend.

a.

Reconciliation of outstanding share based payments

Series

Grant Date

Expiry Date

Exercise 
Price

Opening 
Balance

Granted No. 
(during the 
year)

Exercised No. 
(during the 
year)

Lapsed/Cancelled 
No. (during the 
year)

Closing 
Balance

INC
INC
INC
INC
16/LF2
17/LF3

18/LF4

26/10/2018  USD 0.305   
26/10/2019  USD 0.340   
25/04/2017  USD 0.444   
2/05/2017  USD 0.444   
23/02/2017  AUD 8.48   
8/07/2018  AUD 6.69   

7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
24/02/2012
9/07/2012
21/09/2012-
29/10/2012
25/01/2013-
29/01/2013
24/05/2013
3/09/2013
4/09/2013
26/11/2013
17/12/2013
1/01/2014
12/12/2014
1/07/2014
24/07/2014
5/09/2014
4/08/2014
25/08/2014
9/10/2014
25/11/2014
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
6/01/2015
27/04/2015
12/05/2015
10/07/2015
26/08/2015
27/04/2016
27/04/2016
31/10/2016
30/06/2016
6/12/2016
6/12/2016
13/01/2017

19/LF5
20/LF6
21/LF7
22/LF8
23a
24
25a (i&ii)
25b
25
26/LF11
27/LF12
27(ii)
27(iv)
28/LF13
29
30a(1)
30b(1)
30c(1)
30d(1)
30e(1)
30f(1)
30g(1)
30h(1)
30i(1)
30j
LF14
31a
31b
32
33
34
34a
34b
35
36
36a
36b
June 30, 2017
Weighted average share purchase price

30/06/2017  AUD 6.70   
24/01/2018-
28/01/2018  AUD 6.29   
23/05/2018  AUD 6.36   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.92   
27/08/2018  AUD 6.28   
10/10/2018  AUD 6.20   
16/12/2018  AUD 6.25   
31/12/2018  AUD 6.38   
31/10/2019  AUD 4.51   
6/04/2019  AUD 5.80   
23/07/2019  AUD 4.71   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
3/08/2019  AUD 4.60   
24/08/2019  AUD 4.67   
8/10/2019  AUD 4.54   
24/11/2019  AUD 4.02   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2019  AUD 5.00   
30/06/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
20/01/2019  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2018  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2019  AUD 4.46   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
16/12/2019  AUD 4.66   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.73   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.30   
30/06/2022  AUD 4.22   
16/08/2022  AUD 4.07   
6/03/2023  AUD 2.82   
17/04/2023  AUD 2.76   
6/03/2023  AUD 2.82   
6/10/2019  AUD 2.22   
5/12/2023  AUD 1.33   
5/12/2023  AUD 1.21   
12/01/2024  AUD 1.67   

154,064   
447,848   
127,956   
127,956   
340,000   
250,000   

1,948,333   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   

—   
—   
(127,956)  
(127,956)  
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
(340,000)  
(100,000)  

154,064   
447,848   
—   
—   
—   
150,000   

—   

(1,948,333)  

—   

— 

Vested and 
exercisable 
No (end of 
year)
154,064 
447,848 
— 
— 
— 
150,000 

—   
100,000   
—   
595,000   
—   
2,430,000   
—   
225,000   
—   
33,333   
—   
25,000   
—   
650,000   
—   
50,000   
—   
10,000   
—   
125,000   
—   
2,865,000   
—   
50,000   
—   
75,000   
—   
235,000   
—   
240,000   
—   
650,000   
—   
235,000   
—   
135,000   
—   
300,000   
—   
165,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
300,000   
—   
400,000   
—   
600,000   
—   
150,000   
—   
150,000   
—   
20,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
3,840,000   
—   
125,000   
(16,667)  
5,140,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
—   
—   
1,500,000   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
     25,414,490   
(272,579)  
     AUD 4.39    AUD 1.32    AUD 0.72   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
200,000   
—   
2,095,000   
4,400,000   
450,000   
7,145,000   

50,000   
425,000   
1,865,000   
225,000   
—   
—   
650,000   
50,000   
—   
—   
2,070,000   
—   
75,000   
85,000   
240,000   
650,000   
235,000   
135,000   
300,000   
165,000   
200,000   
300,000   
400,000   
600,000   
150,000   
150,000   
—   
200,000   
2,620,000   
91,667   
3,621,667   
200,000   
200,000   
1,500,000   
2,045,000   
4,400,000   
450,000   

(50,000)  
(170,000)  
(565,000)  
—   
(33,333)  
(25,000)  
—   
—   
(10,000)  
(125,000)  
(795,000)  
(50,000)  
—   
(150,000)  
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
(20,000)  
—   
(1,220,000)  
(33,333)  
(1,501,666)  
—   
—   
—   
(50,000)  
—   
—   

50,000 
425,000 
1,865,000 
225,000 
— 
— 
650,000 
33,334 
— 
— 
1,380,004 
— 
50,000 
56,666 
160,002 
650,000 
235,000 
135,000 
300,000 
165,000 
200,000 
200,000 
266,668 
600,000 
100,000 
100,000 
— 
200,000 
873,334 
41,667 
1,218,324 
66,667 
200,000 
— 
— 
816,667 
150,000 
(7,186,665)   25,100,246    12,165,245 
AUD 5.10    AUD 3.35    AUD 4.36  

(1) 30a to 30i were granted as a remuneration for the repurchase and cancellation of 2,985,000 LFSP during the year ended 30 June 

2015 (see Note 17(b)).

173

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
Series

Grant Date

Expiry Date

Exercise 
Price

Opening 
Balance

Granted No. 
(during the 
year)

Lapsed/Cancelled 
No. (during the 
year)

7/07/2015  USD 0.046   
26/10/2018  USD 0.305   
26/10/2019  USD 0.340   
25/04/2017  USD 0.444   
2/05/2017  USD 0.444   
21/09/2015  AUD 2.64   
29/11/2015  AUD 3.48   
30/06/2016  AUD 7.99   
23/02/2017  AUD 8.48   
8/07/2018  AUD 6.69   

287,903   
154,064   
447,848   
127,956   
127,956   
135,000   
1,453,350   
3,413,334   
340,000   
250,000   

Exercised No. 
(during the 
year)
(287,903)  
—   
—   
—   
—   
(135,000)  
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

Vested and 
exercisable 
No (end of 
year)

Closing 
Balance

—   
154,064   
447,848   
127,956   
127,956   
—   
—   
—   
340,000   
250,000   

— 
154,064 
447,848 
127,956 
127,956 
— 
— 
— 
340,000 
250,000 

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
(1,453,350)  
(3,413,334)  
—   
—   

2,276,667   

—   

—   

(328,334)  

1,948,333   

1,948,333 

INC
INC
INC
INC
INC
13
14
15/LF1
16/LF2
17/LF3

18/LF4

30/06/2017  AUD 6.70   
24/01/2018-
28/01/2018  AUD 6.29   
23/05/2018  AUD 6.36   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.92   
27/08/2018  AUD 6.28   
10/10/2018  AUD 6.20   
16/12/2018  AUD 6.25   
31/12/2018  AUD 6.38   
31/10/2019  AUD 4.51   
6/04/2019  AUD 5.80   
23/07/2019  AUD 4.71   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
3/08/2019  AUD 4.60   
24/08/2019  AUD 4.67   
8/10/2019  AUD 4.54   
24/11/2019  AUD 4.02   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2019  AUD 5.00   
30/06/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
20/01/2019  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2018  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2019  AUD 4.46   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
16/12/2019  AUD 4.66   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.73   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.73   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.30   
30/06/2022  AUD 4.22   
16/08/2022  AUD 4.07   
6/03/2023  AUD 2.82   
17/04/2023  AUD 2.76   
6/10/2019  AUD 2.22   

19/LF5
20/LF6
21/LF7
22/LF8
23a
24
25a (i&ii)
25b
25
26/LF11
27/LF12
27(ii)
27(iv)
28/LF13
29
30a(1)
30b(1)
30c(1)
30d(1)
30e(1)
30f(1)
30g(1)
30h(1)
30i(1)
30j
LF14
31
31a
31b
32
33
34
34a
35
June 30, 2016
Weighted average share purchase price

100,000   
865,000   
2,741,667   
275,000   
50,000   
148,333   
650,000   
50,000   
15,000   
215,000   
3,380,000   
50,000   
75,000   
235,000   
240,000   
650,000   
235,000   
135,000   
300,000   
165,000   
200,000   
300,000   
400,000   
600,000   
150,000   
150,000   
60,000   
20,000   
400,000   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
4,800,000   
—   
125,000   
—   
5,255,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
1,500,000   
     21,869,078    11,880,000   
(422,903)  
     AUD 5.49    AUD 3.32    AUD 0.88   

—   
(270,000)  
(311,667)  
(50,000)  
(16,667)  
(123,333)  
—   
—   
(5,000)  
(90,000)  
(515,000)  
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
(60,000)  
—   
(200,000)  
(960,000)  
—   
(115,000)  
—   
—   

100,000 
100,000   
595,000 
595,000   
1,878,336 
2,430,000   
150,002 
225,000   
33,333 
33,333   
16,666 
25,000   
650,000 
650,000   
16,667 
50,000   
10,000 
10,000   
41,667 
125,000   
961,670 
2,865,000   
16,667 
50,000   
25,000 
75,000   
78,333 
235,000   
80,001 
240,000   
650,000 
650,000   
235,000 
235,000   
135,000 
135,000   
200,000 
300,000   
165,000 
165,000   
200,000 
200,000   
100,000 
300,000   
133,334 
400,000   
400,000 
600,000   
50,000 
150,000   
50,000 
150,000   
— 
—   
6,667 
20,000   
200,000 
200,000   
— 
3,840,000   
— 
125,000   
— 
5,140,000   
— 
200,000   
— 
1,500,000   
(7,911,685)   25,414,490    10,574,500 
AUD 5.93    AUD 4.39    AUD 5.38  

7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
22/09/2010
29/11/2010
22/12/2011
24/02/2012
9/07/2012
21/09/2012-
29/10/2012
25/01/2013-
29/01/2013
24/05/2013
3/09/2013
4/09/2013
26/11/2013
17/12/2013
1/01/2014
12/12/2014
1/07/2014
24/07/2014
5/09/2014
4/08/2014
25/08/2014
9/10/2014
25/11/2014
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
6/01/2015
16/03/2015
27/04/2015
12/05/2015
10/07/2015
26/08/2015
27/04/2016
27/04/2016
30/06/2016

(1) 30a to 30i were granted as a remuneration for the repurchase and cancellation of 2,985,000 LFSP during the year ended 30 June 

2015 (see Note 17(b)).

174

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
7/12/2010
30/11/2009
30/11/2009
22/09/2010
29/11/2010
22/12/2011
24/02/2012
9/07/2012
21/09/2012-
29/10/2012
25/01/2013-
29/01/2013
24/05/2013
3/09/2013
4/09/2013
26/11/2013
30/11/2013
17/12/2013
10/02/2014
17/02/2014
11/12/2013
3/09/2013
1/01/2014
12/12/2014
21/09/2014
1/07/2014
24/07/2014
5/09/2014
28/07/2014
4/08/2014
11/08/2014
25/08/2014
5/09/2014
9/10/2014
25/11/2014
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
25/03/2015
6/01/2015
16/03/2015
27/04/2015
12/05/2015

Series

Grant Date

Expiry Date

Exercise 
Price

Opening 
Balance

Granted No. 
(during the 
year)

Exercised No. 
(during the 
year)

Lapsed/Cancelled 
No. (during the 
year)

INC
INC
INC
INC
INC
10
11
13
14
15/LF1
16/LF2
17/LF3

18/LF4

7/07/2015  USD 0.046   
26/10/2018  USD 0.305   
26/10/2019  USD 0.340   
25/04/2017  USD 0.444   
2/05/2017  USD 0.444   
30/11/2014  AUD 1.73   
30/11/2014  AUD 1.58   
21/09/2015  AUD 2.64   
29/11/2015  AUD 3.48   
30/06/2016  AUD 7.99   
23/02/2017  AUD 8.48   
8/07/2018  AUD 6.69   

287,903   
195,999   
703,761   
127,956   
127,956   
150,000   
480,000   
135,000   
1,569,300   
4,243,334   
340,000   
250,000   

2,653,333   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

—   

—   
(41,935)  
(255,913)  
—   
—   
(150,000)  
(480,000)  
—   
(115,950)  
—   
—   
—   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
(830,000)  
—   
—   

Vested and 
exercisable 
No (end of 
year)
287,903 
154,064 
447,848 
127,956 
127,956 
— 
— 
135,000 
1,453,350 
3,413,334 
340,000 
166,665 

Closing 
Balance

287,903   
154,064   
447,848   
127,956   
127,956   
—   
—   
135,000   
1,453,350   
3,413,334   
340,000   
250,000   

—   

(376,666)  

2,276,667   

1,863,337 

30/06/2017  AUD 6.70   
24/01/2018-
28/01/2018  AUD 6.29   
23/05/2018  AUD 6.36   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.92   
27/08/2018  AUD 6.28   
10/10/2018  AUD 6.20   
29/11/2018  AUD 6.79   
16/12/2018  AUD 6.25   
9/02/2019  AUD 6.41   
16/02/2019  AUD 6.33   
30/06/2017  AUD 6.70   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.92   
31/12/2018  AUD 6.38   
31/10/2019  AUD 4.51   
2/09/2014  AUD 5.43   
6/04/2019  AUD 5.80   
23/07/2019  AUD 4.71   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
27/07/2019  AUD 4.54   
3/08/2019  AUD 4.60   
10/08/2019  AUD 4.43   
24/08/2019  AUD 4.67   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.46   
8/10/2019  AUD 4.54   
24/11/2019  AUD 4.02   
30/06/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2018  AUD 5.00   
25/01/2019  AUD 5.00   
30/06/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
23/07/2019  AUD 5.00   
20/01/2019  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2018  AUD 4.71   
25/01/2019  AUD 4.46   
30/06/2019  AUD 4.71   
16/12/2019  AUD 4.66   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.73   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.73   
16/02/2020  AUD 4.30   

19/LF5
20/LF6
21/LF7
22/LF8
23a
23b
24
24a (i)
24a (ii)
LF9.4
LF9.7
25a (i&ii)
25b
25c
25
26/LF11
27/LF12
27(i)
27(ii)
27(iii)
27(iv)
LF12a
28/LF13
29
30a(1)
30b(1)
30c(1)
30d(1)
30e(1)
30f(1)
30g(1)
30h(1)
30i(1)
30j
LF14
31
31a
31b
June 30, 2015
Weighted average share purchase price

—   
100,000   
—   
1,000,000   
—   
3,290,000   
—   
325,000   
—   
50,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
180,000   
—   
100,000   
—   
25,000   
—   
165,000   
—   
200,000   
—   
650,000   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
     17,549,542   
(1,043,798)  
    AUD 5.58    AUD 4.69    AUD 1.49   

—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
50,000   
60,000   
15,000   
575,000   
3,960,000   
100,000   
50,000   
100,000   
75,000   
600,000   
235,000   
240,000   
650,000   
235,000   
135,000   
300,000   
165,000   
200,000   
300,000   
400,000   
600,000   
150,000   
150,000   
60,000   
20,000   
400,000   
9,825,000   

—   
(135,000)  
(548,333)  
(50,000)  
—   
(200,000)  
(31,667)  
(100,000)  
(25,000)  
(165,000)  
(200,000)  
—   
—   
(60,000)  
—   
(360,000)  
(580,000)  
(100,000)  
—   
(100,000)  
—   
(600,000)  
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   
—   

100,000   
865,000   
2,741,667   
275,000   
50,000   
—   
148,333   
—   
—   
—   
—   
650,000   
50,000   
—   
15,000   
215,000   
3,380,000   
—   
50,000   
—   
75,000   
—   
235,000   
240,000   
650,000   
235,000   
135,000   
300,000   
165,000   
200,000   
300,000   
400,000   
600,000   
150,000   
150,000   
60,000   
20,000   
400,000   

66,668 
576,676 
1,206,671 
91,668 
16,666 
— 
51,666 
— 
— 
— 
— 
650,000 
— 
— 
5,000 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
650,000 
156,666 
135,000 
100,000 
165,000 
133,334 
— 
— 
200,000 
— 
— 
— 
— 
— 
(4,461,666)   21,869,078    12,722,428 
AUD 5.91    AUD 5.49    AUD 5.78  

(1) 30a to 30i were granted as a remuneration for the repurchase and cancellation of 2,985,000 LFSP during the year ended 30 June 

2015 (see Note 17(b)).

175

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
   
The weighted average share price at the date of exercise of options exercised during the years ended June 30, 2017, 2016 and 

2015 were AUD 3.28, AUD 3.68 and AUD 4.06 respectively.

The weighted average remaining contractual life of share options and loan funded shares outstanding as of June 30, 2017, 2016 

and 2015 were 4.09 years, 3.85 years and 2.43 years, respectively

b.

Existing share-based payment arrangements

General terms and conditions attached to share based payments

Share options pursuant to the employee share option plan and shares pursuant to loan funded share plan are generally granted in 
three equal tranches. For issues granted prior to July 1, 2015 the length of time from grant date to expiry date was typically 5 years.  
Grants since July 1, 2015, are issued with a seven year term. Vesting occurs either based on achievement of performance conditions or 
progressively over the life of the option/share with the first tranche vesting one year from grant date, the second tranche two years 
from  grant  date,  and  the  third  tranche  three  years  from  grant  date.  On  cessation  of  employment  the  Company’s  board  of  directors 
determines  if  a  leaver  is  a  bad  leaver  or  not.  If  a  participant  is  deemed  a  bad  leaver,  all  rights,  entitlements  and  interests  in  any 
unexercised  options  or  shares  (pursuant  to  the  loan  funded  share  plan)  held  by  the  participant  will  be  forfeited  and  will  lapse 
immediately.  If  a  leaver  is  not  a  bad  leaver  they  may  retain  vested  options  and  shares  (pursuant  to  the  loan  funded  share  plan), 
however,  they  must  be  exercised  within  60  days  of  cessation  of  employment  (or  within  a  longer  period  if  so  determined  by  the 
Company’s board of directors), after which time they will lapse. Unvested options will normally be forfeited and lapse. 

This policy applies to all issues shown in the above table with the exception of the following:

Series 10

Options granted to the Chairman were approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held on November 
30, 2010. The options were granted in four equal tranches vesting on the achievement of certain milestones, being 
the date on which:

•    Mesoblast  signs  a  commercial  partnering  contract,  e.g.  a  commercial  license  to  one  of  its  products  (vested 

December 7, 2010);

•    Mesoblast receives IND clearance from the FDA for its first clinical trial for Intervertebral Disc Repair (vested 

March 17, 2011);

•    Mesoblast  completes  patient  enrollment  for  its  first  clinical  trial  under  IND  for  Intervertebral  Disc  Repair 

(vested October 12, 2012);

•    Mesoblast  obtains  a  license  from  the  Therapeutics  Goods  Administration  (TGA)  for  the  manufacture  (vested 

July 20, 2010).

All the remaining options under series 10 were exercised during the years ended June 30, 2015 and 2014.

25a(i&ii)

Options were granted in two equal tranches and vested on the date that the option holder had direct involvement (to 
the  reasonable  satisfaction  of  the  Company’s  board  of  directors)  in  the  Company  achieving  certain  confidential 
commercial objectives.

INC.

31b

As part of the acquisition of Mesoblast, Inc., Mesoblast, Inc. options were converted to options of the Company at 
a  conversion  ratio  of  63.978.  The  Mesoblast,  Inc.  option  exercise  price  per  option  was  adjusted  using  the  same 
conversion  ratio.  All  options  vested  on  acquisition  date  (December  7,  2010),  and  will  expire  according  to  their 
original  expiry  dates  (with  the  exception  of  options  held  by  directors  which  were  limited  to  an  expiry  date  not 
exceeding four years from acquisition). 

Options were granted in two equal tranches and will vest on the date that the option holder has direct involvement 
(to the reasonable satisfaction of the Company’s board of directors) in the Company achieving certain confidential 
commercial objectives.

36 (a&b)

Options  were  granted  in  two  or  three  equal  tranches  and  will  vest  on  the  date  that  the  option  holder  has  direct 
involvement (to the reasonable satisfaction of the Company’s board of directors) in the Company achieving certain 
confidential commercial objectives.

176

Modifications to share-based payment arrangements

During the year ended June 30, 2015, the Company repurchased an aggregate amount of $13.9 million (AUD 17.7 million) of 
loans under LFSP and correspondingly cancelled 2,985,000 of the Company’s ordinary shares held in trust for certain employees of 
the  Company.  As  remuneration  for  the  repurchase  of  loans  and  cancellation  of  these  ordinary  shares  under  LFSP,  the  Company 
granted  options  to  purchase  2,985,000  of  the  Company’s  ordinary  shares  at  exercise  prices  ranging  from  AUD  4.46  to  AUD  5.00 
under ESOP 30a to 30i. As of March 25, 2015 (the “modification date”), the total incremental fair value granted as a result of these 
modifications was $0.6 million. There were no modifications made to share-based payment arrangements during the years ended June 
30, 2016 and 2017.

c.

Fair values of share based payments

The weighted average fair value of share options and loan funded shares granted during the years ended June 30, 2017, 2016 

and 2015 were AUD 1.46, AUD 1.07 and AUD 1.22, respectively.

The  fair  value  of  all  shared-based  payments  made  has  been  calculated  using  the  Black-Scholes  model.  This  model  requires  the 
following inputs:

Share price at acceptance date

The  share  price  used  in  valuation  is  the  share  price  at  the  date  at  which  the  entity  and  the  employee  agree  to  a  share-based 
payment  arrangement,  being  when  the  entity  and  the  employee  have  a  shared  understanding  of  the  terms  and  conditions  of  the 
arrangement. This price is generally the volume weighted average share price for the five trading days leading up to the date.

Exercise price

The exercise price is a known value that is contained in the agreements.

Share price volatility

The model requires the Company’s share price volatility to be measured. In estimating the expected volatility of the underlying 
shares our objective is to approximate the expectations that would be reflected in a current market or negotiated exchange price for the 
option or loan funded share. Historical volatility data is considered in determining expected future volatility.

Life of the option/share

The life is generally the time period from grant date through to expiry. Certain assumptions have been made regarding “early 
exercise” i.e. options exercised ahead of the expiry date, with respect to option series 14 and later. These assumptions have been based 
on  historical  trends  for  option  exercises  within  the  Company  and  take  into  consideration  exercise  trends  that  are  also  evident  as  a 
result of local taxation laws.

Dividend yield

The Company has yet to pay a dividend so it has been assumed the dividend yield on the shares underlying the options will be 

0%.

Risk free interest rate

This has been sourced from the Reserve Bank of Australia historical interest rate tables for government bonds.

177

Model inputs

The model inputs for the valuations of options approved and granted during the year ended June 30, 2017 are as follows:

Series
34b
36
36a
36b
(1) Expected life after factoring likely early exercise.

Exercise/Loan
price per share
AUD
2.82
1.33
1.21
1.67

Financial
year of
grant
2017
2017
2017
2017

Share price at
acceptance date
AUD
1.24
2.32
2.32
2.32

Expected share 
price volatility    
51.13%    
51.63%    
51.63%    
51.63%    

Life(1)
4.6 yrs
5.5 yrs
5.5 yrs
5.6 yrs

  Dividend yield  
0%
0%
0%
0%

Risk-free
interest rate

2.16%  
2.15%  
2.15%  
2.15%  

The closing share market price of an ordinary share of Mesoblast Limited on the ASX as of June 30, 2017 was AUD 2.08.

The model inputs for the valuations of options approved and granted during the year ended June 30, 2016 are as follows:

Series
32
33
34
34a
35
(1)  Expected life after factoring likely early exercise.

Exercise/Loan
price per share
AUD
4.22
4.07
2.82
2.76
2.22

Financial
year of
grant
2016
2016
2016
2016
2016

Share price at
acceptance date
AUD
3.87
3.19
2.41
2.41
1.05

Expected share 
price volatility    
40.38%    
40.38%    
53.33%    
53.33%    
53.33%    

Life(1)
5.2 yrs
5.1 yrs
5.0 yrs
5.1 yrs
3.0 yrs

  Dividend yield  
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%

Risk-free
interest rate

2.22%  
2.00%  
2.13%  
2.13%  
1.65%  

The closing share market price of an ordinary share of Mesoblast Limited on the ASX as of June 30, 2016 was AUD 1.08.

The model inputs for the valuations of options approved and granted during the year ended June 30, 2015 are as follows:

Series
25
25b
25c
26/LF11
27/LF12
27(i)
27(ii)
27(iii)
27(iv)
LF12a
28/LF13
29
30a
30b
30c
30d
30e
30f
30g
30h
30i
30j
LF14
31
31a
31b

Financial
year of
grant
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015
2015

Exercise/Loan
price per share
AUD
5.80
4.51
5.43
4.71
4.71
4.54
4.60
4.43
4.67
4.46
4.54
4.02
5.00
5.00
5.00
5.00
5.00
5.00
4.71
4.71
4.46
4.71
4.66
4.73
4.73
4.30

Share price at
acceptance date
AUD
4.48
4.33
4.89
4.04
5.49
4.13
4.19
4.03
4.24
5.49
4.11
4.02
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
3.96
4.33
3.86
3.56
3.72

Expected share 
price volatility    
38.09%    
38.40%    
38.38%    
37.89%    
38.44%    
38.44%    
38.44%    
38.44%    
38.44%    
38.36%    
38.33%    
38.09%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.70%    
38.58%    
38.92%    
40.98%    
40.82%    

178

Life(1)
3.5 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.5 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.5 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.7 yrs
2.4 yrs
2.1 yrs
2.8 yrs
2.8 yrs
2.1 yrs
2.8 yrs
3.2 yrs
3.2 yrs
3.2 yrs
3.2 yrs
3.7 yrs
3.6 yrs
3.6 yrs
3.5 yrs

Risk-free
interest rate

  Dividend yield  
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%
0%

2.99%  
2.45%  
3.19%  
    2.80%-2.94%  
3.12%  
3.12%  
3.12%  
3.12%  
3.12%  
2.81%  
2.86%  
2.71%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
1.87%  
2.27%  
1.99%  
2.02%  
2.42%  

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
 
   
     
     
   
     
(1) Expected life after factoring likely early exercise.

The closing share market price of an ordinary share of Mesoblast Limited on the ASX as of June 30, 2015 was AUD 3.76.

18. Remuneration of auditors

During  the  year  the  following  fees  were  paid  or  payable  for  services  provided  by  the  auditor  of  the  parent  entity,  its  related 

practices and non-related audit firms:

(in U.S. dollars)
a. PricewaterhouseCoopers Australia
Audit and other assurance services
Audit and review of financial reports
Other audit services(1)
Total remuneration of PricewaterhouseCoopers Australia

b. Network firms of PricewaterhouseCoopers Australia
Audit and other assurance services
Audit and review of financial reports
Total remuneration of Network firms of PricewaterhouseCoopers
   Australia
Total auditors' remuneration(2)

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

729,598     
42,306     
771,904     

437,373     
345,965     
783,338     

271,926 
1,003,706 
1,275,632 

77,723     

95,315     

90,991 

77,723     
849,627     

95,315     
878,653     

90,991 
1,366,623  

(1) Audit and review of financial reports and registration statements in connection with the United States initial public offering, 

filing on Form S-8, F-3 and related Australian prospectuses. 

(2) All services provided are considered audit services for the purpose of SEC classification.

179

 
 
 
 
 
   
 
 
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
   
 
19. Losses per share

Losses per share
(in cents)
(a) Basic losses per share
From continuing operations attributable to the ordinary
   equity holders of the company
Total basic losses per share attributable to the ordinary
   equity holders of the company

(b) Diluted losses per share
From continuing operations attributable to the ordinary
   equity holders of the company
Total basic losses per share attributable to the ordinary
   equity holders of the company

(c) Reconciliation of losses used in calculating losses
   per share
(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Basic losses per share
Losses attributable to the ordinary equity holders of the
   company used in calculating basic losses per share:
From continuing operations

Diluted losses per share
Losses from continuing operations attributable to the 
ordinary
   equity holders of the company:
Used in calculating basic losses per share
Losses attributable to the ordinary equity holders of the
   company used in calculating diluted losses per share

2017

Year Ended June 30,
2016

2015

(19.43)   

(1.14)   

(29.99)

(19.43)   

(1.14)   

(29.99)

(19.43)   

(1.14)   

(29.99)

(19.43)   

(1.14)   

(29.99)

(76,815)   

(4,127)   

(96,244)

(76,815)   

(4,127)   

(96,244)

(76,815)   

(4,127)   

(96,244)

2017
Number

2016
Number

2015
Number

Weighted average number of ordinary shares used as the
   denominator in calculating basic losses per share
Weighted average number of ordinary shares and potential
   ordinary shares used in calculating diluted losses per share    395,307,599     360,799,983     320,867,433  

   395,307,599     360,799,983     320,867,433 

Options granted to employees (see Note 17) are considered to be potential ordinary shares. These securities have been excluded 
from  the  determination  of  basic  losses  per  shares.  They  have  also  been  excluded  from  the  calculation  of  diluted  losses  per  share 
because they are anti-dilutive for the years ended June 30, 2017, 2016 and 2015. Shares that may be paid as contingent consideration 
(see Note 13(b)) have also been excluded from basic losses per share. They have also been excluded from the calculation of diluted 
losses per share because they are anti-dilutive for the years ended June 30, 2017, 2016 and 2015.

180

 
 
 
 
 
 
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
 
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
      
      
  
   
   
 
   
      
      
  
 
 
   
   
 
20. Parent entity financial information

a.

Summary financial information

The  parent  entity  financial  information  disclosure  is  an  Australian  Disclosure  Requirement  as  required  by  Corporations 

Regulations 2001. The individual financial statements for the parent entity show the following aggregate amounts:

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Balance Sheet
Current Assets
Total Assets

Current Liabilities
Total Liabilities

Shareholders' Equity
Issued Capital
Reserves
    Foreign Currency Translation Reserve
    Share Options Reserve
(Accumulated losses)

Loss for the period
Total comprehensive loss for the period

As of June 30,

2017

2016

7,276     
666,357     

28,625 
601,249 

6,400     
6,815     

4,699 
4,972 

830,424     

770,272 

(146,840)    
55,265     
(79,307)    
659,542     

(169,248)
50,344 
(55,091)
596,277 

(24,216)    
(24,216)    

(22,334)
(22,334)

b.

Contingent liabilities of the parent entity 

(i) Central Adelaide Local Health Network Incorporated (“CALHNI”) (formerly Medvet)

Mesoblast Limited will be required to make a milestone payment to CALHNI of $0.3 million on completion of Phase 3 (human) 
clinical  trials  and  $0.4  million  on  FDA  marketing  approval  for  products  in  the  orthopaedic  field.  The  Group  will  pay  CALHNI  a 
commercial arm’s length royalty based on net sales by the Group of licensed products in the orthopaedic field each quarter.

The Group may also be required to pay consideration to CALHNI upon successful completion of subsequent clinical milestones 

in fields other than orthopedic. 

21. Summary of significant accounting policies

This note provides the principal accounting policies adopted in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements as set 
out below. These policies have been consistently applied to all the years presented, unless otherwise stated. The financial statements 
are for the consolidated entity consisting of Mesoblast Limited and its subsidiaries.

a.

Basis of preparation

The  general  purpose  financial  statements  of  Mesoblast  Limited  and  its  subsidiaries  have  been  prepared  in  accordance  with 
International  Financial  Reporting  Standards,  as  issued  by  the  International  Accounting  Standards  Board  and  Australian  equivalent 
International  Financial  Reporting  Standards,  as  issued  by  the  Australian  Accounting  Standards  Board.  Mesoblast  Limited  is  a  for-
profit entity for the purpose of preparing the financial statements.

i.

Historical cost convention

These financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, as modified by the revaluation of available-
for-sale financial assets, financial assets and liabilities (including derivative instruments) at fair value through profit or loss, certain 
classes of property, plant and equipment and investment property.

181

 
 
 
 
   
 
     
       
 
   
   
 
     
       
 
   
   
 
     
       
 
     
       
 
   
     
       
 
   
   
   
 
   
 
     
       
 
   
   
ii.

Change in reporting currency

Mesoblast  Limited  changed  its  reporting  currency  from  Australian  dollars  to  U.S.  dollars  and  has  recast  its  consolidated 
financial statements for the year ended June 30, 2015. The reporting currency was changed to align with the expectations of the users 
of the financial statements.

iii.

Change in comparative figures

Comparative figures, are, where appropriate, reclassified to be comparable with figures presented in the current period.

The Company routinely reviews the financial statements for opportunities to improve the quality of financial reporting. For the 
year  ended  June  30,  2017  the  Group  identified  an  opportunity  to  enhance  the  presentation  of  the  Fair  value  remeasurement  of 
contingent  consideration  and  associated  unwinding  of  the  discount  rate  recorded  within  Finance  costs  in  the  Consolidated  Income 
Statement.  The  Group  considered  that  the  change  in  contingent  consideration  is  primarily  due  to  changes  in  assumptions  about  the 
settlement of the contingent consideration and these line items in the Consolidated Income Statement should therefore be reported in 
aggregate, to provide more relevant information to the users of the financial statements.

The impact of the reclassification of the prior period financial statements is summarized below:

(in U.S. dollars, in thousands)
Fair value remeasurement of contingent
   consideration
Finance costs

Year Ended June 30,

Previously
reported  

2016
Currently
reported  

Effect of
change

Previously
reported  

2015
Currently
reported  

Effect of
change

37,423   28,112  
— 
(9,311) 

(9,311)  
9,311 

(6,830)   (15,336)  
— 
(8,506) 

(8,506)
8,506

 iv.  New and amended standards adopted by the Group

There were no new or amended accounting standards that were applicable to the Group for the June 30, 2017 reporting period. 

 iv. New accounting standards and interpretations not yet adopted

Certain  new  accounting  standards  and  interpretations  have  been  published  that  are  not  mandatory  for  the  June  30,  2017 
reporting period. The Group has not elected to apply any pronouncements before their operative date in the annual reporting period 
beginning July 1, 2016.

Initial application of the following Standards is not expected to affect any of the amounts recognized or disclosures made in the 
current  financial  report  and  management  do  not  consider  these  new  accounting  standards  to  have  a  material  impact  on  future 
transactions  made  in  relation  to  the  Group.  The  Group  is  in  the  process  of  assessing  the  impact  of  these  new  standards  on  its 
accounting policy.

The following standards applicable to the Group but are not yet adopted are summarized below:

Title

Key requirements

IFRS 9 Financial 
Instruments 

IFRS 9 introduced revisions in the following areas:

•    Classification and measurement – replacement of the existing 
complex rule-based requirements with a principle-based 
approach which is driven by cash flow characteristics and 
business model;

•    Impairment – a single impairment model to be applied to all 
financial instruments where expected credit losses must be 
accounted for from when the financial instruments are first 
recognized. This requirement lowers the threshold for 
recognition of full lifetime expected losses.

•    Hedge accounting – a reformed model for hedge accounting 
with enhanced disclosures about risk management activity. 

Effective
Date

Annual reporting periods 
commencing on or after 
January 1, 2018

The Group does not intend to 
adopt IFRS 9 before its 
mandatory date.

The Group is currently 
evaluating the effect that the 
updated IFRS 9 will have on 
the consolidated financial 
statements and related 
disclosures.

182

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
IFRS 15 Revenue from 
Contracts with Customers 

IFRS 15 provides a single, principles based five-step model to be 
applied to all contracts with customers.

The five steps in the model are as follows:

•    Identify the contract with the customer
•    Identify the performance obligations in the contract
•    Determine the transaction price
•    Allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations in 

the contracts

•    Recognize revenue when (or as) the entity satisfies a 

performance obligation.

Guidance is provided on topics such as the point in which revenue is 
recognized, accounting for variable consideration, costs of fulfilling 
and obtaining a contract and various related matters. New disclosures 
about revenue are also introduced.

IFRS 16 Leases 

IFRS 16 eliminates the classification of leases as either operating 
leases or finance leases for a lessee; they are recognized on the 
balance sheet as they are treated in a similar way to finance leases 
applying IAS 17. Leases are ‘capitalized’ by recognizing the present 
value of the lease payments and showing them either as lease assets 
(right-of-use assets) or together with property, plant and equipment. If 
lease payments are made over time, a financial liability is required to 
be recognized to represent the obligation to make future lease 
payments.
There is little change for the accounting for a lessor.

Annual reporting periods 
commencing on or after 
January 1, 2018

The Group does not intend to 
adopt IFRS 15 before its 
mandatory date.

While currently not 
considered material to the 
Group, the Group is 
evaluating the impact of 
IFRS 15 on key contracts and 
the effect the updated 
standard will have on the 
consolidated financial 
statements and related 
disclosures.

Annual reporting periods 
commencing on or after 
January 1, 2019

The Group does not intend to 
adopt IFRS 16 before its 
mandatory date. 

Refer to Notes 14 (b) and (c) 
for the lease commitments 
the Group holds as a lessee 
and lessor. 

The Group is currently 
evaluating the effect that the 
updated IFRS 
16 will have on the 
consolidated financial 
statements and related 
disclosures.

b.

i.

Principles of consolidation

Subsidiaries

The consolidated financial statements incorporate the assets and liabilities of all subsidiaries of Mesoblast Limited (“Company” 
or  “Parent  Entity”)  as  of  June  30,  2017  and  the  results  of  all  subsidiaries  for  the  year  then  ended.  Mesoblast  Limited  and  its 
subsidiaries together are referred to in this financial report as the Group or the consolidated entity.

Subsidiaries are all entities (including structured entities) over which the Group has control. The Group controls an entity when 
the Group is exposed to, or has rights to, variable returns from its involvement with the entity and has the ability to affect those returns 
through its power to direct the activities of the entity.

Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. They are deconsolidated from the 

date that control ceases.

The acquisition method of accounting is used to account for business combinations by the Group.

183

 
Intercompany transactions, balances and unrealized gains on transactions between Group companies are eliminated. Unrealized 
losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of the impairment of the asset transferred. Accounting policies of 
subsidiaries have been changed where necessary to ensure consistency with the policies adopted by the Group.

ii.

Employee share trust

The Group has formed a trust to administer the Group’s employee share scheme. This trust is consolidated, as the substance of 

the relationship is that the trust is controlled by the Group.

c.

Segment reporting

The Group predominately operates in one segment as set out in Note 2.

d.

(i)

Foreign currency translation

Functional and presentation currency

Items  included  in  the  financial  statements  of  each  of  the  Group’s  entities  are  measured  using  the  currency  of  the  primary 
economic environment in which the entity operates (the “functional currency”). The functional currency of Mesoblast Limited is the 
AUD. The consolidated financial statements are presented in USD, which is the Group’s presentation currency.

(ii)

Translations and balances

Foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the 
transactions. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the transaction at period 
end exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognized in net loss, except when they 
are deferred in equity as qualifying cash flow hedges and qualifying net investment hedges or attributable to part of the net investment 
in a foreign operation.

Non-monetary  items  that  are  measured  at  fair  value  in  a  foreign  currency  are  translated  using  the  exchange  rates  at  the  date 
when the fair value was determined. Translation differences on assets and liabilities carried at fair value are reported as part of the fair 
value  gain  or  loss.  For  example,  translation  differences  on  non-monetary  assets  and  liabilities  such  as  equities  held  at  fair  value 
through profit or loss are recognized in net loss as part of the fair value gain or loss and translation differences on non-monetary assets 
such as equities classified as available for sale financial assets are recognized in other comprehensive income.

(iii) Group companies

The results and financial position of all the Group entities (none of which has the currency of a hyperinflationary economy) that 

have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated into the presentation currency as follows:

•

•

assets and liabilities for the balance sheets presented are translated at the closing rate at the date of that balance sheets;

income and expenses for the statements of comprehensive income are translated at average exchange rates (unless this is not a 
reasonable  approximation  of  the  cumulative  effect  of  the  rates  prevailing  on  the  transaction  dates,  in  which  case  income  and 
expenses  are  translated  at  the  dates  of  the  transactions);  and  all  resulting  exchange  differences  are  recognized  in  other 
comprehensive income.

(iv) Other

On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of any net investment in foreign entities, and of borrowings 
and  other  financial  instruments  designated  as  hedges  of  such  investments,  are  recognized  in  other  comprehensive  income.  When  a 
foreign  operation  is  sold  or  any  borrowings  forming  part  of  the  net  investment  are  repaid,  the  associated  exchange  differences  are 
reclassified to net loss, as part of the gain or loss on sale.

Goodwill  and  fair  value  adjustments  arising  on  the  acquisition  of  a  foreign  entity  are  treated  as  assets  and  liabilities  of  the 

foreign entities and translated at the closing rate.

e.

Revenue recognition

Revenue  is  measured  at  the  fair  value  of  the  consideration  received  or  receivable.  Amounts  disclosed  as  revenue  are  net  of 

returns, trade allowances, rebates and amounts collected on behalf of third parties.

184

The  Group  recognizes  revenue  when  the  amount  of  revenue  can  be  reliably  measured,  it  is  probable  that  future  economic 
benefits will flow to the entity and specific criteria have been met for each of the Group’s activities as described below. The Group 
bases its estimates on historical results, taking into consideration the type of customer, the type of transaction and the specifics of each 
arrangement.

Revenue is recognized for the major business activities as follows:

(i)

Commercialization and milestone revenue

Commercialization and milestone revenue generally includes non-refundable up-front license and collaboration fees; milestone 
payments, the receipt of which is dependent upon the achievement of certain clinical, regulatory or commercial milestones; as well as 
royalties on product sales of licensed products, if and when such product sales occur; and revenue from the supply of products.

Where  such  arrangements  can  be  divided  into  separately  identifiable  components  (each  component  constituting  a  separate 
earnings  process),  the  arrangement  consideration  is  allocated  to  the  different  components  based  on  their  relative  fair  values  and 
recognized over the respective performance period in accordance with IAS 18 Revenue. Where the components of the arrangement 
cannot be divided into separate units, the individual deliverables are combined as a single unit of accounting and the total arrangement 
consideration is recognized over the estimated collaboration period. Such analysis requires considerable estimates and judgments to be 
made  by  us,  including  the  relative  fair  values  of  the  various  elements  included  in  such  agreements  and  the  estimated  length  of  the 
respective performance periods.

Amounts  received  prior  to  satisfying  the  revenue  recognition  criteria  are  recorded  as  deferred  revenue  in  our  consolidated 
balance sheets. Amounts expected to be recognized as revenue within the 12 months following the balance sheet date are classified as 
deferred  revenue,  within  current  liabilities.  Amounts  not  expected  to  be  recognized  as  revenue  within  the  12  months  following  the 
balance sheet date are classified as deferred revenue, within non-current liabilities.

Cephalon arrangement

In December 2010, the Group entered into a development and commercialization agreement (the “DCA”) with Cephalon, Inc., 
now a wholly-owned subsidiary of Teva Pharmaceutical Industries Ltd (collectively “Teva”), which allowed for Teva to obtain world-
wide rights to commercialize specific products based on the Group’s proprietary adult stem cell technology platform. As part of the 
DCA,  the  Group  received  $130.0  million  as  a  non-refundable  up-front  payment.  In  the  month  of  June  2016,  Teva  exercised  a 
contractual  right  under  the  DCA  to  end  the  joint  development  of  the  lead  asset  in  the  Group’s  cardiovascular  portfolio,  product 
candidate MPC-150-IM, and the Group regained full world-wide rights on this product candidate.

As the joint development of product candidate MPC-150-IM was ended in June 2016, the remaining full amounts of deferred 
revenues were brought to account, resulting in a total of $37.5 million of commercialization revenue recognized during the year ended 
June  30,  2016.  The  recognition  of  commercialization  revenue  relating  to  the  deferred  revenue  amounts  in  the  year  ended  June  30, 
2016 had no impact to cash flows as the cash receipt pertaining to these deferred revenues recognized was received in the year ended 
June 30, 2011. There are no further performance obligations required of us in relation to this product candidate. 

For the year ended June 30, 2015, the Group recognized $15.0 million of revenue, being the amortization of the initial payment 
over the estimated development program term. During the period from the initial recognition date until June 2016, the revenue was 
being recognized on a straight line basis over the estimated development period of product candidate, MPC-150-IM and had no impact 
to  cash  flows  as  the  cash  receipt  pertaining  to  this  revenue  was  received  in  the  year  ended  June  30,  2011.  The  Group’s  policy  of 
reviewing the estimated development program term was on a quarterly basis. 

JCR arrangement

In October 2013, the Group acquired all of Osiris’ culture-expanded, MSC-based assets. These assets included assumption of a 
collaboration agreement with JCR, a research and development oriented pharmaceutical company in Japan. Revenue recognized under 
this model is limited to the amount of cash received or for which we are entitled, as JCR has the right to terminate the agreement at 
any time.

JCR  is  responsible  for  all  development  and  manufacturing  costs  including  sales  and  marketing  expenses.  Under  the  JCR 
Agreement, JCR has the right to develop the Group’s MSCs in two fields for the Japanese market: exclusive in conjunction with the 
treatment  of  hematological  malignancies  by  the  use  of  hematopoietic  stem  cells  derived  from  peripheral  blood,  cord  blood  or  bone 
marrow,  or  the  First  JCR  Field;  and  non-exclusive  for  developing  assays  that  use  liver  cells  for  non-clinical  drug  screening  and 
evaluation, or the Second JCR Field. With respect to the First JCR Field, the Group is entitled to payments when JCR reaches certain 
development and commercial milestones and to escalating double-digit royalties. These royalties are subject to possible renegotiation 

185

downward in the event of competition from non-infringing products in Japan. With respect to the Second JCR Field, we are entitled to 
a  double  digit  profit  share.  Royalty  revenue  is  recognized  upon  the  sale  of  the  related  products  provided  we  have  no  remaining 
performance obligations under the arrangement.

For  the  years  ended  June  30,  2017  and  2016,  the  Group  recognized  $1.4  million  and  $0.4  million,  respectively,  in 
commercialization  revenue  relating  to  royalty  income  earned  on  sales  of  TEMCELL  in  Japan  since  the  launch  of  the  product  on 
February  24,  2016,  by  our  licensee  JCR.  These  amounts  were  recorded  in  revenue  as  there  are  no  further  performance  obligations 
required in regards to these items.

For the year ended June 30, 2017, the Group recognized $0.5 million in milestone revenue upon our licensee, JCR, reaching 
cumulative net sales milestone for sales of TEMCELL in Japan. For the year ended June 30, 2016, the Group recognized $3.5 million 
of  milestone  revenue  from  JCR  for  the  receipt  of  full  regulatory  approval  of  TEMCELL  in  Japan,  which  is  a  milestone  under  the 
Group’s agreement with JCR. These amounts were recorded in revenue as there are no further performance obligations are required of 
the Group in relation to this income.

(ii)

Interest revenue

Interest revenue is accrued on a time basis by reference to the principal outstanding and at the effective interest rate applicable, 
which is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash receipts through the expected life of the financial asset to that asset’s net 
carrying amount.

(iii) Research and development tax incentive

The  Australian  Government  replaced  the  research  and  development  tax  concession  with  the  research  and  development  tax 

incentive from July 1, 2011. The provisions provide refundable or non-refundable tax offsets.

The research and development tax incentive applies to expenditure incurred and the use of depreciating assets in an income year 
commencing on or after July 1, 2011. A refundable tax offset is available to eligible companies with an annual aggregate turnover of 
less  than  AUD  20.0  million.  Eligible  companies  can  receive  a  refundable  tax  offset  for  a  percentage  of  their  of  their  research  and 
development spending at the rate of 45% for periods prior to June 30, 2016 and an expected rate of 43.5% for periods from July 1, 
2016. . 

The  Group’s  research  and  development  activities  are  eligible  under  an  Australian  government  tax  incentive  for  eligible 
expenditure from July 1, 2011. Management has assessed these activities and expenditure to determine which are likely to be eligible 
under the incentive scheme. At each period end management estimates and recognizes the refundable tax offset available to the Group 
based on available information at the time.

The receivable for reimbursable amounts that have not been collected is reflected in trade and other receivables in the Group’s 
consolidated  balance  sheets.   Income  associated  with  the  research  and  development  tax  incentive  is  recorded  in  the  Group’s  other 
operating income and expenses in the Group’s consolidated income statement.

f.

Research and development undertaken internally

The  Group  currently  does  not  have  any  capitalized  development  costs.  Research  expenditure  is  recognized  as  an  expense  as 
incurred.  Costs  incurred  on  development  projects,  which  consist  of  preclinical  and  clinical  trials,  manufacturing  development,  and 
general  research,  are  recognized  as  intangible  assets  when  it  is  probable  that  the  project  will,  after  considering  its  commercial  and 
technical feasibility, be completed and generate future economic benefits and its costs can be measured reliably.

The expenditure capitalized comprises all directly attributable costs, including costs of materials, services, direct labor and an 
appropriate proportion of overheads. Other development costs that do not meet these criteria are expensed as incurred. Development 
costs previously recognized as expenses, are not recognized as an asset in a subsequent period, and will remain expensed. Capitalized 
development costs are recorded as intangible assets and amortized from the point at which the asset is ready for use on a straight-line 
basis over its useful life.

g.

Income tax

The  income  tax  expense  or  benefit  for  the  period  is  the  tax  payable  on  the  current  period’s  taxable  income  based  on  the 
applicable  income  tax  rate  for  each  jurisdiction  adjusted  by  changes  in  deferred  tax  assets  and  liabilities  attributable  to  temporary 
differences and to unused tax losses.

186

The  current  income  tax  charge  is  calculated  on  the  basis  of  the  tax  laws  enacted  or  substantively  enacted  at  the  end  of  the 
reporting  period  in  the  countries  where  the  Group’s  subsidiaries  and  associates  operate  and  generate  taxable  income.  Management 
periodically  evaluates  positions  taken  in  tax  returns  with  respect  to  situations  in  which  applicable  tax  regulation  is  subject  to 
interpretation. It establishes provisions where appropriate on the basis of amounts expected to be paid to the tax authorities.

Deferred income tax is provided in full, using the liability method, on temporary differences arising between the tax bases of 
assets  and  liabilities  and  their  carrying  amounts  in  the  consolidated  financial  statements.  However,  the  deferred  income  tax  is  not 
accounted for if it arises from initial recognition of an asset or liability in a transaction other than a business combination that at the 
time of the transaction affects neither accounting, nor taxable profit or loss. Deferred income tax is determined using tax rates (and 
laws) that have been enacted or substantially enacted by the end of the reporting period and are expected to apply when the related 
deferred income tax asset is realized or the deferred income tax liability is settled.

Deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and unused tax losses only if it is probable that future 

taxable amounts will be available to utilize those temporary differences and losses.

Deferred tax liabilities and assets are not recognized for temporary differences between the carrying amount and tax bases of 
investments in controlled entities where the parent entity is able to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and 
it is probable that the differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets and liabilities 
and  when  the  deferred  tax  balances  relate  to  the  same  taxation  authority.  Current  tax  assets  and  tax  liabilities  are  offset  where  the 
entity has a legally enforceable right to offset and intends either to settle on a net basis, or to realize the asset and settle the liability 
simultaneously.

Current and deferred tax is recognized in net loss, except to the extent that it relates to items recognized in other comprehensive 

income or directly in equity. In this case, the tax is also recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, respectively.

h.

Leases

Leases  in  which  a  significant  portion  of  the  risks  and  rewards  of  ownership  are  not  transferred  to  the  Group  as  lessee  are 
classified as operating leases (Note 14). Payments made under operating leases (net of any incentives received from the lessor) are 
charged to profit or loss on a straight-line basis over the period of the lease.

Lease income from operating leases where the Group is sub-leasing to a third party is recognized in income on a straight-line 

basis over the lease term.

i.

Business combinations

The acquisition method of accounting is used to account for all business combinations, regardless of whether equity instruments 
or other assets are acquired. The consideration transferred for the acquisition of a subsidiary comprises the fair values of the assets 
transferred, the liabilities incurred and the equity interests issued by the Group. The consideration transferred also includes the fair 
value  of  any  asset  or  liability  resulting  from  a  contingent  consideration  arrangement  and  the  fair  value  of  any  pre-existing  equity 
interest in the subsidiary. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred. Identifiable assets acquired and liabilities and contingent 
liabilities assumed in a business combination are, with limited exceptions, measured initially at their fair values at the acquisition date. 
On an acquisition-by-acquisition basis, the Group recognizes any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree either at fair value or at the 
non-controlling interest’s proportionate share of the acquiree’s net identifiable assets.

The excess of the consideration transferred and the amount of any non-controlling interest in the acquiree over the fair value of 
the net identifiable assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If those amounts are less than the fair value of the net identifiable assets of 
the subsidiary acquired and the measurement of all amounts has been reviewed, the difference is recognized directly in net loss as a 
bargain purchase.

Where settlement of any part of cash consideration is deferred, the amounts payable in the future are discounted to their present 
value as at the date of exchange. The discount rate used is the entity’s incremental borrowing rate, being the rate at which a similar 
borrowing could be obtained from an independent financier under comparable terms and conditions.

Contingent  consideration  is  classified  either  as  equity  or  a  financial  liability.  Amounts  classified  as  a  financial  liability  are 

subsequently remeasured to fair value with changes in fair value recognized in profit or loss.

187

j.

Impairment of assets

Goodwill  and  intangible  assets  that  have  an  indefinite  useful  life  are  not  subject  to  amortization  and  are  tested  annually  for 
impairment or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that they might be impaired. Other assets are tested for 
impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable.

An  impairment  loss  is  recognized  for  the  amount  by  which  the  asset’s  carrying  amount  exceeds  its  recoverable  amount.  The 
recoverable  amount  is  the  higher  of  an  asset’s  fair  value  less  costs  to  dispose  and  value  in  use.  For  the  purposes  of  assessing 
impairment,  assets  are  grouped  at  the  lowest  levels  for  which  there  are  separately  identifiable  cash  inflows  which  are  largely 
independent  of  the  cash  inflows  from  other  assets  or  groups  of  assets  (cash-generating  units).  Non-financial  assets  (other  than 
goodwill) that have suffered impairment are reviewed for possible reversal of the impairment at the end of each reporting period.

k.

Cash and cash equivalents

For the purpose of presentation in the statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents includes cash on hand, deposits held at 
call with financial institutions, other short-term and highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less that are 
readily convertible to known amounts of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.

l.

Trade and other receivables

Trade  receivables  and  other  receivables  represent  the  principal  amounts  due  at  balance  date  less,  where  applicable,  any 
provision for doubtful debts. An estimate for doubtful debts is made when collection of the full amount is no longer probable and there 
is  objective  evidence  of  impairment.  Debts  which  are  known  to  be  uncollectible  are  written  off  in  the  statement  of  comprehensive 
income.  All  trade  receivables  and  other  receivables  are  recognized  at  the  value  of  the  amounts  receivable,  as  they  are  due  for 
settlement within 60 days and therefore do not require remeasurement.

m.

(i)

Investments and other financial assets

Classification

The Group classifies its financial assets in the following categories:

•

•

•

•

financial assets at fair value through profit or loss,

available-for-sale financial assets,

loans and receivables, and

held-to-maturity investments.

The classification depends on the purpose for which the investments were acquired. Management determines the classification of its 
investments at initial recognition and, in the case of assets classified as held-to-maturity, re-evaluates this designation at the end of 
each reporting period. See Note 5 for details about each type of financial asset.

(ii) Reclassification.

The Group may choose to reclassify a non-derivative trading financial asset out of the held for trading category if the financial 
asset is no longer held for the purpose of selling it in the near term. Financial assets other than loans and receivables are permitted to 
be reclassified out of the held for trading category only in rare circumstances arising from a single event that is unusual and highly 
unlikely to recur in the near term. In addition, the Group may choose to reclassify financial assets that would meet the definition of 
loans and receivables out of the held for trading or available-for-sale categories if the Group has the intention and ability to hold these 
financial assets for the foreseeable future or until maturity at the date of reclassification

Reclassifications  are  made  at  fair  value  as  of  the  reclassification  date.  Fair  value  becomes  the  new  cost  or  amortized  cost  as 
applicable, and no reversals of fair value gains or losses recorded before reclassification date are subsequently made. Effective interest 
rates  for  financial  assets  reclassified  to  loans  and  receivables  and  held-to-maturity  categories  are  determined  at  the  reclassification 
date.  Further increases in estimates of cash flows adjust effective interest rates prospectively.

188

(iii)

 Recognition and derecognition

Regular  way  purchases  and  sales  of  financial  assets  are  recognized  on  trade-date,  the  date  on  which  the  Group  commits  to 
purchase  or  sell  the  asset.  Financial  assets  are  derecognized  when  the  rights  to  receive  cash  flows  from  the  financial  assets  have 
expired or have been transferred and the Group has transferred substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership.

When securities classified as available-for-sale are sold, the accumulated fair value adjustments recognized in other comprehensive 
income are reclassified to profit or loss as gains and losses from investment securities.

(iv) Measurement

At initial recognition, the Group measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of a financial asset not at fair value 
through  profit  or  loss,  transaction  costs  that  are  directly  attributable  to  the  acquisition  of  the  financial  asset.  Transaction  costs  of 
financial assets carried at fair value through profit or loss are expensed in profit or loss.

Loans and receivables and held-to-maturity investments are subsequently carried at amortized cost using the effective interest 
method.  Available-for-sale  financial  assets  and  financial  assets  at  fair  value  through  profit  or  loss  are  subsequently  carried  at  fair 
value. Gains or losses arising from changes in the fair value are recognized as follows:

•

•

•

for ‘financial assets at fair value through profit or loss’ – in profit or loss within other income or other expenses

for  available  for  sale  financial  assets  that  are  monetary  securities  denominated  in  a  foreign  currency  –  translation 
differences related to changes in the amortized cost of the security are recognized in profit or loss and other changes in the 
carrying amount are recognized in other comprehensive income

for other monetary and non-monetary securities classified as available for sale in other comprehensive income.

Dividends  on  financial  assets  at  fair  value  through  profit  or  loss  and  available-for-sale  equity  instruments  are  recognized  in 

profit or loss as part of revenue from continuing operations when the Group’s right to receive payments is established.

Interest  income  from  financial  assets  at  fair  value  through  profit  or  loss  is  included  in  the  net  gains/(losses).  Interest  on 
available-for-sale  securities  calculated  using  the  effective  interest  method  is  recognized  in  the  income  statement  as  part  of  revenue 
from continuing operations.

Details on how the fair value of financial instruments is determined are disclosed in Note 5(f).

(v)

Impairment

The Group assesses at the end of each reporting period whether there is objective evidence that a financial asset or a group of 
financial assets is impaired. A financial asset or a group of financial assets is impaired and impairment losses are incurred only if there 
is objective evidence of impairment as a result of one or more events that occurred after the initial recognition of the asset (a ‘loss 
event’) and that loss event (or events) has an impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset or group of financial 
assets  that  can  be  reliably  estimated.  In  the  case  of  equity  investments  classified  as  available-for-sale,  a  significant  or  prolonged 
decline in the fair value of the security below its cost is considered an indicator that the assets are impaired.

Assets carried at amortized cost

For  loans  and  receivables,  the  amount  of  the  loss  is  measured  as  the  difference  between  the  asset’s  carrying  amount  and  the 
present value of estimated future cash flows (excluding future credit losses that have not been incurred) discounted at the financial 
asset’s original effective interest rate. The carrying amount of the asset is reduced and the amount of the loss is recognized in profit or 
loss. If a loan or held-to-maturity investment has a variable interest rate, the discount rate for measuring any impairment loss is the 
current effective interest rate determined under the contract. As a practical expedient, the Group may measure impairment on the basis 
of an instrument’s fair value using an observable market price.

If, in a subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event 
occurring after the impairment was recognized (such as an improvement in the debtor’s credit rating), the reversal of the previously 
recognized impairment loss is recognized in profit or loss.

189

Assets classified as available-for-sale

If  there  is  objective  evidence  of  impairment  for  available-for-sale  financial  assets,  the  cumulative  loss  –measured  as  the 
difference  between  the  acquisition  cost  and  the  current  fair  value,  less  any  impairment  loss  on  that  financial  asset  previously 
recognized in profit or loss – is removed from equity and recognized in profit or loss.

Impairment  losses  on  equity  instruments  that  were  recognized  in  profit  or  loss  are  not  reversed  through  profit  or  loss  in  a 

subsequent period.

If  the  fair  value  of  a  debt  instrument  classified  as  available-for-sale  increases  in  a  subsequent  period  and  the  increase  can  be 
objectively related to an event occurring after the impairment loss was recognized in profit or loss, the impairment loss is reversed 
through profit or loss

n.

Derivatives

Derivatives  are  initially  recognized  at  fair  value  on  the  date  a  derivative  contract  is  entered  into  and  are  subsequently 

remeasured to their fair value at the end of each reporting period.

Derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting

Certain derivative instruments do not qualify for hedge accounting. Changes in the fair value of any derivative instrument that 
does not qualify for hedge accounting are recognized immediately in profit or loss and are included in other income or other expenses.

o.

Property, plant and equipment

Plant and equipment are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment. Cost includes expenditure that is 

directly attributable to the acquisition of the item.

Subsequent cost are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognized as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is 
probable  that  future  economic  benefits  associates  with  the  item  will  flow  to  the  Group  and  the  cost  of  the  item  can  be  measured 
reliably.  All other repairs and maintenance are charged to profit and loss during the reporting period in which they are incurred.

Property, plant and equipment, other than freehold land, are depreciated over their estimated useful lives using the straight line 

method (see Note 6(a)).

The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at the end of each reporting period.

An asset’s carrying amount is written down immediately to its recoverable amount if the asset’s carrying amount is greater than 

its estimated recoverable amount.

Gains and losses on disposal of plant and equipment are taken into account in determining the profit for the year.

p.

(i)

Intangible assets

Goodwill

Goodwill is measured as described in Note 21(i) – Business combinations. Goodwill on acquisition of subsidiaries is included in 
intangible  assets  (Note  6(b)).  Goodwill  is  not  amortized  but  it  is  tested  for  impairment  annually  or  more  frequently  if  events  or 
changes  in  circumstances  indicate  that  it  might  be  impaired,  and  is  carried  at  cost  less  accumulated  impairment  losses.  Gains  and 
losses on the disposal of an entity include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the entity sold.

Goodwill  is  allocated  to  cash  generating  units  for  the  purpose  of  impairment  testing.  The  allocation  is  made  to  those  cash 
generating units or groups of cash generating units that are expected to benefit from the business combination in which the goodwill 
arose, identified according to operating segments (Note 2).

(ii)

Trademarks and licenses

Trademarks and licenses have a finite useful life and are carried at cost less accumulated amortization and impairment losses.

190

(iii)

In-process research and development acquired

In-process research and development that has been acquired as part of a business acquisition is considered to be an indefinite life 
intangible  asset  on  the  basis  that  it  is  incomplete  and  cannot  be  used  in  its  current  form.  Indefinite  life  intangible  assets  are  not 
amortized but rather are tested for impairment annually in the fourth quarter of each year, or whenever events or circumstances present 
an indication of impairment.

In-process research and development will continue to be tested for impairment until the related research and development efforts 
are  either  completed  or  abandoned.  Upon  completion  of  the  related  research  and  development  efforts,  management  determines  the 
remaining useful life of the intangible assets and amortizes them accordingly. In order for management to determine the remaining 
useful life of the asset, management would consider the expected flow of future economic benefits to the entity with reference to the 
product life cycle, competitive landscape, obsolescence, market demand, any remaining patent useful life and various other relevant 
factors.

In  the  case  of  abandonment,  the  related  research  and  development  efforts  are  considered  impaired  and  the  asset  is  fully 

expensed.

(iv) Current marketed products

Current marketed products contain products that are currently being marketed. The assets are recognized on our balance sheet as 
a  result  of  business  acquisitions  or  reclassifications  from  In-process  research  and  development  upon  completion.  Upon  completion, 
when assets become available for use, assets are reclassified from in-process research and development to current marketed products 
at the historical value that they were recognized at within the in-process research and development category.

Upon reclassification to the current market products category management determines the remaining useful life of the intangible 
assets and amortizes them from the date they become available for use. In order for management to determine the remaining useful life 
of the asset, management would consider the expected flow of future economic benefits to the entity with reference to the product life 
cycle, competitive landscape, obsolescence, market demand, any remaining patent useful life and any other relevant factors.

Management have chosen to amortize all intangible assets with a finite useful life on a straight-line basis over the useful life of 
the asset. Current marketed products are tested for impairment in accordance with IAS 36 Impairment of Assets which requires testing 
whenever there is an indication that an asset may be impaired. 

q.

Trade and other payables

Payables represent the principal amounts outstanding at balance date plus, where applicable, any accrued interest. Liabilities for 
payables and other amounts are carried at cost which approximates fair value of the consideration to be paid in the future for goods 
and services received, whether or not billed. The amounts are unsecured and are usually paid within 30 to 60 days of recognition.

r.

Provisions

Provisions are recognized when the Group has a present legal obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that the Group 

will be required to settle the obligation, and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.

Provisions  are  measured  at  the  present  value  of  management’s  best  estimate  of  the  expenditure  required  to  settle  the  present 
obligation at the end of the reporting period. The discount rate used to determine the present value is a pre-tax rate that reflects current 
market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. The increase in the provision due to the passage 
of time is recognized as interest expense.

Provisions are recorded on acquisition of a subsidiary, to the extent they relate to a subsidiary’s contingent liabilities, if it relates 

to a past event, regardless of whether it is probable the amount will be paid.

s.

Employee benefits

A  liability  is  recognized  for  benefits  accruing  to  employees  in  respect  of  wages  and  salaries,  bonuses,  annual  leave  and  long 

service leave.

Liabilities recognized in  respect  of employee  benefits  which are  expected  to  be settled within  12 months  after  the  end of  the 
period in which the employees render the related services are measured at their nominal values using the remuneration rates expected 
to apply at the time of settlement.

191

Liabilities recognized in respect of employee benefits which are not expected to be settled within 12 months after the end of the 
period in which the employees render the related services are measured as the present value of the estimated future cash outflows to be 
made by the Group in respect of services provided by employees up to reporting date.

The obligations are presented as current liabilities in the balance sheet if the entity does not have an unconditional right to defer 

settlement for at least twelve months after the reporting period, regardless of when the actual settlement is expected to occur.

Termination benefits are payable when employment is terminated by the Group before the normal retirement date, or when an 
employee accepts voluntary redundancy in exchange for these benefits.  The Group recognizes termination benefits at the earlier of the 
following  dates:  when  the  Group  can  no  longer  withdraw  the  offer  of  those  benefits  and  when  the  entity  recognizes  costs  for  a 
restructuring that is within the scope of IAS 37 and involves the payment of termination benefits.

t.

Share-based payments

Share-based  payments  are  provided  to  eligible  employees,  directors  and  consultants  via  the  Employee  Share  Option  Plan 
(“ESOP”) and the Australian Loan Funded Share Plan (“LFSP”). The terms and conditions of the LFSP are in substance the same as 
the employee share options and therefore they are accounted for on the same basis.

Equity-settled share-based payments with employees and others providing similar services are measured at the fair value of the 
equity instrument at acceptance date. Fair value is measured using the Black-Scholes model. The expected life used in the model has 
been  adjusted,  based  on  management’s  best  estimate,  for  the  effects  of  non-transferability,  exercise  restrictions,  and  behavioral 
considerations. It does not make any allowance for the impact of any service and non-market performance vesting conditions. Further 
details on how the fair value of equity-settled share-based transactions has been determined can be found in Note 17.

The fair value determined at the acceptance date of the equity-settled share-based payments is expensed on a straight-line basis 
over the vesting period, based on management’s estimate of shares that will eventually vest, with a corresponding increase in equity. 
At the end of each period, the entity revises its estimates of the number of shared-based payments that are expected to vest based on 
the  non-market  vesting  conditions.  It  recognizes  the  impact  of  the  revision  to  original  estimates,  if  any,  in  profit  or  loss,  with  a 
corresponding adjustment to equity.

u.

Contributed equity

Ordinary shares are classified as equity.

Transaction costs arising on the issue of equity instruments are recognized separately in equity. Transaction costs are the costs 
that are incurred directly in connection with the issue of those equity instruments and which would not have been incurred had those 
instruments not been issued.

v.

(i)

Loss per share

Basic losses per share

Basic losses per share is calculated by dividing:

•

•

the loss attributable to equity holders of the Group, excluding any costs of servicing equity other than ordinary shares;

by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the financial year, adjusted for bonus elements in 
ordinary shares issued during the year.

(ii) Diluted losses per share

Diluted losses per share adjusts the figures used in the determination of basic earnings per share to take into account

•

•

the after income tax effect of interest and other financing costs associated with dilutive potential ordinary shares; and

the weighted average number of shares assumed to have been issued for no consideration in relation to dilutive potential 
ordinary shares.

192

w. Goods and services tax (“GST”)

Revenues, expenses and assets are recognized net of the amount of GST except where the GST incurred on a purchase of goods 
and services is not recoverable from the taxation authority, in which case the GST is recognized as part of the cost of acquisition of the 
asset or as part of the expense.

Receivables and payables are stated with the amount of GST included. The net amount of GST recoverable from, or payable to, 

the taxation authority is included as part of receivables or payables in the Balance Sheet.

Cash flows are included in the statement of cash flow on a gross basis. The GST component of cash flows arising from investing 

and financing activities, which is recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority, are classified as operating cash flows.

x.

Rounding of amounts

Amounts in the financial statements have been rounded off to the nearest thousand dollars, or in certain cases, the nearest dollar, 

unless mentioned otherwise.

193

 
Australian Disclosure Requirements
Directors’ Declaration

In accordance with a resolution of directors of Mesoblast Limited,

In the directors’ opinion:

(a)

the financial statements and Notes set out on pages 140 to 193 are in accordance with the Corporations Act 2001, including:

(i) Complying  with  Accounting  Standards,  the  Corporations  Regulations  2001  and  other  mandatory  professional  reporting 

requirements, and

(ii) Giving  a  true  and  fair  view  of  the  consolidated  entity’s  financial  position  as  of  June  30,  2017  and  of  its  performance  for  the 

financial year ended on that date, and

(b)

There are reasonable grounds to believe that the Group will be able to pay its debts as and when they become due and payable.

Note 21(a) ‘Basis of preparation’ confirms that the financial statements also comply with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the 
International Accounting Standards Board.

The directors have been given the declarations by the chief executive officer and chief financial officer required by section 295A of the Corporations 
Act 2001.

This declaration is made in accordance with a resolution of the directors.

/s/ Brian Jamieson
Brian Jamieson
Chairman

Melbourne, August 30, 2017

/s/ Silviu Itescu
Silviu Itescu
Chief Executive Officer

194

Independent auditor’s report
To the shareholders of Mesoblast Limited

Report on the audit of the financial report

Our opinion

In our opinion:

The accompanying financial report of Mesoblast Limited (the Company) and its controlled entities
(together, the Group) is in accordance with the Corporations Act 2001, including:

a)

giving a true and fair view of the Group’s financial position as at 30 June 2017 and of its
financial performance for the year then ended

b)

complying with Australian Accounting Standards and the Corporations Regulations 2001.

What we have audited
The Group financial report comprises:















the consolidated balance sheet as at 30 June 2017

the consolidated income statement for the year then ended

the consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the year then ended

the consolidated statement of changes in equity for the year then ended

the consolidated statement of cash flows for the year then ended

the notes to the consolidated financial statements, which include a summary of significant
accounting policies

the directors’ declaration

Basis for opinion

We conducted our audit in accordance with Australian Auditing Standards. Our responsibilities under
those standards are further described in the Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial
report section of our report.

We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for
our opinion.

Independence

We are independent of the Group in accordance with the auditor independence requirements of the
Corporations Act 2001 and the ethical requirements of the Accounting Professional and Ethical
Standards Board’s APES 110 Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants (the Code) that are relevant
to our audit of the financial report in Australia. We have also fulfilled our other ethical responsibilities
in accordance with the Code.

PricewaterhouseCoopers, ABN 52 780 433 757
2 Riverside Quay, Southbank VIC 3006, GPO BOX 1331, Melbourne VIC 3001
T +61 3 8603 1000, F +61 3 8603 1999, www.pwc.com.au

Liability limited by a scheme approved under Professional Standards Legislation.

195

Material uncertainty related to going concern

We draw attention to Note 1 in the financial report, which indicates that the Group incurred net cash
outflows from operations of $95.5 million. As a result, the Group is dependent on entering into a
partnership with a third party for funding of operations and/or raising capital through the issue of new
shares, together with successfully implementing certain cost containment and deferment strategies.
These conditions, along with other matters set forth in Note 1, indicate the existence of a material
uncertainty that may cast significant doubt about the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern.
Our opinion is not modified in respect of this matter.

Our audit approach

An audit is designed to provide reasonable assurance about whether the financial report is free from
material misstatement. Misstatements may arise due to fraud or error. They are considered material if
individually or in aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic decisions of
users taken on the basis of the financial report.

We tailored the scope of our audit to perform enough work to be able to give an opinion on the
financial report as a whole, taking into account the geographic and management structure of the
Group, its accounting processes and controls and the industry in which it operates.

The Group is a Research and Development (R&D) stage biopharmaceutical entity headquartered in
Melbourne, Australia and is in the process of developing innovative cell-based medicines. The Group
has operations in Australia, the United States and Singapore with key management functions,
including finance, performed in Melbourne, Australia.

Materiality

For the purpose of our audit we used overall group materiality of $4 million, which represents
approximately 5% of the Group’s adjusted loss before tax of continuing operations.

We applied this threshold, together with qualitative considerations, to determine the scope of our
audit and the nature, timing and extent of our audit procedures and to evaluate the effect of
misstatements on the financial report as a whole.

We chose loss before tax of continuing operations as the benchmark because, in our view, it is the
metric against which the performance of the Company is most commonly measured. We adjusted for
the non-cash impact of fair value re-measurements of the contingent consideration as it is an unusual

196

or infrequently occurring item.

We utilised a 5% threshold based on our professional judgement, noting it is within the range of
commonly acceptable thresholds.

Audit scope

Our audit focused on where the Group made subjective judgements; for example, significant
accounting estimates involving assumptions and inherently uncertain future events.

Audit procedures were performed over the Australian, United States and Singaporean operations to
enable us to give an opinion on the financial report as a whole. Under instruction and supervision by
PwC Australia, local component auditors in the United States assisted with the procedures.
Key audit matters

Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in
our audit of the financial report for the current period. The key audit matters were addressed in the
context of our audit of the financial report as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon, and we do
not provide a separate opinion on these matters. Further, any commentary on the outcomes of a
particular audit procedure is made in that context.

Amongst other relevant topics, we communicated the following key audit matters to the Audit and Risk
Committee except for the material uncertainty related to going concern matter which is described in
the Material uncertainty related to going concern section.

Key audit matter

How our audit addressed the key audit matter

Carrying value of in-process research
and development (IPRD) acquired
Refer to note 6b in the financial report
The Group recognised an IPRD asset of $427.8
million at 30 June 2017, which is considered to
be an intangible asset subject to annual
impairment testing at the cash generating unit
level, which is the product level.

The recoverable amount of IPRD is derived
from its estimated future cash flows (the
models) and there is a risk that if these cash
flows do not meet the Group’s expectations the
assets may be impaired.

The Directors engage a 3rd party valuation
advisor on a triannual basis to assist with the
valuation of IPRD, with the year ended 30
June 2017 being subject to 3rd party valuation
assistance.

There are a number of significant judgements
and estimates in determining the recoverable

In designing our audit approach for the key audit
matter we leverage information supporting key
assumptions from prior years to serve as a
baseline for assessing future cash flows in the year
ended 30 June 2017. We take this approach
because the assets subject to testing are still in the
research and development stage with no historical
performance information to compare to.
Consequently we focused on relevant changes to
underlying key assumptions in the period given
the long development time of the IPRD products.

We assessed the competency, capabilities and
objectivity of the Group’s 3rd party valuation
adviser based on their qualifications, industry
experience, and scope of work performed.

We assessed whether the models used were
consistent with the requirements of Australian
Accounting Standards through assessing the scope
of work by the valuation advisor.

197

Key audit matter
amount of the IPRD for each product’s cash
flows including estimated market penetration
for each program through to patent expiry,
cost of goods sold, selling costs, clinical trial
schedules, and discount rates.

The carrying value of IPRD is also dependent
on the continued successful development of
the underlying technology platform and the
late stage product candidates.

We focused on this area due to the significant
carrying amount of IPRD assets relative to
total assets of the Group along with the
significant and complex judgements and
estimates by the Group underlying the
impairment assessment.

Carrying value of goodwill
Refer to note 6b in the financial report
The Group recognised goodwill at year end of
$134.5 million, which is tested by the Group
for impairment annually. Goodwill arose from
the acquisition of Angioblast Systems, Inc in
the year ended 30 June 2011 and the
acquisition of Osiris Therapeutics, Inc.’s stem
cell business in the year ending 30 June 2014.

Goodwill is assessed for impairment at the
Group level.

The Group review a number of sources of
information to determine whether an
impairment of Goodwill is required. For the
year ended 30 June 2017 a 3rd party valuation
adviser was engaged to assist with a whole of
business valuation. Additionally, the Director’s
focus on whether the estimated cash flows of

198

How our audit addressed the key audit matter
We assessed the valuation advisor’s consideration
of key inputs underpinning the models to
independent third party sources and comparable
company benchmarks. We placed greater
emphasis on the IPRD valuations where the
strategic focus had changed from the prior year,
with specific focus on developments in the
Group’s Phase 3 trial for Chronic Heart Failure
and the status of potential strategic partnerships
for IPRD assets. For other important inputs
underpinning the models we considered whether
they were based on supportable assumptions.

Assisted by PwC internal valuation experts, we
independently calculated a range of discount rates
through a benchmark analysis of comparable
companies and compared the range to the
discount rates used by the Group.

We obtained and checked the Group’s sensitivity
analysis and performed certain independent
sensitivities to ascertain the impact of reasonably
possible changes in the key assumptions in the
models.

We considered the results of clinical trials and
platform technology updates announced by the
Group.

We considered the Group’s assessment of
Goodwill allocation at the group level based on the
level at which the Group’s performance and
allocation of resources is analysed by the Chief
Operating Decision Maker. We also considered
synergies realised from historical business
combinations in assessing whether impairment
testing over goodwill should be performed at the
group level.

We obtained the valuation for the IPRD assets.
We leveraged audit evidence obtained in assessing
the carrying value of IPRD (described in the
previous key audit matter) and considered if the
total fair value of intangible assets in the valuation
models was higher than their book amount,
including goodwill, in the aggregate.

We assessed the valuation adviser’s analysis of the
total fair value of intangibles assets compared

Key audit matter
product intangible assets (discussed within in-
process research and development above)
support the goodwill balance, scientific results
and progress of clinical trials, and the implied
valuation of the Group as the result of recent
capital raises.

Similar to IPRD, the recoverable amount of
Goodwill is dependent on the continued
successful development of the underlying
technology platform and the late stage product
candidates.

We focused on this area because the
determination of whether or not an
impairment charge for goodwill was necessary
involved significant judgements made by the
Group. The judgements made in valuing in-
process research and development assets are
also relevant for the annual Goodwill
impairment test because of their magnitude
relative to the cash generating unit.

Valuation of contingent consideration
Refer to note 5f in the financial report
The contingent consideration liability arises
from the purchase of Osiris Therapeutics,
Inc.’s stem cell business in the year ended 30
June 2014. The Group is liable for future fixed
and variable payments arising from milestones
achieved and sales from acquired products for
a specified period of time, paid in the form of
royalties.

The Group makes a number of significant
judgements in determining the appropriate
value for the liability at period end.
Underpinning the liability is the financial
information used in developing cash flow
forecasts for the in-process research and
development (IPRD) valuation model
discussed above. Additionally, other
information such as the risk-adjusted discount
rate for the contingent consideration liability is
assessed. The Group focuses on key changes to
assumptions underpinning the estimate during
the period in determining whether the liability
is materially accurate at 30 June 2017.

199

How our audit addressed the key audit matter
with the Company’s market capitalisation at 30
June 2017 and the Company’s historical share
price trends.

We obtained the reports of certain independent
securities analysts who periodically publish
estimates of their calculation of the fair value of
the enterprise and assumptions underlying this.
We compared the average enterprise fair value of
analyst reports obtained with the net assets of the
Group.

As the Group utilises a discounted cash flow
calculation, similar to that used for the valuation
of intangible assets, we agreed the significant
assumptions of patient population, development
timelines, and sales price in the liability
calculation to those which were utilised in the
IPRD model.

We developed an understanding of the drivers of
the most significant change in the valuation of the
contingent consideration for the period. Changes
related primarily to refinements in development
plans and impacted the related timelines for the
underlying products acquired from Osiris
Therapeutics, Inc. We agreed changes to
development plans to underlying management
approved documentation, and where applicable,
documentation assessed by parties external to the
Group.

We engaged PwC valuation experts to
independently calculate an appropriate range of
discount rates for our goodwill and IPRD
impairment testing. We used the results of this
analysis as a reference point to compare to the
discount rate applied by the Group for the

Key audit matter

How our audit addressed the key audit matter
calculation of contingent consideration.

We focused on this area due to the size of the
liability relative to the total liabilities of the
Group and the potentially significant impact to
the financial statements of changes in key
judgemental assumptions.

Other information

The directors are responsible for the other information. The other information comprises of
information included in the annual report for the year ended 30 June 2017 (but does not include the
financial report and our auditor’s report thereon). We obtained some of the other information prior to
the date of this auditor’s report and expect the remaining other information to be made available to us
after the date of this auditor’s report.

Our opinion on the financial report does not cover the other information and we do not and will not
express an opinion or any form of assurance conclusion thereon.

In connection with our audit of the financial report, our responsibility is to read the other information
identified above and, in doing so, consider whether the other information is materially inconsistent
with the financial report or our knowledge obtained in the audit, or otherwise appears to be materially
misstated.

If, based on the work we have performed on the other information that we obtained prior to the date of
this auditor’s report, we conclude that there is a material misstatement of this other information, we
are required to report that fact. We have nothing to report in this regard.

When we receive the other information not yet received as identified above, if we conclude that there is
a material misstatement therein, we are required to communicate the matter to the directors and use
our professional judgement to determine the appropriate action to take.

Responsibilities of the directors for the financial report

The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation of the financial report that gives a
true and fair view in accordance with Australian Accounting Standards and the Corporations Act 2001
and for such internal control as the directors determine is necessary to enable the preparation of the
financial report that gives a true and fair view and is free from material misstatement, whether due to
fraud or error.

In preparing the financial report, the directors are responsible for assessing the ability of the Group to
continue as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern and using the
going concern basis of accounting unless the directors either intend to liquidate the Group or to cease
operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so.

Auditor’s responsibilities for the audit of the financial report

Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial report as a whole is free
from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue an auditor’s report that

200

includes our opinion. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but is not a guarantee that an
audit conducted in accordance with the Australian Auditing Standards will always detect a material
misstatement when it exists. Misstatements can arise from fraud or error and are considered material
if, individually or in the aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic
decisions of users taken on the basis of the financial report.

A further description of our responsibilities for the audit of the financial report is located at the
Auditing and Assurance Standards Board website at:
http://www.auasb.gov.au/auditors_responsibilities/ar1.pdf
This description forms part of our auditor’s report.

Report on the remuneration report

Our opinion on the remuneration report

We have audited the remuneration report included in pages 92 to 112 of the directors’ report for the
year ended 30 June 2017.

In our opinion, the remuneration report of Mesoblast Limited for the year ended 30 June 2017
complies with section 300A of the Corporations Act 2001.

Responsibilities

The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation and presentation of the
remuneration report in accordance with section 300A of the Corporations Act 2001. Our responsibility
is to express an opinion on the remuneration report, based on our audit conducted in accordance with
Australian Auditing Standards.

PricewaterhouseCoopers

Jon Roberts
Partner
Melbourne
30 August 2017

201

Item 19.

Exhibits

Item

1.1

1.2

4.1

4.2
4.3†

4.4

4.5

4.6†

4.7

4.8

4.9†

4.10†

4.11

4.12

4.13

4.14

4.15

4.16#

4.17#

4.18#

4.19

Constitution of Mesoblast Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s Registration Statement on 
Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Certificate of Registration of Mesoblast Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Registration 
Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Form of Deposit Agreement between Mesoblast Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as depositary, and Holders of the 
American Depositary Receipts (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form 
F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Form of American Depositary Receipt evidencing American Depositary Shares (included in Exhibit 4.1).
Development and Commercialization Agreement by and between Angioblast Systems, Inc. and Cephalon, Inc., dated 
December 7, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed 
with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Clinical Trial Agreement by and between The National Heart, Lung, and Blood Institute and Mesoblast, Inc. dated July 28, 
2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC 
on November 2, 2015).
Subscription Deed by and between Mesoblast Limited and Cephalon International Holdings, Inc., dated December 2010 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on 
November 2, 2015).
Manufacturing Services Agreement by and between Mesoblast Limited and Lonza Walkersville, Inc. and Lonza Bioscience 
Singapore Pte. Ltd., dated September 20, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Company’s Registration 
Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Purchase Agreement by and between Mesoblast International Sàrl and Osiris Therapeutics, Inc., dated October 10, 2013 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on 
November 2, 2015).
Amendment #1 to Purchase Agreement by and between Mesoblast International Sàrl and Osiris Therapeutics, Inc., dated 
December 17, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed 
with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
License Agreement by and between Osiris Acquisition II, Inc. and JCR Pharmaceuticals Co., Ltd., dated August 26, 2003 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on 
November 2, 2015).
Amendment 1 to License Agreement by and between Osiris Acquisition II, Inc. and JCR Pharmaceuticals Co., Ltd., dated 
June 27, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with 
the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Technology Transfer and License Agreement by and between Case Western Reserve University and Osiris Therapeutics, 
Inc., dated January 1, 1993 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-
1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Amendment Number 1 to Technology Transfer and License Agreement by and between Case Western Reserve University 
and Osiris Therapeutics, Inc., dated November 3, 1993 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the Company’s 
Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Amendment to the Technology Transfer and License Agreement by and between Case Western Reserve University and 
Osiris Therapeutics, Inc., dated October 18, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s Registration 
Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Third Amendment to Technology Transfer and License Agreement by and between Case Western Reserve University and 
Osiris Therapeutics, Inc., dated October 27, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to the Company’s Registration 
Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Intellectual Property Assignment Deed by and between Mesoblast Limited and Medvet Science Pty Ltd, dated October 4, 
2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC 
on November 2, 2015).
Loan Funded Share Plan Rules, as amended, and form of loan agreement thereunder (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 
10.17 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Employee Share Option Plan Rules, and form of option agreement thereunder (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to 
the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Employment Agreement, dated August 8, 2014, by and between Mesoblast Limited and Silviu Itescu (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.19 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Agreement of Sub-Sublease, by and between Mesoblast Limited and Carlo Pazolini (USA), LLC, dated September 23, 2013 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on 
November 2, 2015).

202

4.20

4.21

4.22

4.23

8.1
10 
12.1 

12.2 

13.1 

13.2 

99.1  
99.2

#
†

Sublease, by and between Mesoblast Limited and CIT Group Inc., dated September 27, 2011 (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10.21 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Sublease, by and between Mesoblast Limited and Collins Place Pty Ltd, AMP Capital Investors Limited, and Australia and 
New Zealand Banking Group Limited, dated April 21, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to the Company’s 
Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Form of 2012 Deed of Indemnity, Insurance and Access (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the Company’s 
Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
Form of 2014 Deed of Indemnity, Insurance and Access (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to the Company’s 
Registration Statement on Form F-1 filed with the SEC on November 2, 2015).
List of Significant Subsidiaries of Mesoblast Limited. 
Consent of independent registered public accounting firm.
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934, as adopted pursuant to section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to rules 13a-14(a) and 15d-14(a) under the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934, as adopted pursuant to section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
Appendix 4E preliminary final report for the twelve months to June 30, 2017.
Auditor’s independence declaration, dated August 30, 2017.

Indicates management contract or compensatory plan.
Confidential treatment has been requested for portions of this exhibit. These portions have been omitted and have been filed 
separately with the Securities and Exchange Commission.

203

SIGNATURES

The  registrant  hereby  certifies  that  it  meets  all  of  the  requirements  for  filing  on  Form  20-F  and  that  it  has  duly  caused  and 

authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

Mesoblast Limited

By:
Name:
Title:

By:
Name:
Title:

/s/ Brian Jamieson
Brian Jamieson
Chairman

/s/ Silviu Itescu
Silviu Itescu
Chief Executive Officer

Dated: August 30, 2017

204

SHAREHOLDER INFORMATION

A.  Substantial Shareholder   

Holders of substantial holdings of ordinary shares in the Company and the numbers of shares in which they and their associates have a relevant 
interest as of 30 September 2017: 

Shareholder 

Professor Silviu Itescu 

M&G Investment Group 

Cephalon, Inc. 

Capital Research Global Investors 

Thorney Holdings Pty Ltd 

Number of ordinary shares held 

68,958,928 

65,452,353 

55,785,806 

30,364,000 

24,696,000 

B.  Distribution of Equity Securities and Voting Rights 

Distribution of holders of equity securities as of 30 September 2017:

Range 

1 – 1,000 

1,001 – 5,000 

5,001 – 10,000 

10,001 – 100,000 

100,001 and Over 

Total number of holders of equity securities 

Ordinary shares (i) 

Options (ii)(1)

3,653 

4,200 

1,323 

1,491 

131 

10,798 

–

–

30

8

40

78

Number of holders of less than a marketable parcel of 365 shares ($1.37 per share) 

1,287 

(1) There are 22,200,246 Options on issue as of 30 September 2017. 

The voting rights attaching to each class of equity securities are: 

i.  Ordinary shares 

On a show of hands, every member present at a meeting, in person or by proxy, shall have one vote and upon a poll each share shall have  
one vote.   

ii.  Options 

No voting rights. 

205  MESOBLAST LIMITED 2017 ANNUAL REPORT

 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
C.  Twenty Largest Holders of Quoted Securities

The names of the 20 largest shareholders of each class of equity security as of 30 September 2017 are listed below. 

Rank  Name 

No. of shares held 

% of total shares

1 

2 

3 

4 

5 

6 

7 

8 

9 

10 

11 

12 

13 

14 

15 

16 

17 

18 

19 

20 

HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited  

Professor Silviu Itescu  

Cephalon Inc.  

J P Morgan Nominees Australia Limited  

Cache Holdings Limited  

Lalp Pty Ltd  

Citicorp Nominees Pty Limited  

UBS Nominees Pty Ltd  

Dalit Pty Ltd  

HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited – A/C 3  

Mesoblast Australia Pty Ltd(1) 

Mr Paul Cozzi  

BNP Paribas Noms Pty Ltd  

Adelaide Health Services Inc  

HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited  

Dalit Pty Ltd 

HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited – A/C 2  

Beth Sackstein  

HSBC Custody Nominees (Australia) Limited-Gsco Eca  

Tigcorp Nominees Pty Ltd  

148,505,017 

67,751,838 

52,395,656 

36,744,438 

20,044,771 

14,934,000 

7,927,969 

6,389,318 

4,468,839 

4,090,044 

3,500,000 

2,100,768 

2,086,162 

1,953,000 

1,675,561 

1,445,000 

1,438,064 

1,277,210 

1,192,911 

1,060,000 

31.57

14.40

11.14

7.81

4.26

3.17

1.69

1.36

0.95

0.87

0.74

0.45

0.44

0.42

0.36

0.31

0.31

0.27

0.25

0.23

(1) As trustee for the Mesoblast Limited Employee Share Trust, held on behalf of employees who participate in the Company’s loan funded share plan. 

380,980,566 

80.98

D.  Securities under escrow   

As of 30 September 2017, there are 20,044,771 ordinary shares in the Company subject to escrow.   The escrow period on these 20,044,771 
ordinary shares will expire on 6 January 2018. 

E.  On-Market Buy-Back 

There is no current on-market buy-back of the Company’s ordinary shares. 

F.  Stock Exchanges 

The Company’s ordinary shares are listed on the Australian Securities Exchange and are traded under the symbol ‘MSB’. The Company’s 
American Depositary Shares, each representing five ordinary shares, are listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market and are traded under 
the symbol ‘MESO’. 

MESOBLAST LIMITED 2017 ANNUAL REPORT 206

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CORPORATE DIRECTORY

Directors 

Share Registry 

Link Market Services Limited
Tower 4
727 Collins Street
Melbourne VIC 3008
Telephone +61 1300 554 474 
Facsimile +61 2 9287 0303 
www.linkmarketservices.com.au 

Auditors

PricewaterhouseCoopers
Level 19, 2 Riverside Quay
Southbank VIC 3006
Telephone +61 3 8603 1000
Facsimile +61 3 8603 1999

Brian Jamieson (Chairman) 
Silviu Itescu 
William Burns 
Donal O’Dwyer 
Eric Rose 
Michael Spooner 
Ben-Zion Weiner

Company Secretary 

Charles Harrison  

Registered Office

Level 38 
55 Collins Street 
Melbourne VIC 3000 
Telephone +61 3 9639 6036 
Facsimile +61 3 9639 6030 

Country of Incorporation 

Australia 

Listing 

Australian Securities Exchange 
(ASX Code: MSB)

NASDAQ Global Select Market 
(NASDAQ Code: MESO) 

Website 

www.mesoblast.com 

207  MESOBLAST LIMITED 2017 ANNUAL REPORT